Pharmaceutical Compositions and Administrations Thereof

Abstract
The present invention relates to pharmaceutical compositions comprising a compound of Formulas I and II, optionally in combination with a Compound of Formula III and/or a Compound of Formula IV. The invention also relates to solid forms and to pharmaceutical formulations thereof, and to methods of using such compositions in the treatment of CFTR mediated diseases, particularly cystic fibrosis.
Description
FIELD OF THE INVENTION

The present invention relates to pharmaceutical compositions comprising a compound of Formulas I and II, optionally in combination with a Compound of Formula III and/or a Compound of Formula IV. The invention also relates to solid forms and to pharmaceutical formulations thereof, and to methods of using such compositions in the treatment of CFTR mediated diseases, particularly cystic fibrosis.


BACKGROUND

Cystic fibrosis (CF) is a recessive genetic disease that affects approximately 30,000 children and adults in the United States and approximately 30,000 children and adults in Europe. Despite progress in the treatment of CF, there is no cure.


CF is caused by mutations in the cystic fibrosis transmembrane conductance regulator (CFTR) gene that encodes an epithelial chloride ion channel responsible for aiding in the regulation of salt and water absorption and secretion in various tissues. Small molecule drugs, known as potentiators that increase the probability of CFTR channel opening, represent one potential therapeutic strategy to treat CF. Potentiators of this type are disclosed in WO 2006/002421, which is herein incorporated by reference in its entirety. Another potential therapeutic strategy involves small molecule drugs known as CF correctors that increase the number and function of CFTR channels. Correctors of this type are disclosed in WO 2005/075435, which are herein incorporated by reference in their entirety.


Specifically, CFTR is a cAMP/ATP-mediated anion channel that is expressed in a variety of cells types, including absorptive and secretory epithelia cells, where it regulates anion flux across the membrane, as well as the activity of other ion channels and proteins. In epithelia cells, normal functioning of CFTR is critical for the maintenance of electrolyte transport throughout the body, including respiratory and digestive tissue. CFTR is composed of approximately 1480 amino acids that encode a protein made up of a tandem repeat of transmembrane domains, each containing six transmembrane helices and a nucleotide binding domain. The two transmembrane domains are linked by a large, polar, regulatory (R)-domain with multiple phosphorylation sites that regulate channel activity and cellular trafficking.


The gene encoding CFTR has been identified and sequenced (See Gregory, R. J. et al. (1990) Nature 347:382-386; Rich, D. P. et al. (1990) Nature 347:358-362), (Riordan, J. R. et al. (1989) Science 245:1066-1073). A defect in this gene causes mutations in CFTR resulting in cystic fibrosis (“CF”), the most common fatal genetic disease in humans. Cystic fibrosis affects approximately one in every 2,500 infants in the United States. Within the general United States population, up to 10 million people carry a single copy of the defective gene without apparent ill effects. In contrast, individuals with two copies of the CF associated gene suffer from the debilitating and fatal effects of CF, including chronic lung disease.


In patients with CF, mutations in CFTR endogenously expressed in respiratory epithelia leads to reduced apical anion secretion causing an imbalance in ion and fluid transport. The resulting decrease in anion transport contributes to enhanced mucus accumulation in the lung and the accompanying microbial infections that ultimately cause death in CF patients. In addition to respiratory disease, CF patients typically suffer from gastrointestinal problems and pancreatic insufficiency that, if left untreated, results in death. In addition, the majority of males with cystic fibrosis are infertile and fertility is decreased among females with cystic fibrosis. In contrast to the severe effects of two copies of the CF associated gene, individuals with a single copy of the CF associated gene exhibit increased resistance to cholera and to dehydration resulting from diarrhea—perhaps explaining the relatively high frequency of the CF gene within the population.


Sequence analysis of the CFTR gene of CF chromosomes has revealed a variety of disease causing mutations (Cutting, G. R. et al. (1990) Nature 346:366-369; Dean, M. et al. (1990) Cell 61:863:870; and Kerem, B-S. et al. (1989) Science 245:1073-1080; Kerem, B-S et al. (1990) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 87:8447-8451). To date, greater than 1000 disease causing mutations in the CF gene have been identified (http://www.genet.sickkids.on.ca/cftr/app). The most prevalent mutation is a deletion of phenylalanine at position 508 of the CFTR amino acid sequence, and is commonly referred to as ΔF508-CFTR. This mutation occurs in approximately 70% of the cases of cystic fibrosis and is associated with a severe disease.


The deletion of residue 508 in ΔF508-CFTR prevents the nascent protein from folding correctly. This results in the inability of the mutant protein to exit the ER, and traffic to the plasma membrane. As a result, the number of channels present in the membrane is far less than observed in cells expressing wild-type CFTR. In addition to impaired trafficking, the mutation results in defective channel gating. Together, the reduced number of channels in the membrane and the defective gating lead to reduced anion transport across epithelia leading to defective ion and fluid transport. (Quinton, P. M. (1990), FASEB J. 4: 2709-2727). Studies have shown, however, that the reduced numbers of ΔF508-CFTR in the membrane are functional, albeit less than wild-type CFTR. (Dalemans et al. (1991), Nature Lond. 354: 526-528; Denning et al., supra; Pasyk and Foskett (1995), J. Cell. Biochem. 270: 12347-50). In addition to ΔF508-CFTR, other disease causing mutations in CFTR that result in defective trafficking, synthesis, and/or channel gating could be up- or down-regulated to alter anion secretion and modify disease progression and/or severity.


Although CFTR transports a variety of molecules in addition to anions, it is clear that this role (the transport of anions) represents one element in an important mechanism of transporting ions and water across the epithelium. The other elements include the epithelial Na+ channel, ENaC, Na+/2Cl/K+ co-transporter, Na+-K+-ATPase pump and the basolateral membrane K+ channels, that are responsible for the uptake of chloride into the cell.


These elements work together to achieve directional transport across the epithelium via their selective expression and localization within the cell. Chloride absorption takes place by the coordinated activity of ENaC and CFTR present on the apical membrane and the Na+-K+-ATPase pump and Clion channels expressed on the basolateral surface of the cell. Secondary active transport of chloride from the luminal side leads to the accumulation of intracellular chloride, which can then passively leave the cell via Clchannels, resulting in a vectorial transport. Arrangement of Na+/2Cl/K+ co-transporter, Na+-K+-ATPase pump and the basolateral membrane K+ channels on the basolateral surface and CFTR on the luminal side coordinate the secretion of chloride via CFTR on the luminal side. Because water is probably never actively transported itself, its flow across epithelia depends on tiny transepithelial osmotic gradients generated by the bulk flow of sodium and chloride.


As discussed above, it is believed that the deletion of residue 508 in ΔF508-CFTR prevents the nascent protein from folding correctly, resulting in the inability of this mutant protein to exit the ER, and traffic to the plasma membrane. As a result, insufficient amounts of the mature protein are present at the plasma membrane and chloride transport within epithelial tissues is significantly reduced. In fact, this cellular phenomenon of defective ER processing of ABC transporters by the ER machinery has been shown to be the underlying basis not only for CF disease, but for a wide range of other isolated and inherited diseases.


Compounds which are potentiators of CFTR protein, such as those of Formula I or Formula II, and compounds which are correctors of CFTR protein, such as those of Formula III or Formula IV, have been shown independently to have utility in the treatment of CFTR modulated diseases, such as Cystic Fibrosis.


Accordingly, there is a need for novel treatments of CFTR mediated diseases which involve CFTR corrector and potentiator compounds.


Particularly, there is a need for combination therapies to treat CFTR mediated diseases, such as Cystic Fibrosis, which include CFTR potentiator and corrector compounds.


More particularly, there is a need for combination therapies to treat CFTR mediated diseases, such as Cystic Fibrosis, which include CFTR potentiator compounds, such as compounds of Formula I and Formula II. There is also a need for combination therapies to treat CFTR mediated diseases, such as Cystic Fibrosis, which include CFTR potentiator compounds, such as compounds of Formula I and Formula II in combination with CFTR corrector compounds such as compounds of Formula III and/or Formula IV.


Even more particularly, there is a need for combination therapies to treat CFTR mediated diseases, such as Cystic Fibrosis, comprising CFTR potentiator compounds such as Compound 1 and Compound 2. There is also a need for combination therapies to treat CFTR mediated diseases, such as Cystic Fibrosis, comprising CFTR potentiator compounds such as Compound 1 and Compound 2, in combination with CFTR corrector compounds, such as Compound 3 and/or Compound 4.


SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION

These and other needs are met by the present invention which is directed to pharmaceutical compositions comprising:


A Compound of Formula I




embedded image


or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein:


Each of WRW2 and WRW4 is independently selected from CN, CF3, halo, C2-6 straight or branched alkyl, C3-12 membered cycloaliphatic, phenyl, a 5-10 membered heteroaryl or 3-7 membered heterocyclic, wherein said heteroaryl or heterocyclic has up to 3 heteroatoms selected from O, S, or N, wherein said WRW2 and WRW4 is independently and optionally substituted with up to three substituents selected from —OR′, —CF3, —OCF3, SR′, S(O)R′, SO2R′, —SCF3, halo, CN, —COOR′, —COR′, —O(CH2)2N(R′)2, —O(CH2)N(R′)2, —CON(R′)2, —(CH2)2OR′, —(CH2)OR′, —CH2CN, optionally substituted phenyl or phenoxy, —N(R′)2, —NR′C(O)OR′, —NR′C(O)R′, —(CH2)2N(R′)2, or —(CH2)N(R′)2;


WRW5 is selected from hydrogen, —OCF3, —CF3, —OH, —OCH3, —NH2, —CN, —CHF2, —NHR′, —N(R′)2, —NHC(O)R′, —NHC(O)OR′, —NHSO2R′, —CH2OH, —CH2N(R′)2, —C(O)OR′, —SO2NHR′, —SO2N(R′)2, or —CH2NHC(O)OR′; and


Each R′ is independently selected from an optionally substituted group selected from a C1-8 aliphatic group, a 3-8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or fully unsaturated monocyclic ring having 0-3 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, or an 8-12 membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or fully unsaturated bicyclic ring system having 0-5 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur; or two occurrences of R′ are taken together with the atom(s) to which they are bound to form an optionally substituted 3-12 membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or fully unsaturated monocyclic or bicyclic ring having 0-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur;


provided that:


i) WRW2 and WRW4 are not both —Cl;


WRW2, WRW4 and WRW5 are not —OCH2CH2Ph, —OCH2CH2(2-trifluoromethyl-phenyl), —OCH2CH2-(6,7-dimethoxy-1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolin-2-yl), or substituted 1H-pyrazol-3-yl;


and


A Compound of Formula II




embedded image


or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein:

    • ring A is selected from:




embedded image




    • R1 is —CF3, —CN, or —C≡CCH2N(CH3)2;

    • R2 is hydrogen, —CH3, —CF3, —OH, or —CH2OH;

    • R3 is hydrogen, —CH3, —OCH3, or —CN;


      provided that both R2 and R3 are not simultaneously hydrogen;


      optionally in combination with:





A Compound of Formula III




embedded image


or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein:

    • T is —CH2—, —CH2CH2—, —CF2—, —C(CH3)2—, or —C(O)—;
    • R1′ is H, C1-6 aliphatic, halo, CF3, CHF2, O(C1-6 aliphatic); and
    • RD1 or RD2 is ZDR9
      • wherein:
      • ZD is a bond, CONH, SO2NH, SO2N(C1-6 alkyl), CH2NHSO2, CH2N(CH3)SO2, CH2NHCO, COO, SO2, or CO; and
      • R9 is H, C1-6 aliphatic, or aryl; and/or


A Compound of Formula IV




embedded image


or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein:

    • R is H, OH, OCH3 or two R taken together form —OCH2O— or —OCF2O—;
    • R4 is H or alkyl;
    • R5 is H or F;
    • R6 is H or CN;
    • R7 is H, —CH2CH(OH)CH2OH, —CH2CH2N+(CH3)3, or —CH2CH2OH;
    • R8 is H, OH, —CH2CH(OH)CH2OH, —CH2OH, or R7 and R8 taken together form a five membered ring.


In one aspect, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a Compound of Formula I and Compound of Formula II.


In another aspect, the pharmaceutical composition comprises Compound 1 and Compound 2.




embedded image


In another aspect, the pharmaceutical composition comprises Compound 1, Compound 2 and Compound 3 and/or Compound 4.




embedded image


In one aspect, the pharmaceutical composition comprises Compound 1, Compound 2, and Compound 3.


In another aspect, the pharmaceutical composition comprises Compound 1, Compound 2, and Compound 4.


In still another aspect, the pharmaceutical composition comprises Compound 1, Compound 2, Compound 3 and Compound 4.


In another aspect, the invention is directed to a pharmaceutical composition comprising at least one component from Column A of Table I, and at least one component from Column B of Table I, and optionally an additional component from one or both of Column C and/or Column D


In another aspect, the invention is directed to a pharmaceutical composition comprising at least one component from Column A of Table I, and optionally an additional component from one or both of Column C and/or Column D.


These components are described in the corresponding sections of the following pages as embodiments of the invention. For convenience, Table I recites the section number and corresponding heading title of the embodiments of the compounds, solid forms and formulations. For example, the embodiments of the compounds of Formula I are disclosed in section II.A.1. of this specification.












TABLE I







Column A
Column B
Column C
Column D


Embodiments
Embodiments
Embodiments
Embodiments














Section
Heading
Section
Heading
Section
Heading
Section
Heading





II.A.1.
Compounds
II.B.1.
Compounds
II.C.1.
Compounds
II.D.1.
Compounds



of Formula I

of Formula

of Formula

of Formula





II

III

IV


II.A.2.
Compound 1
II.B.2.
Compound 2
II.C.2.
Compound 3
II.D.2.
Compound 4


III.A.1.a.
Compound 1
III.B.1.a.
Compound 2
III.C.1.a.
Compound 3
III.D.1.a.
Compound 4



Form C

Form A

Form I

Form A


IV.A.1.a.
Compound 1
III.B.2.a.
Compound 2
III.C.2.a.
Compound 3
III.D.2.a.
Compound 4



First

Form A-HCl

Solvate

Amorphous



Formulation



Form A

Form


IV.A.2.a.
Compound 1
III.B.3.a.
Compound 2
III.C.3.a.
Compound 3
IV.C.1.a.
Compound 4



Tablet and

Form B-HCl

HCl Salt

Tablet



SDD



Form A

Formulation



Formulation




III.B.4.a.
Compound 2
IV.B.1.a.
Compound 3





Form B

Form I







Aqueous







Formulation






IV.B.2.a.
Compound 3







Form I







Capsule







Formulation






IV.B.3.a.
Compound 3







Form I







Tablet







Formulation









In one embodiment based on Table I, the Column A component is a compound of Formula I, the Column B Component is a compound of Formula II, and the third Component is any of the embodiments listed in Column C In a further embodiment, the Column C component is a Compound of Formula III. In a further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Solvate Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I Aqueous Formulation. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I Capsule Formulation. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I Tablet Formulation.


In another embodiment based on Table I, the Column A component is a compound of Formula I, the Column B Component is a compound of Formula II, and the third Component is any of the embodiments listed in Column D In a further embodiment, the Column D component is a Compound of Formula IV. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4 Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4 Tablet Formulation.


In another embodiment based on Table I, the Column A component is a compound of Formula I, the Column B Component is a compound of Formula II, the third Component is any of the embodiments listed in Column C, and the fourth component in any of the embodiments listed in Column D. In a further embodiment, the Column C component is a Compound of Formula III. In a further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Solvate Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I Aqueous Formulation. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I Capsule Formulation. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I Tablet Formulation. In a further embodiment, the Column D component is a Compound of Formula IV. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4 Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4 Tablet Formulation.


In one embodiment based on Table I, the Column C component is a compound of Formula III, and is in combination with one of any embodiment of Column A and one of any embodiment of Column B. In a further embodiment, the Column A component is a compound of Formula I. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 Form C. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 First Formulation. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation. In a further embodiment, the Column B component is a compound of Formula II. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form A-HCl. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form B-HCl. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form B.


In one embodiment based on Table I, the Column D component is a compound of Formula IV, and is in combination with one of any embodiment of Column A and one of any embodiment of Column B. In a further embodiment, the Column A component is a compound of Formula I. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 Form C. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 First Formulation. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation. In a further embodiment, the Column B component is a compound of Formula II. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form A-HCl. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form B-HCl. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form B.


In one embodiment based on Table I, the Column D component is a compound of Formula IV and the Column C component is a compound of Formula III, both of which are in combination with one of any embodiment of Column A and one of any embodiment of Column B In a further embodiment, the Column A component is a compound of Formula I. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 Form C. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 First Formulation. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation. In a further embodiment, the Column B component is a compound of Formula II. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form A-HCl. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form B-HCl. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form B.


In one embodiment based on Table I, the Column C component is Compound 3, and is in combination with one of any embodiment of Column A and one of any embodiment of Column B In a further embodiment, the Column A component is a compound of Formula I. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 Form C. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 First Formulation. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation. In a further embodiment, the Column B component is a compound of Formula II. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form A-HCl. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form B-HCl. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form B.


In one embodiment based on Table I, the Column D component is Compound 4, and is in combination with one of any embodiment of Column A and one of any embodiment of Column B In a further embodiment, the Column A component is a compound of Formula I. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 Form C. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 First Formulation. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation. In a further embodiment, the Column B component is a compound of Formula II. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form A-HCl. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form B-HCl. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form B.


In one embodiment based on Table I, the Column D component is Compound 4 and the Column C component is Compound 3, both of which are in combination with one of any embodiment of Column A and one of any embodiment of Column B. In a further embodiment, the Column A component is a compound of Formula I. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 Form C. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 First Formulation. In another further embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation. In a further embodiment, the Column B component is a compound of Formula II. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form A-HCl. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form B-HCl. In another further embodiment, the Column B component is Compound 2 Form B.


In one embodiment based on Table I, the Column A component is Compound 1, the Column B Component is Compound 2, and the third Component is any of the embodiments listed in Column C. In a further embodiment, the Column C component is a Compound of Formula III. In a further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Solvate Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I Aqueous Formulation. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I Capsule Formulation. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I Tablet Formulation.


In another embodiment based on Table I, the Column A component is Compound 1, the Column B Component is Compound 2, and the third Component is any of the embodiments listed in Column D. In a further embodiment, the Column D component is a Compound of Formula IV. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4 Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4 Tablet Formulation.


In one embodiment based on Table I, the Column A component is Compound 1, the Column B Component is Compound 2, the third Component is any of the embodiments listed in Column C, and the fourth component is any of the embodiments listed in Column D In a further embodiment, the Column C component is a Compound of Formula III. In a further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Solvate Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I Aqueous Formulation. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I Capsule Formulation. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I Tablet Formulation. In a further embodiment, the Column D component is a Compound of Formula IV. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4 Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4 Tablet Formulation.


In one embodiment based on Table I, the Column A component is Compound 1, the Column B Component is Compound 2, and the third Component is Compound 3.


In another embodiment based on Table I, the Column A component is Compound 1, the Column B Component is Compound 2, and the third Component is Compound 4.


In one embodiment based on Table I, the Column A component is Compound 1, the Column B Component is Compound 2, the third Component is Compound 3, and the fourth component in Compound 4.


In another aspect, the invention is directed to method of treating a CFTR mediated disease in a human comprising administering to the human an effective amount of a pharmaceutical composition comprising a pharmaceutical composition according to Table I.


In another aspect, the invention is directed to method of treating a CFTR mediated disease in a human comprising administering to the human an effective amount of a pharmaceutical composition comprising Compound 1 and Compound 2, according to Table I.


In another aspect, the invention is directed to a kit comprising a pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of Formula I and Formula II, according to Table I.


In another aspect, the invention is directed to a kit comprising a pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of Compound 1 and Compound 2, according to Table I.


In another aspect, the invention is directed to a pharmaceutical composition comprising at least one component from Column A of Table I, and optionally an additional component from one or both of Column C and/or Column D.


In one embodiment of this aspect, the Column A component is a compound of Formula I. In another embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1. In another embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 Form C. In another embodiment, the Column A component is Compound 1 First Formulation. In still another embodiment, the Column A component is Compound I SDD and Tablet Formulation.


In one embodiment of this aspect, the Column C component is a Compound of Formula III. In a further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Solvate Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I Aqueous Formulation. In another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I Capsule Formulation. In still another further embodiment, the Column C component is Compound 3 Form I Tablet Formulation.


In one embodiment of this aspect, the Column D component is a Compound of Formula IV. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4 Form A. In another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In still another further embodiment, the Column D component is Compound 4 Tablet Formulation.


In one further embodiment of this aspect, the Column A component is Compound 1 Tablet and SDD formulation, which is in combination with Compound 3 Tablet Formulation or Compound 3 Capsule Formulation. In another further embodiment of this aspect, the Column A component is Compound 1 Tablet and SDD formulation, which is in combination with Compound 4 Tablet Formulation. In another embodiment of this aspect, the Column A component is Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation, which is combination with Compound 3 Tablet Formulation or Compound 3 Capsule Formulation, and in combination with Compound 4 Tablet Formulation.


Various components listed in Table I have been disclosed and can be found in US 2011/0065928 A1, US 2010/0184739, US 2010/0267768, US 2011/0064811, US 2009/0105272, US 2009/0246820, US 2009/0099230, U.S. Pat. No. 7,776,905, U.S. Pat. No. 7,645,789, U.S. Pat. No. 7,495,103, U.S. Pat. No. 7,553,855, US 2010/0074949, US 2010/0256184, US 2010/0113508, US 2010/0130547, U.S. Pat. No. 7,741,321, U.S. Pat. No. 7,659,268, US 2008/0306062A1, US 2009/0170905 A1, US 2009/0176839 and US 2010/0087490, the contents of which are incorporated herein by reference.





LIST OF FIGURES


FIG. 1-1 is an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern of Form C of Compound 1.



FIG. 1-2 is a DSC trace of Compound 1 Form C.



FIG. 1-3 is a TGA trace of Compound 1 Form C.



FIG. 1-4 is a Raman spectrum of Compound 1 Form C.



FIG. 1-5 is an FTIR spectrum of Compound 1 Form C.



FIG. 1-6 is a Solid State NMR Spectrum of Compound 1 Form C.



FIG. 2-1 is an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern of Compound 2 Form A.



FIG. 2-2 is an X-Ray Crystal Structure of Compound 2 Form A.



FIG. 2-3 is an FTIR Spectrum of Compound 2 Form A.



FIG. 2-4 is an XRPD Structure of Compound 2 Form A-HCl.



FIG. 2-5 is a 13C NMR Spectrum of Compound 2 Form A-HCl.



FIG. 2-6 is a 19F NMR Spectrum of Compound 2 Form A-HCl.



FIG. 2-7 is an FTIR Spectrum of Compound 2 Form A-HCl.



FIG. 2-8 is a DSC Curve of Compound 2 Form A-HCl.



FIG. 2-9 is a TGA trace of Compound 2 Form A-HCl.



FIG. 2-10 is an XRPD Pattern of Compound 2 Form B-HCl.



FIG. 2-11 is an FTIR Spectrum of Compound 2 Form B-HCl.



FIG. 2-12 is a DSC Curve of Compound 2 Form B-HCl.



FIG. 2-13 is a TGA trace of Compound 2 Form B-HCl.



FIG. 2-14 is a 13C SSNMR Spectrum of Compound 2 Form B-HCl.



FIG. 2-15 is a 19F SSNMR Spectrum of Compound 2 Form B-HCl.



FIG. 2-16A is an XRPD Pattern for a representative sample of Compound 2 Form B recorded with Instrument 1.



FIG. 2-16B is an XRPD Pattern for a representative sample of Compound 2 Form B recorded with Instrument 2.



FIG. 2-17 is an FTIR Spectrum of Compound 2 Form B.



FIG. 2-18 is a 13C SSNMR Spectrum of Compound 2 Form B.



FIG. 2-19 is a 19F SSNMR Spectrum of Compound 2 Form B.



FIG. 2-20 is a DSC Curve of Compound 2 Form B.



FIG. 2-21 is a TGA of Compound 2 Form B.



FIG. 2-22 is an illustration of the conformational structure of Compound 2 Form B based on single crystal X-ray analysis.



FIG. 2-23 is an illustration of the conformational structure of Compound 2 Form A-HCl based on X-ray analysis.



FIG. 2-24 is a molecular packing diagram of Compound 2 Form A-HCl based on X-ray analysis.



FIG. 2-25 is an illustration of the conformational structure of Compound 2 Form B-HCl based on X-ray analysis.



FIG. 2-26 is a molecular packing diagram of Compound 2 Form B-HCl based on single X-ray analysis.



FIG. 3-1 is an X-ray diffraction pattern calculated from a single crystal structure of Compound 3 Form I.



FIG. 3-2 is an actual X-ray powder diffraction pattern of Compound 3 Form I.



FIG. 3-3 is a conformational picture of Compound 3 Form I based on single crystal X-ray analysis.



FIG. 3-4 is an X-ray powder diffraction pattern of Compound 3 Solvate Form A.



FIG. 3-5 is a Stacked, multi-pattern spectrum of the X-ray diffraction patterns of Compound 3 Solvate Forms selected from:


1) Compound 3, Methanol Solvate Form A;


2) Compound 3, Ethanol Solvate Form A;


3) Compound 3 Acetone Solvate Form A;


4) Compound 3, 2-Propanol Solvate Form A;


5) Compound 3, Acetonitrile Solvate Form A;


6) Compound 3, Tetrahydrofuran Solvate Form A;


7) Compound 3, Methyl Acetate Solvate Form A;


8) Compound 3, 2-Butanone Solvate Form A;


9) Compound 3, Ethyl Formate Solvate Form A; and


10) Compound 3 2-Methyltetrahydrofuran Solvate Form A.



FIG. 3-6 is an X-ray diffraction pattern of Compound 3, Methanol Solvate Form A.



FIG. 3-7 is an X-ray diffraction pattern of Compound 3, Ethanol Solvate Form A.



FIG. 3-8 is an X-ray diffraction pattern of Compound 3 Acetone Solvate Form A.



FIG. 3-9 is an X-ray diffraction pattern of Compound 3, 2-Propanol Solvate Form A.



FIG. 3-10 is an X-ray diffraction pattern of Compound 3, Acetonitrile Solvate Form A.



FIG. 3-11 is an X-ray diffraction pattern of Compound 3, Tetrahydrofuran Solvate Form A.



FIG. 3-12 is an X-ray diffraction pattern of Compound 3, Methyl Acetate Solvate Form A.



FIG. 3-13 is an X-ray diffraction pattern of Compound 3, 2-Butanone Solvate Form A.



FIG. 3-14 is an X-ray diffraction pattern of Compound 3, Ethyl Formate Solvate Form A.



FIG. 3-15 is an X-ray diffraction pattern of Compound 3, 2-Methyltetrahydrofuran Solvate Form A.



FIG. 3-16 is a conformational image of Compound 3 Acetone Solvate Form A based on single crystal X-ray analysis.



FIG. 3-17 is a conformational image of Compound 3 Solvate Form A based on single crystal X-ray analysis as a dimer.



FIG. 3-18 is a conformational image of Compound 3 Solvate Form A showing hydrogen bonding between carboxylic acid groups based on single crystal X-ray analysis.



FIG. 3-19 is a conformational image of Compound 3 Solvate Form A showing acetone as the solvate based on single crystal X-ray analysis.



FIG. 3-20 is a conformational image of the dimer of Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A.



FIG. 3-21 is a packing diagram of Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A.



FIG. 3-22 is an X-ray diffraction pattern of Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A calculated from the crystal structure.



FIG. 3-23 is an overlay of X-ray powder diffraction patterns of Compound 3 HCl salt and the same compound after being suspended in an aqueous methylcellulose formulation for 24 hours at room temperature.



FIG. 3-24 is an 1HNMR analysis of Compound 3 from a 50 mg/mL 0.5% MC/0.5% Tween 80 suspension, at T(0).



FIG. 3-25 is an 1HNMR analysis of Compound 3 from a 50 mg/mL 0.5% MC/0.5% Tween 80 suspension stored at room temperature for 24 hours.



FIG. 3-26 is an 1HNMR analysis of Compound 3 HCl salt standard.



FIG. 3-27 is a 13C SSNMR Spectrum of Compound 3 Form I.



FIG. 3-28 is a 19F SSNMR Spectrum of Compound 3 Form I (15.0 kHz Spinning).



FIG. 3-29 is a 13C SSNMR Spectrum of Compound 3 Acetone Solvate Form A.



FIG. 3-30 is a 19F SSNMR Spectrum of Compound 3 Acetone Solvate Form A (15.0 kHz Spinning).



FIG. 4-1 is an X-ray powder diffraction pattern calculated from a single crystal of Compound 4 Form A.



FIG. 4-2 is an actual X-ray powder diffraction pattern of Compound 4 Form A prepared by the slurry technique (2 weeks) with DCM as the solvent.



FIG. 4-3 is an actual X-ray powder diffraction pattern of Compound 4 Form A prepared by the fast evaporation method from acetonitrile.



FIG. 4-4 is an actual X-ray powder diffraction pattern of Compound 4 Form A prepared by the anti solvent method using EtOAc and heptane.



FIG. 4-5 is a conformational picture of Compound 4 Form A based on single crystal X-ray analysis.



FIG. 4-6 is a conformational picture showing the stacking order of Compound 4 Form A.



FIG. 4-7 is a 13C SSNMR spectrum (15.0 kHz spinning) of Compound 4 Form A.



FIG. 4-8 is a 19F SSNMR spectrum (12.5 kHz spinning) of Compound 4 Form A.



FIG. 4-9 is an X-ray powder diffraction pattern of Compound 4 amorphous form from the fast evaporation rotary evaporation method.



FIG. 4-10 is an X-ray powder diffraction pattern of Compound 4 amorphous form prepared by spray dried methods.



FIG. 4-11 is a solid state 13C NMR spectrum (15.0 kHz spinning) of Compound 4 amorphous form.



FIG. 4-12 is a solid state 19F NMR spectrum (12.5 kHz spinning) of Compound 4 amorphous form.





DETAILED DESCRIPTION
I. Definitions

As used herein, the following definitions shall apply unless otherwise indicated.


The term “ABC-transporter” as used herein means an ABC-transporter protein or a fragment thereof comprising at least one binding domain, wherein said protein or fragment thereof is present in vivo or in vitro. The term “binding domain” as used herein means a domain on the ABC-transporter that can bind to a modulator. See, e.g., Hwang, T. C. et al., J. Gen. Physiol. (1998): 111(3), 477-90.


The term “CFTR” as used herein means cystic fibrosis transmembrane conductance regulator or a mutation thereof capable of regulator activity, including, but not limited to, ΔF508 CFTR, R117H CFTR, and G551D CFTR (see, e.g., http://www.genet.sickkids.on.ca/cftr/, for CFTR mutations).


As used herein, the term “active pharmaceutical ingredient” or “API” refers to a biologically active compound. Exemplary APIs include the CF potentiators N-[2,4-bis(1,1-dimethylethyl)-5-hydroxyphenyl]-1,4-dihydro-4-oxoquinoline-3-carboxamide (Compound 1) and N-(4-(7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-7-yl)-2-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl)-4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxamide (Compound 2). Exemplary APIs also include the CF correctors 3-(6-(1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamido)-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoic acid (Compound 3) and (R)-1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)-N-(1-(2,3-dihydroxypropyl)-6-fluoro-2-(1-hydroxy-2-methylpropan-2-yl)-1H-indol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamide (Compound 4).


The term “modulating” as used herein means increasing or decreasing by a measurable amount.


The term “normal CFTR” or “normal CFTR function” as used herein means wild-type like CFTR without any impairment due to environmental factors such as smoking, pollution, or anything that produces inflammation in the lungs.


The term “reduced CFTR” or “reduced CFTR function” as used herein means less than normal CFTR or less than normal CFTR function.


As used herein, the term “amorphous” refers to a solid material having no long range order in the position of its molecules. Amorphous solids are generally supercooled liquids in which the molecules are arranged in a random manner so that there is no well-defined arrangement, e.g., molecular packing, and no long range order. Amorphous solids are generally isotropic, i.e. exhibit similar properties in all directions and do not have definite melting points. For example, an amorphous material is a solid material having no sharp characteristic crystalline peak(s) in its X-ray power diffraction (XRPD) pattern (i.e., is not crystalline as determined by XRPD). Instead, one or several broad peaks (e.g., halos) appear in its XRPD pattern. Broad peaks are characteristic of an amorphous solid. See, US 2004/0006237 for a comparison of XRPDs of an amorphous material and crystalline material.


As used herein, the term “substantially amorphous” refers to a solid material having little or no long range order in the position of its molecules. For example, substantially amorphous materials have less than about 15% crystallinity (e.g., less than about 10% crystallinity or less than about 5% crystallinity). It is also noted that the term ‘substantially amorphous’ includes the descriptor, ‘amorphous’, which refers to materials having no (0%) crystallinity.


As used herein, the term “dispersion” refers to a disperse system in which one substance, the dispersed phase, is distributed, in discrete units, throughout a second substance (the continuous phase or vehicle). The size of the dispersed phase can vary considerably (e.g. single molecules, colloidal particles of nanometer dimension, to multiple microns in size). In general, the dispersed phases can be solids, liquids, or gases. In the case of a solid dispersion, the dispersed and continuous phases are both solids. In pharmaceutical applications, a solid dispersion can include: an amorphous drug in an amorphous polymer; an amorphous drug in crystalline polymer; a crystalline drug in an amorphous polymer; or a crystalline drug in crystalline polymer. In this invention, a solid dispersion can include an amorphous drug in an amorphous polymer or an amorphous drug in crystalline polymer. In some embodiments, a solid dispersion includes the polymer constituting the dispersed phase, and the drug constitutes the continuous phase. Or, a solid dispersion includes the drug constituting the dispersed phase, and the polymer constitutes the continuous phase.


As used herein, the term “solid dispersion” generally refers to a solid dispersion of two or more components, usually one or more drugs (e.g., one drug (e.g., Compound 1)) and polymer, but possibly containing other components such as surfactants or other pharmaceutical excipients, where the drug(s) (e.g., Compound 1) is substantially amorphous (e.g., having about 15% or less (e.g., about 10% or less, or about 5% or less)) of crystalline drug (e.g., N-[2,4-bis(1,1-dimethylethyl)-5-hydroxyphenyl]-1,4-dihydro-4-oxoquinoline-3-carboxamide) or amorphous (i.e., having no crystalline drug), and the physical stability and/or dissolution and/or solubility of the substantially amorphous or amorphous drug is enhanced by the other components. Solid dispersions typically include a compound dispersed in an appropriate carrier medium, such as a solid state carrier. For example, a carrier comprises a polymer (e.g., a water-soluble polymer or a partially water-soluble polymer) and can include optional excipients such as functional excipients (e.g., one or more surfactants) or nonfunctional excipients (e.g., one or more fillers). Another exemplary solid dispersion is a co-precipitate or a co-melt of N-[2,4-bis(1,1-dimethylethyl)-5-hydroxyphenyl]-1,4-dihydro-4-oxoquinoline-3-carboxamide with at least one polymer.


A “Co-precipitate” is a product after dissolving a drug and a polymer in a solvent or solvent mixture followed by the removal of the solvent or solvent mixture. Sometimes the polymer can be suspended in the solvent or solvent mixture. The solvent or solvent mixture includes organic solvents and supercritical fluids. A “co-melt” is a product after heating a drug and a polymer to melt, optionally in the presence of a solvent or solvent mixture, followed by mixing, removal of at least a portion of the solvent if applicable, and cooling to room temperature at a selected rate.


As used herein “crystalline” refers to compounds or compositions where the structural units are arranged in fixed geometric patterns or lattices, so that crystalline solids have rigid long range order. The structural units that constitute the crystal structure can be atoms, molecules, or ions. Crystalline solids show definite melting points.


As used herein the phrase “substantially crystalline”, means a solid material that is arranged in fixed geometric patterns or lattices that have rigid long range order. For example, substantially crystalline materials have more than about 85% crystallinity (e.g., more than about 90% crystallinity or more than about 95% crystallinity). It is also noted that the term ‘substantially crystalline’ includes the descriptor ‘crystalline’, which is defined in the previous paragraph.


As used herein, “crystallinity” refers to the degree of structural order in a solid. For example, Compound 1, which is substantially amorphous, has less than about 15% crystallinity, or its solid state structure is less than about 15% crystalline. In another example, Compound 1, which is amorphous, has zero (0%) crystallinity.


As used herein, an “excipient” is an inactive ingredient in a pharmaceutical composition. Examples of excipients include fillers or diluents, surfactants, binders, glidants, lubricants, disintegrants, and the like.


As used herein, a “disintegrant” is an excipient that hydrates a pharmaceutical composition and aids in tablet dispersion. Examples of disintegrants include sodium croscarmellose and/or sodium starch glycolate.


As used herein, a “diluent” or “filler” is an excipient that adds bulkiness to a pharmaceutical composition. Examples of fillers include lactose, sorbitol, celluloses, calcium phosphates, starches, sugars (e.g., mannitol, sucrose, or the like) or any combination thereof.


As used herein, a “surfactant” is an excipient that imparts pharmaceutical compositions with enhanced solubility and/or wettability. Examples of surfactants include sodium lauryl sulfate (SLS), sodium stearyl fumarate (SSF), polyoxyethylene 20 sorbitan mono-oleate (e.g., Tween™), or any combination thereof.


As used herein, a “binder” is an excipient that imparts a pharmaceutical composition with enhanced cohesion or tensile strength (e.g., hardness). Examples of binders include dibasic calcium phosphate, sucrose, corn (maize) starch, microcrystalline cellulose, and modified cellulose (e.g., hydroxymethyl cellulose).


As used herein, a “glidant” is an excipient that imparts a pharmaceutical compositions with enhanced flow properties. Examples of glidants include colloidal silica and/or talc.


As used herein, a “colorant” is an excipient that imparts a pharmaceutical composition with a desired color. Examples of colorants include commercially available pigments such as FD&C Blue #1 Aluminum Lake, FD&C Blue #2, other FD&C Blue colors, titanium dioxide, iron oxide, and/or combinations thereof.


As used herein, a “lubricant” is an excipient that is added to pharmaceutical compositions that are pressed into tablets. The lubricant aids in compaction of granules into tablets and ejection of a tablet of a pharmaceutical composition from a die press. Examples of lubricants include magnesium stearate, stearic acid (stearin), hydrogenated oil, sodium stearyl fumarate, or any combination thereof.


As used herein, “friability” refers to the property of a tablet to remain intact and withhold its form despite an external force of pressure. Friability can be quantified using the mathematical expression presented in equation 1:










%





friabiliy

=

100
×


(


W
0

-

W
f


)


W
0







(
1
)







wherein W0 is the original weight of the tablet and Wf is the final weight of the tablet after it is put through the friabilator.


Friability is measured using a standard USP testing apparatus that tumbles experimental tablets for 100 revolutions. Some tablets of the present invention have a friability of less than about 1% (e.g., less than about 0.75%, less than about 0.50%, or less than about 0.30%)


As used herein, “mean particle diameter” is the average particle diameter as measured using techniques such as laser light scattering, image analysis, or sieve analysis.


As used herein, “bulk density” is the mass of particles of material divided by the total volume the particles occupy. The total volume includes particle volume, inter-particle void volume and internal pore volume. Bulk density is not an intrinsic property of a material; it can change depending on how the material is processed.


The term “aliphatic” or “aliphatic group,” as used herein, means a straight-chain (i.e., unbranched) or branched, substituted or unsubstituted hydrocarbon chain that is completely saturated or that contains one or more units of unsaturation, or a monocyclic hydrocarbon or bicyclic hydrocarbon that is completely saturated or that contains one or more units of unsaturation, but which is not aromatic (also referred to herein as “carbocycle” “cycloaliphatic” or “cycloalkyl”), that has a single point of attachment to the rest of the molecule. Unless otherwise specified, aliphatic groups contain 1-20 aliphatic carbon atoms. In some embodiments, aliphatic groups contain 1-10 aliphatic carbon atoms. In other embodiments, aliphatic groups contain 1-8 aliphatic carbon atoms. In still other embodiments, aliphatic groups contain 1-6 aliphatic carbon atoms, and in yet other embodiments aliphatic groups contain 1-4 aliphatic carbon atoms. In some embodiments, “cycloaliphatic” (or “carbocycle” or “cycloalkyl”) refers to a monocyclic C3-C8 hydrocarbon or bicyclic or tricyclic C8-C14 hydrocarbon that is completely saturated or that contains one or more units of unsaturation, but which is not aromatic, that has a single point of attachment to the rest of the molecule wherein any individual ring in said bicyclic ring system has 3-7 members. Suitable aliphatic groups include, but are not limited to, linear or branched, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl groups and hybrids thereof such as (cycloalkyl)alkyl, (cycloalkenyl)alkyl or (cycloalkyl)alkenyl. Suitable cycloaliphatic groups include cycloalkyl, bicyclic cycloalkyl (e.g., decalin), bridged bicycloalkyl such as norbornyl or [2.2.2]bicyclo-octyl, or bridged tricyclic such as adamantyl.


The term “alkyl” as used herein refers to a saturated aliphatic hydrocarbon group containing 1-15 (including, but not limited to, 1-8, 1-6, 1-4, 2-6, 3-12) carbon atoms. An alkyl group can be straight or branched.


The term “heteroaliphatic,” as used herein, means aliphatic groups wherein one or two carbon atoms are independently replaced by one or more of oxygen, sulfur, nitrogen, phosphorus, or silicon. Heteroaliphatic groups may be substituted or unsubstituted, branched or unbranched, cyclic or acyclic, and include “heterocycle,” “heterocyclyl,” “heterocycloaliphatic,” or “heterocyclic” groups.


The term “heterocycle,” “heterocyclyl,” “heterocycloaliphatic,” or “heterocyclic” as used herein means non-aromatic, monocyclic, bicyclic, or tricyclic ring systems in which one or more ring members is an independently selected heteroatom. In some embodiments, the “heterocycle,” “heterocyclyl,” “heterocycloaliphatic,” or “heterocyclic” group has three to fourteen ring members in which one or more ring members is a heteroatom independently selected from oxygen, sulfur, nitrogen, or phosphorus, and each ring in the system contains 3 to 7 ring members.


The term “heteroatom” means one or more of oxygen, sulfur, nitrogen, phosphorus, or silicon (including, any oxidized form of nitrogen, sulfur, phosphorus, or silicon; the quaternized form of any basic nitrogen or; a substitutable nitrogen of a heterocyclic ring, for example N (as in 3,4-dihydro-2H-pyrrolyl), NH (as in pyrrolidinyl) or NR+ (as in N-substituted pyrrolidinyl)).


The term “unsaturated,” as used herein, means that a moiety has one or more units of unsaturation.


The term “aryl” used alone or as part of a larger moiety as in “aralkyl,” “aralkoxy,” or “aryloxyalkyl,” refers to monocyclic, bicyclic, and tricyclic ring systems having a total of five to fourteen ring members, wherein at least one ring in the system is aromatic and wherein each ring in the system contains 3 to 7 ring members. The term “aryl” may be used interchangeably with the term “aryl ring.” The term “aryl” also refers to heteroaryl ring systems as defined herein below.


An aliphatic or heteroaliphatic group, or a non-aromatic heterocyclic ring may contain one or more substituents. Suitable substituents on the saturated carbon of an aliphatic or heteroaliphatic group, or of a non-aromatic heterocyclic ring are selected from those listed above for the unsaturated carbon of an aryl or heteroaryl group and additionally include the following: ═O, ═S, ═NNHR*, ═NN(R*)2, ═NNHC(O)R*, ═NNHCO2(alkyl), ═NNHSO2(alkyl), or ═NR*, where each R* is independently selected from hydrogen or an optionally substituted C1-6 aliphatic. Optional substituents on the aliphatic group of R* are selected from NH2, NH(C1-4 aliphatic), N(C1-4 aliphatic)2, halo, C1-4 aliphatic, OH, O(C1-4 aliphatic), NO2, CN, CO2H, CO2(C1-4 aliphatic), O(halo C1-4 aliphatic), or halo(C1-4 aliphatic), wherein each of the foregoing C1-4aliphatic groups of R* is unsubstituted.


Optional substituents on the nitrogen of a non-aromatic heterocyclic ring are selected from —R+, —N(R+)2, —C(O)R+, —CO2R+, —C(O)C(O)R+, —C(O)CH2C(O)R+, —SO2R+, —SO2N(R+)2, —C(═S)N(R+)2, —C(═NH)—N(R+)2, or —NR+SO2R+; wherein R+ is hydrogen, an optionally substituted C1-6 aliphatic, optionally substituted phenyl, optionally substituted —O(Ph), optionally substituted —CH2(Ph), optionally substituted —(CH2)1-2(Ph); optionally substituted —CH═CH(Ph); or an unsubstituted 5-6 membered heteroaryl or heterocyclic ring having one to four heteroatoms independently selected from oxygen, nitrogen, or sulfur, or, notwithstanding the definition above, two independent occurrences of R+, on the same substituent or different substituents, taken together with the atom(s) to which each R+ group is bound, form a 3-8-membered cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, or heteroaryl ring having 0-3 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur. Optional substituents on the aliphatic group or the phenyl ring of R+ are selected from NH2, NH(C1-4 aliphatic), N(C1-4 aliphatic)2, halo, C1-4 aliphatic, OH, O(C1-4 aliphatic), NO2, CN, CO2H, CO2(C1-4 aliphatic), O(halo C1-4 aliphatic), or halo(C1-4 aliphatic), wherein each of the foregoing C1-4aliphatic groups of R+ is unsubstituted.


As detailed above, in some embodiments, two independent occurrences of R′ (or any other variable similarly defined herein), are taken together with the atom(s) to which each variable is bound to form a 3-8-membered cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, or heteroaryl ring having 0-3 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur. Exemplary rings that are formed when two independent occurrences of R′ (or any other variable similarly defined herein) are taken together with the atom(s) to which each variable is bound include, but are not limited to the following: a) two independent occurrences of R′ (or any other variable similarly defined herein) that are bound to the same atom and are taken together with that atom to form a ring, for example, N(R′)2, where both occurrences of R′ are taken together with the nitrogen atom to form a piperidin-1-yl, piperazin-1-yl, or morpholin-4-yl group; and b) two independent occurrences of R′ (or any other variable similarly defined herein) that are bound to different atoms and are taken together with both of those atoms to form a ring, for example where a phenyl group is substituted with two occurrences of OR′




embedded image


these two occurrences of Ro are taken together with the oxygen atoms to which they are bound to form a fused 6-membered oxygen containing ring:




embedded image


It will be appreciated that a variety of other rings can be formed when two independent occurrences of R′ (or any other variable similarly defined herein) are taken together with the atom(s) to which each variable is bound and that the examples detailed above are not intended to be limiting.


A substituent bond in, e.g., a bicyclic ring system, as shown below, means that the substituent can be attached to any substitutable ring atom on either ring of the bicyclic ring system:




embedded image


The term “protecting group” (PG) as used herein, represents those groups intended to protect a functional group, such as, for example, an alcohol, amine, carboxyl, carbonyl, etc., against undesirable reactions during synthetic procedures. Commonly used protecting groups are disclosed in Greene and Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis, 3rd Edition (John Wiley & Sons, New York, 1999), which is incorporated herein by reference. Examples of nitrogen protecting groups include acyl, aroyl, or carbamyl groups such as formyl, acetyl, propionyl, pivaloyl, t-butylacetyl, 2-chloroacetyl, 2-bromoacetyl, trifluoroacetyl, trichloroacetyl, phthalyl, o-nitrophenoxyacetyl, α-chlorobutyryl, benzoyl, 4-chlorobenzoyl, 4-bromobenzoyl, 4-nitrobenzoyl and chiral auxiliaries such as protected or unprotected D, L or D, L-amino acids such as alanine, leucine, phenylalanine and the like; sulfonyl groups such as benzenesulfonyl, p-toluenesulfonyl and the like; carbamate groups such as benzyloxycarbonyl, p-chlorobenzyloxycarbonyl, p-methoxybenzyloxycarbonyl, p-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl, 2-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl, p-bromobenzyloxycarbonyl, 3,4-dimethoxybenzyloxycarbonyl, 3,5-dimethoxybenzyloxycarbonyl, 2,4-dimethoxybenzyloxycarbonyl, 4-methoxybenzyloxycarbonyl, 2-nitro-4,5-dimethoxybenzyloxycarbonyl, 3,4,5-trimethoxybenzyloxycarbonyl, 1-(p-biphenylyl)-1-methylethoxycarbonyl, α,α-dimethyl-3,5-dimethoxybenzyloxycarbonyl, benzhydryloxycarbonyl, t-butyloxycarbonyl, diisopropylmethoxycarbonyl, isopropyloxycarbonyl, ethoxycarbonyl, methoxycarbonyl, allyloxycarbonyl, 2,2,2,-trichloroethoxycarbonyl, phenoxycarbonyl, 4-nitrophenoxy carbonyl, fluorenyl-9-methoxycarbonyl, cyclopentyloxycarbonyl, adamantyloxycarbonyl, cyclohexyloxycarbonyl, phenylthiocarbonyl and the like, arylalkyl groups such as benzyl, triphenylmethyl, benzyloxymethyl and the like and silyl groups such as trimethylsilyl and the like. Preferred N-protecting groups are tert-butyloxycarbonyl (Boc).


Examples of useful protecting groups for acids are substituted alkyl esters such as 9-fluorenylmethyl, methoxymethyl, methylthiomethyl, tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, methoxyethoxymethyl, 2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxymethyl, benzyloxymethyl, pivaloyloxymethyl, phenylacetoxymethyl, triisopropropylsysilylmethyl, cyanomethyl, acetol, phenacyl, substituted phenacyl esters, 2,2,2-trichloroethyl, 2-haloethyl, ω-chloroalkyl, 2-(trimethylsilyl)ethyl, 2-methylthioethyl, t-butyl, 3-methyl-3-pentyl, dicyclopropylmethyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, allyl, methallyl, cynnamyl, phenyl, silyl esters, benzyl and substituted benzyl esters, 2,6-dialkylphenyl esters such as pentafluorophenyl, 2,6-dialkylpyhenyl. Preferred protecting groups for acids are methyl or ethyl esters.


Methods of adding (a process generally referred to as “protection”) and removing (process generally referred to as “deprotection”) such amine and acid protecting groups are well-known in the art and available, for example in P. J. Kocienski, Protecting Groups, Thieme, 1994, which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety and in Greene and Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis, 3rd Edition (John Wiley & Sons, New York, 1999).


Unless otherwise stated, structures depicted herein are also meant to include all isomeric (e.g., enantiomeric, diastereomeric, and geometric (or conformational)) forms of the structure; for example, the R and S configurations for each asymmetric center, (Z) and (E) double bond isomers, and (Z) and (E) conformational isomers. Therefore, single stereochemical isomers as well as enantiomeric, diastereomeric, and geometric (or conformational) mixtures of the present compounds are within the scope of the invention. Unless otherwise stated, all tautomeric forms of the compounds of the invention are within the scope of the invention. E.g., compounds of Formula II may exist as tautomers:




embedded image


Additionally, unless otherwise stated, structures depicted herein are also meant to include compounds that differ only in the presence of one or more isotopically enriched atoms. For example, compounds having the present structures except for the replacement of hydrogen by deuterium or tritium, or the replacement of a carbon by a 13C- or 14C-enriched carbon are within the scope of this invention. Such compounds are useful, for example, as analytical tools or probes in biological assays.


Examples of suitable solvents are, but not limited to, water, methanol, dichloromethane (DCM), acetonitrile, dimethylformamide (DMF), ethyl acetate (EtOAc), isopropyl alcohol (IPA), isopropyl acetate (IPAc), tetrahydrofuran (THF), methyl ethyl ketone (MEK), t-butanol and N-methyl pyrrolidone (NMP).


II. Compounds of the Invention

In one aspect, the invention is directed to a pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of Formula I and a Compound of Formula II, optionally in combination with one or both of a Compound of Formula III and/or a Compound of Formula IV.




embedded image


II.A. Compounds of Formula I
II.A.1. Embodiments of Compounds of Formula I

In one aspect, the invention includes a composition comprising a compound of Formula I




embedded image


or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein:


Each of WRW2 and WRW4 is independently selected from CN, CF3, halo, C2-6 straight or branched alkyl, C3-12 membered cycloaliphatic, phenyl, a 5-10 membered heteroaryl or 3-7 membered heterocyclic, wherein said heteroaryl or heterocyclic has up to 3 heteroatoms selected from O, S, or N, wherein said WRW2 and WRW4 is independently and optionally substituted with up to three substituents selected from —OR′, —CF3, —OCF3, SR′, S(O)R′, SO2R′, —SCF3, halo, CN, —COOR′, —COR′, —O(CH2)2N(R′)2, —O(CH2)N(R′)2, —CON(R′)2, —(CH2)2OR′, —(CH2)OR′, —CH2CN, optionally substituted phenyl or phenoxy, —N(R′)2, —NR′C(O)OR′, —NR′C(O)R′, —(CH2)2N(R′)2, or —(CH2)N(R′)2;


WRW5 is selected from hydrogen, —OCF3, —CF3, —OH, —OCH3, —NH2, —CN, —CHF2, —NHR′, —N(R′)2, —NHC(O)R′, —NHC(O)OR′, —NHSO2R′, —CH2OH, —CH2N(R′)2, —C(O)OR′, —SO2NHR′, —SO2N(R′)2, or —CH2NHC(O)OR′; and


Each R′ is independently selected from an optionally substituted group selected from a C1-8 aliphatic group, a 3-8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or fully unsaturated monocyclic ring having 0-3 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, or an 8-12 membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or fully unsaturated bicyclic ring system having 0-5 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur; or two occurrences of R′ are taken together with the atom(s) to which they are bound to form an optionally substituted 3-12 membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or fully unsaturated monocyclic or bicyclic ring having 0-4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur;


provided that:


ii) WRW2 and WRW4 are not both —Cl;


WRW2, WRW4 and WRW5 are not —OCH2CH2Ph, —OCH2CH2(2-trifluoromethyl-phenyl), —OCH2CH2-(6,7-dimethoxy-1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolin-2-yl), or substituted 1H-pyrazol-3-yl.


In one embodiment of the compound of Formula I of the composition, each of WRW2 and WRW4 is independently selected from CN, CF3, halo, C2-6 straight or branched alkyl, C3-12 membered cycloaliphatic, or phenyl, wherein said WRW2 and WRW4 is independently and optionally substituted with up to three substituents selected from —OR′, —CF3, —OCF3, —SCF3, halo, —COOR′, —COR′, —O(CH2)2N(R′)2, —O(CH2)N(R′)2, —CON(R′)2, —(CH2)2OR′, —(CH2)OR′, optionally substituted phenyl, —N(R′)2, —NC(O)OR′, —NC(O)R′, —(CH2)2N(R′)2, or —(CH2)N(R′)2; and WRW5 is selected from hydrogen, —OCF3, —CF3, —OH, —OCH3, —NH2, —CN, —NHR′, —N(R′)2, —NHC(O)R′, —NHC(O)OR′, —NHSO2R′, —CH2OH, —C(O)OR′, —SO2NHR′, or —CH2NHC(O)O—R′).


Alternatively, each of WRW2 and WRW4 is independently selected from —CN, —CF3, C2-6 straight or branched alkyl, C3-12 membered cycloaliphatic, or phenyl, wherein each of said WRW2 and WRW4 is independently and optionally substituted with up to three substituents selected from —OR′, —CF3, —OCF3, —SCF3, halo, —COOR′, —COR′, —O(CH2)2N(R′)2, —O(CH2)N(R′)2, —CON(R′)2, —(CH2)2OR′, —(CH2)OR′, optionally substituted phenyl, —N(R′)2, —NC(O)OR′, —NC(O)R′, —(CH2)2N(R′)2, or —(CH2)N(R′)2; and WRW5 is selected from —OH, —CN, —NHR′, —N(R′)2, —NHC(O)R′, —NHC(O)OR′, —NHSO2R′, —CH2OH, —C(O)OR′, —SO2NHR′, or —CH2NHC(O)O—(R′).


In a further embodiment, WRW2 is a phenyl ring optionally substituted with up to three substituents selected from —OR′, —CF3, —OCF3, —SR′, —S(O)R′, —SO2R′, —SCF3, halo, —CN, —COOR′, —COR′, —O(CH2)2N(R′)2, —O(CH2)N(R′)2, —CON(R′)2, —(CH2)2OR′, —(CH2)OR′, —CH2CN, optionally substituted phenyl or phenoxy, —N(R′)2, —NR′C(O)OR′, —NR′C(O)R′, —(CH2)2N(R′)2, or —(CH2)N(R′)2; WRW4 is C2-6 straight or branched alkyl; and WRW5 is —OH.


In another embodiment, each of WRW2 and WRW4 is independently —CF3, —CN, or a C2-6 straight or branched alkyl.


In another embodiment, each of WRW2 and WRW4 is C2-6 straight or branched alkyl optionally substituted with up to three substituents independently selected from —OR′, —CF3, —OCF3, —SR′, —S(O)R′, —SO2R′, —SCF3, halo, —CN, —COOR′, —COR′, —O(CH2)2N(R′)2, —O(CH2)N(R′)2, —CON(R′)2, —(CH2)2OR′, —(CH2)OR′, —CH2CN, optionally substituted phenyl or phenoxy, —N(R′)2, —NR′C(O)OR′, —NR′C(O)R′, —(CH2)2N(R′)2, or —(CH2)N(R′)2.


In another embodiment, each of WRW2 and WRW4 is independently selected from optionally substituted n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, sec-butyl, t-butyl, 1,1-dimethyl-2-hydroxyethyl, 1,1-dimethyl-2-(ethoxycarbonyl)-ethyl, 1,1-dimethyl-3-(t-butoxycarbonyl-amino) propyl, or n-pentyl.


In another embodiment, WRW5 is selected from —CN, —NHR′, —N(R′)2, —CH2N(R′)2, —NHC(O)R′, —NHC(O)OR′, —OH, C(O)OR′, or —SO2NHR′.


In another embodiment, WRW5 is selected from —CN, —NH(C1-6 alkyl), —N(C1-6 alkyl)2, —NHC(O)(C1-6 alkyl), —CH2NHC(O)O(C1-6 alkyl), —NHC(O)O(C1-6 alkyl), —OH, —O(C1-6 alkyl), —C(O)O(C1-6 alkyl), —CH2O(C1-6 alkyl), or —SO2NH2.


In another embodiment, WRW5 is selected from —OH, —CH2OH, —NHC(O)OMe, —NHC(O)OEt, —CN, —CH2NHC(O)O(t-butyl), —C(O)OMe, or —SO2NH2.


In another embodiment:

    • a. WRW2 is C2-6 straight or branched alkyl;
    • b. WRW4 is C2-6 straight or branched alkyl or monocyclic or bicyclic aliphatic; and
    • c. WRW5 is selected from —CN, —NH(C1-6 alkyl), —N(C1-6 alkyl)2, —NHC(O)(C1-6 alkyl), —NHC(O)O(C1-6 alkyl), —CH2C(O)O(C1-6 alkyl), —OH, —O(C1-6 alkyl),
    •  —C(O)O(C1-6 alkyl), or —SO2NH2.


In another embodiment:

    • a. WRW2 is C2-6 alkyl, —CF3, —CN, or phenyl optionally substituted with up to 3 substituents selected from C1-4 alkyl, —O(C1-4 alkyl), or halo;
    • b. WRW4 is —CF3, C2-6 alkyl, or C6-10 cycloaliphatic; and
    • c. WRW5 is —OH, —NH(C1-6 alkyl), or —N(C1-6 alkyl)2.


In another embodiment, WRW2 is tert-butyl.


In another embodiment, WRW4 is tert-butyl.


In another embodiment, WRW5 is —OH.


II.A.2. Compound 1

In another embodiment, the compound of Formula I is Compound 1.




embedded image


Compound 1 is known by the name N-[2,4-bis(1,1-dimethylethyl)-5-hydroxyphenyl]-1,4-dihydro-4-oxoquinoline-3-carboxamide and by the name N-(5-hydroxy-2,4-di-tert-butyl-phenyl)-4-oxo-1H-quinoline-3-carboxamide.


II.A.3. Synthesis of the Compounds of Formula I

Compounds of Formula I




embedded image


are readily prepared by combining an acid moiety




embedded image


with an amine moiety




embedded image


as described herein, wherein WRW2, WRW4, and WRW5 are as defined previously.


II.A.3.a. Synthesis of the Acid Moiety of Compounds of Formula I

The acid precursor of compounds of Formula I, dihydroquinoline carboxylic acid, can be synthesized according to Scheme 1-1, by conjugate addition of EtOCH═C(COOEt)2 to aniline, followed by thermal rearrangement and hydrolysis.




embedded image


II.A.3.b. Synthesis of the Amine Moiety of Compounds of Formula I

Amine precursors of compounds of Formula I are prepared as depicted in Scheme 1-2, wherein WRW2, WRW4, and WRW5 are as defined previously. Thus, ortho alkylation of the para-substituted benzene in step (a) provides a tri-substituted intermediate. Optional protection when WRW5 is OH (step (b) and nitration (step c) provides the trisubstituted nitrated intermediate. Optional deprotection (step d) and hydrogenation (step e) provides the desired amine moiety.




embedded image


II.A.3.c. Synthesis of Compounds of Formula I by Acid and Amine Moiety Coupling

Compounds of Formula I are prepared by coupling an acid moiety with an amine moiety as depicted in Scheme 1-3. In general, the coupling reaction requires a coupling reagent, a base, as well as a solvent. Examples of conditions used include HATU, DIEA; BOP, DIEA, DMF; HBTU, Et3N, CH2Cl2; PFPTFA, pyridine.




embedded image


II.A.4. Examples
Synthesis of Compound 1

Compound 1 can be prepared generally as provided in Schemes 1-3 through 1-6, wherein an acid moiety




embedded image


is coupled with an amine moiety




embedded image


wherein WRW2 and WRW4 are t-butyl, and WRW5 is OH. More detailed schemes and examples are provided below.


II.A.4.a. Synthesis of Acid Moiety of Compound 1

The synthesis of the acid moiety 4-Oxo-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid 26, is summarized in Scheme 1-4.




embedded image


Example 1a
Ethyl 4-oxo-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylate (25)

Compound 23 (4.77 g, 47.7 mmol) was added dropwise to Compound 22 (10 g, 46.3 mmol) with subsurface N2 flow to drive out ethanol below 30° C. for 0.5 hours. The solution was then heated to 100-110° C. and stirred for 2.5 hours. After cooling the mixture to below 60° C., diphenyl ether was added. The resulting solution was added dropwise to diphenyl ether that had been heated to 228-232° C. for 1.5 hours with subsurface N2 flow to drive out ethanol. The mixture was stirred at 228-232° C. for another 2 hours, cooled to below 100° C. and then heptane was added to precipitate the product. The resulting slurry was stirred at 30° C. for 0.5 hours. The solids were then filtered, and the cake was washed with heptane and dried in vacuo to give Compound 25 as a brown solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-d6; 400 MHz) δ 12.25 (s), δ 8.49 (d), δ 8.10 (m), δ 7.64 (m), δ 7.55 (m), δ 7.34 (m), δ 4.16 (q), δ 1.23 (t).


Example 1b
4-Oxo-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid (26)



embedded image


Method 1

Compound 25 (1.0 eq) was suspended in a solution of HCl (10.0 eq) and H2O (11.6 vol). The slurry was heated to 85-90° C., although alternative temperatures are also suitable for this hydrolysis step. For example, the hydrolysis can alternatively be performed at a temperature of from about 75 to about 100° C. In some instances, the hydrolysis is performed at a temperature of from about 80 to about 95° C. In others, the hydrolysis step is performed at a temperature of from about 82 to about 93° C. (e.g., from about 82.5 to about 92.5° C. or from about 86 to about 89° C.). After stirring at 85-90° C. for approximately 6.5 hours, the reaction was sampled for reaction completion. Stirring may be performed under any of the temperatures suited for the hydrolysis. The solution was then cooled to 20-25° C. and filtered. The reactor/cake was rinsed with H2O (2 vol×2). The cake was then washed with 2 vol H2O until the pH≧3.0. The cake was then dried under vacuum at 60° C. to give Compound 26.


Method 2

Compound 25 (11.3 g, 52 mmol) was added to a mixture of 10% NaOH (aq) (10 mL) and ethanol (100 mL). The solution was heated to reflux for 16 hours, cooled to 20-25° C. and then the pH was adjusted to 2-3 with 8% HCl. The mixture was then stirred for 0.5 hours and filtered. The cake was washed with water (50 mL) and then dried in vacuo to give Compound 26 as a brown solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-d6; 400 MHz) δ 15.33 (s), δ 13.39 (s), δ 8.87 (s), δ 8.26 (m), δ 7.87 (m), δ 7.80 (m), δ 7.56 (m).


II.A.4.b. Synthesis of Amine Moiety of Compound 1

The synthesis of the amine moiety 32, is summarized in Scheme 1-5.




embedded image


Example 1c
2,4-Di-tert-butylphenyl methyl carbonate (30)
Method 1

To a solution of 2,4-di-tert-butyl phenol (29) (10 g, 48.5 mmol) in diethyl ether (100 mL) and triethylamine (10.1 mL, 72.8 mmol), was added methyl chloroformate (7.46 mL, 97 mmol) dropwise at 0° C. The mixture was then allowed to warm to room temperature and stir for an additional 2 hours. An additional 5 mL triethylamine and 3.7 mL methyl chloroformate was then added and the reaction stirred overnight. The reaction was then filtered, the filtrate was cooled to 0° C., and an additional 5 mL triethylamine and 3.7 mL methyl chloroformate was then added and the reaction was allowed to warm to room temperature and then stir for an additional 1 hour. At this stage, the reaction was almost complete and was worked up by filtering, then washing with water (2×), followed by brine. The solution was then concentrated to produce a yellow oil and purified using column chromatography to give Compound 30. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 7.35 (d, J=2.4 Hz, 1H), 7.29 (dd, J=8.4, 2.4 Hz, 1H), 7.06 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H), 3.85 (s, 3H), 1.30 (s, 9H), 1.29 (s, 9H).


Method 2

To a reactor vessel charged with 4-dimethylaminopyridine (DMAP, 3.16 g, 25.7 mmol) and 2,4-ditert-butyl phenol (Compound 29, 103.5 g, 501.6 mmol) was added methylene chloride (415 g, 313 mL) and the solution was agitated until all solids dissolved. Triethylamine (76 g, 751 mmol) was then added and the solution was cooled to 0-5° C. Methyl chloroformate (52 g, 550.3 mmol) was then added dropwise over 2.5-4 hours, while keeping the solution temperature between 0-5° C. The reaction mixture was then slowly heated to 23-28° C. and stirred for 20 hours. The reaction was then cooled to 10-15° C. and charged with 150 mL water. The mixture was stirred at 15-20° C. for 35-45 minutes and the aqueous layer was then separated and extracted with 150 mL methylene chloride. The organic layers were combined and neutralized with 2.5% HCl (aq) at a temperature of 5-20° C. to give a final pH of 5-6. The organic layer was then washed with water and concentrated in vacuo at a temperature below 20° C. to 150 mL to give Compound 30.


Example 1d
5-Nitro-2,4-di-tert-butylphenyl methyl carbonate (31)
Method 1

To a stirred solution of Compound 30 (6.77 g, 25.6 mmol) was added 6 mL of a 1:1 mixture of sulfuric acid and nitric acid at 0° C. dropwise. The mixture was allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred for 1 hour. The product was purified using liquid chromatography (ISCO, 120 g, 0-7% EtOAc/Hexanes, 38 min) producing about an 8:1-10:1 mixture of regioisomers of Compound 31 as a white solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 7.63 (s, 1H), 7.56 (s, 1H), 3.87 (s, 3H), 1.36 (s, 9H), 1.32 (s, 9H). HPLC ret. time 3.92 min 10-99% CH3CN, 5 min run; ESI-MS 310 m/z (MH)+.


Method 2

To Compound 30 (100 g, 378 mmol) was added DCM (540 g, 408 mL). The mixture was stirred until all solids dissolved, and then cooled to −5-0° C. Concentrated sulfuric acid (163 g) was then added dropwise, while maintaining the initial temperature of the reaction, and the mixture was stirred for 4.5 hours. Nitric acid (62 g) was then added dropwise over 2-4 hours while maintaining the initial temperature of the reaction, and was then stirred at this temperature for an additional 4.5 hours. The reaction mixture was then slowly added to cold water, maintaining a temperature below 5° C. The quenched reaction was then heated to 25° C. and the aqueous layer was removed and extracted with methylene chloride. The combined organic layers were washed with water, dried using Na2SO4, and concentrated to 124-155 mL. Hexane (48 g) was added and the resulting mixture was again concentrated to 124-155 mL. More hexane (160 g) was subsequently added to the mixture. The mixture was then stirred at 23-27° C. for 15.5 hours, and was then filtered. To the filter cake was added hexane (115 g), the resulting mixture was heated to reflux and stirred for 2-2.5 hours. The mixture was then cooled to 3-7° C., stirred for an additional 1-1.5 hours, and filtered to give Compound 31 as a pale yellow solid.


Example 1e
5-Amino-2,4-di-tert-butylphenyl methyl carbonate (32)

2,4-Di-tert-butyl-5-nitrophenyl methyl carbonate (1.00 eq) was charged to a suitable hydrogenation reactor, followed by 5% Pd/C (2.50 wt % dry basis, Johnson-Matthey Type 37). MeOH (15.0 vol) was charged to the reactor, and the system was closed. The system was purged with N2 (g), and was then pressurized to 2.0 Bar with H2 (g). The reaction was performed at a reaction temperature of 25° C.+/−5° C. When complete, the reaction was filtered, and the reactor/cake was washed with MeOH (4.00 vol). The resulting filtrate was distilled under vacuum at no more than 50° C. to 8.00 vol. Water (2.00 vol) was added at 45° C.+/−5° C. The resultant slurry was cooled to 0° C.+/−5. The slurry was held at 0° C.+/−5° C. for no less than 1 hour, and filtered. The cake was washed once with 0° C.+/−5° C. MeOH/H2O (8:2) (2.00 vol). The cake was dried under vacuum (−0.90 bar and −0.86 bar) at 35° C.-40° C. to give Compound 32. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 7.05 (s, 1H), 6.39 (s, 1H), 4.80 (s, 2H), 3.82 (s, 3H), 1.33 (s, 9H), 1.23 (s, 9H).


Once the reaction was complete, the resulting mixture was diluted with from about 5 to 10 volumes of MeOH (e.g., from about 6 to about 9 volumes of MeOH, from about 7 to about 8.5 volumes of MeOH, from about 7.5 to about 8 volumes of MeOH, or about 7.7 volumes of MeOH), heated to a temperature of about 35±5° C., and filtered to remove palladium. The reactor cake was washed before combining the filtrate and wash, distilling, adding water, cooling, filtering, washing and drying the product cake as described above.


II.A.4.c. Synthesis of Compound 1 by Acid and Amine Moiety Coupling

The coupling of the acid moiety to the amine moiety is summarized in Scheme 1-6.




embedded image


Example 1f
N-(2,4-di-tert-butyl-5-hydroxyphenyl)-4-oxo-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxamide (1)

4-Oxo-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid (26) (1.0 eq) and 5-amino-2,4-di-tert-butylphenyl methyl carbonate (32) (1.1 eq) were charged to a reactor. 2-MeTHF (4.0 vol, relative to the acid) was added followed by T3P® 50% solution in 2-MeTHF (1.7 eq). The T3P charged vessel was washed with 2-MeTHF (0.6 vol). Pyridine (2.0 eq) was then added, and the resulting suspension was heated to 47.5+/−5.0° C. and held at this temperature for 8 hours. A sample was taken and checked for completion by HPLC. Once complete, the resulting mixture was cooled to 25.0° C.+/−2.5° C. 2-MeTHF was added (12.5 vol) to dilute the mixture. The reaction mixture was washed with water (10.0 vol) 2 times. 2-MeTHF was added to bring the total volume of reaction to 40.0 vol (˜16.5 vol charged). To this solution was added NaOMe/MeOH (1.7 equiv) to perform the methanolysis. The reaction was stirred for no less than 1.0 hour, and checked for completion by HPLC. Once complete, the reaction was quenched with 1 N HCl (10.0 vol), and washed with 0.1 N HCl (10.0 vol). The organic solution was polish filtered to remove any particulates and placed in a second reactor. The filtered solution was concentrated at no more than 45° C. (jacket temperature) and no less than 8.0° C. (internal reaction temperature) under reduced pressure to 20 vol. CH3CN was added to 40 vol and the solution concentrated at no more than 45° C. (jacket temperature) and no less than 8.0° C. (internal reaction temperature) to 20 vol. The addition of CH3CN and concentration cycle was repeated 2 more times for a total of 3 additions of CH3CN and 4 concentrations to 20 vol. After the final concentration to 20 vol, 16.0 vol of CH3CN was added followed by 4.0 vol of H2O to make a final concentration of 40 vol of 10% H2O/CH3CN relative to the starting acid. This slurry was heated to 78.0° C.+/−5.0° C. (reflux). The slurry was then stirred for no less than 5 hours. The slurry was cooled to 0.0° C.+/−5° C. over 5 hours, and filtered. The cake was washed with 0.0° C.+/−5.0° C. CH3CN (5 vol) 4 times. The resulting solid (Compound 1) was dried in a vacuum oven at no more than 50.0° C. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 12.8 (s, 1H), 11.8 (s, 1H), 9.2 (s, 1H), 8.9 (s, 1H), 8.3 (s, 1H), 7.2 (s, 1H), 7.9 (t, 1H), 7.8 (d, 1H), 7.5 (t, 1H), 7.1 (s, 1H), 1.4 (s, 9H), 1.4 (s, 9H).


An alternative synthesis of Compound 1 is depicted in Scheme 1-7.




embedded image


Example 1g
N-(2,4-di-tert-butyl-5-hydroxyphenyl)-4-oxo-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxamide (1)

4-Oxo-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid 26 (1.0 eq) and 5-amino-2,4-di-tert-butylphenyl methyl carbonate 32 (1.1 eq) were charged to a reactor. 2-MeTHF (4.0 vol, relative to the acid) was added followed by T3P® 50% solution in 2-MeTHF (1.7 eq). The T3P charged vessel was washed with 2-MeTHF (0.6 vol). Pyridine (2.0 eq) was then added, and the resulting suspension was heated to 47.5+/−5.0° C. and held at this temperature for 8 hours. A sample was taken and checked for completion by HPLC. Once complete, the resulting mixture was cooled to 20° C.+/−5° C. 2-MeTHF was added (12.5 vol) to dilute the mixture. The reaction mixture was washed with water (10.0 vol) 2 times and 2-MeTHF (16.5 vol) was charged to the reactor. This solution was charged with 30% w/w NaOMe/MeOH (1.7 equiv) to perform the methanolysis. The reaction was stirred at 25.0° C.+/−5.0° C. for no less than 1.0 hour, and checked for completion by HPLC. Once complete, the reaction was quenched with 1.2 N HCl/H2O (10.0 vol), and washed with 0.1 N HCl/H2O (10.0 vol). The organic solution was polish filtered to remove any particulates and placed in a second reactor.


The filtered solution was concentrated at no more than 45° C. (jacket temperature) and no less than 8.0° C. (internal reaction temperature) under reduced pressure to 20 vol. CH3CN was added to 40 vol and the solution concentrated at no more than 45° C. (jacket temperature) and no less than 8.0° C. (internal reaction temperature) to 20 vol. The addition of CH3CN and concentration cycle was repeated 2 more times for a total of 3 additions of CH3CN and 4 concentrations to 20 vol. After the final concentration to 20 vol, 16.0 vol of CH3CN was charged followed by 4.0 vol of H2O to make a final concentration of 40 vol of 10% H2O/CH3CN relative to the starting acid. This slurry was heated to 78.0° C.+/−5.0° C. (reflux). The slurry was then stirred for no less than 5 hours. The slurry was cooled to 20 to 25° C. over 5 hours, and filtered. The cake was washed with CH3CN (5 vol) heated to 20 to 25° C. 4 times. The resulting solid (Compound 1) was dried in a vacuum oven at no more than 50.0° C. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 12.8 (s, 1H), 11.8 (s, 1H), 9.2 (s, 1H), 8.9 (s, 1H), 8.3 (s, 1H), 7.2 (s, 1H), 7.9 (t, 1H), 7.8 (d, 1H), 7.5 (t, 1H), 7.1 (s, 1H), 1.4 (s, 9H), 1.4 (s, 9H).


II.B. Compounds of Formula II
II.B.1. Embodiments of Compounds of Formula II

In one aspect, the invention includes a pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of Formula II




embedded image


or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein:

    • ring A is selected from:




embedded image




    • R1 is —CF3, —CN, or —C≡CCH2N(CH3)2;

    • R2 is hydrogen, —CH3, —CF3, —OH, or —CH2OH;

    • R3 is hydrogen, —CH3, —OCH3, or —CN;


      provided that both R2 and R3 are not simultaneously hydrogen.





In one embodiment, ring A of Formula II is




embedded image


In one embodiment, ring A of Formula II is




embedded image


In another embodiment, ring A of Formula II is




embedded image


In yet another embodiment, ring A of Formula II is




embedded image


In one embodiment, R1 of Formula II is —CF3.


In another embodiment, R1 of Formula II is —CN.


In another embodiment, R1 of Formula II is —C≡CCH2N(CH3)2.


In one embodiment, R2 of Formula II is —CH3.


In another embodiment, R2 of Formula II is —CF3.


In another embodiment, R2 of Formula II is —OH.


In another embodiment, R2 of Formula II is —CH2OH.


In one embodiment, R3 of Formula II is —CH3.


In one embodiment, R3 of Formula II is —OCH3.


In another embodiment, R3 of Formula II is —CN.


In one embodiment, R2 of Formula II is hydrogen; and R3 of Formula II is —CH3, —OCH3, or —CN.


In another embodiment, R2 of Formula II is —CH3, —CF3, —OH, or —CH2OH; and R3 of Formula II is hydrogen.


In several embodiments of the present invention, ring A of Formula II is




embedded image


R1 is —CF3, R2 is hydrogen; and R3 is —CH3, —OCH3, or —CN. In other embodiments, R1 is —CN. In still further embodiments, R1 is —C≡CCH2N(CH3)2. In one embodiment, R3 is —CH3. Or, R3 is —OCH3. Or, R3 is —CN.


In further embodiments of the present invention, ring A of Formula II is




embedded image


R1 is —CF3, R2 is —CH3, —CF3, —OH, or —CH2OH, and R3 is hydrogen. In other embodiments, R1 is —CN. In still further embodiments, R1 is —C≡CCH2N(CH3)2. In one embodiment, R2 is —CH3. Or, R2 is —CF3. Or, R2 is —OH. Or, R2 is —CH2OH.


In several embodiments of the present invention, ring A of Formula II is




embedded image


R1 is —CF3, R2 is hydrogen; and R3 is —CH3, —OCH3, or —CN. In other embodiments, R1 is —CN. In still further embodiments, R1 is —C≡CCH2N(CH3)2. In one embodiment, R3 is —OCH3. Or, R3 is —CH3. Or, R3 is —CN.


In further embodiments of the present invention, ring A is




embedded image


R1 of Formula II is —CF3, R2 is —CH3, —CF3, —OH, or —CH2OH, and R3 is hydrogen. In other embodiments, R1 is —CN. In still further embodiments, R1 is —C≡CCH2N(CH3)2. In one embodiment, R2 is —CH3. Or, R2 is —CF3. Or, R2 is —OH. Or, R2 is —CH2OH.


In several embodiments of the present invention, ring A of Formula II is




embedded image


R1 is —CF3, R2 is hydrogen; and R3 is —CH3, —OCH3, or —CN. In other embodiments, R1 is —CN. In still further embodiments, R1 is —C≡CCH2N(CH3)2. In one embodiment, R3 is —CH3. Or, R3 is —OCH3. Or, R3 is —CN.


In further embodiments of the present invention, ring A of Formula II is




embedded image


R1 is —CF3, R2 is —CH3, —CF3, —OH, or —CH2OH, and R3 is hydrogen. In other embodiments, R1 is —CN. In still further embodiments, R1 is —C≡CCH2N(CH3)2. In one embodiment, R2 is —CH3. Or, R2 is —CF3. Or, R2 is —OH. Or, R2 is —CH2OH.


In several embodiments of the present invention, ring A of Formula II is




embedded image


R1 is —CF3, R2 is hydrogen; and R3 is —CH3, —OCH3, or —CN. In other embodiments, R1 is —CN. In still further embodiments, R1 is —C≡CCH2N(CH3)2. In one embodiment, R3 is —CH3. Or, R3 is —OCH3. Or, R3 is —CN.


In further embodiments of the present invention, ring A of Formula II is




embedded image


R1 is —CF3, R2 is —CH3, —CF3, —OH, or —CH2OH, and R3 is hydrogen. In other embodiments, R1 is —CN. In still further embodiments, R1 is —C≡CCH2N(CH3)2. In one embodiment, R2 is —CH3. Or, R2 is —CF3. Or, R2 is —OH. Or, R2 is —CH2OH.


Representative compounds of Formula II are set forth in Table 2-1 below.










TABLE 2-1









embedded image


2-1







embedded image


2







embedded image


2-3







embedded image


2-4







embedded image


2-5







embedded image


2-6







embedded image


2-7







embedded image


2-8







embedded image


2-9







embedded image


2-10







embedded image


2-11







embedded image


2-12







embedded image


2-13







embedded image


2-14









II.B.2. Compound 2

In another embodiment, the Compound of Formula II is Compound 2, which is known by its chemical name N-(4-(7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-7-yl)-2-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl)-4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxamide.




embedded image


II.B.3. Synthesis of Compounds of Formula II



embedded image


Scheme 2-1 depicts a convergent approach to the preparation of compounds of Formula II from substituted benzene derivatives 1a and 2a. In the ultimate transformation, amide formation via coupling of carboxylic acid 1d with amine 2c to give a compound of Formula II can be achieved using either O-(7-azabenzotriazol-1-yl)-N,N,N′,N′-tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate (HATU) and triethylamine in N,N-dimethyl formamide (DMF) or propyl sulfonic acid cyclic anhydride (T3P®) and pyridine in 2-methyltetrahydrofuran. Carboxylic acid 1d is prepared from the corresponding substituted benzene derivative 1a via a sequence commencing with heat-mediated condensation of 1a with an appropriate malonate (CO2R)2CH═CH(OR), wherein R is an alkyl or aryl group such as methyl, ethyl, t-butyl, phenyl, p-nitro phenyl or the like, to provide 1b.


Compound 1b is converted to carboxylic acid 1d via a three step sequence including intramolecular cyclization upon heating at reflux in Dowtherm or diphenyl ether (step b), followed by removal (if needed) of the blocking halo group (step c) under palladium-catalyzed dehalogenation conditions and acid- or base-catalyzed saponification (step d). The order of the deprotection and saponification steps can be reversed; i.e., step c can occur before or after step d, as depicted in Scheme 2-1.


Referring again to Scheme 2-1, aniline derivative 2c can be prepared from nitrobenzene 2a via a three step sequence. Thus, coupling of nitrobenzene 2a with a cyclic amine




embedded image


3 as defined herein in the presence of triethylamine provides compound 2b. Palladium-catalyzed reduction of 2b provides amine 2c.




embedded image


Scheme 2-2 depicts the synthesis of compounds of Formula II bearing a propynyl amine side chain. Thus, coupling of nitrobenzene 2a, wherein Hal is bromide, chloride, or the like, with




embedded image


3 as defined herein in the presence potassium carbonate in DMSO provides compound 4. Palladium-catalyzed coupling of compound 4 with N,N-dimethylprop-2-yn-1-amine, followed by iron or zinc catalyzed reduction of the nitro moiety, provides amine 5. Coupling of amine 5 with carboxylic acid 1d provides compound 6 which is a compound of Formula II.




embedded image


Scheme 2-3 depicts the synthesis of a compound of Formula II wherein




embedded image


3 is 7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptane, optionally bearing an exo or endo hydroxy group at the 2-position. The hydroxy-substituted adducts (+)-endo-7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-2-ol, (−)-endo-7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-2-ol, (+)-exo-7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-2-ol, and (−)-exo-7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-2-ol can be prepared using procedures as described in Fletcher, S. R., et al., “Total Synthesis and Determination of the Absolute Configuration of Epibatidine,” J. Org. Chem, 59, pp. 1771-1778 (1994). 7-Azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptane itself is commercially available from Tyger Scientific Inc. 324 Stokes Avenue Ewing, N.J., 08638 USA.


Thus, as with the series of transformations summarized in Schemes 2-1 and 2-2, coupling of compound 2a with the bicyclo[2.2.1]amine of Formula 7 provides a compound of Formula 8. If the compound of Formula 8 has a hydroxy group, it may be necessary to protect the hydroxy group with a protecting group, such as a silyl protecting group as in step b, prior to subsequent transformations. Treatment of the hydroxylated compound of Formula 8 with a silylating agent such as tert-butyl dimethylsilyl chloride, using known conditions, provides the protected compound of Formula 9. Reduction of the nitro moiety provides an amine of Formula 10. Amide formation with 1d (cf. Scheme 1-3) and removal of the hydroxy protecting group (step e—as needed) provides a compound of Formula 11 which is also a compound of Formula II.


II.B.4. Examples
Synthesis of Compound 2
Intermediate 1: 4-Oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid (17)



embedded image


Example 2a
Diethyl 2-((2-chloro-5-(trifluoromethyl)phenylamino)methylene) malonate (14)

2-Chloro-5-(trifluoromethyl)aniline 12 (200 g, 1.023 mol), diethyl 2-(ethoxymethylene)malonate 13 (276 g, 1.3 mol) and toluene (100 mL) were combined under a nitrogen atmosphere in a three-neck, 1-L round bottom flask equipped with Dean-Stark condenser. The solution was heated with stirring to 140° C. and the temperature was maintained for 4 h. The reaction mixture was cooled to 70° C. and hexane (600 mL) was slowly added. The resulting slurry was stirred and allowed to warm to room temperature. The solid was collected by filtration, washed with 10% ethyl acetate in hexane (2×400 mL) and then dried under vacuum to provide a white solid (350 g, 94% yield) as the desired condensation product diethyl 2-((2-chloro-5-(trifluoromethyl)phenylamino)methylene) malonate 14. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 11.28 (d, J=13.0 Hz, 1H), 8.63 (d, J=13.0 Hz, 1H), 8.10 (s, 1H), 7.80 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 1H), 7.50 (dd, J=1.5, 8.4 Hz, 1H), 4.24 (q, J=7.1 Hz, 2H), 4.17 (q, J=7.1 Hz, 2H), 1.27 (m, 6H).


Example 2b
Ethyl 8-chloro-4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylate (15)
Method 1

A 3-neck, 1-L flask was charged with Dowtherm® (200 mL, 8 mL/g), which was degassed at 200° C. for 1 h. The solvent was heated to 260° C. and charged in portions over 10 min with diethyl 2-((2-chloro-5-(trifluoromethyl)phenylamino)methylene)malonate 14 (25 g, 0.07 mol). The resulting mixture was stirred at 260° C. for 6.5 hours (h) and the resulting ethanol byproduct removed by distillation. The mixture was allowed to slowly cool to 80° C. Hexane (150 mL) was slowly added over 30 minutes (min), followed by an additional 200 mL of hexane added in one portion. The slurry was stirred until it had reached room temperature. The solid was filtered, washed with hexane (3×150 mL), and then dried under vacuum to provide ethyl 8-chloro-4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylate 15 as a tan solid (13.9 g, 65% yield). 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 11.91 (s, 1H), 8.39 (s, 1H), 8.06 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 1H), 7.81 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H), 4.24 (q, J=7.1 Hz, 2H), 1.29 (t, J=7.1 Hz, 3H).


Method 2

Compound 14 (2000 g, 5.468 mol) was introduced into the reactor. Dowtherm (4.000 L) was charged to the reactor and degassed at room temperature overnight with nitrogen purge. It was then stirred and warmed to 260° C. EtOH produced was distilled off. The reaction was monitored and was complete after 5.5 h. The heat source was removed and the reaction mixture was cooled to 80° C. and heptane (2.000 L) was charged. The mixture was stirred for 30 min. Heptane (6.000 L) was charged to the stirred mixture and stirring continued overnight. Solids were filtered off and washed with heptane (4.000 L) and dried in a vacuum oven at 50° C. to provide Compound 15.


Example 2c
Ethyl 4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1H-quinoline-3-carboxylate (16)

A 3-neck, 5-L flask was charged with of ethyl 8-chloro-4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylate 15 (100 g, 0.3 mol), ethanol (1250 mL, 12.5 mL/g) and triethylamine (220 mL, 1.6 mol). The vessel was then charged with 10 g of 10% Pd/C (50% wet) at 5° C. The reaction was stirred vigorously under hydrogen atmosphere for 20 h at 5° C., after which time the reaction mixture was concentrated to a volume of approximately 150 mL. The product, ethyl 4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1H-quinoline-3-carboxylate 16, as a slurry with Pd/C, was taken directly into the next step.


Example 2d
4-Oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid (17)

Ethyl 4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1H-quinoline-3-carboxylate 16 (58 g, 0.2 mol, crude reaction slurry containing Pd/C) was suspended in NaOH (814 mL of 5 M, 4.1 mol) in a 1-L flask with a reflux condenser and heated at 80° C. for 18 h, followed by further heating at 100° C. for 5 h. The reaction was filtered warm through packed Celite to remove Pd/C and the Celite was rinsed with 1 N NaOH. The filtrate was acidified to about pH 1 to obtain a thick, white precipitate. The precipitate was filtered then rinsed with water and cold acetonitrile. The solid was then dried under vacuum to provide 4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid 17 as a white solid (48 g, 92% yield). 1H NMR (400.0 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 15.26 (s, 1H), 13.66 (s, 1H), 8.98 (s, 1H), 8.13 (dd, J=1.6, 7.8 Hz, 1H), 8.06-7.99 (m, 2H).


Alternative Preparation of Intermediate 1: 4-Oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid (17)



embedded image


Example 2e
8-chloro-4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid (15a)

Ethyl 8-chloro-4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylate (15) (1200 g, 3.754 mol) was charged into a reaction vessel followed by the addition of 2-propanol (1.200 L) and water (7.200 L) and stirred. Sodium hydroxide (600.6 g, 7.508 mol) and water (1.200 L) were mixed and allowed to cool to room temperature. The resulting mixture was charged into the reaction vessel and then was heated to 80° C. and stirred for 3.5 h to generate a dark, homogenous mixture. After an additional hour, acetic acid (9.599 L of 20% w/v, 31.97 mol) was added via dropping funnel over 45 min. The reaction mixture was cooled with stirring to 22° C. at a rate of 6° C./h. The resulting solid was filtered and washed with water (3 L) to generate a wet cake (1436 g). The filtrate was dried in a vacuum oven with a nitrogen bleed over Drierite® to generate 8-chloro-4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid as a brown solid (1069 g). The 8-chloro-4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid was purified by slurrying in 1.5 L methanol and stirring for 6 h. It was then filtered and dried to furnish 968.8 g of purified 8-chloro-4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid.


Example 2f
4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid (17)

Compound 15a (18.5 g, 1.00 eq, limiting reagent) was charged into a reaction vessel and MeOH (118 mL, 6.4 vol) was added under inert atmosphere with agitation. Sodium methoxide (3.53 g, 1.00 eq.) was added portion wise over 10 min to the reactor. The mixture was stirred until all solids are in solution (5-10 minutes). Palladium on carbon (2.7 g, 0.03 eq) was then added to the reaction mixture. Potassium formate (10.78 g, 2 eq.) dissolved in MeOH (67 mL, 3.6 vol) was added to the reaction mixture over 30 min [Alternatively, the potassium formate reagent may be replaced with hydrogen gas]. It was then stirred for about 4.5 h at ambient temperature. The reaction was judged complete when 8-chloro-4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid was no more than 1.0% relative to 4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid (17). When the reaction was complete, the mixture was filtered through a pad of Celite (mass of Celite used approximately 2× mass of 8-chloro-4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid charged into the vessel at the start) to remove solids. The Celite cake was washed with MeOH (37 mL, 2 vol). The filtrate was charged into a clean reaction vessel and stirred. Acetic acid (7.22 mL, 2 eq.) was charged continuously to the stirred solution over at least 45 minutes and the resulting slurry stirred for between 5-16 h. The solid was filtered and the cake washed with MeOH (56 mL, 3 vol), suction-dried and then vacuum dried to give the title compound as an white/off white solid.


Intermediate 2: 4-(7-Azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-7-yl)-2-(trifluoromethyl)aniline (20)



embedded image


Example 2g
7-[4-Nitro-3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptane (19)
Method 1

To a flask containing 7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptane hydrochloride 7a (4.6 g, 34.43 mmol, obtained from Tyger Scientific Inc., 324 Stokes Avenue, Ewing, N.J., 08638 USA under a nitrogen atmosphere was added a solution of 4-fluoro-1-nitro-2-(trifluoromethyl)benzene 18 (6.0 g, 28.69 mmol) and triethylamine (8.7 g, 12.00 mL, 86.07 mmol) in acetonitrile (50 mL). The reaction flask was heated at 80° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere for 16 h. The reaction mixture was allowed to cool and then was partitioned between water and dichloromethane. The organic layer was washed with 1 M HCl, dried over Na2SO4, filtered, and concentrated to dryness. Purification by silica gel chromatography (0-10% ethyl acetate in hexanes) yielded 7-[4-nitro-3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptane (19) (7.2 g, 88% yield) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (400.0 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 8.03 (d, J=9.1 Hz, 1H), 7.31 (d, J=2.4 Hz, 1H), 7.25 (dd, J=2.6, 9.1 Hz, 1H), 4.59 (s, 2H), 1.69-1.67 (m, 4H), 1.50 (d, J=7.0 Hz, 4H).


Method 2

4-Fluoro-1-nitro-2-(trifluoromethyl)benzene (18) (901 g, 4.309 mol) was introduced into a 30 L jacketed vessel along with Na2CO3 (959.1 g, 9.049 mol) and DMSO (5 L, 5.5 vol) under nitrogen atmosphere and stirring. 7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptane hydrochloride (7a) (633.4 g, 4.740 mol) was then added to the vessel in portions. The temperature was gradually raised to 55° C. When the reaction was substantially complete, the mixture was diluted with 10 vol EtOAc and washed with water (5.5 vol) three times or until DMSO in the aqueous layer disappeared (HPLC). The organic layer was concentrated to 4 vol and then the solvent was swapped with cyclohexane until all the EtOAc was removed, and the total volume in the flask was about 4 vol containing cyclohexane. The reaction mixture was heated to 60° C. on a rotary evaporator for 30 min. Then the solution was cooled to room temperature with stirring or rotation for 3 h. When all the solid crystallized, the solution was concentrated to dryness to provide 7-[4-nitro-3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptane (19).


Method 3

4-Fluoro-1-nitro-2-(trifluoromethyl)benzene (18) was dissolved in 3 vol DCM. Tetrabutylammoniumbromide (0.05 eq) and KOH (50 wt %, 3.6 eq) were added. 7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptane hydrochloride (7a) was then added at 0-5° C. The reaction was warmed up to ambient temperature and monitored by HPLC. Once substantially complete, the layers were separated and the organic layer was washed with 1M HCl. The layers were separated and the aqueous layer was discarded. The organic layer was washed once with water, once with brine, and then distilled. The resulting material was recrystallized from cyclohexane at reflux. The solid was filtered, washed with cyclohexane, and dried in a vacuum oven at 45° C. with a N2 gas bleed to provide 7-[4-nitro-3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptane (19).


Example 2h
4-(7-Azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-7-yl)-2-(trifluoromethyl)aniline (20)

A flask charged with 7-[4-nitro-3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptane 19 (7.07 g, 24.70 mmol) and 10% Pd/C (0.71 g, 6.64 mmol) was evacuated and then flushed with nitrogen. Ethanol (22 mL) was added and the reaction flask was fitted with a hydrogen balloon. After stirring vigorously for 12 h, the reaction mixture was purged with nitrogen and Pd/C was removed by filtration. The filtrate was concentrated to a dark oil under reduced pressure and the residue purified by silica gel chromatography (0-15% ethyl acetate in hexanes) to provide 4-(7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-7-yl)-2-(trifluoromethyl)aniline (20) as a purple solid (5.76 g, 91% yield). 1H NMR (400.0 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 6.95 (dd, J=2.3, 8.8 Hz, 1H), 6.79 (d, J=2.6 Hz, 1H), 6.72 (d, J=8.8 Hz, 1H), 4.89 (s, 2H), 4.09 (s, 2H), 1.61-1.59 (m, 4H) and 1.35 (d, J=6.8 Hz, 4H).


Example 2i
Preparation of the hydrochloride salt of 4-(7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-7-yl)-2-(trifluoromethyl)aniline (20-HCl)



embedded image


Palladium on carbon (150 g, 5% w/w) was charged into a Büchi Hydrogenator (20 L capacity) under a nitrogen atmosphere followed by the addition of the hydrochloride salt of 7-[4-nitro-3-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptane (19) (1500 g) and 2-methyltetrahydrofuran (10.5 L, 7 vol). Hydrogen gas was charged into the closed vessel to a pressure of +0.5 bar above atmospheric pressure. A vacuum was applied for about 2 min followed by the introduction of hydrogen gas to a pressure of 0.5 bar. This process was repeated 2 times. Then hydrogen gas was continuously charged at +0.5 bar above atmospheric pressure. The mixture was stirred and the temperature was maintained between 18° C. and 23° C. by cooling the jacket of the vessel. Once the reaction consumed no more hydrogen and evolved no more heat, a vacuum was again applied. Nitrogen gas was charged into the vessel at 0.5 bar and a vacuum was reapplied followed by a second charge of 0.5 bar nitrogen gas. When the reaction was substantially complete, the reaction mixture was transferred into a receiving flask under nitrogen atmosphere via a filter funnel using a Celite filter. The Celite filter cake was washed with 2-methyltetrahydrofuran (3 L, 2 vol). The washings and filtrate were charged into a vessel equipped with stirring, temperature control, and a nitrogen atmosphere. 4M HCl in 1,4-dioxane (1 vol) was added continuously over 1 h into the vessel at 20° C. The mixture was stirred for an additional 10 h (or overnight), filtered, and washed with 2-methyltetrahydrofuran (2 vol) and dried to generate 1519 g of the of 4-(7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-7-yl)-2-(trifluoromethyl)aniline hydrochloride (20-HCl) as a white crystalline solid.


Example 2j
Preparation of Compound 2



embedded image


To a solution of 4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1H-quinoline-3-carboxylic acid 17 (9.1 g, 35.39 mmol) and 4-(7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-7-yl)-2-(trifluoromethyl)aniline 20 (9.2 g, 35.74 mmol) in 2-methyltetrahydrofuran (91.00 mL) was added propyl phosphonic acid cyclic anhydride (T3P, 50% solution in ethyl acetate, 52.68 mL, 88.48 mmol) and pyridine (5.6 g, 5.73 mL, 70.78 mmol) at room temperature. The reaction flask heated at 65° C. for 10 h under a nitrogen atmosphere. After cooling to room temperature, the reaction was then diluted with ethyl acetate and quenched with saturated Na2CO3 solution (50 mL). The layers were separated, and the aqueous layer was extracted twice more with ethyl acetate. The combined organic layers were washed with water, dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated to a tan solid. The crude solid product was slurried in ethyl acetate/diethyl ether (2:1), collected by vacuum filtration, and washed twice more with ethyl acetate/diethyl ether (2:1) to provide the product as a light yellow crystalline powder. The powder was dissolved in warm ethyl acetate and absorbed onto Celite. Purification by silica gel chromatography (0-50% ethyl acetate in dichloromethane) provided N-(4-(7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-7-yl)-2-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl)-4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxamide as a white crystalline solid (13.5 g, 76% yield). LC/MS m/z 496.0 [M+H]+, retention time 1.48 min (RP-C18, 10-99% CH3CN/0.05% TFA over 3 min)1H NMR (400.0 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 13.08 (s, 1H), 12.16 (s, 1H), 8.88 (s, 1H), 8.04 (dd, J=2.1, 7.4 Hz, 1H), 7.95-7.88 (m, 3H), 7.22 (dd, 2.5, 8.9 Hz, 1H), 7.16 (d, J=2.5 Hz, 1H), 4.33 (s, 2H), 1.67 (d, J=6.9 Hz, 4H), 1.44 (d, J=6.9 Hz, 4H).


Synthesis of 7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptane hydrochloride (7a)



embedded image


Example 2k
Preparation of trans-4-(tert-butoxycarbonylamino)cyclohexanol (A)
Method 1.

Sodium carbonate (920.2 g, 8.682 mol, 2 eq) was added to a reaction vessel followed by an addition of water (3.000 L, 6 vol) and stirring. Dichloromethane (DCM, 4.000 L, 4 vol) was added followed by trans-4-aminocyclohexanol (500.0 g, 4.341 mol) to generate a biphasic reaction mixture that was vigorously stirred at room temperature. A solution of Boc2O (947.4 g, 997.3 mL, 4.341 mol, 1 eq) in DCM (2 vol) was then rapidly added dropwise to the vessel, and the resulting reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight. The reaction mixture was then filtered and the filter cake was washed with water (2×8 vol). The product was suction-dried until it was a compact cake. The cake was then dried in a vacuum oven at 35° C. for 24 h giving 830 g of trans-4-(tert-butoxycarbonylamino)cyclohexanol (A) as a crystalline solid.


Method 2.

Two 50 L three-neck round bottom flasks were each equipped with a mechanical stirrer and thermocouple. The flasks were placed in a cooling tub, and then each flask was charged with water (8.87 L) and trans-4-aminocyclohexanol (1479 g). After about 10 to 30 minutes, the trans-4-aminocyclohexanol had dissolved, and potassium carbonate (1774.6 g) was added to each flask. After about 10 to 20 minutes, the potassium carbonate had dissolved, and DCM (2.96 L) was charged to each flask. Boc anhydride (3082.6 g) in DCM (1479 mL) was then added to each flask at such a rate as to maintain the temperature at 20 to 30° C. An ice/water bath was used to control the exotherm and to accelerate the addition, which took approximately 1 to 2 hours. A suspension formed during the addition, and the reaction mixtures were allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred overnight, until the reaction was complete based on the disappearance of the Boc anhydride. Heptane (6 L) was then charged to each flask, and the mixtures were cooled to approximately 0 to 5° C. Solids were collected from each flask by filtration using the same filter. The combined solids were washed with heptane (6 L) followed by water (8 L). The solids were charged to an appropriately sized crock equipped with a mechanical stirrer. Water (12 L) and heptane (6 L) were added, and the resulting suspension was mechanically stirred for 30 to 60 minutes. The solids were collected by filtration and then washed on a filter with water (8 L) and heptane (8 L), air-dried on a filter for three days, and then dried under vacuum at 30 to 35° C. to a constant weight to provide the product as a white solid.


Example 21
Preparation of trans-4-(tert-butoxycarbonylamino)cyclohexylmethanesulfonate (B)
Method 1.

A 12 L flask was equipped with a nitrogen flow and a mechanical stirrer. Trans-4-(tert-butoxycarbonylamino)cyclohexanol (750 g, 3.484 mol) was introduced, followed by tetrahydrofuran (THF, 6.000 L, 8 vol), and the mixture was stirred. Triethylamine (370.2 g, 509.9 mL, 3.658 mol, 1.05 eq) was added and the mixture was cooled to 0° C. Methanesulfonyl chloride (419.0 g, 283.1 mL, 3.658 mol, 1.05 eq) was carefully added dropwise, keeping the temperature of the mixture below 5° C. After the addition, the mixture was stirred at 0° C. for 3 h, and then gradually warmed to room temperature (17° C.) and stirred overnight (about 15 h). The mixture was quenched with water (6 vol) and stirred for 15 min. Ethyl acetate (EtOAc, 9.000 L, 12 vol) was added and the stirring was continued for 15 min. The stirring was stopped and the mixture was allowed to stand for 10 min, and the aqueous phase was removed. 1 N HCl (6 vol, 4.5 L) was added and stirring was continued for 15 min. The stirring stopped and the aqueous phase was removed. 10% w/v NaHCO3 (4.5 L, 6 vol) was added and the mixture stirred for 10 min. Stirring was stopped and the aqueous phase was removed. Water (6 vol, 4.5 L) was added and the mixture was stirred for 10 min. The aqueous layer was removed, and the organic layer was polish filtered and concentrated to 4 vol. Heptane (5.5 vol, 4 L) was added and the mixture was concentrated again to dryness resulting in 988 g of trans-4-(tert-butoxycarbonylamino)cyclohexylmethanesulfonate.


Method 2.

A three-neck round bottom flask equipped with a mechanical stirrer, addition funnel, nitrogen inlet, thermocouple and drying tube was placed into a cooling tub. Trans-4-(tert-butoxycarbonylamino)cyclohexanol (2599 g, 12.07 mol, 1.0 eq), tetrahydrofuran (THF) (20.8 L), and triethylamine (1466 g, 14.49 mol, 1.2 eq) were added to the flask. The mixture was cooled with an ice water bath and stirred. Methanesulfonyl chloride (1466 g, 12.80 mol, 1.06 eq) was added dropwise by addition funnel over 1 hour. Once the addition was complete, the cooling bath was removed, and the reaction mixture was stirred until TLC indicated the starting material was consumed (about 30 minutes). The reaction mixture was then quenched with an aqueous solution of hydrochloric acid (223 mL of HCl in 6.7 L of water) and EtOAc (10.4 L). The mixture was stirred for approximately 10 to 20 minutes at ambient temperature and then was transferred to a separatory funnel. The layers were separated, and the aqueous layer discarded. The organic layer was washed with water (2×4.5 L), aqueous saturated sodium bicarbonate solution (1×4.5 L), and dried over anhydrous magnesium sulfate with stirring for 5 to 10 minutes. The mixture was filtered and the filter cake was washed with EtOAc (2×600 mL). The combined washes and filtrate were concentrated under reduced pressure at 40° C., leaving a white solid. The solid was taken up in heptane (3 L) and cooled in an ice/methanol cooling tub. More heptane (5 L) was added, and the mixture was stirred at 0 to 5° C. for not less than 1 hour. The solids were then collected by filtration, washed with cold heptane (0 to 5° C., 2×1.3 L), and dried under vacuum at 40° C. to a constant weight to provide the product.


Note: A jacketed reactor may be used instead of a round bottom flask with a cooling tub and ice bath.


Example 2m
Preparation of trans-4-aminocyclohexylmethanesulfonate (C)
Method 1.

Trans-4-(tert-butoxycarbonylamino)cyclohexylmethanesulfonate (985 g, 3.357 mol) was introduced into a 3-neck 12 L flask equipped with a stirrer under a nitrogen atmosphere and open vent. DCM (1.970 L, 2 vol) was added at room temperature, and stirring was commenced. Trifluoroacetic acid (TFA) (2.844 kg, 1.922 L, 24.94 mol, 2 vol) was slowly added to the mixture in two batches of 1 L each. After the first addition, the mixture was stirred for 30 min followed by a second addition. The mixture was stirred overnight (15 h) at room temperature resulting in a clear solution. 2-Methyltetrahydrofuran (4 vol) was then added to the reaction mixture, which was stirred for 1 h. The mixture was then carefully filtered in a fume hood and suction dried to generate 1100 g of TFA salt of trans-4-aminocyclohexylmethanesulfonate with excess TFA.


Method 2.

A 50 L three-neck round bottom flask was equipped with a mechanical stirrer, addition funnel and thermocouple and was placed into a cooling tub. To the flask was added trans-4-(tert-butoxycarbonylamino)cyclohexylmethanesulfonate (3474 g, 1.0 eq) and DCM (5.9 L) to the flask. The resulting suspension was stirred for 5 to 10 minutes at ambient temperature, and then trifluoroacetic acid (TFA, 5.9 L) was added via addition funnel slowly over 2.5 hours to control the resulting exotherm and rate of gas evolution. The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight and then cooled to 15° C. to 20° C. using an ice water bath. 2-Methyl tetrahydrofuran (2-MeTHF, 11.8 L) was then added via the addition funnel at a rate to maintain the internal temperature below 25° C. (approximately 1.5 hours). The addition of the first 4-5 L of 2-MeTHF was exothermic. The resulting suspension was stirred for 1 hour. The solids were collected by filtration and then washed with 2-MeTHF (2×2.2 L) and then dried under vacuum at ambient temperature to a constant weight to provide the product as a white solid.


Example 2n
Preparation of 7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptane hydrochloride (7a)
Method 1.

The TFA salt of trans-4-aminocyclohexylmethanesulfonate (200 g, 650.9 mmol) was introduced into a 3 L, 3-necked flask followed by the addition of water (2.200 L, 11 vol). NaOH (78.11 g, 1.953 mol, 3 eq) was slowly added, keeping the temperature of the reaction mixture below 25° C. and the mixture was stirred overnight. DCM (1.4 L, 7 vol) was then added and the mixture stirred, and the organic layer was separated. The aqueous layer was then extracted a second time with DCM (1.4 L, 7 vol), and the DCM layers were combined. HCl (108.5 mL, 12M, 1.3020 mol, 2 eq) was then added, the mixture was stirred for 30 min and then concentrated on a rotary evaporator to dryness. Acetonitrile (10 vol) was added and the mixture concentrated. This was repeated 3 times until all trace water was azeotropically removed, to provide 7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptane hydrochloride (7a). The crude product was recrystallized from acetonitrile (10 vol) to provide 7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptane hydrochloride (7a) as a colorless crystalline solid. 1HNMR (DMSO-d6) ppm 8.02-8.04 (d); 7.23-7.31 (m); 4.59 (s); 3.31 (s); 2.51-3.3 (m); 1.63-1.75 (m); 1.45-1.62 (m).


As a note, instead of adding DCM for extraction, the crude product can also be distilled at about 95° C. to 97° C. and further recrystallized.


Method 2.

A 50 L three neck round bottom flask equipped with a mechanical stirrer, addition funnel and thermocouple and was placed into a heating mantle. Trans-4-aminocyclohexylmethanesulfonate trifluoroacetate in (3000 g, 1 eq) and water (30 L) were added to the flask. The mixture was stirred, as 50% NaOH (2343 g, 29.29 mol, 3 eq) was added by an addition funnel at such a rate as to maintain the temperature below 25° C. because the addition was mildly exothermic. Upon completion of the NaOH addition, the reaction mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature. The product was recovered by fractional distillation at reflux temperature, (approximately 100° C.) with a head temperature of 95 to 98° C. The pH of each fraction was adjusted to 2 by adding HCl, and concentrated under reduced pressure at 55° C. to leave a thick paste. Acetonitrile (ACN 1.5 L) was added and the resulting suspension was stirred for 30 minutes and then cooled to 0 to 5° C. for 1 hour. The solids were collected by filtration, washed with cold (0 to 5° C.) ACN (2×600 mL), and dried under vacuum at 50° C. to a constant weight.


A 22 L three-neck round bottom flask was equipped with a mechanical stirrer, thermocouple, and condenser and placed into a heating mantle. The collected solids (2382 g), methanol (4.7 L) and 2-MeTHF (4.7 L) were added to the flask. The resulting suspension was stirred and heated to reflux (approximately 65° C.). The reaction flask was transferred to a cooling tub, and the mixture was stirred. 2-MeTHF (4.7 L) was then added via addition funnel over 30 minutes. The resulting suspension was cooled to 0 to 5° C. and stirred at this temperature for 30 minutes. The solids were collected by filtration, washed with cold (0 to 5° C.) 2-MeTHF (2×600 mL), and then dried under vacuum at 55° C. to a constant weight.


A 12 L three-neck round bottom flask equipped with a mechanical stirrer, thermocouple, nitrogen inlet and condenser was placed into a heating mantle. The crude product (2079 g) and ACN (6.2 L) were added to the flask. The resulting suspension was stirred and heated to reflux (approximately 82° C.) for 30 minutes. The flask was transferred to a cooling tub and the suspension was slowly cooled to 0 to 5° C. and maintained at this temperature for 1 hour. The solids were collected by filtration, washed with cold (0 to 5° C.) ACN (3×600 mL), and dried under vacuum at 55° C. to a constant weight affording to provide the product.


II.C. Compounds of Formula III
II.C.1. Embodiments of the Compounds of Formula III

In one aspect the invention includes a pharmaceutical composition comprising a Compound of Formula III




embedded image


or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein:

    • T is —CH2—, —CH2CH2—, —CF2—, —C(CH3)2—, or —C(O)—;
    • R1′ is H, C1-6 aliphatic, halo, CF3, CHF2, O(C1-6 aliphatic); and
    • RD1 or RD2 is ZDR9
      • wherein:
      • ZD is a bond, CONH, SO2NH, SO2N(C1-6 alkyl), CH2NHSO2, CH2N(CH3)SO2, CH2NHCO, COO, SO2, or CO; and
      • R9 is H, C1-6 aliphatic, or aryl.


II.C.2. Compound 3

In another embodiment, the compound of Formula III is Compound 3, depicted below, which is also known by its chemical name 3-(6-(1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamido)-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoic acid.




embedded image


II.C.3. Overview of the Synthesis of Compound 3

Compound 3 can be prepared by coupling an acid chloride moiety with an amine moiety according to following Schemes 3-1a to 3-3.


II.C.3.a. Synthesis of the Acid Moiety of Compound 3



embedded image


Scheme 3-1a depicts the preparation of 1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarbonyl chloride, which is used in Scheme 3-3 to make the amide linkage of Compound 3.


The starting material, 2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxole-5-carboxylic acid, is commercially available from Saltigo (an affiliate of the Lanxess Corporation). Reduction of the carboxylic acid moiety in 2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxole-5-carboxylic acid to the primary alcohol, followed by conversion to the corresponding chloride using thionyl chloride (SOCl2), provides 5-(chloromethyl)-2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxole, which is subsequently converted to 2-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)acetonitrile using sodium cyanide. Treatment of 2-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)acetonitrile with base and 1-bromo-2-chloroethane provides 1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarbonitrile. The nitrile moiety in 1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarbonitrile is converted to a carboxylic acid using base to give 1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxylic acid, which is converted to the desired acid chloride using thionyl chloride.




embedded image


Scheme 3-1b provides an alternative synthesis of the requisite acid chloride. The compound 5-bromomethyl-2,2-difluoro-1,3-benzodioxole is coupled with ethyl cyanoacetate in the presence of a palladium catalyst to form the corresponding alpha cyano ethyl ester. Saponification of the ester moiety to the carboxylic acid gives the cyanoethyl compound. Alkylation of the cyanoethyl compound with 1-bromo-2-chloro ethane in the presence of base gives the cyanocyclopropyl compound. Treatment of the cyanocyclopropyl compound with base gives the carboxylate salt, which is converted to the carboxylic acid by treatment with acid. Conversion of the carboxylic acid to the acid chloride is then accomplished using a chlorinating agent such as thionyl chloride or the like.


II.C.3.b. Synthesis of the Amine Moiety of Compound 3



embedded image


Scheme 3-2 depicts the preparation of the requisite tert-butyl 3-(6-amino-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate, which is coupled with 1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarbonyl chloride in Scheme 3-3 to give Compound 3. Palladium-catalyzed coupling of 2-bromo-3-methylpyridine with 3-(tert-butoxycarbonyl)phenylboronic acid gives tert-butyl 3-(3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate, which is subsequently converted to the desired compound.


II.C.3.c. Acid and Amine Moiety Coupling



embedded image


Scheme 3-3 depicts the coupling of 1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarbonyl chloride with tert-butyl 3-(6-amino-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate using triethyl amine and 4-dimethylaminopyridine to initially provide the tert-butyl ester of Compound 3. Treatment of the tert-butyl ester with an acid such as HCl, gives the HCl salt of Compound 3, which is typically a crystalline solid.


II.C.4. Examples
Synthesis of Compound 3

Vitride® (sodium bis(2-methoxyethoxy)aluminum hydride [or NaAlH2(OCH2CH2OCH3)2], 65 wt % solution in toluene) was purchased from Aldrich Chemicals. 2,2-Difluoro-1,3-benzodioxole-5-carboxylic acid was purchased from Saltigo (an affiliate of the Lanxess Corporation).


Example 3a
(2,2-Difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-methanol



embedded image


Commercially available 2,2-difluoro-1,3-benzodioxole-5-carboxylic acid (1.0 eq) was slurried in toluene (10 vol). Vitride® (2 eq) was added via addition funnel at a rate to maintain the temperature at 15-25° C. At the end of the addition, the temperature was increased to 40° C. for 2 hours (h), then 10% (w/w) aqueous (aq) NaOH (4.0 eq) was carefully added via addition funnel, maintaining the temperature at 40-50° C. After stirring for an additional 30 minutes (min), the layers were allowed to separate at 40° C. The organic phase was cooled to 20° C., then washed with water (2×1.5 vol), dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford crude (2,2-difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-methanol that was used directly in the next step.


Example 3b
5-Chloromethyl-2,2-difluoro-1,3-benzodioxole



embedded image


(2,2-Difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-methanol (1.0 eq) was dissolved in MTBE (5 vol). A catalytic amount of 4-(N,N-dimethyl)aminopyridine (DMAP) (1 mol %) was added and SOCl2 (1.2 eq) was added via addition funnel. The SOCl2 was added at a rate to maintain the temperature in the reactor at 15-25° C. The temperature was increased to 30° C. for 1 h, and then was cooled to 20° C. Water (4 vol) was added via addition funnel while maintaining the temperature at less than 30° C. After stirring for an additional 30 min, the layers were allowed to separate. The organic layer was stirred and 10% (w/v) aq NaOH (4.4 vol) was added. After stirring for 15 to 20 min, the layers were allowed to separate. The organic phase was then dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford crude 5-chloromethyl-2,2-difluoro-1,3-benzodioxole that was used directly in the next step.


Example 3c
(2,2-Difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-acetonitrile



embedded image


A solution of 5-chloromethyl-2,2-difluoro-1,3-benzodioxole (1 eq) in DMSO (1.25 vol) was added to a slurry of NaCN (1.4 eq) in DMSO (3 vol), while maintaining the temperature between 30-40° C. The mixture was stirred for 1 h, and then water (6 vol) was added, followed by methyl tert-butyl ether (MTBE) (4 vol). After stirring for 30 min, the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with MTBE (1.8 vol). The combined organic layers were washed with water (1.8 vol), dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford crude (2,2-difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-acetonitrile (95%) that was used directly in the next step. 1H NMR (500 MHz, DMSO) δ 7.44 (br s, 1H), 7.43 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H), 7.22 (dd, J=8.2, 1.8 Hz, 1H), 4.07 (s, 2H).


Example 3d
Alternate Synthesis of (2,2-difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-1-ethylacetate-acetonitrile



embedded image


A reactor was purged with nitrogen and charged with toluene (900 mL). The solvent was degassed via nitrogen sparge for no less than 16 hours. To the reactor was then charged Na3PO4 (155.7 g, 949.5 mmol), followed by bis(dibenzylideneacetone) palladium (0) (7.28 g, 12.66 mmol). A 10% w/w solution of tert-butylphosphine in hexanes (51.23 g, 25.32 mmol) was charged over 10 minutes at 23° C. from a nitrogen purged addition funnel. The mixture was allowed to stir for 50 minutes, at which time 5-bromo-2,2-difluoro-1,3-benzodioxole (75 g, 316.5 mmol) was added over 1 minute. After stirring for an additional 50 minutes, the mixture was charged with ethyl cyanoacetate (71.6 g, 633.0 mmol) over 5 minutes, followed by water (4.5 mL) in one portion. The mixture was heated to 70° C. over 40 minutes and analyzed by HPLC every 1 to 2 hours for the percent conversion of the reactant to the product. After complete conversion was observed (typically 100% conversion after 5 to 8 hours), the mixture was cooled to 20 to 25° C. and filtered through a Celite pad. The Celite pad was rinsed with toluene (2×450 mL), and the combined organics were concentrated to 300 mL under vacuum at 60 to 65° C. The concentrate was charged with DMSO (225 mL) and concentrated under vacuum at 70 to 80° C. until active distillation of the solvent ceased. The solution was cooled to 20 to 25° C. and diluted to 900 mL with DMSO in preparation for Step 2. 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.16-7.10 (m, 2H), 7.03 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1H), 4.63 (s, 1H), 4.19 (m, 2H), 1.23 (t, J=7.1 Hz, 3H).


Example 3e
Alternate Synthesis of (2,2-difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-acetonitrile



embedded image


The DMSO solution of (2,2-difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-1-ethylacetate-acetonitrile from above was charged with 3 N HCl (617.3 mL, 1.85 mol) over 20 minutes while maintaining an internal temperature less than 40° C. The mixture was then heated to 75° C. over 1 hour and analyzed by HPLC every 1 to 2 hour for percent conversion. When a conversion of greater than 99% was observed (typically after 5 to 6 hours), the reaction was cooled to 20 to 25° C. and extracted with MTBE (2×525 mL), with sufficient time to allow for complete phase separation during the extractions. The combined organic extracts were washed with 5% NaCl (2×375 mL). The solution was then transferred to equipment appropriate for a 1.5 to 2.5 Torr vacuum distillation that was equipped with a cooled receiver flask. The solution was concentrated under vacuum at less than 60° C. to remove the solvents. (2,2-Difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-acetonitrile was then distilled from the resulting oil at 125 to 130° C. (oven temperature) and 1.5 to 2.0 Torr. (2,2-Difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-acetonitrile was isolated as a clear oil in 66% yield from 5-bromo-2,2-difluoro-1,3-benzodioxole (2 steps) and with an HPLC purity of 91.5% AUC (corresponds to a w/w assay of 95%). 1H NMR (500 MHz, DMSO) δ 7.44 (br s, 1H), 7.43 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H), 7.22 (dd, J=8.2, 1.8 Hz, 1H), 4.07 (s, 2H).


Example 3f
(2,2-Difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-cyclopropanecarbonitrile



embedded image


A mixture of (2,2-difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-acetonitrile (1.0 eq), 50 wt % aqueous KOH (5.0 eq) 1-bromo-2-chloroethane (1.5 eq), and Oct4NBr (0.02 eq) was heated at 70° C. for 1 h. The reaction mixture was cooled, then worked up with MTBE and water. The organic phase was washed with water and brine. The solvent was removed to afford (2,2-difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-cyclopropanecarbonitrile. 1H NMR (500 MHz, DMSO) δ 7.43 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H), 7.40 (d, J=1.9 Hz, 1H), 7.30 (dd, J=8.4, 1.9 Hz, 1H), 1.75 (m, 2H), 1.53 (m, 2H).


Example 3g
1-(2,2-Difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-cyclopropanecarboxylic acid



embedded image


(2,2-Difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-cyclopropanecarbonitrile was hydrolyzed using 6 M NaOH (8 equiv) in ethanol (5 vol) at 80° C. overnight. The mixture was cooled to room temperature and the ethanol was evaporated under vacuum. The residue was taken up in water and MTBE, 1 M HCl was added, and the layers were separated. The MTBE layer was then treated with dicyclohexylamine (DCHA) (0.97 equiv). The slurry was cooled to 0° C., filtered and washed with heptane to give the corresponding DCHA salt. The salt was taken into MTBE and 10% citric acid and stirred until all the solids had dissolved. The layers were separated and the MTBE layer was washed with water and brine. A solvent swap to heptane followed by filtration gave 1-(2,2-difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-cyclopropanecarboxylic acid after drying in a vacuum oven at 50° C. overnight. ESI-MS m/z calc. 242.04, found 241.58 (M+1)+; 1H NMR (500 MHz, DMSO) δ 12.40 (s, 1H), 7.40 (d, J=1.6 Hz, 1H), 7.30 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 1H), 7.17 (dd, J=8.3, 1.7 Hz, 1H), 1.46 (m, 2H), 1.17 (m, 2H).


Example 3h
1-(2,2-Difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-cyclopropanecarbonyl chloride



embedded image


1-(2,2-Difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-cyclopropanecarboxylic acid (1.2 eq) is slurried in toluene (2.5 vol) and the mixture was heated to 60° C. SOCl2 (1.4 eq) was added via addition funnel. The toluene and SOCl2 were distilled from the reaction mixture after 30 minutes. Additional toluene (2.5 vol) was added and the resulting mixture was distilled again, leaving the product acid chloride as an oil, which was used without further purification.


Example 3i
tert-Butyl-3-(3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate



embedded image


2-Bromo-3-methylpyridine (1.0 eq) was dissolved in toluene (12 vol). K2CO3 (4.8 eq) was added, followed by water (3.5 vol). The resulting mixture was heated to 65° C. under a stream of N2 for 1 hour. 3-(t-Butoxycarbonyl)phenylboronic acid (1.05 eq) and Pd(dppf)Cl2.CH2Cl2 (0.015 eq) were then added and the mixture was heated to 80° C. After 2 hours, the heat was turned off, water was added (3.5 vol), and the layers were allowed to separate. The organic phase was then washed with water (3.5 vol) and extracted with 10% aqueous methanesulfonic acid (2 eq MsOH, 7.7 vol). The aqueous phase was made basic with 50% aqueous NaOH (2 eq) and extracted with EtOAc (8 vol). The organic layer was concentrated to afford crude tert-butyl-3-(3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate (82%) that was used directly in the next step.


Example 3j
2-(3-(tert-Butoxycarbonyl)phenyl)-3-methylpyridine-1-oxide



embedded image


tert-Butyl-3-(3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate (1.0 eq) was dissolved in EtOAc (6 vol). Water (0.3 vol) was added, followed by urea-hydrogen peroxide (3 eq). Phthalic anhydride (3 eq) was then added portionwise to the mixture as a solid at a rate to maintain the temperature in the reactor below 45° C. After completion of the phthalic anhydride addition, the mixture was heated to 45° C. After stirring for an additional 4 hours, the heat was turned off. 10% w/w aqueous Na2SO3 (1.5 eq) was added via addition funnel. After completion of Na2SO3 addition, the mixture was stirred for an additional 30 min and the layers separated. The organic layer was stirred and 10% wt/wt aqueous. Na2CO3 (2 eq) was added. After stirring for 30 minutes, the layers were allowed to separate. The organic phase was washed 13% w/v aq NaCl. The organic phase was then filtered and concentrated to afford crude 2-(3-(tert-butoxycarbonyl)phenyl)-3-methylpyridine-1-oxide (95%) that was used directly in the next step.


Example 3k
tert-Butyl-3-(6-amino-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate



embedded image


A solution of 2-(3-(tert-butoxycarbonyl)phenyl)-3-methylpyridine-1-oxide (1 eq) and pyridine (4 eq) in acetonitrile (8 vol) was heated to 70° C. A solution of methanesulfonic anhydride (1.5 eq) in MeCN (2 vol) was added over 50 min via addition funnel while maintaining the temperature at less than 75° C. The mixture was stirred for an additional 0.5 hours after complete addition. The mixture was then allowed to cool to ambient temperature. Ethanolamine (10 eq) was added via addition funnel. After stirring for 2 hours, water (6 vol) was added and the mixture was cooled to 10° C. After stirring for 3 hours, the solid was collected by filtration and washed with water (3 vol), 2:1 acetonitrile/water (3 vol), and acetonitrile (2×1.5 vol). The solid was dried to constant weight (<1% difference) in a vacuum oven at 50° C. with a slight N2 bleed to afford ten-butyl-3-(6-amino-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate as a red-yellow solid (53% yield).


Example 3l
3-(6-(1-(2,2-Difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)-cyclopropanecarboxamido)-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)-t-butylbenzoate



embedded image


The crude acid chloride described above was dissolved in toluene (2.5 vol based on acid chloride) and added via addition funnel to a mixture of tert-butyl-3-(6-amino-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate (1 eq), DMAP, (0.02 eq), and triethylamine (3.0 eq) in toluene (4 vol based on tert-butyl-3-(6-amino-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate). After 2 hours, water (4 vol based on tert-butyl-3-(6-amino-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoate) was added to the reaction mixture. After stirring for 30 minutes, the layers were separated. The organic phase was then filtered and concentrated to afford a thick oil of 3-(6-(1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamido)-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)-t-butylbenzoate (quantitative crude yield). Acetonitrile (3 vol based on crude product) was added and distilled until crystallization occurs. Water (2 vol based on crude product) was added and the mixture stirred for 2 h. The solid was collected by filtration, washed with 1:1 (by volume) acetonitrile/water (2×1 volumes based on crude product), and partially dried on the filter under vacuum. The solid was dried to a constant weight (<1% difference) in a vacuum oven at 60° C. with a slight N2 bleed to afford 3-(6-(1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamido)-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)-t-butylbenzoate as a brown solid.


Example 3m
3-(6-(1-(2,2-Difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamido)-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoic acid.HCl salt (Compound 3)



embedded image


To a slurry of 3-(6-(1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamido)-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)-t-butylbenzoate (1.0 eq) in MeCN (3.0 vol) was added water (0.83 vol) followed by concentrated aqueous HCl (0.83 vol). The mixture was heated to 45±5° C. After stirring for 24 to 48 h, the reaction was complete, and the mixture was allowed to cool to ambient temperature. Water (1.33 vol) was added and the mixture stirred. The solid was collected by filtration, washed with water (2×0.3 vol), and partially dried on the filter under vacuum. The solid was dried to a constant weight (<1% difference) in a vacuum oven at 60° C. with a slight N2 bleed to afford 3-(6-(1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamido)-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoic acid.HCl as an off-white solid.


Table 3-1 below recites physical data for Compound 3.












TABLE 3-1






LC/MS
LC/RT



Compound
M + 1
minutes
NMR







Compound 3
453.3
1.93

1HNMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) 9.14






(s, 1H), 7.99-7.93 (m, 3H), 7.80-7.78





(m, 1H), 7.74-7.72 (m, 1H), 7.60-7.55





(m, 2H), 7.41-7.33 (m, 2H), 2.24 (s,





3H), 1.53-1.51 (m, 2H), 1.19-1.17





(m, 2H).









II.D. Compounds of Formula IV
II.D.1. Embodiments of Compounds of Formula IV

In one aspect the invention includes a pharmaceutical composition comprising a Compound of Formula IV




embedded image


or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein:

    • R is H, OH, OCH3 or two R taken together form —OCH2O— or —OCF2O—;
    • R4 is H or alkyl;
    • R5 is H or F;
    • R6 is H or CN;
    • R7 is H, —CH2CH(OH)CH2OH, —CH2CH2N+(CH3)3, or —CH2CH2OH;
    • R8 is H, OH, —CH2CH(OH)CH2OH, —CH2OH, or R7 and R8 taken together form a five membered ring.


II.D.2. Compound 4

In another embodiment, the compound of Formula IV is Compound 4, which is known by its chemical name (R)-1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)-N-(1-(2,3-dihydroxypropyl)-6-fluoro-2-(1-hydroxy-2-methylpropan-2-yl)-1H-indol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamide.




embedded image


II.D.3. Overview of the Synthesis of Compound 4

Compound 4 can be prepared by coupling an acid chloride moiety with an amine moiety according to the schemes below.


II.D.3.a. Synthesis of the Acid Moiety of Compound 4

The acid moiety of Compound 4 can be synthesized as the acid chloride,




embedded image


according to Scheme 3-1a, Scheme 3-1b and Examples 3a-3h.


II.D.3.b. Synthesis of the Amine Moiety of Compound 4



embedded image


Scheme 4-1 provides an overview of the synthesis of the amine moiety of Compound 4. From the silyl protected propargyl alcohol shown, conversion to the propargyl chloride followed by formation of the Grignard reagent and subsequent nucleophilic substitution provides ((2,2-dimethylbut-3-ynyloxy)methyl)benzene, which is used in another step of the synthesis. To complete the amine moiety, 4-nitro-3-fluoroaniline is first brominated, and then converted to the toluenesulfonic acid salt of (R)-1-(4-amino-2-bromo-5-fluorophenylamino)-3-(benzyloxy)propan-2-ol in a two step process beginning with alkylation of the aniline amino group by (R)-2-(benzyloxymethyl)oxirane, followed by reduction of the nitro group to the corresponding amine. Palladium catalyzed coupling of the product with ((2,2-dimethylbut-3-ynyloxy)methyl)benzene (discussed above) provides the intermediate akynyl compound which is then cyclized to the indole moiety to produce the benzyl protected amine moiety of Compound 4.


II.D.3.c. Synthesis of Compound 4 by Acid and Amine Moiety Coupling



embedded image


Scheme 4-2 depicts the coupling of the Acid and Amine moieties to produce Compound 4. In the first step, (R)-1-(5-amino-2-(1-(benzyloxy)-2-methylpropan-2-yl)-6-fluoro-1H-indol-1-yl)-3-(benzyloxy)propan-2-ol is coupled with 1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarbonyl chloride to provide the benzyl protected Compound 4. This step can be performed in the presence of a base and a solvent. The base can be an organic base such as triethylamine, and the solvent can be an organic solvent such as DCM or a mixture of DCM and toluene.


In the last step, the benzylated intermediate is deprotected to produce Compound 4. The deprotection step can be accomplished using reducing conditions sufficient to remove the benzyl group. The reducing conditions can be hydrogenation conditions such as hydrogen gas in the presence of a palladium catalyst.


II.D.4. Examples
Synthesis of Compound 4
II.D.4.a. Compound 4 Amine Moiety Synthesis
Example 4a
2-Bromo-5-fluoro-4-nitroaniline



embedded image


A flask was charged with 3-fluoro-4-nitroaniline (1.0 equiv) followed by ethyl acetate (10 vol) and stirred to dissolve all solids. N-Bromosuccinimide (1.0 equiv) was added portion-wise as to maintain an internal temperature of 22° C. At the end of the reaction, the reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo on a rotavap. The residue was slurried in distilled water (5 vol) to dissolve and remove succinimide (The succinimide can also be removed by water workup procedure.) The water was decanted and the solid was slurried in 2-propanol (5 vol) overnight. The resulting slurry was filtered and the wetcake was washed with 2-propanol, dried in vacuum oven at 50° C. overnight with N2 bleed until constant weight was achieved. A yellowish tan solid was isolated (50% yield, 97.5% AUC). Other impurities were a bromo-regioisomer (1.4% AUC) and a dibromo adduct (1.1% AUC). 1H NMR (500 MHz, DMSO) δ 8.19 (1H, d, J=8.1 Hz), 7.06 (br. s, 2H), 6.64 (d, 1H, J=14.3 Hz).


Example 4b
p-toluenesulfonic acid salt of (R)-1-((4-amino-2-bromo-5-fluorophenyl)amino)-3-(benzyloxy)propan-2-ol



embedded image


A thoroughly dried flask under N2 was charged with the following: Activated powdered 4 Å molecular sieves (50 wt % based on 2-bromo-5-fluoro-4-nitroaniline), 2-Bromo-5-fluoro-4-nitroaniline (1.0 equiv), zinc perchlorate dihydrate (20 mol %), and toluene (8 vol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature for no more than 30 min. Lastly, (R)-benzyl glycidyl ether (2.0 equiv) in toluene (2 vol) was added in a steady stream. The reaction was heated to 80° C. (internal temperature) and stirred for approximately 7 hours or until 2-bromo-5-fluoro-4-nitroaniline was <5% AUC.


The reaction was cooled to room temperature and Celite® (50 wt %) was added, followed by ethyl acetate (10 vol). The resulting mixture was filtered to remove Celite® and sieves and washed with ethyl acetate (2 vol). The filtrate was washed with ammonium chloride solution (4 vol, 20% w/v). The organic layer was washed with sodium bicarbonate solution (4 vol×2.5% w/v). The organic layer was concentrated in vacuo on a rotovap. The resulting slurry was dissolved in isopropyl acetate (10 vol) and this solution was transferred to a Buchi hydrogenator.


The hydrogenator was charged with 5 wt % Pt(S)/C (1.5 mol %) and the mixture was stirred under N2 at 30° C. (internal temperature). The reaction was flushed with N2 followed by hydrogen. The hydrogenator pressure was adjusted to 1 Bar of hydrogen and the mixture was stirred rapidly (>1200 rpm). At the end of the reaction, the catalyst was filtered through a pad of Celite® and washed with dichloromethane (10 vol). The filtrate was concentrated in vacuo. Any remaining isopropyl acetate was chased with dichloromethane (2 vol) and concentrated on a rotavap to dryness.


The resulting residue was dissolved in dichloromethane (10 vol). p-Toluenesulfonic acid monohydrate (1.2 equiv) was added and stirred overnight. The product was filtered and washed with dichloromethane (2 vol) and suction dried. The wetcake was transferred to drying trays and into a vacuum oven and dried at 45° C. with N2 bleed until constant weight was achieved. The p-toluenesulfonic acid salt of (R)-1-((4-amino-2-bromo-5-fluorophenyl)amino)-3-(benzyloxy)propan-2-ol was isolated as an off-white solid.


Example 4c
(3-Chloro-3-methylbut-1-ynyl)trimethylsilane



embedded image


Propargyl alcohol (1.0 equiv) was charged to a vessel. Aqueous hydrochloric acid (37%, 3.75 vol) was added and stirring begun. During dissolution of the solid alcohol, a modest endotherm (5-6° C.) was observed. The resulting mixture was stirred overnight (16 h), slowly becoming dark red. A 30 L jacketed vessel was charged with water (5 vol) which was then cooled to 10° C. The reaction mixture was transferred slowly into the water by vacuum, maintaining the internal temperature of the mixture below 25° C. Hexanes (3 vol) was added and the resulting mixture was stirred for 0.5 h. The phases were settled and the aqueous phase (pH<1) was drained off and discarded. The organic phase was concentrated in vacuo using a rotary evaporator, furnishing the product as red oil.


Example 4d
(4-(Benzyloxy)-3,3-dimethylbut-1-ynyl)trimethylsilane



embedded image


Method A

All equivalents and volume descriptors in this part are based on a 250 g reaction. Magnesium turnings (69.5 g, 2.86 mol, 2.0 equiv) were charged to a 3 L 4-neck reactor and stirred with a magnetic stirrer under nitrogen for 0.5 h. The reactor was immersed in an ice-water bath. A solution of the propargyl chloride (250 g, 1.43 mol, 1.0 equiv) in THF (1.8 L, 7.2 vol) was added slowly to the reactor, with stirring, until an initial exotherm (about 10° C.) was observed. The Grignard reagent formation was confirmed by IPC using 1H-NMR spectroscopy. Once the exotherm subsided, the remainder of the solution was added slowly, maintaining the batch temperature <15° C. The addition required about 3.5 h. The resulting dark green mixture was decanted into a 2 L capped bottle.


All equivalent and volume descriptors in this part are based on a 500 g reaction. A 22 L reactor was charged with a solution of benzyl chloromethyl ether (95%, 375 g, 2.31 mol, 0.8 equiv) in THF (1.5 L, 3 vol). The reactor was cooled in an ice-water bath. Two Grignard reagent batches prepared as above were combined and then added slowly to the benzyl chloromethyl ether solution via an addition funnel, maintaining the batch temperature below 25° C. The addition required 1.5 h. The reaction mixture was stirred overnight (16 h).


All equivalent and volume descriptors in this part are based on a 1 kg reaction. A solution of 15% ammonium chloride was prepared in a 30 L jacketed reactor (1.5 kg in 8.5 kg of water, 10 vol). The solution was cooled to 5° C. Two Grignard reaction mixtures prepared as above were combined and then transferred into the ammonium chloride solution via a header vessel. An exotherm was observed in this quench, which was carried out at a rate such as to keep the internal temperature below 25° C. Once the transfer was complete, the vessel jacket temperature was set to 25° C. Hexanes (8 L, 8 vol) was added and the mixture was stirred for 0.5 h. After settling the phases, the aqueous phase (pH 9) was drained off and discarded. The remaining organic phase was washed with water (2 L, 2 vol). The organic phase was concentrated in vacuo using a 22 L rotary evaporator, providing the crude product as an orange oil.


Method B

Magnesium turnings (106 g, 4.35 mol, 1.0 eq) were charged to a 22 L reactor and then suspended in THF (760 mL, 1 vol). The vessel was cooled in an ice-water bath such that the batch temperature reached 2° C. A solution of the propargyl chloride (760 g, 4.35 mol, 1.0 equiv) in THF (4.5 L, 6 vol) was added slowly to the reactor. After 100 mL was added, the addition was stopped and the mixture stirred until a 13° C. exotherm was observed, indicating the Grignard reagent initiation. Once the exotherm subsided, another 500 mL of the propargyl chloride solution was added slowly, maintaining the batch temperature <20° C. The Grignard reagent formation was confirmed by IPC using 1H-NMR spectroscopy. The remainder of the propargyl chloride solution was added slowly, maintaining the batch temperature <20° C. The addition required about 1.5 h. The resulting dark green solution was stirred for 0.5 h. The Grignard reagent formation was confirmed by IPC using 1H-NMR spectroscopy. Neat benzyl chloromethyl ether was charged to the reactor addition funnel and then added dropwise into the reactor, maintaining the batch temperature below 25° C. The addition required 1.0 h. The reaction mixture was stirred overnight. The aqueous work-up and concentration was carried out using the same procedure and relative amounts of materials as in Method A to give the product as an orange oil.


Example 4e
4-Benzyloxy-3,3-dimethylbut-1-yne



embedded image


A 30 L jacketed reactor was charged with methanol (6 vol) which was then cooled to 5° C. Potassium hydroxide (85%, 1.3 equiv) was added to the reactor. A 15-20° C. exotherm was observed as the potassium hydroxide dissolved. The jacket temperature was set to 25° C. A solution of 4-benzyloxy-3,3-dimethyl-1-trimethylsilylbut-1-yne (1.0 equiv) in methanol (2 vol) was added and the resulting mixture was stirred until reaction completion, as monitored by HPLC. Typical reaction time at 25° C. was 3-4 h. The reaction mixture was diluted with water (8 vol) and then stirred for 0.5 h. Hexanes (6 vol) was added and the resulting mixture was stirred for 0.5 h. The phases were allowed to settle and then the aqueous phase (pH 10-11) was drained off and discarded. The organic phase was washed with a solution of KOH (85%, 0.4 equiv) in water (8 vol) followed by water (8 vol). The organic phase was then concentrated down using a rotary evaporator, yielding the title material as a yellow-orange oil. Typical purity of this material was in the 80% range with primarily a single impurity present. 1H NMR (400 MHz, C6D6) δ 7.28 (d, 2H, J=7.4 Hz), 7.18 (t, 2H, J=7.2 Hz), 7.10 (d, 1H, J=7.2 Hz), 4.35 (s, 2H), 3.24 (s, 2H), 1.91 (s, 1H), 1.25 (s, 6H).


Example 4f
(R)-1-(4-amino-2-(4-(benzyloxy)-3,3-dimethylbut-1-ynyl)-5-fluorophenylamino)-3-(benzyloxy)propan-2-ol



embedded image


The tosylate salt of (R)-1-(4-amino-2-bromo-5-fluorophenylamino)-3-(benzyloxy)propan-2-ol was converted to the free base by stirring in dichloromethane (5 vol) and saturated NaHCO3 solution (5 vol) until a clear organic layer was achieved. The resulting layers were separated and the organic layer was washed with saturated NaHCO3 solution (5 vol) followed by brine and concentrated in vacuo to obtain (R)-1-(4-amino-2-bromo-5-fluorophenylamino)-3-(benzyloxy)propan-2-ol (free base) as an oil.


Palladium acetate (0.01 eq), dppb (0.015 eq), CuI (0.015 eq) and potassium carbonate (3 eq) were suspended in acetonitrile (1.2 vol). After stirring for 15 minutes, a solution of 4-benzyloxy-3,3-dimethylbut-1-yne (1.1 eq) in acetonitrile (0.2 vol) was added. The mixture was sparged with nitrogen gas for 1 h and then a solution of (R)-1-((4-amino-2-bromo-5-fluorophenyl)amino)-3-(benzyloxy)propan-2-ol free base (1 eq) in acetonitrile (4.1 vol) was added. The mixture was sparged with nitrogen gas for another hour and then was heated to 80° C. Reaction progress was monitored by HPLC and the reaction was usually complete within 3-5 h. The mixture was cooled to room temperature and then filtered through Celite. The cake was washed with acetonitrile (4 vol). The combined filtrates were azeotroped to dryness and then the mixture was polish filtered into the next reactor. The acetonitrile solution of (R)-1-((4-amino-2-(4-(benzyloxy)-3,3-dimethylbut-1-yn-1-yl)-5-fluorophenyl)amino)-3-(benzyloxy)propan-2-ol thus obtained was used directly in the next procedure (cyclization) without further purification.


Example 4g
(R)-1-(5-amino-2-(1-(benzyloxy)-2-methylpropan-2-yl)-6-fluoro-1H-indol-1-yl)-3-(benzyloxy)propan-2-ol



embedded image


Bis-acetonitriledichloropalladium (0.1 eq) and CuI (0.1 eq) were charged to the reactor and then suspended in a solution of (R)-1-((4-amino-2-(4-(benzyloxy)-3,3-dimethylbut-1-yn-1-yl)-5-fluorophenyl)amino)-3-(benzyloxy)propan-2-ol obtained above (1 eq) in acetonitrile (9.5 vol total). The mixture was sparged with nitrogen gas for 1 h and then was heated to 80° C. The reaction progress was monitored by HPLC and the reaction was typically complete within 1-3 h. The mixture was filtered through Celite and the cake was washed with acetonitrile. A solvent swap into ethyl acetate (7.5 vol) was performed. The ethyl acetate solution was washed with aqueous NH3—NH4Cl solution (2×2.5 vol) followed by 10% brine (2.5 vol). The ethyl acetate solution was then stirred with silica gel (1.8 wt eq) and Si-TMT (0.1 wt eq) for 6 h. After filtration, the resulting solution was concentrated down. The residual oil was dissolved in DCM/heptane (4 vol) and then purified by column chromatography. The oil thus obtained was then crystallized from 25% EtOAc/heptane (4 vol). Crystalline (R)-1-(5-amino-2-(1-(benzyloxy)-2-methylpropan-2-yl)-6-fluoro-1H-indol-1-yl)-3-(benzyloxy)propan-2-ol was typically obtained in 27-38% yield. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO) 7.38-7.34 (m, 4H), 7.32-7.23 (m, 6H), 7.21 (d, 1H, J=12.8 Hz), 6.77 (d, 1H, J=9.0 Hz), 6.06 (s, 1H), 5.13 (d, 1H, J=4.9 Hz), 4.54 (s, 2H), 4.46 (br. s, 2H), 4.45 (s, 2H), 4.33 (d, 1H, J=12.4 Hz), 4.09-4.04 (m, 2H), 3.63 (d, 1H, J=9.2 Hz), 3.56 (d, 1H, J=9.2 Hz), 3.49 (dd, 1H, J=9.8, 4.4 Hz), 3.43 (dd, 1H, J=9.8, 5.7 Hz), 1.40 (s, 6H).


II.D.4.b. Coupling
Example 4h
Synthesis of (R)—N-(1-(3-(benzyloxy)-2-hydroxypropyl)-2-(1-(benzyloxy)-2-methylpropan-2-yl)-6-fluoro-1H-indol-5-yl)-1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamide



embedded image


1-(2,2-Difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-cyclopropanecarboxylic acid (1.3 equiv) was slurried in toluene (2.5 vol, based on 1-(2,2-difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-cyclopropanecarboxylic acid). Thionyl chloride (SOCl2, 1.7 equiv) was added via addition funnel and the mixture was heated to 60° C. The resulting mixture was stirred for 2 h. The toluene and the excess SOCl2 were distilled off using a rotovap. Additional toluene (2.5 vol, based on 1-(2,2-difluoro-1,3-benzodioxol-5-yl)-cyclopropanecarboxylic acid) was added and the mixture was distilled down to 1 vol of toluene. A solution of (R)-1-(5-amino-2-(1-(benzyloxy)-2-methylpropan-2-yl)-6-fluoro-1H-indol-1-yl)-3-(benzyloxy)propan-2-ol (1 eq) and triethylamine (3 eq) in DCM (4 vol) was cooled to 0° C. The acid chloride solution in toluene (1 vol) was added while maintaining the batch temperature below 10° C. The reaction progress was monitored by HPLC, and the reaction was usually complete within minutes. After warming to 25° C., the reaction mixture was washed with 5% NaHCO3 (3.5 vol), 1 M NaOH (3.5 vol) and 1 M HCl (5 vol). A solvent swap to into methanol (2 vol) was performed and the resulting solution of (R)—N-(1-(3-(benzyloxy)-2-hydroxypropyl)-2-(1-(benzyloxy)-2-methylpropan-2-yl)-6-fluoro-1H-indol-5-yl)-1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamide in methanol was used without further purification in the next step (hydrogenolysis).


II.D.4.c. Deprotection and Isolation of Compound 4
Example 4i
Synthesis of Compound 4



embedded image


5% palladium on charcoal (˜50% wet, 0.01 eq) was charged to an appropriate hydrogenation vessel. The (R)—N-(1-(3-(benzyloxy)-2-hydroxypropyl)-2-(1-(benzyloxy)-2-methylpropan-2-yl)-6-fluoro-1H-indol-5-yl)-1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamide solution in methanol (2 vol) obtained above was added carefully, followed by a 3 M solution of HCl in methanol. The vessel was purged with nitrogen gas and then with hydrogen gas. The mixture was stirred vigorously until the reaction was complete, as determined by HPLC analysis. Typical reaction time was 3-5 h. The reaction mixture was filtered through Celite and the cake was washed with methanol (2 vol). A solvent swap into isopropanol (3 vol) was performed. Crude Compound 3 was crystallized from 75% IPA-heptane (4 vol, ie. 1 vol heptane added to the 3 vol of IPA) and the resulting crystals were matured in 50% IPA-heptane (ie. 2 vol of heptane added to the mixture). Typical yields of Compound 4 from the two-step acylation/hydrogenolysis procedure range from 68% to 84%. Compound 4 can be recrystallized from IPA-heptane following the same procedure just described.


Compound 4 may also be prepared by one of several synthetic routes disclosed in US published patent application US 2009/0131492, incorporated herein by reference.









TABLE 4-1







Physical Data for Compound 4.










Cmpd.
LC/MS
LC/RT



No.
M + 1
min
NMR





4
521.5
1.69
1H NMR (400.0 MHz, CD3CN) d 7.69 (d, J = 7.7 Hz,





1H), 7.44 (d, J = 1.6 Hz, 1H), 7.39 (dd, J = 1.7, 8.3 Hz,





1H), 7.31 (s, 1H), 7.27 (d, J = 8.3 Hz, 1H), 7.20 (d, J = 12.0 Hz,





1H), 6.34 (s, 1H), 4.32 (d, J = 6.8 Hz, 2H),





4.15-4.09 (m, 1H), 3.89 (dd, J = 6.0, 11.5 Hz, 1H),





3.63-3.52 (m, 3H), 3.42 (d, J = 4.6 Hz, 1H), 3.21 (dd, J = 6.2, 7.2 Hz,





1H), 3.04 (t, J = 5.8 Hz, 1H), 1.59 (dd, J = 3.8, 6.8 Hz,





2H), 1.44 (s, 3H), 1.33 (s, 3H) and 1.18 (dd, J = 3.7, 6.8 Hz,





2H) ppm.









III. Solid Forms
III.A. Solid Forms of Compound 1
III.A.1. Compound 1 Form C
III.A.1.a. Characterization and Embodiments of Compound 1 Form C

XRPD (X-Ray Powder Diffraction)


The XRPD patterns were acquired at room temperature in reflection mode using a Bruker D8 Advance diffractometer equipped with a sealed tube copper source and a Vantec-1 detector. The X-ray generator was operating at a voltage of 40 kV and a current of 40 mA. The data were recorded in a θ-θ scanning mode over the range of 3°-40° 2θ with a step size of 0.014° and the sample spinning at 15 rpm.


In one aspect, Compound 1 is in Form C. In one embodiment, of this aspect, the invention includes crystalline N-[2,4-bis(1,1-dimethylethyl)-5-hydroxyphenyl]-1,4-dihydro-4-oxoquinoline-3-carboxamide (Compound 1) characterized as Form C.


In one embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a peak having a 2-Theta value from about 6.0 to about 6.4 degrees in an XRPD pattern. In a further embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak having a 2-Theta value from about 7.3 to about 7.7 degrees in an XRPD pattern. In a further embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak having a 2-Theta value from about 8.1 to about 8.5 degrees in an XRPD pattern. In a further embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak having a 2-Theta value from about 12.2 to about 12.6 degrees in an XRPD pattern. In a further embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak having a 2-Theta value from about 14.4 to about 14.8 degrees in an XRPD pattern. In a further embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak having a 2-Theta value from about 17.7 to about 18.1 degrees in an XRPD pattern. In a further embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak having a 2-Theta value from about 20.3 to about 20.7 degrees in an XRPD pattern. In a further embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak having a 2-Theta value from about 20.7 to about 21.1 degrees in an XRPD pattern.


In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak having a 2-Theta value of about 6.2 degrees in an XRPD pattern. In a further embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak having a 2-Theta value of about 7.5 degrees in an XRPD pattern. In a further embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak having a 2-Theta value of about 8.3 degrees in an XRPD pattern. In a further embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak having a 2-Theta value of about 12.4 degrees in an XRPD pattern. In a further embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak having a 2-Theta value of about 14.6 degrees in an XRPD pattern. In a further embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak having a 2-Theta value of about 17.9 degrees in an XRPD pattern. In a further embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak having a 2-Theta value of about 20.5 degrees in an XRPD pattern. In a further embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak having a 2-Theta value of about 20.9 degrees in an XRPD pattern.


In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by one or more peaks in an XRPD pattern selected from about 6.2, about 7.5, about 8.3, about 12.4, about 14.6, about 17.9, about 20.5 and about 20.9 degrees as measured on a 2-Theta scale.


In still another embodiment, Form C is characterized by all of the following peaks in an XRPD pattern: about 6.2, about 7.5, about 8.3, about 12.4, about 14.6, about 17.9, about 20.5 and about 20.9 degrees as measured on a 2-Theta scale. Compound 1 Form C can be characterized by the X-Ray powder diffraction pattern depicted in FIG. 1-1. Representative peaks as observed in the XRPD pattern are provided in Table 1-1a and Table 1-1b below. Each peak described in Table 1-1a also has a corresponding peak label (A-H), which are used to describe some embodiments of the invention.









TABLE 1-1a







Representative XRPD peaks for Compound 1 Form C.









Peak #
Angle 2-θ (°)
Peak Label












1
6.2
A


2
7.5
B


3
8.3
C


4
12.4
D


5
14.6
E


6
17.9
F


7
20.5
G


8
20.9
H









In another embodiment, Form C can be characterized by an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern having the representative peaks listed in Table 1-1b.









TABLE 1-1b







Further representative XRPD peaks for Form C.










Peak #
Angle 2-θ (°)














1
6.2



2
7.5



3
8.3



4
11.0



5
12.4



6
14.6



7
16.3



8
17.1



9
17.9



10
18.1



11
18.7



12
19.5



13
20.5



14
20.9



15
21.3



16
21.5



17
21.8



18
22.1



19
22.4



20
22.7










In one aspect, Compound 1 Form C can be characterized by an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern having one or more of peaks A, B, C, D, E, F, G and H as described in Table 1-1a.


In one embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by peak A. In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by peak B. In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by peak B. In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by peak C. In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by peak D. In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by peak E. In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by peak F. In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by peak G. In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by peak H.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern having one of the following groups of peaks as described in Table 1-1a: A and B; A and C; A and D; A and E; A and F; A and G; A and H; B and C; B and D; B and E; B and F; B and G; B and H; C and D; C and E; C and F; C and G; C and H; D and E; D and F; D and G; D and H; E and F; E and G; E and H; F and G; F and H; and G and H.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern having one of the following groups of peaks as described in Table 1-1a: A, B and C; A, B and D; A, B and E; A, B and F; A, B and G; A, B and H; A, C and D; A, C and E; A, C and F; A, C and G; A, C and H; A, D and E; A, D and F; A, D and G; A, D and H; A, E and F; A, E and G; A, E and H; A, F and G; A, F and H; A, G and H; B, C and D; B, C and E; B, C and F; B, C and G; B, C and H; B, D and E; B, D and F; B, D and G; B, D and H; B, E and F; B, E and G; B, E and H; B, F and G; B, F and H; B, G and H; C, D and E; C, D F; C, D and G; C, D and H; C, E and F; C, E and G; C, E and H; C, F and G; C, F and H; C, G and H; D, E and F; D, E and G; D, E and H; D, F and G; D, F and H; D, G and H; E, F and G; E, F and H, E, G and H; and F, G and H.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern having one of the following groups of peaks as described in Table 1-1a: A, B, C and D; A, B, C and E, A, B, C and F; A, B, C and G; A, B, C and H; A, B, D and E; A, B, D and F; A, B, D and G; A, B, D and H; A, B, E and F; A, B, E and G; A, B, E and H; A, B, F and G; A, B, F and H; A, B, G and H; A, C, D and E; A, C, D and F; A, C, D and G; A, C, D and H; A, C, E and F; A, C, E and G; A, C, E and H; A, C, F and G; A, C, F and H; A, C, G and H; A, D, F and G; A, D, F and H; A, D, G and H; A, E, F and G; A, E, F and H; A, E, G and H; A, F, G and H; B, C, D and E; B, C, D and F; B, C, D and G; B, C, D and H; B, C, E and F; B, C, E and G; B, C, E and H; B, C, F and G; B, C, F and H; B, C, G and H; B, D, E and F; B, D, E and G; B, D, E and H; B, D, F and G; B, D, F and H; B, D, G and H; B, E, F and G; B, E, F and H; B, E, G and H; B, F, G and H; C, D, E and F; C, D, E and G; C, D, E and H; C, D, F and G; C, D, F and H; C, D, G and H; C, E, F and G; C, E, F and H; C, E, G and H; C, F, G and H; D, E, F and G; D, E, F and H; D, E, G and H; D, F, G and H; and E, F, G and H.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern having one of the following groups of peaks as described in Table 1-1a: A, B, C, D and E; A, B, C, D and F; A, B, C, D and G; A, B, C, D and H; A, B, C, E and F; A, B, C, E and G; A, B, C, E and H; A, B, C, F and G; A, B, C, F and H; A, B, C, G and H; A, B, C, E and F; A, B, C, E and G; A, B, C, E and H; A, B, C, F and G; A, B, C, F and H; A, B, C, G and H; A, B, D, E and F; A, B, D, E and G; A, B, D, E and H; A, B, D, F and G; A, B, D, F and H; A, B, D, G and H; A, B, E, F and G; A, B, E, F and H; A, B, E, G and H; A, B, F, G and H; A, C, D, E and F; A, C, D, E and G; A, C, D, E and H; A, C, D, F and G; A, C, D, F and H; A, C, D, G and H; A, C, E, F and G; A, C, E, F and H; A, C, E, G and H; A, C, F, G and H; A, D, E, F and G; A, D, E, F and H; A, D, E, G and H; A, D, F, G and H; A, E, F, G and H; B, C, D, E and F; B, C, D, E and G; B, C, D, E and H; B, C, D, F and G; B, C, D, F and H; B, C, D, G and H; B, C, E, F and G; B, C, E, F and H; B, C, E, G and H; B, C, F, G and H; B, D, E, F and G; B, D, E, F and H; B, D, E, G and H; B, D, F, G and H; B, E, F, G and H; C, D, E, F and G; C, D, E, F and H; C, D, E, G and H; C, D, F, G and H; C, E, F, G and H; and D, E, F, G and H.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern having one of the following groups of peaks as described in Table 1-1a: A, B, C, D, E and F; A, B, C, D, E and G; A, B, C, D, E and H; A, B, C, D, F and G; A, B, C, D, F and H; A, B, C, D, G and H; A, B, C, E, F and G; A, B, C, E, F and H; A, B, C, E, G and H; A, B, C, F, G and H; A, B, D, E, F and G; A, B, D, E, F and H; A, B, D, E, G and H; A, B, D, F, G and H; A, B, E, F, G and H; A, C, D, E, F and G; A, C, D, E, F and H; A, C, D, E, G and H; A, C, D, F, G and H; A, C, E, F, G and H; A, D, E, F, G and H; B, C, D, E, F and G; B, C, D, E, F and H; B, C, D, E, G and H; B, C, D, F, G and H; B, C, E, F, G and H; B, D, E, F, G and H; and C, D, E, F, G and H.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern having one of the following groups of peaks as described in Table 1-1a: A, B, C, D, E, F and G; A, B, C, D, E, F and H; A, B, C, D, E, G and H; A, B, C, D, F, G and H; A, B, C, E, F, G and H; A, B, D, E, F, G and H; A, C, D, E, F, G and H; and B, C, D, E, F, G and H.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern having all of the following peaks as described in Table 1-1a: A, B, C, D, E, F, G and H.


In another aspect, Compound 1 Form C can be characterized by an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern having one or more of peaks that range in value within ±0.2 degrees of one or more of the peaks A, B, C, D, E, F, G and H as described in Table 1. In one embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a peak within ±0.2 degrees of A. In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak within ±0.2 degrees of B. In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak within ±0.2 degrees of B. In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak within ±0.2 degrees of C. In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak within ±0.2 degrees of D. In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak within ±0.2 degrees of E. In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak within ±0.2 degrees of F. In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak within ±0.2 degrees of G. In another embodiment, Form C is characterized by a peak within ±0.2 degrees of H.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern having one of the following groups of peaks as described in Table 1-1a: A and B; A and C; A and D; A and E; A and F; A and G; A and H; B and C; B and D; B and E; B and F; B and G; B and H; C and D; C and E; C and F; C and G; C and H; D and E; D and F; D and G; D and H; E and F; E and G; E and H; F and G; F and H; and G and H, wherein each peak in the group is within ±0.2 degrees of the corresponding value described in Table 1-1a.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern having one of the following groups of peaks as described in Table 1-1a: A, B and C; A, B and D; A, B and E; A, B and F; A, B and G; A, B and H; A, C and D; A, C and E; A, C and F; A, C and G; A, C and H; A, D and E; A, D and F; A, D and G; A, D and H; A, E and F; A, E and G; A, E and H; A, F and G; A, F and H; A, G and H; B, C and D; B, C and E; B, C and F; B, C and G; B, C and H; B, D and E; B, D and F; B, D and G; B, D and H; B, E and F; B, E and G; B, E and H; B, F and G; B, F and H; B, G and H; C, D and E; C, D F; C, D and G; C, D and H; C, E and F; C, E and G; C, E and H; C, F and G; C, F and H; C, G and H; D, E and F; D, E and G; D, E and H; D, F and G; D, F and H; D, G and H; E, F and G; E, F and H, E, G and H; and F, G and H, wherein each peak in the group is within ±0.2 degrees of the corresponding value described in Table 1-1a.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern having one of the following groups of peaks as described in Table 1-1a: A, B, C and D; A, B, C and E, A, B, C and F; A, B, C and G; A, B, C and H; A, B, D and E; A, B, D and F; A, B, D and G; A, B, D and H; A, B, E and F; A, B, E and G; A, B, E and H; A, B, F and G; A, B, F and H; A, B, G and H; A, C, D and E; A, C, D and F; A, C, D and G; A, C, D and H; A, C, E and F; A, C, E and G; A, C, E and H; A, C, F and G; A, C, F and H; A, C, G and H; A, D, F and G; A, D, F and H; A, D, G and H; A, E, F and G; A, E, F and H; A, E, G and H; A, F, G and H; B, C, D and E; B, C, D and F; B, C, D and G; B, C, D and H; B, C, E and F; B, C, E and G; B, C, E and H; B, C, F and G; B, C, F and H; B, C, G and H; B, D, E and F; B, D, E and G; B, D, E and H; B, D, F and G; B, D, F and H; B, D, G and H; B, E, F and G; B, E, F and H; B, E, G and H; B, F, G and H; C, D, E and F; C, D, E and G; C, D, E and H; C, D, F and G; C, D, F and H; C, D, G and H; C, E, F and G; C, E, F and H; C, E, G and H; C, F, G and H; D, E, F and G; D, E, F and H; D, E, G and H; D, F, G and H; and E, F, G and H, wherein each peak in the group is within ±0.2 degrees of the corresponding value described in Table 1-1a.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern having one of the following groups of peaks as described in Table 1-1a: A, B, C, D and E; A, B, C, D and F; A, B, C, D and G; A, B, C, D and H; A, B, C, E and F; A, B, C, E and G; A, B, C, E and H; A, B, C, F and G; A, B, C, F and H; A, B, C, G and H; A, B, C, E and F; A, B, C, E and G; A, B, C, E and H; A, B, C, F and G; A, B, C, F and H; A, B, C, G and H; A, B, D, E and F; A, B, D, E and G; A, B, D, E and H; A, B, D, F and G; A, B, D, F and H; A, B, D, G and H; A, B, E, F and G; A, B, E, F and H; A, B, E, G and H; A, B, F, G and H; A, C, D, E and F; A, C, D, E and G; A, C, D, E and H; A, C, D, F and G; A, C, D, F and H; A, C, D, G and H; A, C, E, F and G; A, C, E, F and H; A, C, E, G and H; A, C, F, G and H; A, D, E, F and G; A, D, E, F and H; A, D, E, G and H; A, D, F, G and H; A, E, F, G and H; B, C, D, E and F; B, C, D, E and G; B, C, D, E and H; B, C, D, F and G; B, C, D, F and H; B, C, D, G and H; B, C, E, F and G; B, C, E, F and H; B, C, E, G and H; B, C, F, G and H; B, D, E, F and G; B, D, E, F and H; B, D, E, G and H; B, D, F, G and H; B, E, F, G and H; C, D, E, F and G; C, D, E, F and H; C, D, E, G and H; C, D, F, G and H; C, E, F, G and H; and D, E, F, G and H, wherein each peak in the group is within ±0.2 degrees of the corresponding value described in Table 1-1a.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern having one of the following groups of peaks as described in Table 1-1a: A, B, C, D, E and F; A, B, C, D, E and G; A, B, C, D, E and H; A, B, C, D, F and G; A, B, C, D, F and H; A, B, C, D, G and H; A, B, C, E, F and G; A, B, C, E, F and H; A, B, C, E, G and H; A, B, C, F, G and H; A, B, D, E, F and G; A, B, D, E, F and H; A, B, D, E, G and H; A, B, D, F, G and H; A, B, E, F, G and H; A, C, D, E, F and G; A, C, D, E, F and H; A, C, D, E, G and H; A, C, D, F, G and H; A, C, E, F, G and H; A, D, E, F, G and H; B, C, D, E, F and G; B, C, D, E, F and H; B, C, D, E, G and H; B, C, D, F, G and H; B, C, E, F, G and H; B, D, E, F, G and H; and C, D, E, F, G and H, wherein each peak in the group is within ±0.2 degrees of the corresponding value described in Table 1-1a.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern having one of the following groups of peaks as described in Table 1-1a: A, B, C, D, E, F and G; A, B, C, D, E, F and H; A, B, C, D, E, G and H; A, B, C, D, F, G and H; A, B, C, E, F, G and H; A, B, D, E, F, G and H; A, C, D, E, F, G and H; and B, C, D, E, F, G and H, wherein each peak in the group is within ±0.2 degrees of the corresponding value described in Table 1-1a.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by an X-Ray powder diffraction pattern having all of the following peaks as described in Table 1-1a: A, B, C, D, E, F, G and H, wherein each peak in the group is within ±0.2 degrees of the corresponding value described in Table 1-1a.


Rietveld Refinement of Form C (Compound 1) from Powder


High resolution data were collected for a crystalline powder sample of Compound 1 Form C (Collection performed at the European Synchrotron Radiation Facility, Grenoble, France) at the beamline ID31. The X-rays are produced by three 11-mm-gap ex-vacuum undulatory. The beam is monochromated by a cryogenically cooled double-crystal monochromator (Si 111 crystals). Water-cooled slits define the size of the beam incident on the monochromator, and of the monochromatic beam transmitted to the sample in the range of 0.5-2.5 mm (horizontal) by 0.1-1.5 mm (vertical). The wavelength used for the experiment was 1.29984(3) Å.


The powder diffraction data were processed and indexed using Materials Studio (Reflex module). The structure was solved using PowderSolve module of Materials Studio. The resulting solution was assessed for structural viability and subsequently refined using Rietveld refinement procedure.


The structure was solved and refined in a centrosymmetric space group P21/c using simulated annealing algorithm. The main building block in form C is a dimer composed of two Compound 1 molecules related to each other by a crystallographic inversion center and connected via a pair of hydrogen bonds between the hydroxyl and the amide carbonyl group. These dimers are then further arranged into infinite chains and columns through hydrogen bonding, π-π stacking and van der Waals interactions. Two adjacent columns are oriented perpendicular to each other, one along the crystallographic direction a, the other along b. The columns are connected with each other through van der Waals interactions.


The 4-oxo-1H-quinoline group is locked in a nearly coplanar conformation with the amide group via an intramolecular hydrogen bond. Owing to the centrosymmetric space group, Form C structure contains two Compound 1 molecular conformations related to one another by rotation around the C1-N12 bond.


A powder pattern calculated from the crystal structure of form C and an experimental powder pattern recorded on powder diffractometer using a flat sample in reflectance mode have been compared. The peak positions are in excellent agreement. Some discrepancies in intensities of some peaks exist and are due to preferred orientation of crystallites in the flat sample.


The results of refinement, instrument setup, radiation details, lattice parameters of the resulting crystal are listed below.









TABLE 1-2





Results of refinement:




















Final Rwp:
10.24%
Final Rp:
7.27%



Final Rwp (without
15.98%
Final CMACS:
0.09%



background):

















TABLE 1-3





Results of further refinement:




















Final Rwp:
10.50%
Final Rp:
7.49%



Final Rwp (without
16.41%
Final CMACS:
0.09%



background):

















TABLE 1-4





Setup




















2θ Range
1.00-50.00
Step Size
0.003



(degrees):

(degrees):



Excluded Regions:


















TABLE 1-5





Radiation


















Type:
X-ray
Source:
Synchrotron


λ1 (Å):
1.299840
Monochromator:
Double


Anom. Dispersion:
No
Angle:
50.379




Polarization:
 0.950
















TABLE 1-6







Lattice Parameters (Lattice Type: Monoclinic; Space Group: P21/c









Parameter
Value
Refined?





a
12.211 Å
Yes


b
 5.961 Å
Yes


c
32.662 Å
Yes


α
90.00°
No


β
119.62° 
Yes


γ
90.00°
No









In one embodiment, the crystal structure of Compound 1 Form C has a monoclinic lattice type. In another embodiment, the crystal structure of Compound 1 Form C has a P21/c space group. In another embodiment, the crystal structure of Compound 1 Form C has a monoclinic lattice type and a P21/c space group.


In one embodiment, the crystal structure of Compound 1 Form C has the following unit cell dimensions:


a=12.211 Angstroms


b=5.961 Angstroms


c=32.662 Angstroms


α=90.00°


β=119.62°


γ=90.00°


In one aspect, the invention includes Pharmaceutical compositions including Compound 1 Form C and a pharmaceutically acceptable adjuvant or carrier. In one embodiment, Compound 1 Form C can be formulated in a pharmaceutical composition, in some instances, with another therapeutic agent, for example another therapeutic agent for treating cystic fibrosis or a symptom thereof.


Processes for preparing Compound 1 Form C are exemplified herein.


Methods of treating a CFTR mediated disease, such as cystic fibrosis, in a patient include administering to said patient Compound 1 Form C or a pharmaceutical composition comprising Compound 1 Form C.


Compound 1 Form C can be also characterized by an endotherm beginning at 292.78° C., that plateaus slightly and then peaks at 293.83° C. as measured by DSC (FIG. 1-2). Further, this endotherm precedes an 85% weight loss, as measured by TGA (FIG. 1-3), which is attributed to chemical degradation.


Compound 1 Form C can be characterized by a FT-IR spectrum as depicted in FIG. 1-5 and by Raman spectroscopy as depicted by FIG. 1-4.


Compound 1 Form C can be characterize by solid state NMR spectrum as depicted in FIG. 1-6.


Processes for preparing Compound 1 Form C are exemplified below.


III.A.1.b. Synthesis of Compound 1 Form C

Compound 1 Form C was prepared by adding an excess of optionally recrystallized Compound 1, prepared as provided in Section II.A.3, into acetonitrile, stirring at 90° C. for 3 days, and cooling to room temperature. The product was harvested by filtration, and the purity of the Compound was confirmed using SSNMR. The recrystallization procedure is reproduced below for convenience.


Recrystallization of Compound 1




embedded image


Compound 1 (1.0 eq) was charged to a reactor. 2-MeTHF (20.0 vol) was added followed by 0.1N HCl (5.0 vol). The biphasic solution was stirred and separated and the top organic phase was washed twice more with 0.1N HCl (5.0 vol). The organic solution was polish filtered to remove any particulates and placed in a second reactor. The filtered solution was concentrated at no more than 35° C. (jacket temperature) and no more than 8.0° C. (internal reaction temperature) under reduced pressure to 10 vol. Isopropyl acetate (IPAc) (10 vol) was added and the solution concentrated at no more than 35° C. (jacket temperature) and no more than 8.0° C. (internal reaction temperature) to 10 vol. The addition of IPAc and concentration was repeated 2 more times for a total of 3 additions of IPAc and 4 concentrations to 10 vol. After the final concentration, 10 vol of IPAc was charged and the slurry was heated to reflux and maintained at this temperature for 5 hours. The slurry was cooled to 0.0° C.+/−5° C. over 5 hours and filtered. The cake was washed with IPAc (5 vol) once. The resulting solid was dried in a vacuum oven at 50.0° C.+/−5.0° C.


Methods & Materials


Differential Scanning calorimetry (DSC)


The DSC traces of Form C were obtained using TA Instruments DSC Q2000 equipped with Universal Analysis 2000 software. An amount (3-8 mg) of Compound 1 Form C was weighed into an aluminum pan and sealed with a pinhole lid. The sample was heated from 25° C. to 325° C. at 10° C./min. The sample exhibited high melting points which is consistent with highly crystalline material. In one embodiment, the melting range is about 293.3 to about 294.7° C. In a further embodiment, the melting range is about 293.8° C. to about 294.2° C. In another embodiment, the onset temperature range is about 292.2° C. to about 293.5° C. In a further embodiment, the onset temperature range is about 292.7° C. to about 293.0° C.


Thermogravimetric Analysis (TGA)


TGA was conducted on a TA Instruments model Q5000. An amount (3-5 mg) of Compound 1 Form C was placed in a platinum sample pan and heated at 10° C./min from room temperature to 400° C. Data were collected by Thermal Advantage Q Series™ software and analyzed by Universal Analysis 2000 software.


XRPD (X-Ray Powder Diffraction)


As stated previously, the XRPD patterns were acquired at room temperature in reflection mode using a Bruker D8 Advance diffractometer equipped with a sealed tube copper source and a Vantec-1 detector. The X-ray generator was operating at a voltage of 40 kV and a current of 40 mA. The data were recorded in a θ-θ scanning mode over the range of 3°-40° 2θ with a step size of 0.014° and the sample spinning at 15 rpm.


Raman and FTIR Spectroscopy


Raman spectra for Compound 1, Form C was acquired at room temperature using the VERTEX 70 FT-IR spectrometer coupled to a RAMII FT-Raman module. The sample was introduced into a clear vial, placed in the sample compartment and analyzed using the parameters outlined in the table below.


Raman Parameters
















Parameter
Setting









Beam splitter
CaF2



Laser frequency
9395.0 cm−1



Laser power
1000 mW



Save data from
3501 to 2.94 cm−1



Resolution
4 cm−1



Sample scan time
64 scans










The FTIR spectra for Compound 1, Form C was acquired at room temperature using the Bruker VERTEX 70 FT-IR spectrometer using the parameters described in the table below.


FTIR Parameters
















Parameter
Setting









Scan range
4000-650 cm−1



Resolution
    4 cm−1



Scans sample
16



Scans background
16



Sampling mode
ATR, single reflection ZnSe

















TABLE 1-7







FTIR and Raman peak assignments for Compound 1, Form C: vs =


very strong s = strong, m = medium, w = weak intensity.










FTIR
Raman



Wavenumber
Wavenumber


Peak assignments
Intensity
Intensity





N—H str in
3281 m
Not observed


—C(═O)—NHR trans


Unsaturated C—H str-substituted
3085 m, 3056 m
3071 w, 2991 w


aromatic and olefin


Aliphatic C—H str
2991 m, 2955 m, 2907 m,
2959 w, 2913 w, 2878 w



2876 m


Amide C═O str +
1643 s
Not observed


Conjugated ketone C═O str


Olefin C═C conjugated with C═O
Not observed
1615 s


Amide II in
1524 vs
1528 s


—C(═O)—NHR trans


Benzene ring str
1475 s
Not observed


Amide III in
1285 s
1310 vs


—C(═O)—NHR trans


Aromatic C—H wag
765 vs
Not observed


Aromatic in-plane bend modes
Not observed
748 s









SSNMR (Solid State Nuclear Magnetic Resonance Spectroscopy)


Bruker-Biospin 400 MHz wide-bore spectrometer equipped with Bruker-Biospin 4 mm HFX probe was used. Samples were packed into 4 mm ZrO2 rotors and spun under Magic Angle Spinning (MAS) condition with spinning speed of 12.0 kHz. The proton relaxation time was first measured using 1H MAS T1 saturation recovery relaxation experiment in order to set up proper recycle delay of the 13C cross-polarization (CP) MAS experiment. The CP contact time of carbon CPMAS experiment was set to 2 ms. A CP proton pulse with linear ramp (from 50% to 100%) was employed. The Hartmann-Hahn match was optimized on external reference sample (glycine). TPPM15 decoupling sequence was used with the field strength of approximately 100 kHz. Some peaks from a 13C SSNMR spectrum of Compound 1 Form C are given in Table 1-14.









TABLE 1-14







Listing of some of the SSNMR peaks for Form C.


Compound 1 Form C












Peak #
Chemical Shift [ppm]
Intensity
Peak Label
















1
176.5
17.95
A



2
165.3
23.73
B



3
152.0
47.53
C



4
145.8
33.97
D



5
139.3
30.47
E



6
135.4
21.76
F



7
133.3
35.38
G



8
131.8
21.72
H



9
130.2
21.45
I



10
129.4
29.31
J



11
127.7
31.54
K



12
126.8
25.44
L



13
124.8
20.47
M



14
117.0
42.4
N



15
112.2
61.08
O



16
34.5
33.34
P



17
32.3
14.42
Q



18
29.6
100
R










In some embodiments, the 13C SSNMR spectrum of Compound 1 Form C is includes one or more of the following peaks: 176.5 ppm, 165.3 ppm, 152.0 ppm, 145.8 ppm, 139.3 ppm, 135.4 ppm, 133.3 ppm, 131.8 ppm, 130.2 ppm, 129.4 ppm, 127.7 ppm, 126.8 ppm, 124.8 ppm, 117.0 ppm, 112.2 ppm, 34.5 ppm, 32.3 ppm and 29.6 ppm.


In some embodiments, the 13C SSNMR spectrum of Compound 1 Form C includes all of the following peaks: 152.0 ppm, 135.4 ppm, 131.8 ppm, 130.2 ppm, 124.8 ppm, 117.0 ppm and 34.5 ppm.


In some embodiments, the 13C SSNMR spectrum of Compound 1 Form C includes all of the following peaks: 152.0 ppm, 135.4 ppm, 131.8 ppm and 117.0 ppm.


In some embodiments, the 13C SSNMR spectrum of Compound 1 Form C includes all of the following peaks: 135.4 ppm and 131.8 ppm.


In some embodiments, the SSNMR of Compound 1 Form C includes a peak at about 152.0 ppm, about 135.4, about 131.8 ppm, and about 117 ppm.


In one aspect, the invention includes Compound 1 Form C which is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having one or more of the following peaks: C, F, H, I, M, N and P, as described by Table 1-14.


In one embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by one peak in a 13C SSNMR spectrum, wherein the peak is selected from C, F, H, I, M, N and P, as described by Table 1-14.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C and F; C and H; C and N; F and H; F and N; and H and N, as described by Table 1-14. In a further embodiment, the 13C SSNMR spectrum includes the peaks I, M and P as described by Table 1-14.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, F and H; C, H and N; and F, H and N, as described by Table 1-14. In a further embodiment, the 13C SSNMR spectrum includes the peaks I, M and P as described by Table 1-14.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having the following group of peaks: C, F, H and N, as described by Table 1-14. In a further embodiment, the 13C SSNMR spectrum includes the peaks I, M and P as described by Table 1-14.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C and F; C and H, C and N; C and I; C and M; or C and P, as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from F and H; F and N; F and I; F and M; or F and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from H and N; H and I; H and M; or H and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from N and I; N and M; or N and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from I and M; I and P or M and P as described by Table 1-14.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, F and H; C, F and N; C, F and I; C, F and M; or C, F and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, H and N; C, H and I; C, H and M; or C, H and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, N and I; C, N and M; or C, N and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, I and M; or C, I and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, M and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from F, H, and N; F, H and I; F, H and M; or F, H and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from F, N and I; F, N and M; or F, N and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from F, I and M; or F, I and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from F, M and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from H, N and I; H, N and M; or H, N and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from H, I and M; or H, I and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from H, M and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from N, I and M; or N, I and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from N, M and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from I, M and P as described by Table 1-14.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, F, H, and N; C, F H, and I; C, F H, and M; or C, F H, and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from F, H, N and I; F, H, N and M; or F, H, N and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from H, N, I and M; H, N, I and P; or H, N, I and C as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from N, I, M and P; N, I, M and C; or N, I, M and F as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from I, M, P and C; I, M, P and F; I, M, P and H as described by Table 1-14.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, H, N and I; C, H, N, and M; or C, H, N, and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, N, I and M; C, N, I and P; or C, N, I and F as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, I, M and P; C, I, M and F; or C, I, M and H as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, M, P and F; C, M, P and H; or C, M, P and N as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from F, N, I and M; F, N, I and P; or F, N, I and C as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from F, I, M and P; F, I, M and C; F, I, M and H; or F, I, M and N as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from F, M, P and C; F, M, P and H; or F, M, P and N as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from H, I, M and P; H, I, M and C; or H, I, M and F as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from N, M, P and C; N, M, P and F; or N, M, P and H as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from N, M, C and F; or N, M, C and H as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from N, M, F and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from N, M, H and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, H, I and P; C, F, I and P; C, F, N and P or F, H, I and P as described by Table 1-14.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, F, H, N and I; C, F, H, N and M; or C, F, H, N and P; C, F, H, I and M; C, F, H, I and P; C, F, H, M and P; C, F, N, I and M; C, F, N, I and P; C, F, N, M and P; C, H, N, I and M; C, H, N, I and P; C, H, N, M and P; C, H, I, M and P; F, H, N, I and M; F, H, N, I and P; F, H, N, M and P; F, H, I, M and P; F, N, I, M and P or H, N, I, M and P as described by Table 1-14.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, F, H, N and I; C, F, H, N and M; or C, F, H, N and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, H, N, I and M; or C, H, N, I and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, N, I, M and P; or C, N, I, M and F as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, I, M, P and F; or C, I, M, P and H as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, M, P, F and H; or C, M, P, F and N as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, P, F, H and I; or C, P, F, H and M as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from F, H, N, I and M; or F, H, N, I and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from F, N, I, M and P; or F, N, I, M and C as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from F, I, M, C and H; F, I, M, C and N as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from F, M, P, C and H; F, M, P, C and N, N, I and M; or F, H, N, I and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from H, N, I M, and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from H, I M, P and F as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from H, M, P, C and F as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from H, P, C, F and I as described by Table 1-14.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, F, H, N, I, and M; or C, F, H, N, I and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from F, H, N, I, M and P as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from H, N, I, M, P and C as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from N, I, M, P, C and F as described by Table 1-14. In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from M, P, C, F, H and N as described by Table 1-14.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, F, H, N, I, and M; C, F, H, N, I and P; C, F, H, N, M and P; C, F, H, I, M and P; C, F, N, I, M and P; C, H, N, I, M and P or F, H, N, I, M and P as described by Table 1-14.


In another embodiment of this aspect, Form C is characterized by a 13C SSNMR spectrum having a group of peaks selected from C, F, H, N, I, M and P as described by Table 1-14.


III.B. Solid Forms of Compound 2
III.B.1. Compound 2 Form A
III.B.1.a. Embodiments of Compound 2 Form A

In one aspect, the invention includes a compositions comprising various solid forms of Compound 2.


In one aspect of the composition, Compound 2 is Compound 2 Form A.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form A is characterized by one or more peaks: from about 7.7 to about 8.1 degrees, for example, about 7.9 degrees; from about 11.7 to about 12.1 degrees, for example, about 11.9 degrees; from about 14.2 to about 14.6 degrees, for example, about 14.4 degrees; and about 15.6 to about 16.0 degrees, for example, about 15.8 degrees; in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form A is characterized by one or more peaks: from about 7.8 to about 8.0 degrees, for example, about 7.9 degrees; from about 11.8 to about 12.0 degrees, for example, about 11.9 degrees; from about 14.3 to about 14.5 degrees, for example, about 14.4 degrees; and about 15.7 to about 15.9 degrees, for example, about 15.8 degrees; in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation.


In other embodiments, Compound 2 Form A is characterized by one or more peaks from about: 7.7 to about 8.1 degrees, for example, about 7.9 degrees; from about 21.6 to about 22.0 degrees, for example, about 21.8 degrees; and about 23.6 to about 24.0 degrees, for example, about 23.8 degrees; in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation.


In still other embodiments, Compound 2 Form A is characterized by one or more peaks from about: 7.8 to about 8.0 degrees, for example, about 7.9 degrees; from about 21.7 to about 21.9 degrees, for example, about 21.8 degrees; and about 23.7 to about 23.9 degrees, for example, about 23.8 degrees; in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form A is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured in degrees in an X-ray powder diffraction pattern: a peak from about 7.7 to about 8.1 degrees (e.g., about 7.9 degrees); a peak from about 9.1 to about 9.5 degrees, (e.g., about 9.3 degrees); a peak from about 11.7 to about 12.1 degrees, (e.g., about 11.9 degrees); a peak from about 14.2 to about 14.6 degrees, (e.g., about 14.4 degrees); a peak from about 14.9 to about 15.3 degrees, (e.g., about 15.1 degrees); a peak from about 15.6 to about 16.0 degrees, (e.g., about 15.8 degrees); a peak from about 16.8 to about 17.2 degrees, (e.g., about 17.0 degrees); a peak from about 17.5 to about 17.9 degrees, (e.g., about 17.7 degrees); a peak from about 19.1 to about 19.5 degrees, (e.g., about 19.3 degrees); a peak from about 19.9 to about 20.3 degrees, (e.g., about 20.1 degrees); a peak from about 21.2 to about 21.6 degrees, (e.g., about 21.4 degrees); a peak from about 21.6 to about 22.0 degrees, (e.g., about 21.8 degrees); a peak from about 23.2 to about 23.6 degrees, (e.g., about 23.4 degrees); a peak from about 23.6 to about 24.0 degrees, (e.g., about 23.8 degrees); a peak from about 25.4 to about 25.8 degrees, (e.g., about 25.6 degrees); a peak from about 26.6 to about 27.0 degrees, (e.g., about 26.8 degrees); a peak from about 29.2 to about 29.6 degrees, (e.g., about 29.4 degrees); a peak from about 29.5 to about 29.9 degrees, (e.g., about 29.7 degrees); a peak from about 29.9 to about 30.3 degrees, (e.g., about 30.1 degrees); and a peak from about 31.0 to about 31.4 degrees, (e.g., about 31.2 degrees).


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form A is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured in degrees in an X-ray powder diffraction pattern: a peak from about 7.8 to about 8.0 degrees (e.g., about 7.9 degrees); a peak from about 9.2 to about 9.4 degrees, (e.g., about 9.3 degrees); a peak from about 11.8 to about 12.0 degrees, (e.g., about 11.9 degrees); a peak from about 14.3 to about 14.5 degrees, (e.g., about 14.4 degrees); a peak from about 15.0 to about 15.2 degrees, (e.g., about 15.1 degrees); a peak from about 15.7 to about 15.9 degrees, (e.g., about 15.8 degrees); a peak from about 16.9 to about 17.1 degrees, (e.g., about 17.0 degrees); a peak from about 17.6 to about 17.8 degrees, (e.g., about 17.7 degrees); a peak from about 19.2 to about 19.4 degrees, (e.g., about 19.3 degrees); a peak from about 20.0 to about 20.2 degrees, (e.g., about 20.1 degrees); a peak from about 21.3 to about 21.5 degrees, (e.g., about 21.4 degrees); a peak from about 21.7 to about 21.9 degrees, (e.g., about 21.8 degrees); a peak from about 23.3 to about 23.5 degrees, (e.g., about 23.4 degrees); a peak from about 23.7 to about 23.9 degrees, (e.g., about 23.8 degrees); a peak from about 25.5 to about 25.7 degrees, (e.g., about 25.6 degrees); a peak from about 26.7 to about 26.9 degrees, (e.g., about 26.8 degrees); a peak from about 29.3 to about 29.5 degrees, (e.g., about 29.4 degrees); a peak from about 29.6 to about 29.8 degrees, (e.g., about 29.7 degrees); a peak from about 30.0 to about 30.2 degrees, (e.g., about 30.1 degrees); and a peak from about 31.1 to about 31.3 degrees, (e.g., about 31.2 degrees).


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form A is characterized by a diffraction pattern as provided in FIG. 2-1.


III.B.1.b. Synthesis of Compound 2 Form A
Preparation of Compound 2 as Form A.



embedded image


To a solution of 4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1H-quinoline-3-carboxylic acid 17 (9.1 g, 35.39 mmol) and 4-(7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-7-yl)-2-(trifluoromethyl)aniline 20 (9.2 g, 35.74 mmol) in 2-methyltetrahydrofuran (91.00 mL) was added propyl phosphonic acid cyclic anhydride (T3P, 50% solution in ethyl acetate, 52.68 mL, 88.48 mmol) and pyridine (5.6 g, 5.73 mL, 70.78 mmol) at room temperature. The reaction flask heated at 65° C. for 10 h under a nitrogen atmosphere. After cooling to room temperature, the reaction was then diluted with ethyl acetate and quenched with saturated Na2CO3 solution (50 mL). The layers were separated, and the aqueous layer was extracted twice more with ethyl acetate. The combined organic layers were washed with water, dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated to a tan solid. The crude solid product was slurried in ethyl acetate/diethyl ether (2:1), collected by vacuum filtration, and washed twice more with ethyl acetate/diethyl ether (2:1) to provide the product as a light yellow crystalline powder. The powder was dissolved in warm ethyl acetate and absorbed onto Celite. Purification by silica gel chromatography (0-50% ethyl acetate in dichloromethane) provided Compound 2 as a white crystalline solid (13.5 g, 76% yield). LC/MS m/z 496.0 [M+H]+, retention time 1.48 min (RP-C18, 10-99% CH3CN/0.05% TFA over 3 min)1H NMR (400.0 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 13.08 (s, 1H), 12.16 (s, 1H), 8.88 (s, 1H), 8.04 (dd, J=2.1, 7.4 Hz, 1H), 7.95-7.88 (m, 3H), 7.22 (dd, 2.5, 8.9 Hz, 1H), 7.16 (d, J=2.5 Hz, 1H), 4.33 (s, 2H), 1.67 (d, J=6.9 Hz, 4H), 1.44 (d, J=6.9 Hz, 4H).


III.B.1.c. Characterization of Compound 2 Form A
Methods & Materials
XRPD (X-Ray Powder Diffraction)

The X-ray powder diffraction (XRPD) data were recorded at room temperature using a Rigaku/MSC MiniFlex Desktop Powder X-ray Diffractometer (Rigaku, The Woodlands, Tex.). The X-Ray was generated using Cu tube operated at 30 kV and 15 mA with KB suppression filter. The divergence slit was variable with the scattering and receiving slits set at 4.2 degree and slit 0.3 mm, respectively. The scan mode was fixed time (FT) with 0.02 degree step width and count time of 2.0 seconds. The Powder X-ray Diffractometer was calibrated using reference standard: 75% Sodalite (Na3Al4Si4O12Cl) and 25% Silicon (Rigaku, Cat#2100/ALS). The six samples stage was used with zero background sample holders (SH-LBSI511-RNDB). The powder sample was placed on the indented area and flattened with glass slide.


FTIR (Fourier Transform Infrared) Spectroscopy

FTIR spectra were collected from a Thermo Scientific, Nicolet 6700 FT-IR spectrometer, with smart orbit sampling compartment, diamond window, using Software: Omnic, 7.4. The powder sample was placed directly on the diamond crystal and pressure was added to conform the surface of the sample to the surface of the diamond crystal. The background spectrum was collected and then the sample spectrum was collected. The collection settings were as follows:


Detector: DTGS KBr


Beamsplitter: KBr


Source: IR


Scan range: 4000-400 cm−1


Gain: 8.0


Optical velocity: 0.6329 cm/s


Aperture: 100


No. of scans: 32


Resolution: 4 cm−1


The powder diffractogram of Compound 2 Form A is shown in FIG. 2-1.


Table 2-2 provides representative XRPD peaks of Compound 2 Form A.









TABLE 2-2







Compound 2 Form A XRPD Peaks










2 Theta (degrees)
Intensity (%)














7.90
100.0



9.28
10.8



11.90
12.8



14.38
35.2



15.08
12.6



15.80
34.1



16.96
25.2



17.66
13.8



19.28
39.4



20.06
20.2



21.36
14.5



21.80
94.2



23.40
30.0



23.80
92.0



25.64
8.9



26.82
6.4



29.36
8.1



29.72
18.1



30.14
14.2



31.20
9.9










Conformational pictures of Compound 2 Form A based on single crystal X-ray analysis are shown in FIG. 2-2. Diffraction data were acquired on a Bruker Apex II Diffractometer equipped with sealed tube CuK-alpha source and an Apex II CCD detector. The structure was solved and refined using SHELX program (Sheldrick, G. M., Acta Cryst. A64, pp. 112-122 (2008)). Based on intensities, statistics and symmetry, the structure was solved and refined in a trigonal crystal system and an R-3 space group. Compound 2 Form A has the following unit cell dimensions: a=19.1670(4) Λ, b=19.1670(4) Å, c=33.6572(12) Å, α=90°, β=90°, and γ=120°.


An FTIR spectra of Compound 2 Form A is provided in FIG. 2-3.


Table 2-3, below provides representative FTIR peaks of Compound 2 Form A.









TABLE 2-3







FTIR Peaks for Compound 2 Form A










Position (cm−1)
Intensity














407.4
46.07



436.7
72.55



471.5
61.17



497.8
63.61



505.7
60.34



532.9
61.14



567.8
54.31



590.7
55.23



614.4
64.01



649.7
50.74



661.0
49.82



686.8
51.43



726.1
53.80



751.4
35.60



798.1
48.21



808.8
48.47



824.8
42.25



875.5
52.89



898.6
71.77



918.7
68.93



977.7
42.31



1008.1
64.09



1047.3
35.70



1072.5
53.76



1091.2
43.79



1113.4
28.46



1131.4
30.00



1153.0
34.61



1168.3
40.13



1199.3
74.26



1221.8
48.07



1253.1
47.84



1277.6
36.67



1291.7
48.07



1310.8
55.99



1329.1
63.21



1352.8
42.30



1433.2
42.45



1463.0
63.68



1526.0
35.86



1574.0
60.60



1607.5
60.30



1662.6
55.12



1740.9
86.74



2870.0
81.63



2947.7
75.12



2963.8
75.30



3092.7
84.58










Melting Point:

The melting point of Compound 2 Form A was determined by DSC to be 300-303° C. As shown in FIG. 2-20, Compound 2 Form B can undergo a solid transition from Form B to Form A at about 256° C. or 265° C., which then melts at 300-303° C. (melting point of Compound 2 Form A).


III.B.2. Compound 2 Form A-HCl
III.B.2.a. Embodiments of Compound 2 Form A-HCl

In one aspect, the invention features a form of Compound 2 characterized as Form A-HCl.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form A-HCl is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured in degrees in an X-ray powder diffraction pattern: a peak from about 6.9 to about 7.3 degrees (e.g., about 7.1 degrees); a peak from about 8.0 to about 8.4 degrees, (e.g., about 8.2 degrees); a peak from about 13.9 to about 14.2 degrees, (e.g., about 14.1 degrees); and a peak from about 21.0 to about 21.4 degrees, (e.g., about 21.2 degrees); in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form A-HCl is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured in degrees in an X-ray powder diffraction pattern: a peak from about 6.9 to about 7.3 degrees (e.g., about 7.1 degrees); a peak from about 8.0 to about 8.4 degrees, (e.g., about 8.2 degrees); a peak from about 11.9 to about 12.3 degrees, (e.g., about 12.1 degrees); a peak from about 13.5 to about 13.9 degrees, (e.g., about 13.7 degrees); a peak from about 16.2 to about 16.6 degrees, (e.g., about 16.4 degrees); a peak from about 18.5 to about 18.9 degrees, (e.g., about 18.7 degrees); and a peak from about 21.0 to about 21.4 degrees, (e.g., about 21.2 degrees) in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form A-HCl is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured in degrees in an X-ray powder diffraction pattern: a peak from about 6.9 to about 7.2 degrees (e.g., about 7.1 degrees); a peak from about 8.0 to about 8.4 degrees, (e.g., about 8.2 degrees); a peak from about 13.9 to about 14.3 degrees, (e.g., about 14.1 degrees); a peak from about 14.5 to about 14.9 degrees, (e.g., about 14.7 degrees); a peak from about 16.2 to about 16.6 degrees, (e.g., about 16.4 degrees); a peak from about 18.5 to about 18.9 degrees, (e.g., about 18.7 degrees); three peaks from about 21.0 to about 22.2 degrees, (e.g., peaks about 21.2 degrees, about 21.7, and about 21.9); a peak from about 22.6 to about 23.0 degrees, (e.g., about 22.8 degrees); 2 peaks from about 24 to about 25 degrees, (e.g., about 24.6 degrees and about 25.0 degrees); and 2 peaks from about 35.3 to about 36.0 degrees, (e.g., about 35.6 degrees); in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form A-HCl is characterized by the X-ray powder diffraction pattern provided in FIG. 2-4.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form A-HCl is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured in parts-per-million (ppm) in a solid state 13C NMR spectrum: a peak from about 163.5 to about 163.9 ppm (e.g., about 163.7 ppm), a peak from about 137.0 to about 137.4 ppm (e.g., about 137.2 ppm), and a peak from about 121.3 to about 121.7 ppm (e.g., about 121.5 ppm).


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form A-HCl is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured in parts-per-million (ppm) in a solid state 13C NMR spectrum: a peak from about 175.5 to about 175.9 ppm (e.g., about 175.7 ppm), a peak from about 163.5 to about 163.9 ppm (e.g., about 163.7 ppm), a peak from about 142.4 to about 142.8 ppm (e.g., about 142.6 ppm), a peak from about 140.6 to about 141.0 ppm (e.g., about 140.8 ppm), a peak from about 137.0 to about 137.4 ppm (e.g., 137.2 ppm), a peak from about 131.3 to about 131.7 ppm (e.g., about 131.5 ppm), and a peak from about 121.3 to about 121.7 ppm (e.g., about 121.5 ppm). In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form A-HCl is characterized by a solid state 13C NMR spectrum shown in FIG. 2-5.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form A-HCl is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured in parts-per-million (ppm) in a solid state 19F NMR spectrum: a peak from about −56.8 to about −57.2 ppm (e.g., about −57.0 ppm), and a peak from about −60.3 to about −60.7 ppm (e.g., about −60.5 ppm).


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form A-HCl is characterized by a solid state 19F NMR spectrum shown in FIG. 2-6.


In still other embodiments, Compound 2 Form A-HCl is characterized by the FTIR spectrum provided in FIG. 2-7.


III.B.2.b. Synthesis of Compound 2 Form A-HCl

Preparation of Compound 2 Form A-HCl




embedded image


2-Methyltetrahydrofuran (0.57 L, 1.0 vol) was charged into a 30 L jacketed reactor vessel, followed by the addition of the hydrochloride salt of 4-(7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-7-yl)-2-(trifluoromethyl)aniline (20) (791 g, 2.67 mol) and 4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid (17) (573 g, 2.23 mol) and an additional 5.2 L (9.0 vol) of 2-methyltetrahydrofuran. Stirring commenced, and T3P in 2-methyltetrahydrofuran (2.84 kg, 4.46 mol) was added to the reaction mixture over 15 min. Pyridine (534.0 g, 546.0 mL, 6.68 mol) was then added via an addition funnel dropwise over 30 min. The mixture was warmed to 45° C. over about 30 min and stirred for 12-15 h. The mixture was then cooled to room temperature and 2-methyltetrahydrofuran (4 vol, 2.29 L) was added followed by water (6.9 vol, 4 L), while the temperature was maintained below 30° C. The water layer was removed and the organic layer was carefully washed twice with NaHCO3 saturated aqueous solution. The organic layer was then washed with 10% w/w citric acid (5 vol) and finally with water (7 vol). The mixture was polished filtered and transferred into another dry vessel. Seed crystals of N-(4-(7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-7-yl)-2-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl)-4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxamide hydrochloride (Compound 2 Form A-HCl) (3.281 g, 5.570 mmol) were added. HCl (g) (10 eq) was bubbled over 2 h and the mixture was stirred overnight. The resulting suspension was filtered, washed with 2-methyltetrahydrofuran (4 vol), suction dried and oven dried at 60° C. provide Compound 2 Form A-HCl.


III.B.2.c. Characterization of Compound 2 Form A-HCl
Methods & Materials
XRPD (X-Ray Powder Diffraction)

Instrument 1


X-ray powder diffraction (XRPD) data are recorded at room temperature using a Rigaku/MSC MiniFlex Desktop Powder X-ray Diffractometer (Rigaku, The Woodlands, Tex.). The X-Ray is generated using Cu tube operated at 30 kV and 15 mA with KB suppression filter. The divergence slit is variable with the scattering and receiving slits set at 4.2 degree and slit 0.3 mm, respectively. The scan mode is fixed time (FT) with 0.02 degree step width and count time of 2.0 seconds. The Powder X-ray Diffractometer is calibrated using reference standard: 75% Sodalite (Na3Al4Si4O12Cl) and 25% Silicon (Rigaku, Cat#2100/ALS). The six samples stage is used with zero background sample holders (SH-LBSI511-RNDB). The powder sample is placed on the indented area and flattened with glass slide.


Instrument 2


Alternatively, the powder x-ray diffraction measurements were performed using PANalytical's X-pert Pro diffractometer at room temperature with copper radiation (1.54060 A). The incident beam optic was comprised of a variable divergence slit to ensure a constant illuminated length on the sample and on the diffracted beam side. A fast linear solid state detector was used with an active length of 2.12 degrees 2 theta measured in a scanning mode. The powder sample was packed on the indented area of a zero background silicon holder and spinning was performed to achieve better statistics. A symmetrical scan was measured from 4-40 degrees 2 theta with a step size of 0.017 degrees and a scan step time of 15.5 s.


Instrument 3


Alternatively, high resolution data were collected at room temperature at the beamline ID31 (European Synchrotron Radiation Facility in Grenoble, France) The X-rays are produced by three 11-mm-gap ex-vacuum undulatory. The beam is monochromated by a cryogenically cooled double-crystal monochromator (Si(111) crystals). Water-cooled slits define the size of the beam incident on the monochromator, and of the monochromatic beam transmitted to the sample in the range of 0.5 to 2.5 mm (horizontal) by 0.1 to 1.5 mm (vertical). The wavelength used for the experiment was 1.29984 (3) A. The diffractometer consists of a bank of nine detectors which is scanned vertically to measure the diffracted intensity as a function of 20. Each detector is preceded by a Si(111) analyser crystal and the detector channels are approximately 2° apart. This diffractometer is capable of producing very precise high resolution diffraction patterns with peak widths as low as 0.003°, and accuracy of peak positions is in the order of 0.0001°. The powder diffraction data were processed and indexed using Materials Studio (Reflex module). The structure was solved using PowderSolve module of Materials Studio. The resulting solution was assessed for structural viability and subsequently refined using Rietveld refinement procedure.


The XPRD spectra described in the examples for Compound 2 Form B were recorded using Instrument 1 (FIG. 16A) or Instrument 2 (FIG. 16B) with the settings described above. XPRD spectra described in the examples for Form B-HCl, and Form A-HCl were recorded using Instrument 2 with the settings described above. The crystal system, space group and unit cell dimensions for Form A-HCl and Form B-HCl were determined using instrument 3.


Differential Scanning Calorimetry (DSC)

Differential Scanning calorimetry (DSC) was performed using TA DSC Q2000 differential scanning calorimeter (TA Instruments, New Castle, Del.). The instrument was calibrated with indium. Samples of approximately 2-3 mg were weighed into hermetic pans that were crimped using lids with one hole. The DSC samples were scanned from 25° C. to 315° C. at a heating rate of 10° C./min. Data was collected by Thermal Advantage Q Series™ software and analyzed by Universal Analysis software (TA Instruments, New Castle, Del.).


Thermogravimetric Analysis (TGA)

Thermogravimetric Analysis (TGA) data were collected on a TA Q500 Thermogravimetric Analyzer (TA Instruments, New Castle, Del.). A sample with weight of approximately 3-5 mg was scanned from 25° C. to 350° C. at a heating rate of 10° C./min. Data were collected by Thermal Advantage Q Series™ software and analyzed by Universal Analysis software (TA Instruments, New Castle, Del.).


FTIR Spectroscopy

FTIR spectra were collected from a Thermo Scientific, Nicolet 6700 FT-IR spectrometer, with smart orbit sampling compartment (multi-bounce Attenuated Total Reflection accessory), diamond window at 45 degrees. The Software used for data collection and analysis is: Omnic, 7.4. The collection settings were as follows:


Detector: DTGS KBr


Beamsplitter: Ge on KBr


Source: EverGlo IR


Scan range: 4000-400 cm−1


Gain: 8.0


Optical velocity: 0.6329 cm/s


Aperture: 100


No. of scans: 32


Resolution: 4 cm−1


The powder sample was placed directly on the diamond crystal and pressure was added to conform the surface of the sample to the surface of the diamond crystal. The background spectrum was collected and then the sample spectrum was collected.


Solid State Nuclear Magnetic Spectroscopy

Solid state nuclear magnetic spectroscopy (SSNMR) spectra were acquired on Bruker 400 MHz proton frequency wide bore spectrometer. Proton relaxation longitudinal relaxation times (1H T1) were obtained by fitting proton detected proton saturation recovery data to an exponential function. These values were used to set an optimal recycle delay of carbon cross-polarization magic angle spinning experiment (13C CPMAS), which, typically, was set between 1.2×1H T1 and 1.5×1H T1. The carbon spectra were acquired with 2 ms contact time using linear amplitude ramp on proton channel (from 50% to 100%) and 100 kHz TPPM decoupling. The typical magic angle spinning (MAS) speed was 15.0 kHz. Fluorine spectra were obtained using proton decoupled, direct polarization MAS experiment. 100 kHz TPPM decoupling was used. The recycle delay was set to ≧5×19F T1. The fluorine longitudinal relaxation time (19F T1) was obtained by fitting fluorine detected, proton decoupled saturation recovery data to an exponential function. Carbon as well as fluorine spectra were externally referenced using the upfield resonance of solid phase adamantane which was set to 29.5 ppm. Using this procedure, carbon spectra were indirectly referenced to tetramethylsilane at 0 ppm and fluorine spectra were indirectly referenced to nitromethane at 0 ppm.


The powder diffractogram of Compound 2 Form A-HCl is shown in FIG. 2-4.


Table 2-4 provides the representative XRPD peaks of Form A-HCl.









TABLE 2-4







Compound 2 Form A-HCl XPRD Peaks.










2-Theta (degrees)
Relative Intensity (%)














7.1
44.3



8.2
33.3



10.8
1.5



11.7
1.5



12.1
5.8



13.7
3.3



14.1
32.1



14.7
16.9



15.0
5.7



16.1
3.0



16.4
16.9



16.6
3.7



16.8
1.9



17.6
0.6



18.7
12.4



18.9
1.9



19.7
5.4



19.8
6.9



20.3
1.5



21.2
100.0



21.7
10.6



21.9
12.3



22.2
4.0



22.8
21.9



23.4
9.8



24.6
34.3



25.0
17.9



25.2
8.6



25.9
3.6



26.5
1.5



26.9
7.0



27.5
8.3



28.0
5.3



28.3
1.6



28.7
3.5



29.0
4.8



29.2
7.5



29.8
1.40



30.1
1.8



31.0
5.4



31.3
2.6



31.9
1.7



32.3
4.6



32.4
3.7



32.8
2.3



33.3
3.9



34.3
1.8



34.5
3.6



34.7
8.7



35.3
3.0



35.6
12.7



35.6
18.9



36.1
3.2



36.8
3.3



37.2
1.7



37.8
3.1



38.5
2.8



39.1
3.1



39.7
2.3










A crystal structure of Compound 2 Form A-HCl was determined to possess a monoclinic crystal system, a P21/c space group, and the following unit cell dimensions: a=13.6175(4) Å, b=21.614(3) Å, c=8.3941(4) Å, α=90°, β=112.303°, and γ=90°. FIG. 2-23 illustrates the conformational structure of Compound 2 Form A-HCl based on X-ray analysis. FIG. 2-24 shows the molecular packing of Compound 2 Form A-HCl based on X-ray analysis.


A representative sample of Compound 2 Form A-HCl was also evaluated using microscopy.


A representative sample of Compound 2 Form A-HCl gave the FTIR spectrum provided in FIG. 2-7.


A DSC curve for a representative sample of Compound 2 Form A-HCl is provided at FIG. 2-8.


A TGA curve for a representative sample of Compound 2 Form A-HCl is provided in FIG. 2-9.


Table 2-5 provides the characteristic FTIR absorptions of Compound 2 Form A-HCl.









TABLE 2-5







Compound 2 Form A-HCl FTIR Absorptions.










Position (cm−1)
Intensity (% Reflectance)














407.6
51.1



422.7
69.7



445.7
62.6



479.1
51.8



508.4
55.7



538.1
58.6



568.4
56.7



586.3
65.7



614.9
66.8



640.5
55.8



663.2
44.2



669.3
53.2



687.2
58.2



752.1
34.4



796.2
32.5



821.7
40.0



836.8
62.0



868.2
60.8



884.7
60.5



900.2
56.1



940.0
59.0



965.4
56.3



1052.4
35.1



1065.7
40.0



1109.5
23.9



1122.8
27.3



1147.7
38.8



1159.3
42.1



1212.8
37.9



1237.0
65.1



1255.3
51.4



1270.6
46.6



1300.8
47.0



1328.6
45.1



1434.1
41.6



1452.0
61.6



1521.8
40.2



1568.2
64.0



1608.8
55.2



1688.5
54.5



2256.5
68.0



2880.9
73.2



3676.3
90.5










A representative sample of Compound 2 Form A-HCl was also analyzed using solid state (SS)13C and 19F NMR. The respective NMR spectra are provided in FIGS. 2-5 and 2-6. Several peaks found in the 13C SSNMR and 19F SSNMR spectra are described in Tables 2-6 and 2-7.









TABLE 2-6







Compound 2 Form A-HCl 13C SSNMR Peaks.










Peak No.
Chemical Shift (ppm)














1
175.7



2
163.7



3
142.6



4
140.8



5
137.2



6
131.5



7
129.0



8
126.0



9
124.8



10
123.8



11
121.5



12
117.8



13
112.4



14
65.7



15
29.2



16
28.3



17
26.1

















TABLE 2-7







Compound 2 Form A-HCl 19F SSNMR Peaks.










Peak No.
Chemical Shift (ppm)







1
−57.0



2
−60.5










III.B.3. Compound 2 Form B-HCl
III.B.3.a. Embodiments of Compound 2 Form B-HCl

In one aspect, the invention features a form of Compound 2 characterized as Form B-HCl.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form B-HCl is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured in degrees in an X-ray powder diffraction pattern: a peak from about 8.1 to about 8.5 degrees (e.g., about 8.3 degrees); a peak from about 8.8 to about 9.2 degrees, (e.g., about 9.0 degrees); a peak from about 12.8 to about 13.2 degrees, (e.g., about 13.0 degrees); a peak from about 17.8 to about 18.2 degrees, (e.g., about 18.0 degrees); and a peak from about 22.8 to about 23.2 degrees, (e.g., about 23.0 degrees); in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form B-HCl is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured in degrees in an X-ray powder diffraction pattern: a peak from about 8.1 to about 8.5 degrees (e.g., about 8.3 degrees); a peak from about 14.6 to about 15.1 degrees, (e.g., about 14.8 degrees); a peak from about 16.5 to about 16.9 degrees, (e.g., about 16.7 degrees); 3 peaks from about 17.6 to about 18.4 degrees, (e.g., about 17.8 degrees, about 18.0 degrees, and about 18.2 degrees); 2 peaks from about 21.4 to about 22.1 degrees, (e.g., about 21.7 degrees and about 22.0 degrees); 2 peaks from about 22.8 to about 23.8 degrees, (e.g., peaks about 23.0 degrees and about 23.6); 2 peaks from about 24.7 to about 25.4 degrees, (e.g., about 24.9 degrees and about 25.2 degrees); a peak from about 26.9 to about 27.3 degrees, (e.g., about 27.1 degrees); a peak from about 30.9 to about 31.3 degrees, (e.g., about 31.1 degrees); and a peak from about 38.2 to about 38.7 degrees, (e.g., about 38.5 degrees); in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form B-HCl is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured in degrees in an X-ray powder diffraction pattern: a peak from about 8.1 to about 8.5 degrees (e.g., about 8.3 degrees); a peak from about 13.8 to about 14.3 degrees, (e.g., about 14.1 degrees); 2 peaks from about 14.6 to about 15.5 degrees, (e.g., about 14.8 degrees and about 15.2 degrees); a peak from about 16.5 to about 16.9 degrees, (e.g., about 16.7 degrees); 3 peaks from about 17.6 to about 18.4 degrees, (e.g., about 17.8 degrees, about 18.0 degrees, and about 18.2 degrees); 2 peaks from about 19.1 to about 19.7 degrees, (e.g., about 19.3 degrees and about 19.5 degrees); 2 peaks from about 21.4 to about 22.1 degrees, (e.g., about 21.7 degrees and about 22.0 degrees); 2 peaks from about 22.8 to about 23.8 degrees, (e.g., peaks about 23.0 degrees and about 23.6 degrees); 4 peaks from about 24.5 to about 25.9 degrees, (e.g., about 24.7 degrees, about 24.9 degrees, about 25.2 degrees, and about 25.7 degrees); a peak from about 26.9 to about 27.3 degrees, (e.g., about 27.1 degrees); 2 peaks from about 27.7 to about 28.3 degrees, (e.g., about 27.9 degrees and about 28.1 degrees); 2 peaks from about 29.5 to about 30.0 degrees, (e.g., about 29.7 degrees and about 29.8 degrees); 2 peaks from about 29.5 to about 30.0 degrees, (e.g., about 29.7 degrees and about 29.8 degrees); a peak from about 30.9 to about 31.3 degrees, (e.g., about 31.1 degrees); a peak from about 32.1 to about 32.5 degrees, (e.g., about 32.3 degrees); 3 peaks from about 33.2 to about 34.1 degrees, (e.g., about 33.4 degrees, about 33.8 degrees, and about 33.9 degrees); a peak from about 35.0 to about 35.4 degrees, (e.g., about 35.2 degrees); a peak from about 36.0 to about 36.4 degrees, (e.g., about 36.2 degrees); and 3 peaks from about 38.3 to about 40.1 degrees, (e.g., about 38.5 degrees, about 38.6 degrees, and about 39.9 degrees); in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form B-HCl is characterized by the X-ray powder diffraction pattern provided in FIG. 2-10.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form B-HCl is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured in parts-per-million (ppm) in a solid state 13C NMR spectrum: a peak from about 168.0 to about 168.4 ppm (e.g., about 168.2 ppm), a peak from about 148.5 to about 148.9 ppm (e.g., about 148.7 ppm), a peak from about 138.6 to about 139.0 ppm (e.g., about 138.8 ppm), a peak from about 119.6 to about 120.0 ppm (e.g., about 119.8 ppm), and a peak from about 23.7 to about 24.1 ppm (e.g., about 23.9 ppm).


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form B-HCl is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured in parts-per-million (ppm) in a solid state 13C NMR spectrum: a peak from about 176.1 to about 176.5 ppm (e.g., about 176.3 ppm), a peak from about 168.0 to about 168.4 ppm (e.g., about 168.2 ppm), a peak from about 148.5 to about 148.9 ppm (e.g., about 148.7 ppm), a peak from about 143.0 to about 143.4 ppm (e.g., about 143.2 ppm), a peak from about 138.6 to about 139.0 ppm (e.g., about 138.8 ppm), 7 peaks from about 119 to about 134 ppm (e.g., about 131.6 ppm, about 129.6 ppm, about 129.1 ppm, about 126.7 ppm, about 125.8 ppm, about 122.7 ppm, and about 119.8 ppm), a peak from about 112.1 to about 112.5 ppm (e.g., about 112.3 ppm), a peak from about 68.8 to about 69.2 ppm (e.g., about 69.0 ppm), a peak from about 66.7 to about 67.1 ppm (e.g., about 66.9 ppm), a peak from about 28.1 to about 28.5 ppm (e.g., about 28.3 ppm) and a peak from about 23.7 to about 24.1 ppm (e.g., about 23.9 ppm).


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form B-HCl is characterized by a solid state 13C NMR spectrum shown in FIG. 2-14.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form B-HCl is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured in parts-per-million (ppm) in a solid state 19F NMR spectrum: a peak from about −55.4 to about −55.8 ppm (e.g., about −55.6 ppm), and a peak from about −61.8 to about −62.2 ppm (e.g., about −62.0 ppm).


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form B-HCl is characterized by a solid state 19F NMR spectrum shown in FIG. 2-15.


In still other embodiments, Compound 2 Form B-HCl is characterized by the FTIR spectrum provided in FIG. 2-11.


III.B.3.b. Synthesis of Compound 2 Form B-HCl
Preparation of Compound 2 Form B-HCl



embedded image


100 mL of 2-methyltetrahydrofuran was charged into a 3-necked flask having a nitrogen atmosphere equipped with a stirrer. Compound 2 Form A-HCl (55 g, 0.103 mol) was added to the flask, followed by 349 mL of 2-methyltetrahydrofuran, and stirring commenced. 28 mL of water was added into the flask and the flask was warmed to an internal temperature of 60° C. and stirred for 48 h. The flask was cooled to room temperature and stirred for 1 h. The reaction mixture was vacuum filtered until the filter cake was dry. The solid filter cake was washed with 2-methyltetrahydrofuran (4 vol) twice. The solid filter cake remained under vacuum suction for a period of about 30 minutes and was transferred to a drying tray. The filter cake was dried under vacuum at 60° C., to give Compound 2 Form B-HCl as a white crystalline solid.


Alternative Preparation of Compound 2 Form B-HCl.

Compound 2 Form A-HCl (14.638 g, 27.52 mmol) was charged to a 100 mL round bottom flask. EtOH (248.9 mL) and water (27.82 mL) were added. The white slurry was heated to reflux. A clear solution was obtained at 77° C. The reaction was cooled to 45° C., and was allowed to stir for 30 min, and then was cooled to 20° C. The mixture was allowed to stir for an additional 3 h at 20° C. The product was filtered and the cake washed with EtOH. The solid was dried in a vacuum oven at 45° C. with a nitrogen bleed. A white solid was isolated in 72.9% yield. XRPD analysis confirmed the identity of the solid as Compound 2 Form B-HCl.


As a note, other solvent combination such as MeOH/H2O and IPA/H2O or the like can be used instead of EtOH/H2O as described in this example. Examples of alternative solvent combinations are provided in Table 2-8.









TABLE 2-8







Other Solvents that Can Be Used to Make


Compound 2 Form B-HCl.











Solvent
Solvent Volume
T [° C.]







MeOH
10
60



MeOH:H2O
10:0.2
60



MeOH:H2O
10:0.5
60



MeOH:H2O
10:1  
60



MeOH:H2O
10:1.5
60



IPA:H2O
10:1  
75



IPA:H2O
10:1.5
75



MeOH:H2O
10:1  
65



EtOH
10
70



EtOH:H2O
10:0.2
70



EtOH:H2O
10:0.5
70



EtOH:H2O
10:1  
70



EtOH:H2O
10:1.5
70










III.B.3.c. Characterization of Compound 2 Form B-HCl
Methods and Materials: See Compound 2 Form A-HCl

The powder diffractogram of Compound 2 Form B-HCl is shown in FIG. 2-10.


Table 2-9, below provides the representative XRPD peaks of Form B-HCl.









TABLE 2-9







Compound 2 Form B-HCl XRPD peaks.










2-Theta (degrees)
Relative Intensity (%)














8.3
93.7



9.0
8.4



10.9
0.8



11.4
1.4



13.0
4.9



14.1
19.8



14.8
32.7



15.2
12.6



16.7
23.8



17.8
37.8



18.0
90.0



18.2
28.6



19.3
19.0



19.5
17.5



19.9
2.7



20.4
9.4



20.6
6.2



21.7
41.2



22.0
22.2



23.0
100.0



23.6
20.5



23.9
4.0



24.1
3.9



24.5
9.2



24.7
13.0



24.9
31.9



25.2
22.6



25.7
12.6



26.1
3.3



26.7
4.5



27.1
21.3



27.9
10.6



28.1
18.7



28.5
4.3



28.7
5.8



29.7
11.1



29.8
14.2



30.1
4.0



30.5
8.2



31.1
30.2



31.5
9.1



32.3
11.4



32.8
3.8



33.1
9.2



33.4
11.3



33.8
11.1



33.9
10.1



34.1
5.6



34.6
8.5



34.9
6.4



35.2
10.8



36.0
4.1



36.2
13.2



36.4
4.7



37.2
5.9



37.6
3.7



37.9
2.2



38.2
7.5



38.5
22.3



38.6
13.8



39.9
10.7










A crystal structure of Compound 2 Form B-HCl was determined to possess a monoclinic crystal system, a P21/a space group, and the following unit cell dimensions: a=12.57334(5) Å, b=19.68634(5) Å, c=8.39399(5) Å, α=90°, β=90.0554°, and γ=90°. FIG. 2-25 illustrates the conformational structure of Compound 2 Form A-HCl based on X-ray analysis. FIG. 2-26 shows the molecular packing of Compound 2 Form A-HCl based on X-ray analysis.


A representative sample of Compound 2 Form B-HCl was also evaluated using microscopy.


A representative sample of Compound 2 Form B-HCl gave the FTIR spectrum provided in FIG. 2-11.


A DSC curve for a representative sample of Compound 2 Form B-HCl is provided in FIG. 2-12.


A TGA curve for a representative sample of Compound 2 Form B-HCl is provided in FIG. 2-13.


Table 2-10 provides the characteristic FTIR absorptions of Compound 2 Form B-HCl.









TABLE 2-10







Compound 2 Form B-HCl FTIR Absorptions.










Position (cm−1)
Intensity (% Reflectance)














406.3
48.8



428.2
70.9



453.1
66.8



478.2
52.3



507.5
59.5



537.8
58.9



563.8
51.8



585.3
63.9



610.1
56.4



641.1
50.5



664.7
44.8



694.5
60.2



740.0
52.2



763.5
40.3



797.8
49.9



809.9
47.5



833.6
34.0



874.2
48.7



888.5
47.7



907.6
56.1



936.0
62.1



969.6
57.1



1051.0
39.2



1070.2
44.3



1113.2
30.4



1126.7
26.9



1142.4
39.3



1166.0
53.4



1208.0
56.3



1233.6
49.7



1254.4
50.8



1270.7
47.3



1291.5
47.6



1328.3
50.5



1355.8
58.6



1372.4
67.3



1434.1
43.3



1463.9
48.0



1520.9
33.0



1574.4
56.8



1612.6
60.1



1653.8
61.0



2709.5
63.0



2994.4
68.3










Compound 2 Form B-HCl was also analyzed using solid state 13C and 19F NMR. The respective NMR spectra are provided in FIGS. 2-14 and 2-15. Several peaks found in the 13C SSNMR and 19F SSNMR spectra are listed in Tables 2-11 and 2-12.









TABLE 2-11







Compound 2 Form B-HCl 13C SSNMR Peaks.










Peak No.
Chemical Shift (ppm)














1
176.3



2
168.2



3
148.7



4
143.2



5
138.8



6
131.6



7
129.6



8
129.1



9
126.7



10
125.8



11
122.7



12
119.8



13
112.3



14
69.0



15
66.9



16
28.3



17
23.9

















TABLE 2-12







Compound 2 Form B-HCl 19F SSNMR Peaks.










Peak No.
F1 (ppm)







1
−55.6



2
−62.1










III.B.4. Compound 2 Form B
III.B.4.a. Embodiments of Compound 2 Form B

In one aspect, the invention features a form of Compound 2 characterized as Form B.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form B is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured in degrees in an X-ray powder diffraction pattern: a peak from about 6.5 to about 6.9 degrees (e.g., about 6.7 degrees); a peak from about 9.8 to about 10.2 degrees, (e.g., about 10.0 degrees); a peak from about 11.0 to about 11.4 degrees, (e.g., about 11.2 degrees); a peak from about 13.2 to about 13.6 degrees, (e.g., about 13.4 degrees); and a peak from about 23.8 to about 24.2 degrees, (e.g., about 24.2 degrees) in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form B is characterized by one or more peaks: a peak from about 6.5 to about 6.9 degrees (e.g., about 6.7 degrees), a peak from about 9.2 to about 9.6 degrees (e.g., about 9.4), a peak from about 11.0 to about 11.4 degrees (e.g., about 11.2 degrees), a peak from about 13.2 to about 13.6 degrees (e.g., about 13.4 degrees), a peak from about 15.0 to about 15.4 degrees (e.g., about 15.2 degrees), a peak from about 17.0 to about 17.4 degrees (e.g., about 17.2 degrees), a peak from about 17.6 to about 18.0 degrees (e.g., about 17.8 degrees), a peak from about 17.9 to about 18.3 degrees (e.g., about 18.1 degrees), a peak from about 19.0 to about 19.4 degrees (e.g., about 19.2), a peak from about 19.9 to about 20.3 degrees (e.g., about 20.1 degrees), a peak from about 21.0 to about 21.5 degrees (e.g., about 21.2 degrees), a peak from about 21.8 to 22.2 degrees (e.g., about 22.0 degrees), a peak from about 23.8 to about 24.2 degrees (e.g., about 24.0 degrees), a peak from about 26.0 to about 26.4 degrees (e.g., about 26.2 degrees), a peak from about 27.0 to about 27.4 degrees (e.g., about 27.2), a peak from about 27.5 to about 27.9 degrees (e.g., about 27.7 degrees), and a peak from about 28.7 to about 29.1 degrees (e.g., about 28.9); in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form B is characterized by the X-ray powder diffraction pattern provided in FIGS. 2-16A and 2-16B.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form B is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured in parts-per-million (ppm) in a solid state 13C NMR spectrum: a peak from about 165.1 to about 165.5 ppm (e.g., about 165.3 ppm), a peak from about 145.7 to about 146.1 ppm (about 145.9 ppm), a peak from about 132.7 to about 133.1 ppm (e.g., about 132.9 ppm), and a peak from about 113.2 to about 113.6 ppm (e.g., about 113.4 ppm).


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form B is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured as parts-per-million (ppm) in a solid state 13C NMR spectrum: a peak from about 175.1 to about 175.5 ppm (e.g., about 175.3 ppm), a peak from about 165.1 to about 165.5 ppm (e.g., about 165.3 ppm), a peak from about 141.2 to about 141.6 ppm (e.g., about 141.4 ppm), a peak from about 145.7 to about 146.1 ppm (e.g., about 145.9 ppm), a peak from about 132.7 to about 133.1 ppm (e.g., about 132.9 ppm), a peak from about 123.3 to about 123.7 ppm (e.g., about 123.5 ppm) a peak from about 126.6 to about 127.0 ppm (e.g., about 126.8 ppm), a peak from about 113.2 to about 113.6 ppm (e.g., about 113.4 ppm), a peak from about 117.2 to about 117.6 ppm (e.g., about 117.4 ppm), a peak from about 58.1 to about 58.5 ppm (e.g., about 58.3 ppm), a peak from about 26.7 to about 27.1 ppm (e.g., about 26.9 ppm) and a peak from about 29.00 to about 29.4 ppm (e.g., about 29.2 ppm).


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form B is characterized by a solid state 13C NMR spectrum shown in FIG. 2-18.


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form B is characterized by one or more of the following peaks measured in parts-per-million (ppm) in a solid state 19F NMR spectrum: a peak from about −55.9 to about −56.3 ppm (e.g., about −56.1 ppm), and a peak from about −61.9 to about −62.3 ppm (e.g., about −62.1 ppm).


In some embodiments, Compound 2 Form B is characterized by a solid state 19F NMR spectrum shown in FIG. 2-19.


In another embodiment, the present invention features a crystal of N-(4-(7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-7-yl)-2-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl)-4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxamide in Form B having a monoclinic crystal system, a P21/c space group, and the following unit cell dimensions: a=13.5429(4) Å, b=13.4557(4) Å, c=12.0592(4) Å, α=90°, β=101.193°, and γ=90°.


In one embodiment, the present invention provides a crystal of N-(4-(7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-7-yl)-2-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl)-4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxamide in Form B having a monoclinic crystal system, a P21/c space group, and the following unit cell dimensions: a=13.5429(4) Å, b=13.4557(4) Å, c=12.0592(4) Å.


In still other embodiments, Compound 2 Form B is characterized by the FTIR spectrum provided in FIG. 2-17.


III.B.4.b. Synthesis of Compound 2 Form B

Preparation of Compound 2 Form B




embedded image


2-Methyltetrahydrofuran (1 vol) was charged into a 30 L jacketed reactor vessel followed by the addition of the hydrochloride salt of 4-(7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]heptan-7-yl)-2-(trifluoromethyl)aniline 20 (1.2 eq) and 4-oxo-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1,4-dihydroquinoline-3-carboxylic acid 17 (573 g, 2.228 mol). Additional 2-methyltetrahydrofuran (9 vol) was charged into the vessel and stirring commenced. T3P in 2-methyltetrahydrofuran (2 eq) was added to the reaction mixture over a period of 15 min. Pyridine (3 eq) was added rapidly in a dropwise fashion using an addition funnel. Under stirring, the mixture was then heated to 45° C. over a period of about 30 min and this temperature was maintained for about 5 h. The mixture was cooled to room temperature. 2-Methyltetrahydrofuran (4 vol) was added, followed by the slow addition of water (6.9 vol), and the temperature of the reaction was kept below 30° C. The water layer was removed and the organic layer was washed twice with NaHCO3 saturated aqueous solution. The organic layer was then carefully washed with 10% w/w citric acid (5 vol) and water (7 vol), polished filtered, and then transferred into another dry vessel. 2-Methyltetrahydrofuran (10 vol) was added and stirring commenced. Heptane (10 vol) was rapidly added in a dropwise fashion with stirring. The mixture was stirred for a period of about 12 h, and then was vacuum filtered. The solid filter cake was introduced into another vessel. Water (15 vol) was charged into the vessel and the suspension was stirred vigorously for 48 h, and then filtered. The solid cake was washed with water (5 vol) and dried at 45° C. to constant weight to give Compound 2 Form B (90% recovery).


III.B.4.c. Characterization of Compound 2 Form B
Materials and Methods: See Compound 2 Form A-HCl
X-Ray Crystal Structure Determination

A single crystal of Compound 2 Form B was mounted on a MicroMount loop and centered on a Broker Apex II diffractometer that was equipped with a sealed copper X-ray tube and Apex II CCD detector. Initially, 3 sets of 40 frames were collected to determine a preliminary unit cell. Subsequently a full data set consisting of 15 scans and 6084 frames was acquired. Data collection was performed at room temperature. Data were integrated and scaled using Apex II software from Bruker AXS. Integration and scaling resulted in 6176 reflections, 2250 of which were unique. Structure was solved by direct methods in space group P21/c using SHELXTL software. Refinement was performed with full-matrix least-square method on F2 using SHELXTL software as well. Altogether 392 parameters were used in refinement resulting in reflection to parameter ratio of 5.74. The final refinement index was wR2=0.0962 and R1=0.0682 (wR2=0.0850 and R1=0.0412 for reflections with I>2 sigma(I)).


Data collection: Apex II; cell refinement: Apex II; data reduction: Apex II; program(s) used to solve structure: SHELXS97 (Sheldrick, 1990); program(s) used to refine structure: SHELXL97 (Sheldrick, 1997); molecular graphics: Mercury


Table 2-13: Representative XRPD peaks of Compound 2 Form B









TABLE 2-13







Compound 2 Form B XPRD Peaks










2 Theta (degrees)
Relative Intensity (%)














6.7
36.6



9.4
37.2



10.0
29.5



11.2
35.3



13.4
70.6



14.8
18.1



15.2
88.8



15.4
16.6



17.2
49.5



17.8
48.0



18.1
83.8



18.8
13.6



19.2
47.6



20.1
68.9



21.2
71.8



22.0
42.6



22.6
7.6



23.5
18.1



24.0
100.0



25.0
9.6



25.9
9.7



26.2
44.8



26.9
26.3



27.2
86.7



27.7
37.8



28.2
7.4



28.9
49.0



29.6
21.3



30.3
8.6



30.6
5.5



31.2
19.3



32.3
5.5



33.7
11.4



34.2
8.9



34.7
12.4



35.1
8.0



36.7
6.5



38.1
4.7



39.3
5.3










A representative sample of Compound 2 Form B gave the FTIR spectrum provided in FIG. 2-17.


A DSC curve for a representative sample of Compound 2 Form B is provided in FIG. 2-20.


A TGA curve for a representative sample of Compound 2 Form B is provided in FIG. 2-21.


Table 2-14 provides the characteristic FTIR absorptions of Compound 2 Form B.









TABLE 2-14







FTIR Absorptions of Compound 2 Form B.










Position (cm−1)
Intensity (% Reflectance)














406.1
78.6



435.2
93.3



450.0
91.0



464.3
87.9



473.7
84.0



490.7
81.3



505.1
81.2



531.7
81.5



565.2
79.3



586.1
80.5



603.0
75.9



642.5
77.3



661.9
74.3



682.5
78.0



726.9
80.7



749.6
68.8



766.4
81.9



798.7
81.3



823.2
63.4



842.9
93.6



876.8
83.5



902.3
92.2



919.5
85.7



976.3
72.4



1045.8
71.0



1073.6
76.6



1109.0
65.5



1119.4
65.2



1139.6
58.8



1167.6
71.4



1197.9
92.0



1206.6
90.3



1227.8
81.9



1253.9
79.2



1272.8
77.9



1285.0
78.6



1301.1
74.6



1329.6
83.8



1349.7
76.6



1435.1
75.5



1466.6
78.2



1501.3
75.0



1534.8
68.4



1577.4
82.6



1620.4
83.5



1657.4
79.7



2952.5
92.2



2988.6
92.1










A representative sample of Compound 2 Form B was also analyzed using solid state 13C and 19F NMR. The respective NMR spectra are provided in FIGS. 2-18 and 2-19. Several peaks found in the 13C SSNMR and 19F SSNMR spectra are described in Tables 2-15 and 2-16, below.









TABLE 2-15







Compound 2 Form B 13C SSNMR Peaks.










Peak No.
Chemical Shift (ppm)














1
175.3



2
165.3



3
145.9



4
141.4



5
132.9



6
126.8



7
123.5



8
117.4



9
113.4



10
58.3



11
29.2



12
26.9

















TABLE 2-16







Compound 2 Form B 19F SSNMR Peaks.










Peak No.
Chemical Shift (ppm)







1
−56.1



2
−62.1










A single crystal of Compound 2 Form B was mounted on a MicroMount loop and centered on a Broker Apex II diffractometer that was equipped with a sealed copper X-ray tube and Apex II CCD detector. Initially, 3 sets of 40 frames were collected to determine a preliminary unit cell. Subsequently a full data set consisting of 15 scans and 6084 frames was acquired. Data collection was performed at room temperature. Data were integrated and scaled using Apex II software from Bruker AXS. Integration and scaling resulted in 6176 reflections, 2250 of which were unique. Structure was solved by direct methods in space group P21/c using SHELXTL software. Refinement was performed with full-matrix least-square method on F2 using SHELXTL software as well. Altogether 392 parameters were used in refinement resulting in reflection to parameter ratio of 5.74. The final refinement index was wR2=0.0962 and R1=0.0682 (wR2=0.0850 and R1=0.0412 for reflections with I>2 sigma(I).


A single crystal of Compound 2 Form B was determined to possess a monoclinic crystal system, a P21/c space group, and the following unit cell dimensions: a=13.5429(10) Å, b=13.4557(9) Å, c=12.0592(8) Å, α=90°, β=101.193°, and γ=90°.


















C24H19F6N3O2
Dx = 1.526 Mg m−3



Mr = 495.42
Melting point: 265-267° C.



Monoclinic, P21/c
Cu Kα radiation




λ = 1.54178 Å



Hall symbol: -P 2ybc
Cell parameters from 2250 reflections



a = 13.5429 (10) Å



b = 13.4557 (9) Å
μ = 1.17 mm−1



c = 12.0592 (8) Å
T = 273 (2) K



β = 101.193 (4)°



V = 2155.7 (3) Å3
Needle, colourless



Z = 4
0.80 × 0.08 × 0.04 mm



F000 = 1016
























APEX II
1603 reflections



diffractometer
with I > 2σ(I)









Radiation source: fine-focus
Rint = 0.031



sealed tube




Monochromator: graphite
θmax = 50.7°



T = 273(2) K
θmin = 3.3°



P = 101.3 kPa
h = −11→13



Absorption correction:
k = −8→13



multiscan




6176 measured reflections
l = −12→11



2250 independent reflections























Refinement on F2
Secondary atom site location:



difference Fourier map


Least-squares matrix: full
Hydrogen site location: inferred



from neighboring sites


R[F2 > 2σ(F2)] = 0.041
H atoms treated by a mixture of



independent and constrained



refinement


wR(F2) = 0.096
w = 1/[σ2(F2(Fo2) + (0.0293P)2 +



2.2985P]



where P = (Fo2 + 2Fc2)/3


S = 0.99
(Δ/σ)max < 0.001


2250 reflections
Δρmax = 0.15 e Å-3


392 parameters
Δρmin = −0.16 e Å-3


0 constraints
Extinction correction: none


Primary atom site location:



structure-invariant



direct methods









Refinement of F2 against ALL reflections. The weighted R-factor wR and goodness of fit S are based on F2, conventional R-factors R are based on F, with F set to zero for negative F2. The threshold expression of F2>2sigma(F2) is used only for calculating R-factors(gt) etc. and is not relevant to the choice of reflections for refinement. R-factors based on F2 are statistically about twice as large as those based on F, and R-factors based on ALL data will be even larger. FIG. 2-22 illustrates the conformational structure of Compound 2 Form B based on single crystal X-ray analysis.


Melting Point:

The melting point of Compound 2 Form B was determined by DSC to be 265-267° C. As shown by the DSC trace in FIG. 2-20, Compound 2 Form B can undergo a solid transition from Form B to Form A at about 256° C., and then melt at 300-302° C. (melting point of Compound 2 Form A). Compound 2 Form B can also melt at a temperature range of about 265-267° C., and then recrystallize upon melting as Compound 2 Form A.


III.C. Solid Forms of Compound 3
III.C.1. Compound 3 Form I
III.C.1.a. Embodiments of Compound 3 Form I

In one aspect of the composition, Compound 3 is in solid Form I (Compound 3 Form I).


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Form I is characterized by one or more peaks at 15.2 to 15.6 degrees, 16.1 to 16.5 degrees, and 14.3 to 14.7 degrees in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Form I is characterized by one or more peaks at 15.4, 16.3, and 14.5 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Form I is further characterized by a peak at 14.6 to 15.0 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Form I is further characterized by a peak at 14.8 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Form I is further characterized by a peak at 17.6 to 18.0 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Form I is further characterized by a peak at 17.8 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Form I is further characterized by a peak at 16.4 to 16.8 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Form I is further characterized by a peak at 16.4 to 16.8 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Form I is further characterized by a peak at 16.6 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Form I is further characterized by a peak at 7.6 to 8.0 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Form I is further characterized by a peak at 7.8 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Form I is further characterized by a peak at 25.8 to 26.2 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Form I is further characterized by a peak at 26.0 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Form I is further characterized by a peak at 21.4 to 21.8 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Form I is further characterized by a peak at 21.6 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Form I is further characterized by a peak at 23.1 to 23.5 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Form I is further characterized by a peak at 23.3 degrees.


In some embodiments, Compound 3 Form I is characterized by a diffraction pattern substantially similar to that of FIG. 3-1.


In some embodiments, Compound 3 Form I is characterized by a diffraction pattern substantially similar to that of FIG. 3-2.


In some embodiments, the particle size distribution of D90 is about 82 μm or less for Compound 3 Form I.


In some embodiments, the particle size distribution of D50 is about 30 μm or less for Compound 3 Form I.


In one aspect, the invention features a crystal form of Compound 3 Form I having a monoclinic crystal system, a P21/n space group, and the following unit cell dimensions: a=4.9626 (7) Å, b=12.2994 (18) Å, c=33.075 (4) Å, α=90°, β=93.938 (9)°, and γ=90°.


III.C.1.b. Synthesis of Compound 3 Form I
Preparation of Compound 3 Form I
Method A.



embedded image


A slurry of 3-(6-(1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamido)-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoic acid.HCl (1 eq) in water (10 vol) was stirred at ambient temperature. A sample was taken after stirring for 24 h. The sample was filtered and the solid was washed with water (2 times). The solid sample was submitted for DSC analysis. When DSC analysis indicated complete conversion to Form I, the solid was collected by filtration, washed with water (2×1.0 vol), and partially dried on a filter under vacuum. The solid was then dried to a constant weight (<1% difference) in a vacuum oven at 60° C. with a slight N2 bleed to afford Compound 3 Form I as an off-white solid (98% yield).


Method B:



embedded image


A solution of 3-(6-(1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamido)-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)-t-butylbenzoate (1.0 eq) in formic acid (3.0 vol) was heated with stirring to 70±10° C., for 8 h. The reaction was deemed complete when no more than 1.0% AUC by chromatographic methods of 3-(6-(1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamido)-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)-t-butylbenzoate) remained. The mixture was allowed to cool to ambient temperature. The solution was added to water (6 vol), heated at 50° C., and the mixture was stirred. The mixture was then heated to 70±10° C. until the level of 3-(6-(1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamido)-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)-t-butylbenzoate was no more than 0.8% (AUC). The solid was collected by filtration, washed with water (2×3 vol), and partially dried on the filter under vacuum. The solid was dried to a constant weight (<1% difference) in a vacuum oven at 60° C. with a slight N2 bleed to afford Compound 3 Form I as an off-white solid.


III.C.1.c. Characterization of Compound 3 Form I
Methods & Materials

XRPD (X-Ray Powder Diffraction)


The X-Ray diffraction (XRD) data of Compound 3 Form I were collected on a Bruker D8 DISCOVER powder diffractometer with HI-STAR 2-dimensional detector and a flat graphite monochromator. Cu sealed tube with Kα radiation was used at 40 kV, 35 mA. The samples were placed on zero-background silicon wafers at 25° C. For each sample, two data frames were collected at 120 seconds each at 2 different θ2 angles: 8° and 26°. The data were integrated with GADDS software and merged with DIFFRACTplusEVA software. Uncertainties for the reported peak positions are ±0.2 degrees.


Differential Scanning Calorimetry (DSC)


The Differential scanning calorimetry (DSC) data of Compound 3 Form I were collected using a DSC Q100 V9.6 Build 290 (TA Instruments, New Castle, Del.). Temperature was calibrated with indium and heat capacity was calibrated with sapphire. Samples of 3-6 mg were weighed into aluminum pans that were crimped using lids with 1 pin hole. The samples were scanned from 25° C. to 350° C. at a heating rate of 1.0° C./min and with a nitrogen gas purge of 50 ml/min. Data were collected by Thermal Advantage Q Series™ version 2.2.0.248 software and analyzed by Universal Analysis software version 4.1D (TA Instruments, New Castle, Del.). The reported numbers represent single analyses.


Compound 3 Form I Single Crystal Structure Determination

Diffraction data were acquired on Bruker Apex II diffractometer equipped with sealed tube Cu K-alpha source and an Apex II CCD detector. The structure was solved and refined using SHELX program (Sheldrick, G. M., Acta Cryst., (2008) A64, 112-122). Based on systematic absences and intensities statistics the structure was solved and refined in P21/n space group.


An X-ray diffraction pattern was calculated from a single crystal structure of Compound 3 Form I and is shown in FIG. 3-1. Table 3-2 lists the calculated peaks for FIG. 3-1.











TABLE 3-2







Relative


Peak
2θ Angle
Intensity


Rank
[degrees]
[%]

















11
14.41
48.2


8
14.64
58.8


1
15.23
100.0


2
16.11
94.7


3
17.67
81.9


7
19.32
61.3


4
21.67
76.5


5
23.40
68.7


9
23.99
50.8


6
26.10
67.4


10
28.54
50.1









An actual X-ray powder diffraction pattern of Compound 3 Form I is shown in FIG. 3-2. Table 3-3 lists the actual peaks for FIG. 3-2.











TABLE 3-3







Relative


Peak
2θ Angle
Intensity


Rank
[degrees]
[%]

















7
7.83
37.7


3
14.51
74.9


4
14.78
73.5


1
15.39
100.0


2
16.26
75.6


6
16.62
42.6


5
17.81
70.9


9
21.59
36.6


10
23.32
34.8


11
24.93
26.4


8
25.99
36.9









Colorless crystals of Compound 3 Form I were obtained by cooling a concentrated 1-butanol solution from 75° C. to 10° C. at a rate of 0.2° C./min. A crystal with dimensions of 0.50×0.08×0.03 mm was selected, cleaned with mineral oil, mounted on a MicroMount and centered on a Bruker APEX II system. Three batches of 40 frames separated in reciprocal space were obtained to provide an orientation matrix and initial cell parameters. Final cell parameters were obtained and refined based on the full data set.


A diffraction data set of reciprocal space was obtained to a resolution of 0.82 Å using 0.5° steps using 30 s exposure for each frame. Data were collected at 100 (2) K. Integration of intensities and refinement of cell parameters were accomplished using APEXII software. Observation of the crystal after data collection showed no signs of decomposition.


A conformational picture of Compound 3 Form I based on single crystal X-ray analysis is shown in FIG. 3-3. Compound 3 Form I is monoclinic, P21/n, with the following unit cell dimensions: a=4.9626(7) Å, b=12.299(2) Å, c=33.075 (4) Å, β=93.938(9)°, V=2014.0 Å3, Z=4. Density of Compound 3 in Form I calculated from structural data is 1.492 g/cm3 at 100 K.


Melting for Compound 3 in Form I occurs at about 204° C.


Compound 3 Form I SSNMR Characterization

Bruker-Biospin 400 MHz wide-bore spectrometer equipped with Bruker-Biospin 4 mm HFX probe was used. Samples were packed into 4 mm ZrO2 rotors and spun under Magic Angle Spinning (MAS) condition with spinning speed of 15.0 kHz. The proton relaxation time was first measured using 1H MAS T1 saturation recovery relaxation experiment in order to set up proper recycle delay of the 13C cross-polarization (CP) MAS experiment. The fluorine relaxation time was measured using 19F MAS T1 saturation recovery relaxation experiment in order to set up proper recycle delay of the 19F MAS experiment. The CP contact time of carbon CPMAS experiment was set to 2 ms. A CP proton pulse with linear ramp (from 50% to 100%) was employed. The carbon Hartmann-Hahn match was optimized on external reference sample (glycine). The fluorine MAS and CPMAS spectra were recorded with proton decoupling. TPPM15 proton decoupling sequence was used with the field strength of approximately 100 kHz for both 13C and 19F acquisitions.



FIG. 3-27 shows the 13C CPMAS NMR spectrum of Compound 3 Form I. Some peaks of this spectrum are summarized in Table 3-4.









TABLE 3-4







Compound 3 Form I



13C Chem. Shifts










Peak #
[ppm]
Intensity












1
172.1
8.59


2
170.8
4.3


3
157.0
4.04


4
148.0
3.46


5
144.3
6.1


6
140.9
9.9


7
135.6
7.21


8
131.8
6.94


9
131.0
7.78


10
130.4
5.49


11
128.9
5.72


12
128.4
7.26


13
128.0
8.43


14
126.6
6.3


15
113.3
7.52


16
111.1
9.57


17
31.5
9.14


18
19.3
6.51


19
18.1
10


20
15.1
6.16










FIG. 3-28 shows the 19F MAS NMR spectrum of Compound 3 Form I. The peaks marked with an asterisk (*) are spinning side bands (15.0 kHz spinning speed). Some peaks of this spectrum are summarized in Table 3-5.









TABLE 3-5







Compound 3 Form I



19F Chem. Shifts*










Peak #
[ppm]
Intensity












1
−42.3
12.5


2
−47.6
10.16









III.C.2. Compound 3 Solvate Form A
III.C.2.a. Embodiments of Compound 3 Solvate Form A

In one aspect, the invention includes compositions comprising various combinations of Compound 3.


In one aspect of the composition, Compound 3 is characterized as an isostructural solvate form referred to as Compound 3 Solvate Form A.


Compound 3 Solvate Form A as disclosed herein comprises a crystalline lattice of Compound 3 in which voids in the crystalline lattice are occupied by one or more molecules of a suitable solvent. Suitable solvents include, but are not limited to, methanol, ethanol, acetone, 2-propanol, acetonitrile, tetrahydrofuran, methyl acetate, 2-butanone, ethyl formate, and 2-methyl tetrahydrofuran. Certain physical characteristics of Compound 3 isostructural solvate forms, such as X-ray powder diffraction, melting point and DSC, are not substantially affected by the particular solvent molecule in question.


In one embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is characterized by one or more peaks at 21.50 to 21.90 degrees, 8.80 to 9.20 degrees, and 10.80 to 11.20 degrees in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is characterized by one or more peaks at 21.50 to 21.90 degrees, 8.80 to 9.20 degrees, 10.80 to 11.20 degrees, 18.00 to 18.40 degrees, and 22.90 to 23.30 degrees in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is characterized by one or more peaks at 21.70, 8.98, and 11.04 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is characterized by one or more peaks at 21.70, 8.98, 11.04, 18.16, and 23.06 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is characterized by a peak at 21.50 to 21.90 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 21.70 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 8.80 to 9.20 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 8.98 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 10.80 to 11.20 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 11.04.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 18.00 to 18.40 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 18.16 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 22.90 to 23.30 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 23.06 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 20.40 to 20.80 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 20.63 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 22.00 to 22.40 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 22.22 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 18.40 to 18.80 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 18.57 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 16.50 to 16.90 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 16.66 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 19.70 to 20.10 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is further characterized by a peak at 19.86 degrees.


In some embodiments, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is characterized by a diffraction pattern substantially similar to that of FIG. 3-6.


In some embodiments, Compound 3 Solvate Form A is characterized by diffraction patterns substantially similar to those provided in FIG. 3-7.


In other embodiments, the solvate or solvate mixture that forms Solvate Form A with Compound 3 is selected from the group consisting of an organic solvent of sufficient size to fit in the voids in the crystalline lattice of Compound 3. In some embodiments, the solvate is of sufficient size to fit in voids measuring about 100 Å3.


In another embodiment, the solvate that forms Compound 3 Solvate Form A is selected from the group consisting of methanol, ethanol, acetone, 2-propanol, acetonitrile, tetrahydrofuran, methyl acetate, 2-butanone, ethyl formate, and 2-methyl tetrahydrofuran. Diffraction patterns are provided for the following Compound 3, Solvate A forms: methanol (FIG. 3-6), ethanol (FIG. 3-7), acetone (FIG. 3-8), 2-propanol (FIG. 3-9), acetonitrile (FIG. 3-10), tetrahydrofuran (FIG. 3-11), methyl acetate (FIG. 3-12), 2-butanone (FIG. 3-13), ethyl formate (FIGS. 3-14), and 2-methytetrahydrofuran (FIG. 3-15).


In another embodiment, the invention features crystalline Compound 3 Acetone Solvate Form A having a P21/n space group, and the following unit cell dimensions: a=16.5235 (10) Å, b=12.7425 (8) Å, c=20.5512 (13) Å, α=90°, β=103.736 (4)°, and γ=90°.


In another embodiment, the invention provides Compound 3 Solvate Form A which exhibits two or more phase transitions as determined by DSC or a similar analytic method known to the skilled artisan.


In another embodiment of this aspect, the DSC gives two phase transitions.


In another embodiment, the DSC gives three phase transitions.


In another embodiment, one of the phase transitions occurs between 200 and 207° C. In another embodiment, one of the phase transitions occurs between 204 and 206° C. In another embodiment, one of the phase transitions occurs between 183 and 190° C. In another embodiment, one of the phase transitions occurs between 185 and 187° C.


In another embodiment, the melting point of Compound 3 Solvate Form A is between 183° C. to 190° C. In another embodiment, the melting point of Compound 3 Solvate Form A is between 185° C. to 187° C.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A comprises 1 to 10 weight percent (wt. %) solvate as determined by TGA.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 Solvate Form A comprises 2 to 5 wt. % solvate as determined by TGA or a similar analytic method known to the skilled artisan.


In another embodiment, the conformation of Compound 3 Acetone Solvate Form A is substantially similar to that depicted in FIG. 3-16, which is based on single X-ray analysis.


In one aspect, the present invention features a process for preparing Compound 3 Solvate Form A. Accordingly, an amount of Compound 3 Form I is slurried in an appropriate solvent at a sufficient concentration for a sufficient time. The slurry is then filtered centrifugally or under vacuum and dried at ambient conditions for sufficient time to yield Compound 3 Solvate Form A.


In some embodiments, about 20 to 40 mg of Compound 3 Form I is slurried in about 400 to 600 μL of an appropriate solvent. In another embodiment, about 25 to 35 mg of Compound 3 Form I is slurried in about 450 to 550 μL of an appropriate solvent. In another embodiment, about 30 mg of Compound 3 Form I is slurried in about 500 μL of an appropriate solvent.


In some embodiments, the time that Compound 3 Form I is allowed to slurry with the solvent is from 1 hour to four days. More particularly, the time that Compound 3 Form I is allowed to slurry with the solvent is from 1 to 3 days. More particularly, the time is 2 days.


In some embodiments, the appropriate solvent is selected from an organic solvent of sufficient size to fit the voids in the crystalline lattice of Compound 3. In other embodiments, the solvate is of sufficient size to fit in voids measuring about 100 Å3.


In other embodiments, the solvent is selected from the group consisting of methanol, ethanol, acetone, 2-propanol, acetonitrile, tetrahydrofuran, methyl acetate, 2-butanone, ethyl formate, and 2-methyl tetrahydrofuran.


In other embodiments, a mixture of two or more of these solvents may be used to obtain Compound 3 Solvate Form A. Alternatively, Compound 3 Solvate Form A may be obtained from a mixture comprising one or more of these solvents and water.


In some embodiments, the effective amount of time for drying Compound 3 Solvate Form A is 1 to 24 hours. More particularly, the time is 6 to 18 hours. More particularly, the time is about 12 hours.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl salt is used to prepare Compound 3 Solvate Form A. Compound 3 Solvate Form A is prepared by dispersing or dissolving a salt form, such as the HCl salt, in an appropriate solvent for an effective amount of time.


III.C.2.b. Synthesis of Compound 3 Solvate Form A
Preparation of Compound 3 Solvate Form A

Compound 3 Form I (approximately 30 mg) was slurried in 500 μL, of an appropriate solvent (for example, methanol, ethanol, acetone, 2-propanol, acetonitrile, tetrahydrofuran, methyl acetate, 2-butanone, ethyl formate, and -methyl tetrahydrofuran for two days. The slurry was then filtered centrifugally or under vacuum and was left to dry at ambient temperature overnight to yield Compound 3 Solvate Form A.


III.C.2.c. Characterization of Compound 3 Solvate Form A
Methods & Materials

Differential Scanning Calorimetry (DSC)


The Differential scanning calorimetry (DSC) data for Compound 3 Solvate Form A were collected using a DSC Q100 V9.6 Build 290 (TA Instruments, New Castle, Del.). Temperature was calibrated with indium and heat capacity was calibrated with sapphire. Samples of 3-6 mg were weighed into aluminum pans that were crimped using lids with 1 pin hole. The samples were scanned from 25° C. to 350° C. at a heating rate of 1.0° C./min and with a nitrogen gas purge of 50 ml/min. Data were collected by Thermal Advantage Q Series™ version 2.2.0.248 software and analyzed by Universal Analysis software version 4.1D (TA Instruments, New Castle, Del.). The reported numbers represent single analyses.


XRPD (X-Ray Powder Diffraction)


X-Ray diffraction (XRD) data were collected on either a Bruker D8 DISCOVER or Bruker APEX II powder diffractometer. The Bruker D8 DISCOVER Diffractometer with HI-STAR 2-dimensional detector and a flat graphite monochromator. Cu sealed tube with Kα radiation was used at 40 kV, 35 mA. The samples were placed on zero-background silicon wafers at 25° C. For each sample, two data frames were collected at 120 seconds each at 2 different 02 angles: 8° and 26°. The data were integrated with GADDS software and merged with DIFFRACTplusEVA software. Uncertainties for the reported peak positions are ±0.2 degrees. equipped with sealed tube Cu Kα source and an Apex II CCD detector.


The Bruker II powder diffractometer was equipped with a sealed tube CuK source and an APEX II CCD detector. Structures were solved and refined using the SHELX program. (Sheldrick, G. M., Acta Cryst. (2008) A64, 112-122).


The melting point for Compound 3 Acetone Solvate Form A occurs at about 188° C. and 205° C.


An actual X-ray powder diffraction pattern of Compound 3 Solvate Form A is shown in FIG. 3-4. Table 3-6 lists the actual peaks for FIG. 3-4 in descending order of relative intensity.












TABLE 3-6








Relative



Angle
Intensity



[degrees]
[%]



















21.70
100.0



8.98
65.5



11.04
57.4



18.16
55.9



23.06
55.4



20.63
53.1



22.22
50.2



18.57
49.1



16.66
47.2



19.86
35.0










Conformational depictions of Compound 3 Acetone Solvate Form A based on single crystal X-ray analysis are shown in FIGS. 3-16 through 3-19. FIG. 3-16 shows a conformational image of Compound 3 Acetone Solvate Form A, based on single crystal X-ray analysis. FIG. 3-17 provides a conformational image of Compound 3 Acetone Solvate Form A as a dimer showing hydrogen bonding between the carboxylic acid groups based on single X-ray crystal analysis. FIG. 3-18 provides a conformational image of a tetramer of Compound 3 Acetone Solvate Form A. FIG. 3-19 provides a confirmation of Compound 3 Acetone Solvate Form A, based on single crystal X-ray analysis. The stoichiometry between Compound 3 Solvate Form A and acetone is approximately 4.4:1 (4.48:1 calculated from 1H NMR; 4.38:1 from X-ray). The crystal structure reveals a packing of the molecules where there are two voids or pockets per unit cell, or 1 void per host molecule. In the acetone solvate, approximately 92 percent of voids are occupied by acetone molecules. Compound 3 Solvate Form A is a monoclinic P21/n space group with the following unit cell dimensions: a=16.5235(10) Å, b=12.7425(8) Å, c=20.5512 (13) Å, α=90°, β=103.736(4)°, γ=90°, V=4203.3(5) Å3, =4. The density of Compound 3 in Compound 3 Solvate Form A calculated from structural data is 1.430/cm3 at 100 K.


Compound 3 Acetone Solvate Form A SSNMR Characterization

Bruker-Biospin 400 MHz wide-bore spectrometer equipped with Bruker-Biospin 4 mm HFX probe was used. Samples were packed into 4 mm ZrO2 rotors and spun under Magic Angle Spinning (MAS) condition with spinning speed of 15.0 kHz. The proton relaxation time was first measured using 1H MAS T1 saturation recovery relaxation experiment in order to set up proper recycle delay of the 13C cross-polarization (CP) MAS experiment. The fluorine relaxation time was measured using 19F MAS T1 saturation recovery relaxation experiment in order to set up proper recycle delay of the 19F MAS experiment. The CP contact time of carbon CPMAS experiment was set to 2 ms. A CP proton pulse with linear ramp (from 50% to 100%) was employed. The carbon Hartmann-Hahn match was optimized on external reference sample (glycine). The fluorine MAS and CPMAS spectra were recorded with proton decoupling. TPPM15 proton decoupling sequence was used with the field strength of approximately 100 kHz for both 13C and 19F acquisitions.



FIG. 3-29 shows the 13C CPMAS NMR spectrum of Compound 3 Acetone Solvate Form A. Some peaks of this spectrum are summarized in Table 3-7.









TABLE 3-7







Compound 3 Acetone


Solvate Form A



13C Chem. Shifts










Peak #
[ppm]
Intensity












1
202.8
6.05


2
173.3
62.66


3
171.9
20.53


4
153.5
28.41


5
150.9
21.68


6
150.1
19.49


7
143.2
45.74


8
142.3
42.68


9
140.1
37.16


10
136.6
26.82


11
135.9
30.1


12
134.6
39.39


13
133.2
23.18


14
131.0
60.92


15
128.5
84.58


16
116.0
34.64


17
114.2
23.85


18
112.4
25.3


19
110.9
24.12


20
107.8
18.21


21
32.0
54.41


22
22.2
20.78


23
18.8
100










FIG. 3-30 shows the 19F MAS NMR spectrum of Compound 3 Acetone Solvate Form A. The peaks marked with an asterisk (*) are spinning side bands (15.0 kHz spinning speed). Some peaks of this spectrum are summarized in Table 3-8.









TABLE 3-8







Compound 3 Acetone


Solvate Form A



19F Chem. Shifts*










Peak #
[ppm]
Intensity












1
−41.6
12.5


2
−46.4
6.77


3
−51.4
9.05









III.C.3. Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A
III.C.3.a. Embodiments of Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A

In one aspect of the composition, Compound 3 is characterized as Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A.


In one embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is characterized by one or more peaks at 8.80 to 9.20 degrees, 17.30 to 17.70 degrees, and 18.20 to 18.60 degrees in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is characterized by one or more peaks at 8.80 to 9.20 degrees, 17.30 to 17.70 degrees, 18.20 to 18.60 degrees, 10.10 to 10.50, and 15.80 to 16.20 degrees in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is characterized by one or more peaks at 8.96, 17.51, and 18.45 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is characterized by one or more peaks at 8.96, 17.51, 18.45. 10.33, and 16.01 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is characterized by a peak at 8.80 to 9.20 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is characterized by a peak at 8.96 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 17.30 to 17.70 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is characterized by a peak at 17.51 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 18.20 to 18.60 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 18.45 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 10.10 to 10.50 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 10.33 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 15.80 to 16.20 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 16.01 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 11.70 to 12.10 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 11.94 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 7.90 to 8.30 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 8.14 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 9.90 to 10.30 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 10.10 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 16.40 to 16.80 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 16.55 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 9.30 to 9.70 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 9.54 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 16.40 to 16.80 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is further characterized by a peak at 16.55 degrees.


In some embodiments, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is characterized as a dimer as depicted in FIG. 3-20.


In some embodiments, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is characterized by the packing diagram depicted in FIG. 3-21.


In some embodiments, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A is characterized by a diffraction pattern substantially similar to that of FIG. 3-22.


In another embodiment, the invention features crystalline Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A having a P1 space group, and the following unit cell dimensions: a=10.2702 (2) Å, b=10.8782 (2) Å, c=12.4821 (3) Å, α=67.0270 (10)°, β=66.1810 (10)°, and γ=72.4760 (10)°.


In one embodiment, Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A was prepared from the HCl salt of Compound 3, by dissolving the HCl salt of Compound 3 in a minimum of solvent and removing the solvent by slow evaporation. In another embodiment, the solvent is an alcohol. In a further embodiment, the solvent is ethanol. In one embodiment, slow evaporation includes dissolving the HCl salt of Compound 3 in a partially covered container.


III.C.3.b. Synthesis of Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A
Preparation of Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A

Colorless crystals of Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A was obtained by slow evaporation from a concentrated solution in ethanol A crystal with dimensions of 0.30×⅕×0.15 mm was selected, cleaned using mineral oil, mounted on a MicroMount and centered on a Bruker APEXII diffractometer. Three batches of 40 frames separated in reciprocal space were obtained to provide an orientation matrix and initial cell parameters. Final cell parameters were obtained and refined based on the full data set.


III.C.3.c. Characterization of Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A
Methods & Materials

Differential Scanning Calorimetry (DSC)


The Differential scanning calorimetry (DSC) data for Compound 3 Solvate Form A were collected using a DSC Q100 V9.6 Build 290 (TA Instruments, New Castle, Del.). Temperature was calibrated with indium and heat capacity was calibrated with sapphire. Samples of 3-6 mg were weighed into aluminum pans that were crimped using lids with 1 pin hole. The samples were scanned from 25° C. to 350° C. at a heating rate of 1.0° C./min and with a nitrogen gas purge of 50 ml/min. Data were collected by Thermal Advantage Q Series™ version 2.2.0.248 software and analyzed by Universal Analysis software version 4.1D (TA Instruments, New Castle, Del.). The reported numbers represent single analyses.


XRPD (X-Ray Powder Diffraction)


X-Ray diffraction (XRD) data were collected on either a Bruker D8 DISCOVER or Bruker APEX II powder diffractometer. The Bruker D8 DISCOVER Diffractomer with HI-STAR 2-dimensional detector and a flat graphite monochromator. Cu sealed tube with Kα radiation was used at 40 kV, 35 mA. The samples were placed on zero-background silicon wafers at 25° C. For each sample, two data frames were collected at 120 seconds each at 2 different θ2 angles: 8° and 26°. The data were integrated with GADDS software and merged with DIFFRACTplusEVA software. Uncertainties for the reported peak positions are ±0.2 degrees. equipped with sealed tube Cu Kα source and an Apex II CCD detector.


The Bruker II powder diffractomer was equipped with a sealed tube CuK source and an APEX II CCD detector. Structures were solved and refined using the SHELX program. (Sheldrick, G. M., Acta Cryst. (2008) A64, 112-122).



FIG. 3-20 provides a conformational image of Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A as a dimer, based on single crystal analysis. FIG. 3-21 provides a packing diagram of Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A, based on single crystal analysis. An X-ray diffraction pattern of Compound 3 HCl Salt Form A calculated from the crystal structure is shown in FIG. 3-22. Table 3-9 contains the calculated peaks for FIG. 3-22 in descending order of relative intensity.












TABLE 3-9








Relative




Intensity



[degrees]
[%]



















8.96
100.00



17.51
48.20



18.45
34.60



10.33
32.10



16.01
18.90



11.94
18.40



8.14
16.20



10.10
13.90



16.55
13.30



9.54
10.10



16.55
13.30










III.D. Solid Forms of Compound 4
III.D.1. Compound 4 Form A
III.D.1.a. Embodiments of Compound 4 Form A

In one aspect, the invention features Compound 4 characterized as crystalline Form A.


In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is characterized by one or more peaks at 19.3 to 19.7 degrees, 21.5 to 21.9 degrees, and 16.9 to 17.3 degrees in an X-ray powder diffraction obtained using Cu K alpha radiation. In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is characterized by one or more peaks at about 19.5, 21.7, and 17.1 degrees. In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is further characterized by a peak at 20.2 to 20.6 degrees. In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is further characterized by a peak at about 20.4 degrees. In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is further characterized by a peak at 18.6 to 19.0 degrees. In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is further characterized by a peak at about 18.8 degrees. In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is further characterized by a peak at 24.5 to 24.9 degrees. In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is further characterized by a peak at about 24.7 degrees. In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is further characterized by a peak at 9.8 to 10.2 degrees. In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is further characterized by a peak at about 10.0 degrees. In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is further characterized by a peak at 4.8 to 5.2 degrees. In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is further characterized by a peak at about 5.0 degrees. In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is further characterized by a peak at 24.0 to 24.4 degrees. In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is further characterized by a peak at about 24.2 degrees. In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is further characterized by a peak at 18.3 to 18.7 degrees. In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is further characterized by a peak at about 18.5 degrees.


In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is characterized by a diffraction pattern substantially similar to that of FIG. 4-1. In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is characterized by a diffraction pattern substantially similar to that of FIG. 4-2.


In another aspect, the invention features a crystal form of Compound 4 Form A having a monoclinic crystal system, a C2 space group, and the following unit cell dimensions: a=21.0952(16) Å, α=90°, b=6.6287(5) Å, β=95.867(6)°, c=17.7917(15) Å, and γ=90°.


In another aspect, the invention features a process of preparing Compound 4 Form A comprising slurrying Compound 4 in a solvent for an effective amount of time. In another embodiment, the solvent is ethyl acetate, dichloromethane, MTBE, isopropyl acetate, water/ethanol, water/acetonitrile, water/methanol, or water/isopropyl alcohol. In another embodiment, the effective amount of time is 24 hours to 2 weeks. In another embodiment, the effective amount of time is 24 hours to 1 week. In another embodiment, the effective amount of time is 24 hours to 72 hours.


In another aspect, the invention features a process of preparing Compound 4 Form A comprising dissolving Compound 4 in a solvent and evaporating the solvent. In another embodiment, the solvent is acetone, acetonitrile, methanol, or isopropyl alcohol.


In another aspect, the invention features a process of preparing Compound 4 Form A comprising dissolving Compound 4 in a first solvent and adding a second solvent that Compound 4 is not soluble in. In another embodiment, the first solvent is ethyl acetate, ethanol, isopropyl alcohol, or acetone. In another embodiment, the second solvent is heptane or water. In another embodiment, the addition of the second solvent is done while stirring the solution of the first solvent and Compound 4.


In another aspect, the invention features a kit comprising Compound 4 Form A, and instructions for use thereof.


In one embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is prepared by slurrying Compound 4 in an appropriate solvent for an effective amount of time. In another embodiment, the appropriate solvent is ethyl acetate, dichloromethane, MTBE, isopropyl acetate, various ratios of water/ethanol solutions, various ratios of water/acetonitrile solutions, various ratios of water/methanol solutions, or various ratios of water/isopropyl alcohol solutions. For example, various ratios of water/ethanol solutions include water/ethanol 1:9 (vol/vol), water/ethanol 1:1 (vol/vol), and water/ethanol 9:1 (vol/vol). Various ratios of water/acetonitrile solutions include water/acetonitrile 1:9 (vol/vol), water/acetonitrile 1:1 (vol/vol), and water/acetonitrile 9:1 (vol/vol). Various ratios of water/methanol solutions include water/methanol 1:9 (vol/vol), water/methanol 1:1 (vol/vol), and water/methanol 9:1 (vol/vol). Various ratios of water/isopropyl alcohol solutions include water/isopropyl alcohol 1:9 (vol/vol), water/isopropyl alcohol 1:1 (vol/vol), and water/isopropyl alcohol 9:1 (vol/vol).


Generally, about 40 mg of Compound 4 is slurred in about 1.5 mL of an appropriate solvent (target concentration at 26.7 mg/mL) at room temperature for an effective amount of time. In some embodiments, the effective amount of time is about 24 hours to about 2 weeks. In some embodiments, the effective amount of time is about 24 hours to about 1 week. In some embodiments, the effective amount of time is about 24 hours to about 72 hours. The solids are then collected.


In another embodiment, Compound 4 Form A is prepared by dissolving Compound 4 in an appropriate solvent and then evaporating the solvent. In one embodiment, the appropriate solvent is one in which Compound 4 has a solubility of greater than 20 mg/mL. For example, these solvents include acetonitrile, methanol, ethanol, isopropyl alcohol, acetone, and the like.


Generally, Compound 4 is dissolved in an appropriate solvent, filtered, and then left for either slow evaporation or fast evaporation. An example of slow evaporation is covering a container, such as a vial, comprising the Compound 4 solution with parafilm having one hole poked in it. An example of fast evaporation is leaving a container, such as a vial, comprising the Compound 4 solution uncovered. The solids are then collected.


In another aspect, the invention features a process of preparing Compound 4 Form A comprising dissolving Compound 4 in a first solvent and adding a second solvent that Compound 4 has poor solubility in (solubility <1 mg/mL). For example, the first solvent may be a solvent that Compound 4 has greater than 20 mg/mL solubility in, e.g. ethyl acetate, ethanol, isopropyl alcohol, or acetone. The second solvent may be, for example, heptane or water.


Generally, Compound 4 is dissolved in the first solvent and filtered to remove any seed crystals. The second solvent is added slowly while stirring. The solids are precipitated and collected by filtering.


III.D.1.b. Synthesis of Compound 4 Form A
Preparation of Compound 4 Form A
Slurry Method

For EtOAc, MTBE, Isopropyl acetate, or DCM, approximately 40 mg of Compound 4 was added to a vial along with 1-2 mL of any one of the above solvents. The slurry was stirred at room temperature for 24 h to 2 weeks and Compound 4 Form A was collected by centrifuging the suspension (with filter). FIG. 4-2 discloses an XRPD pattern of Compound 4 Form A obtained by this method with DCM as the solvent.


For EtOH/water solutions, approximately 40 mg of Compound 4 was added to three separate vials. In the first vial, 1.35 mL of EtOH and 0.15 mL of water were added. In the second vial, 0.75 mL of EtOH and 0.75 mL of water were added. In the third vial, 0.15 mL of EtOH and 1.35 mL of water were added. All three vials were stirred at room temperature for 24 h. Each suspension was then centrifuged separately (with filter) to collect Compound 4 Form A.


For isopropyl alcohol/water solutions, approximately 40 mg of Compound 4 was added to three separate vials. In the first vial, 1.35 mL of isopropyl alcohol and 0.15 mL of water were added. In the second vial, 0.75 mL of isopropyl alcohol and 0.75 mL of water were added. In the third vial, 0.15 mL of isopropyl alcohol and 1.35 mL of water were added. All three vials were stirred at room temperature for 24 h. Each suspension was then centrifuged separately (with filter) to collect Compound 4 Form A.


For methanol/water solutions, approximately 40 mg of Compound 4 was added to a vial. 0.5 mL of methanol and 1 mL of water were added and the suspension was stirred at room temperature for 24 h. The suspension was centrifuged (with filter) to collect Compound 4 Form A.


For acetonitrile, approximately 50 mg of Compound 4 was added to a vial along with 2.0 mL of acetonitrile. The suspension was stirred at room temperature for 24 h and Compound 4 Form A was collected by centrifuge (with filter).


For acetonitrile/water solutions, approximately 50 mg of Compound 4 was dissolved in 2.5 mL of acetonitrile to give a clear solution after sonication. The solution was filtered and 1 mL withdrawn to a vial. 2.25 mL of water was added to give a cloudy suspension. The suspension was stirred at room temperature for 24 h and Compound 4 Form A was collected by centrifuge (with filter).


Slow Evaporation Method

Approximately 55 mg of Compound 4 was dissolved in 0.5 mL of acetone to give a clear solution after sonication. The solution was filtered and 0.2 mL was withdrawn to a vial. The vial was covered with parafilm with one hole poked in it and allowed to stand. Recrystallized Compound 4 Form A was collected by filtering.


Fast Evaporation Method

For isopropyl alcohol, approximately 43 mg of Compound 4 was dissolved in 2.1 mL of isopropyl alcohol to give a clear solution after sonication. The solution was filtered into a vial and allowed to stand uncovered. Recrystallized Compound 4 Form A was collected by filtering.


For methanol, approximately 58 mg of Compound 4 was dissolved in 0.5 mL of methanol to give a clear solution after sonication. The solution was filtered and 0.2 mL was withdrawn to an uncovered vial and allowed to stand. Recrystallized Compound 4 Form A was collected by filtering.


For acetonitrile, approximately 51 mg of Compound 4 was dissolved in 2.5 mL of acetonitrile to give a clear solution after sonication. The solution was filtered and half the solution was withdrawn to an uncovered vial and allowed to stand. Recrystallized Compound 4 Form A was collected by filtering. FIG. 4-3 discloses an XRPD pattern of Compound 4 Form A prepared by this method.


Anti-Solvent Method

For EtOAc/heptane, approximately 30 mg of Compound 4 was dissolved in 1.5 mL of EtOAc to give a clear solution after sonicating. The solution was filtered and 2.0 mL of heptane was added to the filtered solution while slowly stirring. The solution was stirred for an additional 10 minutes and allowed to stand. Recrystallized Compound 4 Form A was collected by filtering. FIG. 4-4 discloses an XRPD pattern of Compound 4 Form A prepared by this method.


For isopropyl alcohol/water, approximately 21 mg of Compound 4 was dissolved in 1.0 mL of isopropyl alcohol to give a clear solution after sonicating. The solution was filtered to give 0.8 mL of solution. 1.8 mL of water was added while slowly stirring. An additional 0.2 mL of water was added to give a cloudy suspension. Stirring was stopped for 5 minutes to give a clear solution. The solution was stirred for an additional 2 minutes and allowed to stand. Recrystallized Compound 4 Form A was collected by filtering.


For ethanol/water, approximately 40 mg of Compound 4 was dissolved in 1.0 mL of ethanol to give a clear solution after sonicating. The solution was filtered and 1.0 mL of water was added. The solution was stirred for 1 day at room temperature. Recrystallized Compound 4 Form A was collected by filtering.


For acetone/water, approximately 55 mg of Compound 4 was dissolved in 0.5 mL of acetone to give a clear solution after sonicating. The solution was filtered and 0.2 mL was withdrawn to a vial. 1.5 mL of water was added, and then an additional 0.5 mL of water to give a cloudy suspension. The suspension was stirred for 1 day at room temperature. Compound 4 Form A was collected by filtering.


Table 4-2 summarizes the various techniques to form Compound 4 Form A.











TABLE 4-2






Re-crystallization
Results of residue


Vehicle
method
solid

















ACN
Fast Evaporation
Form A


Methanol
Fast Evaporation
Form A


Ethanol
N/A
N/A


IPA
Fast Evaporation
Form A


Acetone
Slow Evaporation
Form A


EtOAc
Slurry
Form A


DCM
Slurry
Form A


MTBE
Slurry
Form A


Isopropyl acetate
Slurry
Form A


Water/Ethanol 1:9
N/A
N/A


Water/Ethanol 1:1
Slurry
Form A


Water/Ethanol 9:1
Slurry
Form A


Water/ACN 9:4
Slurry
Form A


Water/Methanol 2:1
Slurry
Form A


Water/IPA 1:9
N/A
N/A


Water/ IPA 9:1
Slurry
Form A


Water/IPA 7:3
Slurry
Form A


Methanol/Water 4:3
Slurry
Form A


EtOAc/Heptane 3:4
Anti-solvent
Form A


IPA/Water 2:5
Anti-solvent
Form A


Ethanol/Water 1:1
Anti-solvent
Form A


Acetone/water 1:10
Anti-solvent
Form A


Ethanol/Water 5:6
Anti-solvent
N/A


Toluene
N/A
N/A


MEK
N/A
N/A


Water
N/A
N/A









III.D.1.c. Characterization of Compound 4 Form A
Methods & Materials
XRPD (X-Ray Powder Diffraction)

X-ray Powder Diffraction was used to characterize the physical form of the lots produced to date and to characterize different polymorphs identified. The XRPD data of a compound were collected on a PANalytical X'pert Pro Powder X-ray Diffractometer (Almelo, the Netherlands). The XRPD pattern was recorded at room temperature with copper radiation (1.54060 A). The X-ray was generated using Cu sealed tube at 45 kV, 40 mA with a Nickel Kβ suppression filter. The incident beam optic was comprised of a variable divergence slit to ensure a constant illuminated length on the sample and on the diffracted beam side; a fast linear solid state detector was used with an active length of 2.12 degrees 2 theta measured in a scanning mode. The powder sample was packed on the indented area of a zero background silicon holder and spinning was performed to achieve better statistics. A symmetrical scan was measured from 4-40 degrees 2 theta with a step size of 0.017 degrees and a scan step time of 15.5 seconds. The data collection software is X'pert Data Collector (version 2.2e). The data analysis software is either X'pert Data Viewer (version 1.2d) or X'pert Highscore (version: 2.2c).


Compound 4 Form A Single Crystal Structure Determination

Diffraction data were acquired on Bruker Apex II diffractometer equipped with sealed tube Cu Kα source and an Apex II CCD detector. The structure was solved and refined using SHELX program (Sheldrick, G. M., Acta Cryst., (2008) A64, 112-122). Based on intensities statistics and systematic absences the structure was solved and refined in C2 space group. The absolute configuration was determined using anomalous diffraction. Flack parameter refined to 0.00 (18) indicating that the model represent the correct enantiomer [(R)].


Solid State NMR

Solid state NMR was conducted on a Bruker-Biospin 400 MHz wide-bore spectrometer equipped with a Bruker-Biospin 4 mm HFX probe. Samples were packed into 4 mm ZrO2 rotors and spun under Magic Angle Spinning (MAS) condition with spinning speed of 12.5 kHz. The proton relaxation time was first measured using 1H MAS T1 saturation recovery relaxation experiment in order to set up proper recycle delay of the 13C cross-polarization (CP) MAS experiment. The CP contact time of carbon CPMAS experiment was set to 2 ms. A CP proton pulse with linear ramp (from 50% to 100%) was employed. The Hartmann-Hahn match was optimized on external reference sample (glycine). The fluorine MAS spectrum was recorded with proton decoupling. TPPM15 decoupling sequence was used with the field strength of approximately 100 kHz for both 13C and 19F acquisitions.


An X-ray diffraction pattern was calculated from a single crystal structure of Compound 4 Form A and single crystal structure of Compound 4 Form A is depicted in FIG. 4-5. Table 4-3 lists the calculated peaks for FIG. 4-5.











TABLE 4-3







Relative


Peak
2θ Angle
Intensity


Rank
[degrees]
[%]

















1
19.4
100.0


2
21.6
81.9


3
17.1
71.4


4
5.0
56.1


5
20.3
49.6


6
18.8
43.4


7
24.7
36.6


8
18.4
33.9


9
10.0
31.2


10
24.2
24.0


11
14.0
20.7


12
20.9
19.9


13
8.4
18.4


14
14.7
18.2


15
18.0
16.0


16
12.4
14.9









An actual X-ray powder diffraction pattern of Compound 4 Form A is shown in FIG. 4-2. Table 4-4 lists the actual peaks for FIG. 4-2.











TABLE 4-4







Relative


Peak
2θ Angle
Intensity


Rank
[degrees]
[%]

















1
19.5
100.0


2
21.7
88.2


3
17.1
85.1


4
20.4
80.9


5
18.8
51.0


6
24.7
40.8


7
10.0
40.7


8
5.0
39.0


9
24.2
35.4


10
18.5
35.0


11
18.0
29.0


12
20.9
27.0


13
14.8
19.9


14
14.1
19.2


15
12.4
18.2


16
8.4
14.1









Single crystal data were obtained for Compound 4 Form A, providing additional detail about the crystal structure, including lattice size and packing.


Crystal Preparation

Crystals of Compound 4 Form A were obtained by slow evaporation from a concentrated solution of methanol (10 mg/mL). A colorless crystal of Compound 4 Form A with dimensions of 0.20×0.05×0.05 mm was selected, cleaned using mineral oil, mounted on a MicroMount and centered on a Bruker APEXII diffractometer. Three batches of 40 frames separated in reciprocal space were obtained to provide an orientation matrix and initial cell parameters. Final cell parameters were obtained and refined based on the full data set.


Experimental

A diffraction data set of reciprocal space was obtained to a resolution of 0.83 Å using 0.5° steps with 30 s exposure for each frame. Data were collected at room temperature [295 (2) K]. Integration of intensities and refinement of cell parameters were accomplished using APEXII software. Observation of the crystal after data collection showed no signs of decomposition.


Geometry: All esds (except the esd in the dihedral angle between two 1.s. planes) are estimated using the full covariance matrix. The cell esds are taken into account individually in the estimation of esds in distances, angles and torsion angles; correlations between esds in cell parameters are only used when they are defined by crystal symmetry. An approximate (isotropic) treatment of cell esds is used for estimating esds involving 1.s. planes.


Data collection: Apex II; cell refinement: Apex II; data reduction: Apex II; program(s) used to solve structure: SHELXS97 (Sheldrick, 1990); program(s) used to refine structure: SHELXL97 (Sheldrick, 1997); molecular graphics: Mercury; software used to prepare material for publication: publCIF.


Refinement: Refinement of F2 against ALL reflections. The weighted R-factor wR and goodness of fit S are based on F2, conventional R-factors R are based on F, with F set to zero for negative F2. The threshold expression of F2>2sigma(F2) is used only for calculating R-factors(gt) etc. and is not relevant to the choice of reflections for refinement. R-factors based on F2 are statistically about twice as large as those based on F, and R-factors based on ALL data will be even larger.


Conformational pictures of Compound 4 Form A based on single crystal X-ray analysis are shown in FIGS. 4-5 and 4-6. The terminal —OH groups are connected via hydrogen bond networks to form a tetrameric cluster with four adjacent molecules (FIG. 4-6). The other hydroxyl group acts as a hydrogen bond donor to form a hydrogen bond with a carbonyl group from an adjacent molecule. The crystal structure reveals a dense packing of the molecules. Compound 4 Form A is monoclinic, C2 space group, with the following unit cell dimensions: a=21.0952(16) Å, b=6.6287(5) Å, c=17.7917(15) Å, p=95.867(6)°, γ=90°.


A solid state 13C NMR spectrum of Compound 4 Form A is shown in FIG. 4-7. Table 4-5 provides chemical shifts of the relevant peaks.










TABLE 4-5








Compound 4 Form A




13C Chem. Shifts










Peak #
F1 [ppm]
Intensity












1
175.3
2.9


2
155.4
0.54


3
153.3
0.81


4
144.3
3.35


5
143.7
4.16


6
143.0
4.24


7
139.0
2.86


8
135.8
5.19


9
128.2
5.39


10
123.3
5.68


11
120.0
4.55


12
115.8
2.66


13
114.9
4.2


14
111.3
5.17


15
102.8
5.93


16
73.8
10


17
69.8
7.06


18
64.5
8.29


19
51.6
4.96


20
39.1
9.83


21
30.5
7.97


22
26.8
6.94


23
24.4
9.19


24
16.3
5.58


25
15.8
6.33









A solid state 19F NMR spectrum of Compound 4 Form A is shown in FIG. 4-8. Peaks with an asterisk denote spinning side bands. Table 4-6 provides chemical shifts of the relevant peaks.










TABLE 4-6








Compound 4 Form A




19F Chem. Shifts










Peak #
F1 [ppm]
Intensity












1
−45.9
9.48


2
−51.4
7.48


3
−53.3
4.92


4
−126.5
11.44


5
−128.4
12.5









III.D.2. Compound 4 Amorphous Form
III.D.2.a. Embodiments of Compound 4 Amorphous Form

In another aspect, the invention features a solid substantially amorphous Compound 4. In another embodiment, the amorphous Compound 4 comprises less than about 5% crystalline Compound 4.


In another aspect, the invention features a pharmaceutical composition comprising the amorphous Compound 4 and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In another embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition further comprises an additional therapeutic agent. In another embodiment, the additional therapeutic agent is selected from a mucolytic agent, bronchodialator, an anti-biotic, an anti-infective agent, an anti-inflammatory agent, a CFTR potentiator, or a nutritional agent.


In another aspect, the invention features a process of preparing the amorphous Compound 4 comprising dissolving Compound 4 in a suitable solvent and removing the solvent by rotary evaporation. In another embodiment, the solvent is methanol.


In another aspect, the invention features a solid dispersion comprising the amorphous Compound 4 and a polymer. In another embodiment, the polymer is hydroxypropylmethylcellulose (HPMC). In another embodiment, the polymer is hydroxypropylmethylcellulose acetate succinate (HPMCAS).


In another embodiment, the polymer is present in an amount from 10% by weight to 80% by weight. In another embodiment, the polymer is present in an amount from 30% by weight to 60% by weight. In another embodiment, the polymer is present in an amount of about 49.5% by weight.


In another embodiment, Compound 4 is present in an amount from 10% by weight to 80% by weight. In another embodiment, Compound 4 is present in an amount from 30% by weight to 60% by weight. In another embodiment, Compound 4 is present in an amount of about 50% by weight.


In another embodiment, the solid dispersion further comprises a surfactant. In another embodiment, the surfactant is sodium lauryl sulfate. In another embodiment, the surfactant is present in an amount from 0.1% by weight to 5% by weight. In another embodiment, the surfactant is present in an amount of about 0.5% by weight.


In another embodiment, the polymer is hydroxypropylmethylcellulose acetate succinate (HPMCAS) in the amount of 49.5% by weight, the surfactant is sodium lauryl sulfate in the amount of 0.5% by weight, and Compound 4 is present in the amount of 50% by weight.


In another aspect, the invention features a pharmaceutical composition comprising the solid dispersion and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In another embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition further comprises an additional therapeutic agent. In another embodiment, the additional therapeutic agent is selected from a mucolytic agent, bronchodialator, an anti-biotic, an anti-infective agent, an anti-inflammatory agent, a CFTR potentiator, or a nutritional agent.


In another aspect, the invention features a process of preparing amorphous Compound 4 comprising spray drying Compound 4.


In another embodiment, the process comprises combining Compound 4 and a suitable solvent and then spray drying the mixture to obtain amorphous Compound 4. In another embodiment, the solvent is an alcohol. In another embodiment, the solvent is methanol.


In another embodiment, the process comprises: a) forming a mixture comprising Compound 4, a polymer, and a solvent; and b) spray drying the mixture to form a solid dispersion.


In another embodiment, the polymer is hydroxypropylmethylcellulose acetate succinate (HPMCAS). In another embodiment, the polymer is in an amount of from 10% by weight to 80% by weight of the solid dispersion. In another embodiment, the polymer is in an amount of about 49.5% by weight of the solid dispersion. In another embodiment, the solvent is methanol. In another embodiment, the mixture further comprises a surfactant. In another embodiment, the surfactant is sodium lauryl sulfate (SLS). In another embodiment, the surfactant is in an amount of from 0.1% by weight to 5% by weight of the solid dispersion. In another embodiment, the surfactant is in an amount of about 0.5% by weight of the solid dispersion.


In another embodiment, the polymer is hydroxypropylmethylcellulose acetate succinate (HPMCAS) in the amount of about 49.5% by weight of the solid dispersion, the solvent is methanol, and the mixture further comprises sodium lauryl sulfate in an amount of about 0.5% by weight of the solid dispersion.


Starting from Compound 4 or Compound 4 Form A, the amorphous form of Compound 4 may be prepared by rotary evaporation or by spray dry methods.


Dissolving Compound 4 in an appropriate solvent like methanol and rotary evaporating the methanol to leave a foam produces Compound 4 amorphous form. In some embodiments, a warm water bath is used to expedite the evaporation.


Compound 4 amorphous form may also be prepared from Compound 4 Form A using spray dry methods. Spray drying is a process that converts a liquid feed to a dried particulate form. Optionally, a secondary drying process such as fluidized bed drying or vacuum drying, may be used to reduce residual solvents to pharmaceutically acceptable levels. Typically, spray drying involves contacting a highly dispersed liquid suspension or solution, and a sufficient volume of hot air to produce evaporation and drying of the liquid droplets. The preparation to be spray dried can be any solution, coarse suspension, slurry, colloidal dispersion, or paste that may be atomized using the selected spray drying apparatus. In a standard procedure, the preparation is sprayed into a current of warm filtered air that evaporates the solvent and conveys the dried product to a collector (e.g. a cyclone). The spent air is then exhausted with the solvent, or alternatively the spent air is sent to a condenser to capture and potentially recycle the solvent. Commercially available types of apparatus may be used to conduct the spray drying. For example, commercial spray dryers are manufactured by Buchi Ltd. And Niro (e.g., the PSD line of spray driers manufactured by Niro) (see, US 2004/0105820; US 2003/0144257).


Spray drying typically employs solid loads of material from about 3% to about 30% by weight, (i.e., drug and excipients), for example about 4% to about 20% by weight, preferably at least about 10%. In general, the upper limit of solid loads is governed by the viscosity of (e.g., the ability to pump) the resulting solution and the solubility of the components in the solution. Generally, the viscosity of the solution can determine the size of the particle in the resulting powder product.


Techniques and methods for spray drying may be found in Perry's Chemical Engineering Handbook, 6th Ed., R. H. Perry, D. W. Green & J. O. Maloney, eds.), McGraw-Hill book co. (1984); and Marshall “Atomization and Spray-Drying” 50, Chem. Eng. Prog. Monogr. Series 2 (1954). In general, the spray drying is conducted with an inlet temperature of from about 60° C. to about 200° C., for example, from about 95° C. to about 185° C., from about 110° C. to about 182° C., from about 96° C. to about 180° C., e.g., about 145° C. The spray drying is generally conducted with an outlet temperature of from about 30° C. to about 90° C., for example from about 40° C. to about 80° C., about 45° C. to about 80° C. e.g., about 75° C. The atomization flow rate is generally from about 4 kg/h to about 12 kg/h, for example, from about 4.3 kg/h to about 10.5 kg/h, e.g., about 6 kg/h or about 10.5 kg/h. The feed flow rate is generally from about 3 kg/h to about 10 kg/h, for example, from about 3.5 kg/h to about 9.0 kg/h, e.g., about 8 kg/h or about 7.1 kg/h. The atomization ratio is generally from about 0.3 to 1.7, e.g., from about 0.5 to 1.5, e.g., about 0.8 or about 1.5.


Removal of the solvent may require a subsequent drying step, such as tray drying, fluid bed drying (e.g., from about room temperature to about 100° C.), vacuum drying, microwave drying, rotary drum drying or biconical vacuum drying (e.g., from about room temperature to about 200° C.).


In one embodiment, the solid dispersion is fluid bed dried.


In one process, the solvent includes a volatile solvent, for example a solvent having a boiling point of less than about 100° C. In some embodiments, the solvent includes a mixture of solvents, for example a mixture of volatile solvents or a mixture of volatile and non-volatile solvents. Where mixtures of solvents are used, the mixture can include one or more non-volatile solvents, for example, where the non-volatile solvent is present in the mixture at less than about 15%, e.g., less than about 12%, less than about 10%, less than about 8%, less than about 5%, less than about 3%, or less than about 2%.


Preferred solvents are those solvents where Compound 4 has a solubility of at least about 10 mg/mL, (e.g., at least about 15 mg/mL, 20 mg/mL, 25 mg/mL, 30 mg/mL, 35 mg/mL, 40 mg/mL, 45 mg/mL, 50 mg/mL, or greater). More preferred solvents include those where Compound 4 has a solubility of at least about 20 mg/mL.


Exemplary solvents that could be tested include acetone, cyclohexane, dichloromethane, N,N-dimethylacetamide (DMA), N,N-dimethylformamide (DMF), 1,3-dimethyl-2-imidazolidinone (DMI), dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO), dioxane, ethyl acetate, ethyl ether, glacial acetic acid (HAc), methyl ethyl ketone (MEK), N-methyl-2-pyrrolidinone (NMP), methyl tert-butyl ether (MTBE), tetrahydrofuran (THF), pentane, acetonitrile, methanol, ethanol, isopropyl alcohol, isopropyl acetate, and toluene. Exemplary co-solvents include acetone/DMSO, acetone/DMF, acetone/water, MEK/water, THF/water, dioxane/water. In a two solvent system, the solvents can be present in of from about 0.1% to about 99.9%. In some preferred embodiments, water is a co-solvent with acetone where water is present from about 0.1% to about 15%, for example about 9% to about 11%, e.g., about 10%. In some preferred embodiments, water is a co-solvent with MEK where water is present from about 0.1% to about 15%, for example about 9% to about 11%, e.g., about 10%. In some embodiments the solvent solution include three solvents. For example, acetone and water can be mixed with a third solvent such as DMA, DMF, DMI, DMSO, or HAc. In instances where amorphous Compound 4 is a component of a solid amorphous dispersion, preferred solvents dissolve both Compound 4 and the polymer. Suitable solvents include those described above, for example, MEK, acetone, water, methanol, and mixtures thereof.


The particle size and the temperature drying range may be modified to prepare an optimal solid dispersion. As would be appreciated by skilled practitioners, a small particle size would lead to improved solvent removal. Applicants have found however, that smaller particles can lead to fluffy particles that, under some circumstances do not provide optimal solid dispersions for downstream processing such as tabletting. At higher temperatures, crystallization or chemical degradation of Compound 4 may occur. At lower temperatures, a sufficient amount of the solvent may not be removed. The methods herein provide an optimal particle size and an optimal drying temperature.


In general, particle size is such that D10 (μm) is less than about 5, e.g., less than about 4.5, less than about 4.0, or less than about 3.5, D50 (μm) is generally less than about 17, e.g., less than about 16, less than about 15, less than about 14, less than about 13, and D90 (μm) is generally less than about 175, e.g., less than about 170, less than about 170, less than about 150, less than about 125, less than about 100, less than about 90, less than about 80, less than about 70, less than about 60, or less than about less than about 50. In general bulk density of the spray dried particles is from about 0.08 g/cc to about 0.20 g/cc, e.g., from about 0.10 to about 0.15 g/cc, e.g., about 0.11 g/cc or about 0.14 g/cc. Tap density of the spray dried particles generally ranges from about 0.08 g/cc to about 0.20 g/cc, e.g., from about 0.10 to about 0.15 g/cc, e.g., about 0.11 g/cc or about 0.14 g/cc, for 10 taps; 0.10 g/cc to about 0.25 g/cc, e.g., from about 0.11 to about 0.21 g/cc, e.g., about 0.15 g/cc, about 0.19 g/cc, or about 0.21 g/cc for 500 taps; 0.15 g/cc to about 0.27 g/cc, e.g., from about 0.18 to about 0.24 g/cc, e.g., about 0.18 g/cc, about 0.19 g/cc, about 0.20 g/cc, or about 0.24 g/cc for 1250 taps; and 0.15 g/cc to about 0.27 g/cc, e.g., from about 0.18 to about 0.24 g/cc, e.g., about 0.18 g/cc, about 0.21 g/cc, about 0.23 g/cc, or about 0.24 g/cc for 2500 taps.


Polymers


Solid dispersions including amorphous Compound 4 and a polymer (or solid state carrier) also are included herein. For example, Compound 4 is present as an amorphous compound as a component of a solid amorphous dispersion. The solid amorphous dispersion, generally includes Compound 4 and a polymer. Exemplary polymers include cellulosic polymers such as HPMC or HPMCAS and pyrrolidone containing polymers such as PVP/VA. In some embodiments, the solid amorphous dispersion includes one or more additional excipients, such as a surfactant.


In one embodiment, a polymer is able to dissolve in aqueous media. The solubility of the polymers may be pH-independent or pH-dependent. The latter include one or more enteric polymers. The term “enteric polymer” refers to a polymer that is preferentially soluble in the less acidic environment of the intestine relative to the more acid environment of the stomach, for example, a polymer that is insoluble in acidic aqueous media but soluble when the pH is above 5-6. An appropriate polymer should be chemically and biologically inert. In order to improve the physical stability of the solid dispersions, the glass transition temperature (Tg) of the polymer should be as high as possible. For example, preferred polymers have a glass transition temperature at least equal to or greater than the glass transition temperature of the drug (i.e., Compound 4). Other preferred polymers have a glass transition temperature that is within about 10 to about 15° C. of the drug (i.e., Compound 4). Examples of suitable glass transition temperatures of the polymers include at least about 90° C., at least about 95° C., at least about 100° C., at least about 105° C., at least about 110° C., at least about 115° C., at least about 120° C., at least about 125° C., at least about 130° C., at least about 135° C., at least about 140° C., at least about 145° C., at least about 150° C., at least about 155° C., at least about 160° C., at least about 165° C., at least about 170° C., or at least about 175° C. (as measured under dry conditions). Without wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed that the underlying mechanism is that a polymer with a higher Tg generally has lower molecular mobility at room temperature, which can be a crucial factor in stabilizing the physical stability of the amorphous solid dispersion.


Additionally, the hygroscopicity of the polymers should be as low, e.g., less than about 10%. For the purpose of comparison in this application, the hygroscopicity of a polymer or composition is characterized at about 60% relative humidity. In some preferred embodiments, the polymer has less than about 10% water absorption, for example less than about 9%, less than about 8%, less than about 7%, less than about 6%, less than about 5%, less than about 4%, less than about 3%, or less than about 2% water absorption. The hygroscopicity can also affect the physical stability of the solid dispersions. Generally, moisture adsorbed in the polymers can greatly reduce the Tg of the polymers as well as the resulting solid dispersions, which will further reduce the physical stability of the solid dispersions as described above.


In one embodiment, the polymer is one or more water-soluble polymer(s) or partially water-soluble polymer(s). Water-soluble or partially water-soluble polymers include but are not limited to, cellulose derivatives (e.g., hydroxypropylmethylcellulose (HPMC), hydroxypropylcellulose (HPC)) or ethylcellulose; polyvinylpyrrolidones (PVP); polyethylene glycols (PEG); polyvinyl alcohols (PVA); acrylates, such as polymethacrylate (e.g., Eudragit® E); cyclodextrins (e.g., β-cyclodextrins) and copolymers and derivatives thereof, including for example PVP-VA (polyvinylpyrollidone-vinyl acetate).


In some embodiments, the polymer is hydroxypropylmethylcellulose (HPMC), such as HPMC E50, HPMCE15, or HPMC60SH50).


As discussed herein, the polymer can be a pH-dependent enteric polymer. Such pH-dependent enteric polymers include, but are not limited to, cellulose derivatives (e.g., cellulose acetate phthalate (CAP)), hydroxypropyl methyl cellulose phthalates (HPMCP), hydroxypropyl methyl cellulose acetate succinate (HPMCAS), carboxymethylcellulose (CMC) or a salt thereof (e.g., a sodium salt such as (CMC-Na)); cellulose acetate trimellitate (CAT), hydroxypropylcellulose acetate phthalate (HPCAP), hydroxypropylmethyl-cellulose acetate phthalate (HPMCAP), and methylcellulose acetate phthalate (MCAP), or polymethacrylates (e.g., Eudragit® S). In some embodiments, the polymer is hydroxypropyl methyl cellulose acetate succinate (HPMCAS). In some embodiments, the polymer is hydroxypropyl methyl cellulose acetate succinate HG grade (HPMCAS-HG).


In yet another embodiment, the polymer is a polyvinylpyrrolidone co-polymer, for example, avinylpyrrolidone/vinyl acetate co-polymer (PVP/VA).


In embodiments where Compound 4 forms a solid dispersion with a polymer, for example with an HPMC, HPMCAS, or PVP/VA polymer, the amount of polymer relative to the total weight of the solid dispersion ranges from about 0.1% to 99% by weight. Unless otherwise specified, percentages of drug, polymer and other excipients as described within a dispersion are given in weight percentages. The amount of polymer is typically at least about 20%, and preferably at least about 30%, for example, at least about 35%, at least about 40%, at least about 45%, or about 50% (e.g., 49.5%). The amount is typically about 99% or less, and preferably about 80% or less, for example about 75% or less, about 70% or less, about 65% or less, about 60% or less, or about 55% or less. In one embodiment, the polymer is in an amount of up to about 50% of the total weight of the dispersion (and even more specifically, between about 40% and 50%, such as about 49%, about 49.5%, or about 50%). HPMC and HPMCAS are available in a variety of grades from ShinEtsu, for example, HPMCAS is available in a number of varieties, including AS-LF, AS-MF, AS-HF, AS-LG, AS-MG, AS-HG. Each of these grades vary with the percent substitution of acetate and succinate.


In some embodiments, Compound 4 and polymer are present in roughly equal amounts, for example each of the polymer and the drug make up about half of the percentage weight of the dispersion. For example, the polymer is present in about 49.5% and the drug is present in about 50%.


In some embodiments, Compound 4 and the polymer combined represent 1% to 20% w/w total solid content of the non-solid dispersion prior to spray drying. In some embodiments, Compound 4 and the polymer combined represent 5% to 15% w/w total solid content of the non-solid dispersion prior to spray drying. In some embodiments, Compound 4 and the polymer combined represent about 11% w/w total solid content of the non-solid dispersion prior to spray drying.


In some embodiments, the dispersion further includes other minor ingredients, such as a surfactant (e.g., SLS). In some embodiments, the surfactant is present in less than about 10% of the dispersion, for example less than about 9%, less than about 8%, less than about 7%, less than about 6%, less than about 5%, less than about 4%, less than about 3%, less than about 2%, about 1%, or about 0.5%.


In embodiments including a polymer, the polymer should be present in an amount effective for stabilizing the solid dispersion. Stabilizing includes inhibiting or preventing, the crystallization of Compound 4. Such stabilizing would inhibit the conversion Compound 4 from amorphous to crystalline form. For example, the polymer would prevent at least a portion (e.g., about 5%, about 10%, about 15%, about 20%, about 25%, about 30%, about 35%, about 40%, about 45%, about 50%, about 55%, about 60%, about 65%, about 70%, about 75%, or greater) of Compound 4 from converting from an amorphous to a crystalline form. Stabilization can be measured, for example, by measuring the glass transition temperature of the solid dispersion, measuring the rate of relaxation of the amorphous material, or by measuring the solubility or bioavailability of Compound 4.


Suitable polymers for use in combination with Compound 4, for example to form a solid dispersion such as an amorphous solid dispersion, should have one or more of the following properties:


The glass transition temperature of the polymer should have a temperature of no less than about 10-15° C. lower than the glass transition temperature of Compound 4. Preferably, the glass transition temperature of the polymer is greater than the glass transition temperature of Compound 4, and in general at least 50° C. higher than the desired storage temperature of the drug product. For example, at least about 100° C., at least about 105° C., at least about 105° C., at least about 110° C., at least about 120° C., at least about 130° C., at least about 140° C., at least about 150° C., at least about 160° C., at least about 160° C., or greater.


The polymer should be relatively non-hygroscopic. For example, the polymer should, when stored under standard conditions, absorb less than about 10% water, for example, less than about 9%, less than about 8%, less than about 7%, less than about 6%, or less than about 5%, less than about 4%, or less than about 3% water. Preferably the polymer will, when stored under standard conditions, be substantially free of absorbed water.


The polymer should have similar or better solubility in solvents suitable for spray drying processes relative to that of Compound 4. In preferred embodiments, the polymer will dissolve in one or more of the same solvents or solvent systems as Compound 4. It is preferred that the polymer is soluble in at least one non-hydroxy containing solvent such as methylene chloride, acetone, or a combination thereof.


The polymer, when combined with Compound 4, for example in a solid dispersion or in a liquid suspension, should increase the solubility of Compound 4 in aqueous and physiologically relative media either relative to the solubility of Compound 4 in the absence of polymer or relative to the solubility of Compound 4 when combined with a reference polymer. For example, the polymer could increase the solubility of amorphous Compound 4 by reducing the amount of amorphous Compound 4 that converts to crystalline Compound 4, either from a solid amorphous dispersion or from a liquid suspension.


The polymer should decrease the relaxation rate of the amorphous substance.


The polymer should increase the physical and/or chemical stability of Compound 4.


The polymer should improve the manufacturability of Compound 4.


The polymer should improve one or more of the handling, administration or storage properties of Compound 4.


The polymer should not interact unfavorably with other pharmaceutical components, for example excipients.


The suitability of a candidate polymer (or other component) can be tested using the spray drying methods (or other methods) described herein to form an amorphous composition. The candidate composition can be compared in terms of stability, resistance to the formation of crystals, or other properties, and compared to a reference preparation, e.g., a preparation of neat amorphous Compound 4 or crystalline Compound 4. For example, a candidate composition could be tested to determine whether it inhibits the time to onset of solvent mediated crystallization, or the percent conversion at a given time under controlled conditions, by at least 50%, 75%, 100%, or 110% as well as the reference preparation, or a candidate composition could be tested to determine if it has improved bioavailability or solubility relative to crystalline Compound 4.


Surfactants

A solid dispersion or other composition may include a surfactant. A surfactant or surfactant mixture would generally decrease the interfacial tension between the solid dispersion and an aqueous medium. An appropriate surfactant or surfactant mixture may also enhance aqueous solubility and bioavailability of Compound 4 from a solid dispersion. The surfactants for use in connection with the present invention include, but are not limited to, sorbitan fatty acid esters (e.g., Spans®), polyoxyethylene sorbitan fatty acid esters (e.g., Tweens®), sodium lauryl sulfate (SLS), sodium dodecylbenzene sulfonate (SDBS) dioctyl sodium sulfosuccinate (Docusate), dioxycholic acid sodium salt (DOSS), Sorbitan Monostearate, Sorbitan Tristearate, hexadecyltrimethyl ammonium bromide (HTAB), Sodium N-lauroylsarcosine, Sodium Oleate, Sodium Myristate, Sodium Stearate, Sodium Palmitate, Gelucire 44/14, ethylenediamine tetraacetic acid (EDTA), Vitamin E d-alpha tocopheryl polyethylene glycol 1000 succinate (TPGS), Lecithin, MW 677-692, Glutanic acid monosodium monohydrate, Labrasol, PEG 8 caprylic/capric glycerides, Transcutol, diethylene glycol monoethyl ether, Solutol HS-15, polyethylene glycol/hydroxystearate, Taurocholic Acid, Pluronic F68, Pluronic F108, and Pluronic F127 (or any other polyoxyethylene-polyoxypropylene co-polymers (Pluronics®) or saturated polyglycolized glycerides (Gelucirs®)). Specific example of such surfactants that may be used in connection with this invention include, but are not limited to, Span 65, Span 25, Tween 20, Capryol 90, Pluronic F108, sodium lauryl sulfate (SLS), Vitamin E TPGS, pluronics and copolymers. SLS is generally preferred.


The amount of the surfactant (e.g., SLS) relative to the total weight of the solid dispersion may be between 0.1-15%. Preferably, it is from about 0.5% to about 10%, more preferably from about 0.5 to about 5%, e.g., about 0.5 to 4%, about 0.5 to 3%, about 0.5 to 2%, about 0.5 to 1%, or about 0.5%.


In certain embodiments, the amount of the surfactant relative to the total weight of the solid dispersion is at least about 0.1%, preferably about 0.5%. In these embodiments, the surfactant would be present in an amount of no more than about 15%, and preferably no more than about 12%, about 11%, about 10%, about 9%, about 8%, about 7%, about 6%, about 5%, about 4%, about 3%, about 2% or about 1%. An embodiment wherein the surfactant is in an amount of about 0.5% by weight is preferred.


Candidate surfactants (or other components) can be tested for suitability for use in the invention in a manner similar to that described for testing polymers.


III.D.2.b. Synthesis of Compound 4 Amorphous Form
Preparation of Compound 4 Amorphous Form
Rotary Evaporation Method

Compound 4 Amorphous Form was achieved via rotary evaporation. Compound 4 (approximately 10 g) was dissolved in 180 mL of MeOH and rotary evaporated under reduced pressure in a 50° C. bath to a foam. XRPD (FIG. 4-9) confirmed amorphous form of Compound 4.


Spray-Dried Method

9.95 g of Hydroxypropylmethylcellulose acetate succinate HG grade (HPMCAS-HG) was weighed into a 500 mL beaker, along with 50 mg of sodium lauryl sulfate (SLS). MeOH (200 mL) was mixed with the solid. The material was allowed to stir for 4 h. To insure maximum dissolution, after 2 h of stirring the solution was sonicated for 5 min, then allowed to continue stirring for the remaining 2 h. A very fin suspension of HPMCAS remained in solution. However, visual observation determined that no gummy portions remained on the walls of the vessel or stuck to the bottom after tilting the vessel.


Compound 4 Form A (10 g) was poured into the 500 mL beaker, and the system was allowed to continue stirring. The solution was spray dried using the following parameters:












Formulation Description: Compound 4 Form


A/HPMCAS/SLS (50/49.5/0.5)










Buchi Mini Spray Dryer
















T inlet (setpoint)
145°
C.



T outlet (start)
75°
C.



T outlet (end)
55°
C.



Nitrogen Pressure
5
psi










Aspirator
100%



Pump
 35%











Rotometer
40
mm



Filter Pressure
65
mbar



Condenser Temp
−3°
C.



Run Time
1
h










Approximately 16 g of Compound 4 Amorphous Form (80% yield) was recovered. Compound 4 Amorphous Form was confirmed by XRPD (FIG. 4-10).


III.D.2.c. Characterization of Compound 4 Amorphous Form
Methods & Materials
XRPD (X-Ray Powder Diffraction)

X-ray Powder Diffraction was used to characterize the physical form of the lots produced to date and to characterize different polymorphs identified. The XRPD data of a compound were collected on a PANalytical X'pert Pro Powder X-ray Diffractometer (Almelo, the Netherlands). The XRPD pattern was recorded at room temperature with copper radiation (1.54060 A). The X-ray was generated using Cu sealed tube at 45 Kv, 40 Ma with a Nickel Kβ suppression filter. The incident beam optic was comprised of a variable divergence slit to ensure a constant illuminated length on the sample and on the diffracted beam side; a fast linear solid state detector was used with an active length of 2.12 degrees 2 theta measured in a scanning mode. The powder sample was packed on the indented area of a zero background silicon holder and spinning was performed to achieve better statistics. A symmetrical scan was measured from 4-40 degrees 2 theta with a step size of 0.017 degrees and a scan step time of 15.5 seconds. The data collection software is X'pert Data Collector (version 2.2e). The data analysis software is either X'pert Data Viewer (version 1.2d) or X'pert Highscore (version: 2.2c).


A solid state 13C NMR spectrum of Compound 4 amorphous form is shown in FIG. 4-11. Table 4-7 provides chemical shifts of the relevant peaks.


Table 4-7














Compound 4 amorphous form




13C Chem. Shifts










Peak #
F1 [ppm]
Intensity












1
171.6
26.33


2
147.9
41.9


3
144.0
100


4
135.8
70.41


5
127.3
38.04


6
123.8
62.66


7
119.8
42.09


8
111.2
68.11


9
102.4
37.01


10
97.5
37.47


11
70.0
65.02


12
64.7
37.94


13
48.3
38.16


14
39.1
80.54


15
31.1
92.01


16
25.1
58.68


17
16.5
78.97









A solid state 19F NMR spectrum of Compound 4 amorphous form is shown in FIG. 4-12. Peaks with an asterisk denote spinning side bands. To avoid extensive spinning side bands overlap, 19F MAS spectrum of Compound 4 amorphous form was collected with spinning speed of 21.0 kHz using a Bruker-Biospin 2.5 mm probe and corresponding 2.5 mm ZrO2 rotors. Table 4-8 provides chemical shifts of the relevant peaks.










TABLE 4-8








Compound 4 amorphous form




19F Chem. Shifts










Peak #
F1 [ppm]
Intensity












1
−46.1
100


2
−53.1
94.9


3
−139.4
76.05









IV. Formulations

In one aspect, the invention features a pharmaceutical formulation comprising a Compound of Formula I and a Compound of Formula II, or according to Table I.


Table I is reproduced here for convenience.












TABLE I







Column A
Column B
Column C
Column D


Embodiments
Embodiments
Embodiments
Embodiments














Section
Heading
Section
Heading
Section
Heading
Section
Heading





II.A.1.
Compounds
II.B.1.
Compounds
II.C.1.
Compounds
II.D.1.
Compounds



of Formula I

of Formula

of Formula

of Formula





II

III

IV


II.A.2.
Compound 1
II.B.2.
Compound 2
II.C.2.
Compound 3
II.D.2.
Compound 4


III.A.1.a.
Compound 1
III.B.1.a.
Compound 2
III.C.1.a.
Compound 3
III.D.1.a.
Compound 4



Form C

Form A

Form I

Form A


IV.A.1.a.
Compound 1
III.B.2.a.
Compound 2
III.C.2.a.
Compound 3
III.D.2.a.
Compound 4



First

Form A-HCl

Solvate

Amorphous



Formulation



Form A

Form


IV.A.2.a.
Compound 1
III.B.3.a.
Compound 2
III.C.3.a.
Compound 3
IV.C.1.a.
Compound 4



Tablet and

Form B-HCl

HCl Salt

Tablet



SDD



Form A

Formulation



Formulation




III.B.4.a.
Compound 2
IV.B.1.a.
Compound 3





Form B

Form I







Aqueous







Formulation






IV.B.2.a.
Compound 3







Form I







Capsule







Formulation






IV.B.3.a.
Compound 3







Form I







Tablet







Formulation









According to Table I, the pharmaceutical composition comprises at least one component from Column A of Table I, and at least one component from Column B of Table 1, and optionally an additional component from one or both of Column C and/or Column D In one aspect Compound 1 is the component from Column A and Compound 2 is the component from Column B In one embodiment, the additional component is Compound 3 from Column C. In another embodiment, the additional component Compound 4 from Column D In a further embodiment, the additional components are Compound 3 from Column C and Compound 4 from Column D.


In one embodiment, the composition comprises a homogeneous mixture comprising a composition according to Table I. In another embodiment, the composition comprises a non-homogeneous mixture comprising a composition according to Table 1.


The pharmaceutical composition of Table I can be administered in one vehicle or separately.


In some embodiments, the pharmaceutical composition optionally comprises a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, adjuvant or vehicle. In certain embodiments, these compositions optionally further comprise one or more additional therapeutic agents.


It will also be appreciated that certain of the Compounds of present invention can exist in free form for treatment, or where appropriate, as a pharmaceutically acceptable derivative or a prodrug thereof. According to the present invention, a pharmaceutically acceptable derivative or a prodrug includes, but is not limited to, pharmaceutically acceptable salts, esters, salts of such esters, or any other adduct or derivative which upon administration to a patient in need thereof is capable of providing, directly or indirectly, a Compound as otherwise described herein, or a metabolite or residue thereof.


As used herein, the term “pharmaceutically acceptable salt” refers to those salts which are, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of humans and lower animals without undue toxicity, irritation, allergic response and the like, and are commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio. A “pharmaceutically acceptable salt” means any non-toxic salt or salt of an ester of a Compound of this invention that, upon administration to a recipient, is capable of providing, either directly or indirectly, a Compound of this invention or an inhibitorily active metabolite or residue thereof.


Pharmaceutically acceptable salts are well known in the art. For example, S. M. Berge, et al. describe pharmaceutically acceptable salts in detail in J. Pharmaceutical Sciences, 1977, 66, 1-19, incorporated herein by reference. Pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the Compounds of this invention include those derived from suitable inorganic and organic acids and bases. Examples of pharmaceutically acceptable, nontoxic acid addition salts are salts of an amino group formed with inorganic acids such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, phosphoric acid, sulfuric acid and perchloric acid or with organic acids such as acetic acid, oxalic acid, maleic acid, tartaric acid, citric acid, succinic acid or malonic acid or by using other methods used in the art such as ion exchange. Other pharmaceutically acceptable salts include adipate, alginate, ascorbate, aspartate, benzenesulfonate, benzoate, bisulfate, borate, butyrate, camphorate, camphorsulfonate, citrate, cyclopentanepropionate, digluconate, dodecylsulfate, ethanesulfonate, formate, fumarate, glucoheptonate, glycerophosphate, gluconate, hemisulfate, heptanoate, hexanoate, hydroiodide, 2-hydroxy-ethanesulfonate, lactobionate, lactate, laurate, lauryl sulfate, malate, maleate, malonate, methanesulfonate, 2-naphthalenesulfonate, nicotinate, nitrate, oleate, oxalate, palmitate, pamoate, pectinate, persulfate, 3-phenylpropionate, phosphate, picrate, pivalate, propionate, stearate, succinate, sulfate, tartrate, thiocyanate, p-toluenesulfonate, undecanoate, valerate salts, and the like. Salts derived from appropriate bases include alkali metal, alkaline earth metal, ammonium and N+(C1-4alkyl)4 salts. This invention also envisions the quaternization of any basic nitrogen-containing groups of the Compounds disclosed herein. Water or oil-soluble or dispersible products may be obtained by such quaternization. Representative alkali or alkaline earth metal salts include sodium, lithium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, and the like. Further pharmaceutically acceptable salts include, when appropriate, nontoxic ammonium, quaternary ammonium, and amine cations formed using counterions such as halide, hydroxide, carboxylate, sulfate, phosphate, nitrate, lower alkyl sulfonate and aryl sulfonate.


As described above, the pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of the present invention additionally comprise a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, adjuvant, or vehicle, which, as used herein, includes any and all solvents, diluents, or other liquid vehicle, dispersion or suspension aids, surface active agents, isotonic agents, thickening or emulsifying agents, preservatives, solid binders, lubricants and the like, as suited to the particular dosage form desired. Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, Sixteenth Edition, E. W. Martin (Mack Publishing Co., Easton, Pa., 1980) discloses various carriers used in formulating pharmaceutically acceptable compositions and known techniques for the preparation thereof. Except insofar as any conventional carrier medium is incompatible with the Compounds of the invention, such as by producing any undesirable biological effect or otherwise interacting in a deleterious manner with any other component(s) of the pharmaceutically acceptable composition, its use is contemplated to be within the scope of this invention. Some examples of materials which can serve as pharmaceutically acceptable carriers include, but are not limited to, ion exchangers, alumina, aluminum stearate, lecithin, serum proteins, such as human serum albumin, buffer substances such as phosphates, glycine, sorbic acid, or potassium sorbate, partial glyceride mixtures of saturated vegetable fatty acids, water, salts or electrolytes, such as protamine sulfate, disodium hydrogen phosphate, potassium hydrogen phosphate, sodium chloride, zinc salts, colloidal silica, magnesium trisilicate, polyvinyl pyrrolidone, polyacrylates, waxes, polyethylene-polyoxypropylene-block polymers, wool fat, sugars such as lactose, glucose and sucrose; starches such as corn starch and potato starch; cellulose and its derivatives such as sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose and cellulose acetate; powdered tragacanth; malt; gelatin; talc; excipients such as cocoa butter and suppository waxes; oils such as peanut oil, cottonseed oil; safflower oil; sesame oil; olive oil; corn oil and soybean oil; glycols; such a propylene glycol or polyethylene glycol; esters such as ethyl oleate and ethyl laurate; agar; buffering agents such as magnesium hydroxide and aluminum hydroxide; alginic acid; pyrogen-free water; isotonic saline; Ringer's solution; ethyl alcohol, and phosphate buffer solutions, as well as other non-toxic compatible lubricants such as sodium lauryl sulfate and magnesium stearate, as well as coloring agents, releasing agents, coating agents, sweetening, flavoring and perfuming agents, preservatives and antioxidants can also be present in the composition, according to the judgment of the formulator.


The pharmaceutically acceptable compositions of this invention can be administered to humans and other animals orally, rectally, parenterally, intracisternally, intravaginally, intraperitoneally, topically (as by powders, ointments, or drops), bucally, as an oral or nasal spray, or the like, depending on the severity of the infection being treated. In certain embodiments, the compositions of the invention may be administered orally or parenterally at dosage levels of about 0.01 mg/kg to about 50 mg/kg and preferably from about 1 mg/kg to about 25 mg/kg, of subject body weight per day, one or more times a day, to obtain the desired therapeutic effect.


Liquid dosage forms for oral administration include, but are not limited to, pharmaceutically acceptable emulsions, microemulsions, solutions, suspensions, syrups and elixirs. In addition to the active Compounds of the composition, the liquid dosage forms may contain inert diluents commonly used in the art such as, for example, water or other solvents, solubilizing agents and emulsifiers such as ethyl alcohol, isopropyl alcohol, ethyl carbonate, ethyl acetate, benzyl alcohol, benzyl benzoate, propylene glycol, 1,3-butylene glycol, dimethylformamide, oils (in particular, cottonseed, groundnut, corn, germ, olive, castor, and sesame oils), glycerol, tetrahydrofurfuryl alcohol, polyethylene glycols and fatty acid esters of sorbitan, and mixtures thereof. Besides inert diluents, the oral compositions can also include adjuvants such as wetting agents, emulsifying and suspending agents, sweetening, flavoring, and perfuming agents.


Injectable preparations, for example, sterile injectable aqueous or oleaginous suspensions may be formulated according to the known art using suitable dispersing or wetting agents and suspending agents. The sterile injectable preparation may also be a sterile injectable solution, suspension or emulsion in a nontoxic parenterally acceptable diluent or solvent, for example, as a solution in 1,3-butanediol. Among the acceptable vehicles and solvents that may be employed are water, Ringer's solution, U.S.P. and isotonic sodium chloride solution. In addition, sterile, fixed oils are conventionally employed as a solvent or suspending medium. For this purpose any bland fixed oil can be employed including synthetic mono- or diglycerides. In addition, fatty acids such as oleic acid are used in the preparation of injectables.


The injectable formulations can be sterilized, for example, by filtration through a bacterial-retaining filter, or by incorporating sterilizing agents in the form of sterile solid compositions which can be dissolved or dispersed in sterile water or other sterile injectable medium prior to use.


In order to prolong the effect of a composition of the present invention, it is often desirable to slow the absorption of the composition from subcutaneous or intramuscular injection. This may be accomplished by the use of a liquid suspension of crystalline or amorphous material with poor water solubility. The rate of absorption of the composition then depends upon its rate of dissolution that, in turn, may depend upon crystal size and crystalline form. Alternatively, delayed absorption of a parenterally administered composition form is accomplished by dissolving or suspending the composition in an oil vehicle. Injectable depot forms are made by forming microencapsule matrices of the composition in biodegradable polymers such as polylactide-polyglycolide. Depending upon the ratio of composition to polymer and the nature of the particular polymer employed, the rate of composition release can be controlled. Examples of other biodegradable polymers include poly(orthoesters) and poly(anhydrides). Depot injectable formulations are also prepared by entrapping the composition in liposomes or microemulsions that are compatible with body tissues.


Compositions for rectal or vaginal administration are preferably suppositories which can be prepared by mixing the Compounds of this invention with suitable non-irritating excipients or carriers such as cocoa butter, polyethylene glycol or a suppository wax which are solid at ambient temperature but liquid at body temperature and therefore melt in the rectum or vaginal cavity and release the active Compound.


Solid dosage forms for oral administration include capsules, tablets, pills, powders, and granules. In such solid dosage forms, the active Compound is mixed with at least one inert, pharmaceutically acceptable excipient or carrier such as sodium citrate or dicalcium phosphate and/or a) fillers or extenders such as starches, lactose, sucrose, glucose, mannitol, and silicic acid, b) binders such as, for example, carboxymethylcellulose, alginates, gelatin, polyvinylpyrrolidinone, sucrose, and acacia, c) humectants such as glycerol, d) disintegrating agents such as agar-agar, calcium carbonate, potato or tapioca starch, alginic acid, certain silicates, and sodium carbonate, e) solution retarding agents such as paraffin, f) absorption accelerators such as quaternary ammonium Compounds, g) wetting agents such as, for example, cetyl alcohol and glycerol monostearate, h) absorbents such as kaolin and bentonite clay, and i) lubricants such as talc, calcium stearate, magnesium stearate, solid polyethylene glycols, sodium lauryl sulfate, and mixtures thereof. In the case of capsules, tablets and pills, the dosage form may also comprise buffering agents.


Solid compositions of a similar type may also be employed as fillers in soft and hard-filled gelatin capsules using such excipients as lactose or milk sugar as well as high molecular weight polyethylene glycols and the like. The solid dosage forms of tablets, dragees, capsules, pills, and granules can be prepared with coatings and shells such as enteric coatings and other coatings well known in the pharmaceutical formulating art. They may optionally contain opacifying agents and can also be of a composition that they release the active ingredient(s) only, or preferentially, in a certain part of the intestinal tract, optionally, in a delayed manner Examples of embedding compositions that can be used include polymeric substances and waxes. Solid compositions of a similar type may also be employed as fillers in soft and hard-filled gelatin capsules using such excipients as lactose or milk sugar as well as high molecular weight polethylene glycols and the like.


The active Compounds can also be in microencapsulated form with one or more excipients as noted above. The solid dosage forms of tablets, dragees, capsules, pills, and granules can be prepared with coatings and shells such as enteric coatings, release controlling coatings and other coatings well known in the pharmaceutical formulating art. In such solid dosage forms the active Compound may be admixed with at least one inert diluent such as sucrose, lactose or starch. Such dosage forms may also comprise, as is normal practice, additional substances other than inert diluents, e.g., tabletting lubricants and other tabletting aids such a magnesium stearate and microcrystalline cellulose. In the case of capsules, tablets and pills, the dosage forms may also comprise buffering agents. They may optionally contain opacifying agents and can also be of a composition that they release the active ingredient(s) only, or preferentially, in a certain part of the intestinal tract, optionally, in a delayed manner Examples of embedding compositions that can be used include polymeric substances and waxes.


Dosage forms for topical or transdermal administration of a Compound of this invention include ointments, pastes, creams, lotions, gels, powders, solutions, sprays, inhalants or patches. The active component is admixed under sterile conditions with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier and any needed preservatives or buffers as may be required. Ophthalmic formulation, eardrops, and eye drops are also contemplated as being within the scope of this invention. Additionally, the present invention contemplates the use of transdermal patches, which have the added advantage of providing controlled delivery of a Compound to the body. Such dosage forms are prepared by dissolving or dispensing the Compound in the proper medium. Absorption enhancers can also be used to increase the flux of the Compound across the skin. The rate can be controlled by either providing a rate controlling membrane or by dispersing the Compound in a polymer matrix or gel.


It will also be appreciated that the compositions disclosed herein can be administered concurrently with, prior to, or subsequent to, one or more other desired therapeutics or medical procedures. The particular combination of therapies (therapeutics or procedures) to employ in a combination regimen will take into account compatibility of the desired therapeutics and/or procedures and the desired therapeutic effect to be achieved. It will also be appreciated that the therapies employed may achieve a desired effect for the same disorder (for example, an inventive Compound may be administered concurrently with another agent used to treat the same disorder), or they may achieve different effects (e.g., control of any adverse effects). As used herein, additional therapeutic agents that are normally administered to treat or prevent a particular disease, or condition, are known as “appropriate for the disease, or condition, being treated”.


In one embodiment, the additional agent is selected from a mucolytic agent, bronchodialator, an anti-biotic, an anti-infective agent, an anti-inflammatory agent, a CFTR modulator other than a Compound of the present invention, or a nutritional agent.


In one embodiment, the additional agent is an antibiotic. Exemplary antibiotics useful herein include tobramycin, including tobramycin inhaled powder (TIP), azithromycin, aztreonam, including the aerosolized form of aztreonam, amikacin, including liposomal formulations thereof, ciprofloxacin, including formulations thereof suitable for administration by inhalation, levoflaxacin, including aerosolized formulations thereof, and combinations of two antibiotics, e.g., fosfomycin and tobramycin.


In another embodiment, the additional agent is a mucolyte. Exemplary mucolytes useful herein includes Pulmozyme®.


In another embodiment, the additional agent is a bronchodialator. Exemplary bronchodilators include albuterol, metaprotenerol sulfate, pirbuterol acetate, salmeterol, or tetrabuline sulfate.


In another embodiment, the additional agent is effective in restoring lung airway surface liquid. Such agents improve the movement of salt in and out of cells, allowing mucus in the lung airway to be more hydrated and, therefore, cleared more easily. Exemplary such agents include hypertonic saline, denufosol tetrasodium ([[(3S,5R)-5-(4-amino-2-oxopyrimidin-1-yl)-3-hydroxyoxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl][[[(2R,3S,4R,5R)-5-(2,4-dioxopyrimidin-1-yl)-3,4-dihydroxyoxolan-2-yl]methoxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]oxy-hydroxyphosphoryl]hydrogen phosphate), or bronchitol (inhaled formulation of mannitol).


In another embodiment, the additional agent is an anti-inflammatory agent, i.e., an agent that can reduce the inflammation in the lungs. Exemplary such agents useful herein include ibuprofen, docosahexanoic acid (DHA), sildenafil, inhaled glutathione, pioglitazone, hydroxychloroquine, or simavastatin.


In another embodiment, the additional agent is a CFTR modulator other than Compound 1, i.e., an agent that has the effect of modulating CFTR activity. Exemplary such agents include ataluren (“PTC124®”; 3-[5-(2-fluorophenyl)-1,2,4-oxadiazol-3-yl]benzoic acid), sinapultide, lancovutide, depelestat (a human recombinant neutrophil elastase inhibitor), cobiprostone (7-{(2R,4aR,5R,7aR)-2-[(3S)-1,1-difluoro-3-methylpentyl]-2-hydroxy-6-oxooctahydrocyclopenta[b]pyran-5-yl}heptanoic acid), or (3-(6-(1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamido)-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoic acid. In another embodiment, the additional agent is (3-(6-(1-(2,2-difluorobenzo[d][1,3]dioxol-5-yl)cyclopropanecarboxamido)-3-methylpyridin-2-yl)benzoic acid.


In another embodiment, the additional agent is a nutritional agent. Exemplary such agents include pancrelipase (pancreating enzyme replacement), including Pancrease®, Pancreacarb®, Ultrase®, or Creon®, Liprotomase® (formerly Trizytek®), Aquadeks®, or glutathione inhalation. In one embodiment, the additional nutritional agent is pancrelipase.


The amount of additional therapeutic agent present in the compositions of this invention will be no more than the amount that would normally be administered in a composition comprising that therapeutic agent as the only active agent. Preferably the amount of additional therapeutic agent in the presently disclosed compositions will range from about 50% to 100% of the amount normally present in a composition comprising that agent as the only therapeutically active agent.


A composition of the invention as disclosed herein may also be incorporated into compositions for coating an implantable medical device, such as prostheses, artificial valves, vascular grafts, stents and catheters. Accordingly, the present invention, in another aspect, includes a composition for coating an implantable device comprising a composition as disclosed herein or a pharmaceutically acceptable composition thereof, and in classes and subclasses herein, and a carrier suitable for coating said implantable device. In still another aspect, the present invention includes an implantable device coated with a composition comprising a composition as described herein or a pharmaceutically acceptable composition thereof, and a carrier suitable for coating said implantable device. Suitable coatings and the general preparation of coated implantable devices are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,099,562; 5,886,026; and 5,304,121. The coatings are typically biocompatible polymeric materials such as a hydrogel polymer, polymethyldisiloxane, polycaprolactone, polyethylene glycol, polylactic acid, ethylene vinyl acetate, and mixtures thereof. The coatings may optionally be further covered by a suitable topcoat of fluorosilicone, polysaccarides, polyethylene glycol, phospholipids or combinations thereof to impart controlled release characteristics in the composition.


In order that the invention described herein may be more fully understood, the following examples are set forth. It should be understood that these examples are for illustrative purposes only and are not to be construed as limiting this invention in any manner.


IV.A. Formulations of Compound 1

In some embodiments, Compound 1 is formulated as provided herein, and is administered together with Compound 2 or as provided in Table I. As a note, Compound 1 may be in any of the solid forms specified herein.


IV.A.1. Compound 1 First Formulation
IV.A.1.a. Embodiments of Compound 1 First Formulation

In one embodiment, the Compound 1 Formulation comprises:

    • (i) Compound 1;
    • (ii) PEG 400; and
    • (iii) PVP K30.


In another embodiment, the Compound 1 Formulation comprises:

    • (i) Compound 1 or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof;
    • (ii) A liquid PEG (polyethylene glycol polymer) that has an average molecular weight of between about 200 and about 600; and
    • (iii) Optionally, PVP.


In another embodiment, the Compound 1 Formulation comprises:

    • (i) Compound 1 or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof;
    • (ii) a suitable liquid PEG; and
    • (iii) optionally, a suitable viscosity enhancing agent.


As used herein, the phrase “suitable liquid PEG” means a polyethylene glycol polymer that is in liquid form at ambient temperature and is amenable for use in a pharmaceutical composition. Such suitable polyethylene glycols are well known in the art; see, e.g., http://www.medicinescomplete.com/mc/excipients/current, which is incorporated herein by reference. Exemplary PEGs include low molecular weight PEGs such as PEG 200, PEG 300, PEG 400, etc. The number that follows the term “PEG” indicates the average molecular weight of that particular polymer. E.g., PEG 400 is a polyethylene glycol polymer wherein the average molecular weight of the polymer therein is about 400.


In one embodiment, said suitable liquid PEG has an average molecular weight of from about 200 to about 600. In another embodiment, said suitable liquid PEG is PEG 400 (for example a PEG having a molecular weight of from about 380 to about 420 g/mol).


In another embodiment, the present invention provides a pharmaceutical composition comprising Compound 1 or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof; propylene glycol; and, optionally, a suitable viscosity enhancing agent.


In another embodiment, the pharmaceutical formulations of the present invention comprise a suitable viscosity enhancing agent. In one embodiment, the suitable viscosity enhancing agent is a polymer soluble in PEG. Such suitable viscosity enhancing agents are well known in the art, e.g., polyvinyl pyrrolidine (hereinafter “PVP”). PVP is characterized by its viscosity in aqueous solution, relative to that of water, expressed as a K-value (denoted as a suffix, e.g., PVP K2O), in the range of from about 10 to about 120. See, e.g., http://www.medicinescomplete.com/mc/excipients/current. Embodiments of PVP useful in the present invention have a K-value of about 90 or less. An exemplary such embodiment is PVP K30.


In one embodiment, the Compound 1 formulation comprises:

    • (i) Compound 1 or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof;
    • (ii) PEG 400; and
    • (iii) PVP K30.


In another embodiment, Compound 1 is present in an amount from about 0.01% w/w to about 6.5% w/w.


In another embodiment, the present invention provides a pharmaceutical formulation, wherein said PEG is present in an amount from about 87.5% w/w to about 99.99% w/w.


In another embodiment, the PVP K30 is present in an amount between 0% w/w to about 6% w/w.


In another embodiment, the formulation comprises PEG 400 (e.g., from about 97.8 to about 98.0% w/w, for example, about 97.88% w/w), PVP K30 (e.g., from about 1.9 to about 2.1% w/w, for example, about 2.0% w/w), and Compound 1 (e.g., from about 0.10 to about 0.15% w/w, for example, about 0.13% w/w).


In another embodiment, the formulation comprises PEG 400 (e.g., from about 97.5 to about 98.0% w/w, for example, about 97.75% w/w), PVP K30 (e.g., from about 1.8 to about 2.2% w/w, for example, about 2.0% w/w), and Compound 1 (e.g., from about 0.2 to about 0.3% w/w, for example, about 0.25% w/w).


In another embodiment, the formulation comprises PEG 400 (e.g., from about 97.2 to about 97.8, for example, about 97.50% w/w), PVP K30 (e.g., from about 1.8 to about 2.2% w/w, for example, about 2.0% w/w), and Compound 1 (e.g., from about 0.4 to about 0.6% w/w, for example, about 0.50% w/w).


In another embodiment, the formulation comprises PEG 400 (e.g., from about 96.5 to about 97.5% w/w, for example, about 97.0% w/w), PVP K30 (e.g., from about 1.8 to about 2.2% w/w, for example, about 2.0% w/w), and Compound 1 (e.g., from about 0.9 to about 1.1% w/w, for example, about 1.0% w/w).


In another embodiment, formulation comprises PEG 400 (e.g., from about 96.60 to about 96.65% w/w, for example, about 96.63% w/w), PVP K30 (e.g., from about 1.8 to about 2.2% w/w, for example, about 2.0% w/w), and Compound 1 (e.g., from about 1.30 to about 1.45% w/w, for example, about 1.38% w/w).


In another embodiment, the formulation comprises PEG 400 (e.g., from about 96.0 to about 96.3% w/w, for example, about 96.12% w/w), PVP K30 (e.g., from about 1.8 to about 2.0% w/w, for example, about 2.0% w/w), and Compound 1 (e.g., from about 1.8 to about 2.2% w/w, for example, about 1.88% w/w).


In another embodiment, the formulation comprises PEG 400 (e.g., from about 95.5 to about 96.0% w/w, for example, about 95.75% w/w), PVP K30 (e.g., from about 1.8 to about 2.2% w/w, for example, about 2.0% w/w), and Compound 1 (e.g., from about 2.0 to about 2.5% w/w, for example, about 2.25% w/w).


In another embodiment, the formulation comprises PEG 400 (e.g., from about 95 to about 96% w/w, for example, about 95.5% w/w), PVP K30 (e.g., from about 1.8 to about 2.2% w/w, for example, about 2.0% w/w), and Compound 1 (e.g., from about 2.3 to about 2.7% w/w, for example, about 2.50% w/w).


In another embodiment, the formulation comprises PEG 400 (e.g., from about 94.5 to about 94.8, for example, about 94.63% w/w), PVP K30 (e.g., from about 1.8 to about 2.2% w/w, for example, about 2.0% w/w), and Compound 1 (e.g., from about 3.5 to about 4.0% w/w, for example, about 3.38% w/w).


In another embodiment, the formulation comprises PEG 400 (e.g., from about 93.5 to about 94.5% w/w, for example, about 94.0% w/w), PVP K30 (e.g., from about 1.8 to about 2.2% w/w, for example, about 2.0% w/w), and Compound 1 (e.g., from about 3.7 to about 4.3% w/w, for example, about 4.0% w/w).


In one embodiment, the formulation comprises:

    • (i) Compound 1 or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof;
    • (ii) a suitable PEG lipid; and
    • (iii) PVP.


In some embodiments, the PEG lipid has an average molecular weight of from about 400 to about 600, for example, PEG 400. In some embodiments, the PVP is PVP K30.


The formulation comprises a therapeutically effective amount of Compound 1. The phrase “therapeutically effective amount” is that amount effective for treating or lessening the severity of any of the diseases, conditions, or disorders recited below.


IV.A.1.b. Preparation of Compound 1 First Formulation
Materials:





    • A Glass bottle for formulation preparation (250 cc amber glass with Teflon lined lid)

    • Glass bottle for dose confirmation sample (30 cc amber glass with Teflon lined lid)

    • Stir Plate with temperature probe (ensure probe has been cleaned)

    • New magnetic stir bar

    • Spatulas for dispensing excipient and active.





Step 1:

To a clean 250 cc amber glass bottle add the stir bar to the bottle and record the tare weight of the bottle, stir bar, label and cap. Tare the bottle with the label and stir bar.


Step 2:

Dispense targeted amount of PEG400 into the bottle and accurately weigh. Place the bottle on stir plate and stir to form a small vortex at the surface of the liquid (˜300-500 rpm or as necessary). Insert the cleaned temperature probe into the liquid to a depth of ˜1 cm and raise the setpoint of the heater to 40° C. Cover the bottle opening with aluminum foil. Allow the PEG400 to stabilize at 40+/−5° C.


Step 3:

Dispense the required amount of PVP K30 and add to the stirring PEG400. Add the PVP in a slow stream (over ˜2-3 minutes) and allow the particles to disperse. If the particles clump, the dissolution will take longer. Cover the bottle opening with foil and continue stirring the mixture at 40+/−5° C. The mixture should be sampled at 10 minutes using a small transfer pipette to determine if the PVP has completely dissolved. The stirring solution should also be examined for large, undissolved clumps. If the solution is clear, proceed to the next step. If undissolved polymer remains, continue stirring. Check for dissolution every 10 minutes, with a maximum stirring time of 30 minutes total. When complete dissolution is observed, proceed to the next step. If complete dissolution is not observed within 30 minutes after PVP addition, terminate preparation, discard the material, and start the preparation from the beginning.


Step 4:

Dispense the required amount of Compound 1 and add to the stirred PEG/PVP solution in a slow stream. Cover the bottle opening with foil and continue stirring the mixture at 40+/−5° C. The mixture should be sampled after 30 minutes using a small transfer pipette to determine if the Compound 1 has completely dissolved. If the solution is clear after 30 minutes, proceed to the next step. If undissolved Compound 1 remains, continue stirring. Check for dissolution every 30 minutes with a maximum stirring time of 300 minutes (5 hours) after addition of Compound 1. If complete dissolution is not observed within 300 minutes (5 hours) after addition of Compound 1, terminate preparation, discard the material, and start the preparation from the beginning.


Upon complete dissolution of the Compound 1, remove from the stir plate, and cap the bottle. The formulation should be maintained at room temperature until dosing, but must be dosed within 24 hours of preparation. If precipitation of Compound 1 is observed, do not dose the solution.


Using the above method, the following ten pharmaceutical formulations in Table 1-A were prepared.













TABLE 1-A





Composition
% PEG 400
% PVP
% Cmpd 1
Amount of Cmpd 1


#
w/w
K30 w/w
w/w
per 20 g dose (mg)



















1
97.875
2.0
0.125
25


2
97.750
2.0
0.250
50


3
97.500
2.0
0.500
100


4
97.000
2.0
1.000
200


5
96.625
2.0
1.375
275


6
96.125
2.0
1.875
375


7
95.750
2.0
2.25
450


8
95.500
2.0
2.500
500


9
94.625
2.0
3.375
675


10
94.000
2.0
4.000
800









IV.A.2. Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation
IV.A.2.a. Embodiments of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation

In one embodiment, the present invention provides a pharmaceutical composition comprising:

    • a. a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS;
    • b. a filler;
    • c. a disintegrant;
    • d. a surfactant;
    • e. a binder;
    • f. a glidant; and
    • g. a lubricant,


wherein the solid dispersion comprises about 100 mg of substantially amorphous Compound 1.


In one embodiment, the present invention provides a pharmaceutical composition comprising:

    • a. a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS;
    • b. a filler;
    • c. a disintegrant;
    • d. a surfactant;
    • e. a binder;
    • f. a glidant; and
    • g. a lubricant,


wherein the solid dispersion comprises about 150 mg of substantially amorphous Compound 1.


In one embodiment, the present invention provides a pharmaceutical composition comprising:

    • a. a solid dispersion of amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS;
    • b. a filler;
    • c. a disintegrant;
    • d. a surfactant;
    • e. a binder;
    • f. a glidant; and
    • g. a lubricant,


wherein the solid dispersion comprises about 100 mg of amorphous Compound 1.


In one embodiment, the present invention provides a pharmaceutical composition comprising:

    • a. a solid dispersion of amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS;
    • b. a filler;
    • c. a disintegrant;
    • d. a surfactant;
    • e. a binder;
    • f. a glidant; and
    • g. a lubricant,


wherein the solid dispersion comprises about 150 mg of amorphous Compound 1.


In some embodiments, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a solid dispersion a filler, a disintegrant, a surfactant, a binder, a glidant, and a lubricant, wherein the solid dispersion comprises from about 75 wt % to about 95 wt % (e.g., about 80 wt %) of Compound 1 by weight of the dispersion and a polymer.


In one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition of the present invention comprises a solid dispersion of Compound 1. For example, the solid dispersion comprises substantially amorphous Compound 1, where Compound 1 is less than about 15% (e.g., less than about 10% or less than about 5%) crystalline, and at least one polymer. In another example, the solid dispersion comprises amorphous Compound 1, i.e., Compound 1 has about 0% crystallinity. The concentration of Compound 1 in the solid dispersion depends on several factors such as the amount of pharmaceutical composition needed to provide a desired amount of Compound 1 and the desired dissolution profile of the pharmaceutical composition.


In another embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a solid dispersion that contains substantially amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS, in which the solid dispersion has a mean particle diameter, measured by light scattering (e.g., using a Malvern Mastersizer available from Malvern Instruments in England) of greater than about 5 μm (e.g., greater than about 6 μm, greater than about 7 μm, greater than about 8 μm, or greater than about 10 μm). For example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a solid dispersion that contains amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS, in which the solid dispersion has a mean particle diameter, measured by light scattering, of greater than about 5 μm (e.g., greater than about 6 μm, greater than about 7 μm, greater than about 8 μm, or greater than about 10 μm). In another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a solid dispersion comprising substantially amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS, in which the solid dispersion has a mean particle diameter, measured by light scattering, of from about 7 μm to about 25 μm. For instance, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a solid dispersion comprising amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS, in which the solid dispersion has a mean particle diameter, measured by light scattering, of from about 7 μm to about 25 μm. In yet another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a solid dispersion comprising substantially amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS, in which the solid dispersion has a mean particle diameter, measured by light scattering, of from about 10 μm to about 35 μm. For instance, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a solid dispersion comprising amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS, in which the solid dispersion has a mean particle diameter, measured by light scattering, of from about 10 μm to about 35 μm. In another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a solid dispersion comprising substantially amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS, in which the solid dispersion has a bulk density of about 0.10 g/cc or greater (e.g., 0.15 g/cc or greater, 0.17 g/cc or greater). For instance, the pharmaceutical composition comprising a solid dispersion comprising amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS, in which the solid dispersion has a bulk density of about 0.10 g/cc or greater (e.g., 0.15 g/cc or greater, 0.17 g/cc or greater). In another instance, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a solid dispersion that comprises substantially amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS, in which the solid dispersion has a bulk density of from about 0.10 g/cc to about 0.45 g/cc (e.g., from about 0.15 g/cc to about 0.42 g/cc, or from about 0.17 g/cc to about 0.40 g/cc). In still another instance, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a solid dispersion that includes amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS, in which the solid dispersion has a bulk density of from about 0.10 g/cc to about 0.45 g/cc (e.g., from about 0.15 g/cc to about 0.42 g/cc, or from about 0.17 g/cc to about 0.40 g/cc). In another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a solid dispersion that comprises substantially amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS, in which the solid dispersion has a bulk density of from about 0.10 g/cc to about 0.45 g/cc (e.g., from about 0.15 g/cc to about 0.42 g/cc, or from about 0.17 g/cc to about 0.40 g/cc). For instance, the pharmaceutical composition includes a solid dispersion that comprises amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS, in which the solid dispersion has a bulk density of from about 0.10 g/cc to about 0.45 g/cc (e.g., from about 0.15 g/cc to about 0.42 g/cc, or from about 0.17 g/cc to about 0.40 g/cc).


Other solid dispersions comprise from about 65 wt % to about 95 wt % (e.g., from about 67 wt % to about 92 wt %, from about 70 wt % to about 90 wt %, or from about 72 wt % to about 88 wt %) of substantially amorphous Compound 1 by weight of the solid dispersion and from about 45 wt % to about 5 wt % of polymer (e.g., HPMCAS). For instance, the solid dispersion comprises from about 65 wt % to about 95 wt % (e.g., from about 67 wt % to about 92 wt %, from about 70 wt % to about 90 wt %, or from about 72 wt % to about 88 wt %) of amorphous Compound 1 by weight of the solid dispersion and from about 45 wt % to about 5 wt % of polymer (e.g., HPMCAS).


Suitable surfactants include sodium lauryl sulfate (SLS), sodium stearyl fumarate (SSF), polyoxyethylene 20 sorbitan mono-oleate (e.g., Tween™), any combination thereof, or the like. In one example, the solid dispersion comprises less than 5 wt % (less than 3.0 wt %, less than 1.5 wt %, or less than 1.0 wt %) of surfactant by weight of solid dispersion. In another example, the solid dispersion comprises from about 0.30 wt % to about 0.80 wt % (e.g., from about 0.35 wt % to about 0.70 wt %, from about 0.40 wt % to about 0.60 wt %, or from about 0.45 wt % to about 0.55 wt %) of surfactant by weight of solid dispersion.


In alternative embodiments, the solid dispersion comprises from about 45 wt % to about 85 wt % of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1, from about 0.45 wt % to about 0.55 wt % of SLS, and from about 14.45 wt % to about 55.55 wt % of HPMCAS by weight of the solid dispersion. One exemplary solid dispersion contains about 80 wt % of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1, about 19.5 wt % of HPMCAS, and about 0.5 wt % of SLS.


Fillers suitable for the present invention are compatible with the ingredients of the pharmaceutical composition, i.e., they do not substantially reduce the solubility, the hardness, the chemical stability, the physical stability, or the biological activity of the pharmaceutical composition. Exemplary fillers include lactose, sorbitol, celluloses, calcium phosphates, starches, sugars (e.g., mannitol, sucrose, or the like), or any combination thereof. In one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises at least one filler in an amount of at least about 10 wt % (e.g., at least about 20 wt %, at least about 25 wt %, or at least about 27 wt %) by weight of the composition. For example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 10 wt % to about 60 wt % (e.g., from about 20 wt % to about 55 wt %, from about 25 wt % to about 50 wt %, or from about 27 wt % to about 45 wt %) of filler, by weight of the composition. In another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises at least about 20 wt % (e.g., at least 25 wt % or at least 27 wt %) of lactose, by weight of the composition. In yet another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 20 wt % to about 60 wt % (e.g., from about 25 wt % to about 55 wt % or from about 27 wt % to about 45 wt %) of lactose, by weight of the composition.


Disintegrants suitable for the present invention enhance the dispersal of the pharmaceutical composition and are compatible with the ingredients of the pharmaceutical composition, i.e., they do not substantially reduce the chemical stability, the physical stability, the hardness, or the biological activity of the pharmaceutical composition. Exemplary disintegrants include sodium croscarmellose, sodium starch glycolate, or a combination thereof. In one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises disintegrant in an amount of about 10 wt % or less (e.g., about 7 wt % or less, about 6 wt % or less, or about 5 wt % or less) by weight of the composition. For example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 1 wt % to about 10 wt % (e.g., from about 1.5 wt % to about 7.5 wt % or from about 2.5 wt % to about 6 wt %) of disintegrant, by weight of the composition. In another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises about 10 wt % or less (e.g., 7 wt % or less, 6 wt % or less, or 5 wt % or less) of sodium croscarmellose, by weight of the composition. In yet another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 1 wt % to about 10 wt % (e.g., from about 1.5 wt % to about 7.5 wt % or from about 2.5 wt % to about 6 wt %) of sodium croscarmellose, by weight of the composition. In some examples, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 0.1% to about 10 wt % (e.g., from about 0.5 wt % to about 7.5 wt % or from about 1.5 wt % to about 6 wt %) of disintegrant, by weight of the composition. In still other examples, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 0.5% to about 10 wt % (e.g., from about 1.5 wt % to about 7.5 wt % or from about 2.5 wt % to about 6 wt %) of disintegrant, by weight of the composition.


Surfactants suitable for the present invention enhance the solubility of the pharmaceutical composition and are compatible with the ingredients of the pharmaceutical composition, i.e., they do not substantially reduce the chemical stability, the physical stability, the hardness, or the biological activity of the pharmaceutical composition. Exemplary surfactants include sodium lauryl sulfate (SLS), sodium stearyl fumarate (SSF), polyoxyethylene 20 sorbitan mono-oleate (e.g., Tween™), any combination thereof, or the like. In one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a surfactant in an amount of about 10 wt % or less (e.g., about 5 wt % or less, about 2 wt % or less, about 1 wt % or less, about 0.8 wt % or less, or about 0.6 wt % or less) by weight of the composition. For example, the pharmaceutical composition includes from about 10 wt % to about 0.1 wt % (e.g., from about 5 wt % to about 0.2 wt % or from about 2 wt % to about 0.3 wt %) of surfactant, by weight of the composition. In another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises 10 wt % or less (e.g., about 5 wt % or less, about 2 wt % or less, about 1 wt % or less, about 0.8 wt % or less, or about 0.6 wt % or less) of sodium lauryl sulfate, by weight of the composition. In yet another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 10 wt % to about 0.1 wt % (e.g., from about 5 wt % to about 0.2 wt % or from about 2 wt % to about 0.3 wt %) of sodium lauryl sulfate, by weight of the composition.


Binders suitable for the present invention enhance the tablet strength of the pharmaceutical composition and are compatible with the ingredients of the pharmaceutical composition, i.e., they do not substantially reduce the chemical stability, the physical stability, or the biological activity of the pharmaceutical composition. Exemplary binders include microcrystalline cellulose, dibasic calcium phosphate, sucrose, corn (maize) starch, modified cellulose (e.g., hydroxymethyl cellulose), or any combination thereof. In one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a binder in an amount of at least about 1 wt % (e.g., at least about 10 wt %, at least about 15 wt %, at least about 20 wt %, or at least about 22 wt %) by weight of the composition. For example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 5 wt % to about 50 wt % (e.g., from about 10 wt % to about 45 wt % or from about 20 wt % to about 45 wt %) of binder, by weight of the composition. In another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises at least about 1 wt % (e.g., at least about 10 wt %, at least about 15 wt %, at least about 20 wt %, or at least about 22 wt %) of microcrystalline cellulose, by weight of the composition. In yet another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 5 wt % to about 50 wt % (e.g., from about 10 wt % to about 45 wt % or from about 20 wt % to about 45 wt %) of microcrystalline cellulose, by weight of the composition.


Glidants suitable for the present invention enhance the flow properties of the pharmaceutical composition and are compatible with the ingredients of the pharmaceutical composition, i.e., they do not substantially reduce the solubility, the hardness, the chemical stability, the physical stability, or the biological activity of the pharmaceutical composition. Exemplary glidants include colloidal silicon dioxide, talc, or a combination thereof. In one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a glidant in an amount of 2 wt % or less (e.g., 1.75 wt %, 1.25 wt % or less, or 1.00 wt % or less) by weight of the composition. For example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 2 wt % to about 0.05 wt % (e.g., from about 1.5 wt % to about 0.07 wt % or from about 1.0 wt % to about 0.09 wt %) of glidant, by weight of the composition. In another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises 2 wt % or less (e.g., 1.75 wt %, 1.25 wt % or less, or 1.00 wt % or less) of colloidal silicon dioxide, by weight of the composition. In yet another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 2 wt % to about 0.05 wt % (e.g., from about 1.5 wt % to about 0.07 wt % or from about 1.0 wt % to about 0.09 wt %) of colloidal silicon dioxide, by weight of the composition.


Lubricants suitable for the present invention improve the compression and ejection of compressed pharmaceutical compositions from a die press and are compatible with the ingredients of the pharmaceutical composition, i.e., they do not substantially reduce the solubility, the hardness, or the biological activity of the pharmaceutical composition. Exemplary lubricants include magnesium stearate, stearic acid (stearin), hydrogenated oil, sodium stearyl fumarate, or any combination thereof. In one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a lubricant in an amount of 2 wt % or less (e.g., 1.75 wt %, 1.25 wt % or less, or 1.00 wt % or less) by weight of the composition. For example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 2 wt % to about 0.10 wt % (e.g., from about 1.5 wt % to about 0.15 wt % or from about 1.3 wt % to about 0.30 wt %) of lubricant, by weight of the composition. In another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises 2 wt % or less (e.g., 1.75 wt %, 1.25 wt % or less, or 1.00 wt % or less) of magnesium stearate, by weight of the composition. In yet another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 2 wt % to about 0.10 wt % (e.g., from about 1.5 wt % to about 0.15 wt % or from about 1.3 wt % to about 0.30 wt %) of magnesium stearate, by weight of the composition.


Pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention can optionally comprise one or more colorants, flavors, and/or fragrances to enhance the visual appeal, taste, and/or scent of the composition. Suitable colorants, flavors, or fragrances are compatible with the ingredients of the pharmaceutical composition, i.e., they do not substantially reduce the solubility, the chemical stability, the physical stability, the hardness, or the biological activity of the pharmaceutical composition. In one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a colorant, a flavor, and/or a fragrance. For example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises less than about 1 wt % (e.g., less than about 0.75 wt % or less than about 0.5 wt %) of each optionally ingredient, i.e., colorant, flavor and/or fragrance, by weight of the composition. In another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises less than about 1 wt % (e.g., less than about 0.75 wt % or less than about 0.5 wt %) of a colorant. In still another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises less than about 1 wt % (e.g., less than about 0.75 wt % or less than about 0.5 wt %) of a blue colorant (e.g., FD&C Blue #1 and/or FD&C Blue #2 Aluminum Lake, commercially available from Colorcon, Inc. of West Point, Pa.)


In some embodiments, the pharmaceutical composition can be made into tablets and the tablets can be coated with a colorant and optionally labeled with a logo, other image and/or text using a suitable ink. In still other embodiments, the pharmaceutical composition can be made into tablets and the tablets can be coated with a colorant, waxed, and optionally labeled with a logo, other image and/or text using a suitable ink. Suitable colorants and inks are compatible with the ingredients of the pharmaceutical composition, i.e., they do not substantially reduce the solubility, the chemical stability, the physical stability, the hardness, or the biological activity of the pharmaceutical composition. The suitable colorants and inks can be any color and are water based or solvent based. In one embodiment, tablets made from the pharmaceutical composition are coated with a colorant and then labeled with a logo, other image, and/or text using a suitable ink. For example, tablets comprising pharmaceutical composition as described herein can be coated with about 3 wt % (e.g., less than about 6 wt % or less than about 4 wt %) of film coating comprising a colorant. The colored tablets can be labeled with a logo and text indicating the strength of the active ingredient in the tablet using a suitable ink. In another example, tablets comprising pharmaceutical composition as described herein can be coated with about 3 wt % (e.g., less than about 6 wt % or less than about 4 wt %) of a film coating comprising a blue colorant (e.g., OPADRY® II, commercially available from Colorcon, Inc. of West Point, Pa.). The colored tablets can be labeled with a logo and text indicating the strength of the active ingredient in the tablet using a black ink (e.g., Opacode® WB, commercially available from Colorcon, Inc. of West Point, Pa.). In another embodiment, tablets made from the pharmaceutical composition are coated with a colorant, waxed, and then labeled with a logo, other image, and/or text using a suitable ink. For example, tablets comprising pharmaceutical composition as described herein can be coated with about 3 wt % (e.g., less than about 6 wt % or less than about 4 wt %) of film coating comprising a colorant. The colored tablets can be waxed with Carnauba wax powder weighed out in the amount of about 0.01% w/w of the starting tablet core weight. The waxed tablets can be labeled with a logo and text indicating the strength of the active ingredient in the tablet using a suitable ink. In another example, tablets comprising pharmaceutical composition as described herein can be coated with about 3 wt % (e.g., less than about 6 wt % or less than about 4 wt %) of a film coating comprising a blue colorant (e.g., OPADRY® II, commercially available from Colorcon, Inc. of West Point, Pa.). The colored tablets can be waxed with Carnauba wax powder weighed out in the amount of about 0.01% w/w of the starting tablet core weight. The waxed tablets can be labeled with a logo and text indicating the strength of the active ingredient in the tablet using a black ink (e.g., Opacode® S-1-17823—a solvent based ink, commercially available from Colorcon, Inc. of West Point, Pa.).


Another exemplary pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 5 wt % to about 50 wt % (e.g., from about 5 wt % to about 25 wt %, from about 15 wt % to about 40 wt %, or from about 30 wt % to about 50 wt %) of a solid dispersion, by weight of the composition, comprising from about 70 wt % to about 90 wt % of substantially amorphous Compound 1, by weight of the dispersion, and from about 30 wt % to about 10 wt % of a polymer, by weight of the dispersion; from about 25 wt % to about 50 wt % of a filler; from about 1 wt % to about 10 wt % of a disintegrant; from about 2 wt % to about 0.3 wt % of a surfactant; from about 5 wt % to about 50 wt % of a binder; from about 2 wt % to about 0.05 wt % of a glidant; and from about 2 wt % to about 0.1 wt % of a lubricant. Or, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 5 wt % to about 50 wt % (e.g., from about 5 wt % to about 25 wt %, from about 15 wt % to about 40 wt %, or from about 30 wt % to about 50 wt %) of a solid dispersion, by weight of the composition, comprising from about 70 wt % to about 90 wt % of amorphous Compound 1, by weight of the dispersion, and from about 30 wt % to about 10 wt % of a polymer, by weight of the dispersion; from about 25 wt % to about 50 wt % of a filler; from about 1 wt % to about 10 wt % of a disintegrant; from about 2 wt % to about 0.3 wt % of a surfactant; from about 5 wt % to about 50 wt % of a binder; from about 2 wt % to about 0.05 wt % of a glidant; and from about 2 wt % to about 0.1 wt % of a lubricant.


In another pharmaceutical composition of the present invention, a caplet shaped pharmaceutical tablet composition having an initial hardness of between about 6 and 16 Kp comprises about 34.1 wt % of a solid dispersion by weight of the composition, wherein the dispersion comprises about 80 wt % of substantially amorphous Compound 1 by weight of the dispersion, about 19.5 wt % of HPMCAS by weight of the dispersion, and about 0.5 wt % SLS by weight of the dispersion; about 30.5 wt % of microcrystalline cellulose by weight of the composition; about 30.4 wt % of lactose by weight of the composition; about 3 wt % of sodium croscarmellose by weight of the composition; about 0.5 wt % of SLS by weight of the composition; about 0.5 wt % of colloidal silicon dioxide by weight of the composition; and about 1 wt % of magnesium stearate by weight of the composition. In some aspects, the caplet shaped pharmaceutical tablet composition contains 100 mg of Compound 1. In some further aspects, the caplet shaped pharmaceutical tablet composition comprises a colorant coated, a wax coating, and a printed logo or text. In some embodiments of this aspect, the caplet shaped pharmaceutical tablet includes a blue OPADRY® II coating and a water or solvent based ink logo or text. In some instances, the colorant coating is blue OPADRY® II. In some instances, the wax coating comprises Carnauba wax. In certain aspects, the ink for the printed logo or text is a solvent based ink. In some aspects, the caplet shaped pharmaceutical tablet composition contains 150 mg of Compound 1.


In still another pharmaceutical composition of the present invention, a pharmaceutical tablet composition having an initial hardness of between about 9 and 21 Kp comprises about 34.1 wt % of a solid dispersion by weight of the composition, wherein the dispersion comprises about 80 wt % of substantially amorphous Compound 1 by weight of the dispersion, about 19.5 wt % of HPMCAS by weight of the dispersion, and about 0.5 wt % SLS by weight of the dispersion; about 30.5 wt % of microcrystalline cellulose by weight of the composition; about 30.4 wt % of lactose by weight of the composition; about 3 wt % of sodium croscarmellose by weight of the composition; about 0.5 wt % of SLS by weight of the composition; about 0.5 wt % of colloidal silicon dioxide by weight of the composition; and about 1 wt % of magnesium stearate by weight of the composition. In some embodiments, the caplet shaped pharmaceutical tablet composition contains 150 mg of Compound 1. In some aspects, the caplet shaped pharmaceutical tablet composition further comprises a colorant coated, a wax coating, and a printed logo or text. In some instances, the tablet includes a blue OPADRY® II coating and a water or solvent based ink logo or text. In still other instances, the wax coating comprises Carnauba wax. In some embodiments, the ink for the printed logo or text is a solvent based ink. In some aspects, the caplet shaped pharmaceutical tablet composition contains 100 mg of Compound 1.


In another pharmaceutical composition of the present invention, a pharmaceutical composition comprises about 34.1 wt % of a solid dispersion by weight of the composition, wherein the dispersion comprises about 80 wt % of substantially amorphous Compound 1 by weight of the dispersion, about 19.5 wt % of HPMCAS by weight of the dispersion, and about 0.5 wt % SLS by weight of the dispersion; about 30.5 wt % of microcrystalline cellulose by weight of the composition; about 30.4 wt % of lactose by weight of the composition; about 3 wt % of sodium croscarmellose by weight of the composition; about 0.5 wt % of SLS by weight of the composition; about 0.5 wt % of colloidal silicon dioxide by weight of the composition; and about 1 wt % of magnesium stearate by weight of the composition. In some aspects, the pharmaceutical tablet contains 100 mg of Compound 1. In other embodiments, the pharmaceutical composition contains 150 mg of Compound 1. In some further aspects, the pharmaceutical composition is formed as a tablet and comprises a colorant coated, a wax coating, and a printed logo or text. In some embodiments of this aspect, the pharmaceutical tablet includes a blue OPADRY® II coating and a water or solvent based ink logo or text. In some instances, the colorant coating is blue OPADRY® II. In some instances, the wax coating comprises Carnauba wax. In certain aspects, the ink for the printed logo or text is a solvent based ink.


Another aspect of the present invention provides a pharmaceutical composition consisting of a tablet that includes a CF potentiator API (e.g., a solid dispersion of N-[2,4-bis(1,1-dimethylethyl)-5-hydroxyphenyl]-1,4-dihydro-4-oxoquinoline-3-carboxamide) and other excipients (e.g., a filler, a disintegrant, a surfactant, a binder, a glidant, a colorant, a lubricant, or any combination thereof), each of which is described above and in the Examples below, wherein the tablet has a dissolution of at least about 50% (e.g., at least about 60%, at least about 70%, at least about 80%, at least about 90%, or at least about 99%) in about 30 minutes. In one example, the pharmaceutical composition consists of a tablet that includes a CF potentiator API (e.g., a solid dispersion of Compound 1) and other excipients (e.g., a filler, a disintegrant, a surfactant, a binder, a glidant, a colorant, a lubricant, or any combination thereof), each of which is described above and in the Examples below, wherein the tablet has a dissolution of from about 50% to about 100% (e.g., from about 55% to about 95% or from about 60% to about 90%) in about 30 minutes. In another example, the pharmaceutical composition consists of a tablet that comprises a solid dispersion comprising substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS; and, a filler, a disintegrant, a surfactant, a binder, a glidant, and a lubricant, wherein the tablet has a dissolution of at least about 50% (e.g., at least about 60%, at least about 70%, at least about 80%, at least about 90%, or at least about 99%) in about 30 minutes. In still another example, the pharmaceutical composition consists of a tablet that comprises a solid dispersion comprising substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS; and, a filler, a disintegrant, a surfactant, a binder, a glidant, and a lubricant, wherein the tablet has a dissolution of from about 50% to about 100% (e.g., from about 55% to about 95% or from about 60% to about 90%) in about 30 minutes.


In one embodiment, the tablet comprises a solid dispersion comprising at least about 100 mg, or at least 150 mg of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1; and HPMCAS and SLS.


Dissolution can be measured with a standard USP Type II apparatus that employs a dissolution media of 0.6% sodium lauryl sulfate dissolved in 900 mL of DI water, stirring at about 50-75 rpm at a temperature of about 37° C. A single experimental tablet is tested in each test vessel of the apparatus. Dissolution can also be measured with a standard USP Type II apparatus that employs a dissolution media of 0.7% sodium lauryl sulfate dissolved in 900 mL of 50 mM sodium phosphate buffer (pH 6.8), stirring at about 65 rpm at a temperature of about 37° C. A single experimental tablet is tested in each test vessel of the apparatus. Dissolution can also be measured with a standard USP Type II apparatus that employs a dissolution media of 0.5% sodium lauryl sulfate dissolved in 900 mL of 50 mM sodium phosphate buffer (pH 6.8), stirring at about 65 rpm at a temperature of about 37° C. A single experimental tablet is tested in each test vessel of the apparatus.


Another aspect of the present invention provides a pharmaceutical composition consisting of a tablet that comprises a CF potentiator API (e.g., a solid dispersion of Compound 1) and other excipients (e.g., a filler, a disintegrant, a surfactant, a binder, a glidant, a colorant, a lubricant, or any combination thereof), each of which is described above and in the Examples below, wherein the tablet has a hardness of at least about 5 Kp. In one example, the pharmaceutical composition consists of a tablet that comprises a CF potentiator API (e.g., a solid dispersion of Compound 1) and other excipients (e.g., a filler, a disintegrant, a surfactant, a binder, a glidant, a colorant, a lubricant, or any combination thereof), each of which is described above and in the Examples below, wherein the tablet has a hardness of at least about 5 Kp (e.g., at least about 5.5, at least about 6 Kp, or at least about 7 Kp).


IV.A.2.b. Preparation of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation

Another aspect of the present invention provides a method of producing a pharmaceutical composition comprising providing an admixture of a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1, a binder, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler, and compressing the admixture into a tablet having a dissolution of at least about 50% in about 30 minutes.


Each of the ingredients of this admixture is described above and in the Examples below. Furthermore, the admixture can comprise optional additives such as one or more colorants, one or more flavors, and/or one or more fragrances as described above and in the Examples below. And, the relative concentrations (e.g., wt %) of each of these ingredients (and any optional additives) in the admixture is also presented above and in the Examples below. The ingredients constituting the admixture can be provided sequentially or in any combination of additions; and, the ingredients or combination of ingredients can be provided in any order. In one embodiment the lubricant is the last component added to the admixture.


In one embodiment, the admixture comprises a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous Compound 1, a binder, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler, wherein each of these ingredients is provided in a powder form (e.g., provided as particles having a mean diameter, measured by light scattering, of 250 μm or less (e.g., 150 μm or less, 100 μm or less, 50 μm or less, 45 μm or less, 40 μm or less, or 35 μm or less)). For instance, the admixture comprises a solid dispersion of amorphous Compound 1, a binder, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler, wherein each of these ingredients is provided in a powder form (e.g., provided as particles having a mean diameter, measured by light scattering, of 250 μm or less (e.g., 150 μm or less, 100 μm or less, 50 μm or less, 45 μm or less, 40 μm or less, or 35 μm or less)).


In another embodiment, the admixture comprises a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous Compound 1, a binder, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler, wherein each of these ingredients is substantially free of water. Each of the ingredients comprises less than 5 wt % (e.g., less than 2 wt %, less than 1 wt %, less than 0.75 wt %, less than 0.5 wt %, or less than 0.25 wt %) of water by weight of the ingredient. For instance, the admixture comprises a solid dispersion of amorphous Compound 1, a binder, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler, wherein each of these ingredients is substantially free of water. Each of the ingredients comprises less than 5 wt % (e.g., less than 2 wt %, less than 1 wt %, less than 0.75 wt %, less than 0.5 wt %, or less than 0.25 wt %) of water by weight of the ingredient.


In another embodiment, compressing the admixture into a tablet is accomplished by filling a form (e.g., a mold) with the admixture and applying pressure to admixture. This can be accomplished using a die press or other similar apparatus. It is also noted that the application of pressure to the admixture in the form can be repeated using the same pressure during each compression or using different pressures during the compressions. In another example, the admixture is compressed using a die press that applies sufficient pressure to form a tablet having a dissolution of about 50% or more at about 30 minutes (e.g., about 55% or more at about 30 minutes or about 60% or more at about 30 minutes). For instance, the admixture is compressed using a die press to produce a tablet hardness of at least about 5 Kp (at least about 5.5 Kp, at least about 6 Kp, at least about 7 Kp, at least about 11 Kp, or at least 21Kp). In some instances, the admixture is compressed to produce a tablet hardness of between about 6 and 21 Kp.


In some embodiments, tablets comprising a pharmaceutical composition as described herein can be coated with about 3.0 wt % of a film coating comprising a colorant by weight of the tablet. In certain instances, the colorant suspension or solution used to coat the tablets comprises about 20% w/w of solids by weight of the colorant suspension or solution. In still further instances, the coated tablets can be labeled with a logo, other image or text.


In another embodiment, the method of producing a pharmaceutical composition comprises providing an admixture of a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous Compound 1, a binder, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler; mixing the admixture until the admixture is substantially homogenous, and compressing the admixture into a tablet as described above or in the Examples below. Or, the method of producing a pharmaceutical composition comprises providing an admixture of a solid dispersion of amorphous Compound 1, a binder, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler; mixing the admixture until the admixture is substantially homogenous, and compressing the admixture into a tablet as described above or in the Examples below. For example, the admixture is mixed by stirring, blending, shaking, or the like using hand mixing, a mixer, a blender, any combination thereof, or the like. When ingredients or combinations of ingredients are added sequentially, mixing can occur between successive additions, continuously throughout the ingredient addition, after the addition of all of the ingredients or combinations of ingredients, or any combination thereof. The admixture is mixed until it has a substantially homogenous composition.


Intermediate F


A solvent system of MEK and DI water, formulated according to the ratio 90 wt % MEK/10 wt % DI water, was heated to a temperature of 20-30° C. in a reactor, equipped with a magnetic stirrer and thermal circuit. Into this solvent system, hypromellose acetate succinate polymer (HPMCAS)(HG grade), SLS, and Compound 1 were added according to the ratio 19.5 wt % hypromellose acetate succinate/0.5 wt % SLS/80 wt % Compound 1. The resulting mixture contained 10.5 wt % solids. The actual amounts of ingredients and solvents used to generate this mixture are recited in Table 1-F1.









TABLE 1-F1







Solid Spray Dispersion Ingredients for Intermediate F.










Units
Batch















Compound 1
Kg
70.0



HPMCAS
Kg
17.1



SLS
Kg
0.438



Total Solids
Kg
87.5



MEK
Kg
671



Water
Kg
74.6



Total Solvents
Kg
746



Total Spray Solution Weight
Kg
833










The mixture temperature was adjusted to a range of 20-45° C. and mixed until it was substantially homogenous and all components were substantially dissolved.


A spray drier, Niro PSD4 Commercial Spray Dryer, fitted with pressure nozzle (Spray Systems Maximum Passage series SK-MFP having orifice/core size 54/21) equipped with anti-bearding cap, was used under normal spray drying mode, following the dry spray process parameters recited in Table 1-F2.









TABLE 1-F2







Dry Spray Process Parameters Used to Generate Intermediate F.










Parameter
Value







Feed Pressure
20 bar



Feed Flow Rate
92-100 Kg/hr



Inlet Temperature
93-99° C.



Outlet Temperature
53-57° C.



Vacuum Dryer Temperature
80° C. for 2 hours then




110° C. (+/−5° C.)



Vacuum Drying Time
20-24 hours










A high efficiency cyclone separated the wet product from the spray gas and solvent vapors. The wet product contained 8.5-9.7% MEK and 0.56-0.83% Water and had a mean particle size of 17-19 um and a bulk density of 0.27-0.33 g/cc. The wet product was transferred to a 4000 L stainless steel double cone vacuum dryer for drying to reduce residual solvents to a level of less than about 5000 ppm and to generate dry Intermediate F. The dry Intermediate F contained <0.03% MEK and 0.3% Water.


Intermediate G


A solvent system of MEK and DI water, formulated according to the ratio 90 wt % MEK/10 wt % DI water, was heated to a temperature of 20-30° C. in a reactor, equipped with a magnetic stirrer and thermal circuit. Into this solvent system, hypromellose acetate succinate polymer (HPMCAS)(HG grade), SLS, and Compound 1 were added according to the ratio 19.5 wt % hypromellose acetate succinate/0.5 wt % SLS/80 wt % Compound 1. The resulting mixture contained 10.5 wt % solids. The actual amounts of ingredients and solvents used to generate this mixture are recited in Table 1-G1.









TABLE 1-G1







Solid Spray Dispersion Ingredients for Intermediate G.










Units
Batch















Compound 1
Kg
24.0



HPMCAS
Kg
5.85



SLS
Kg
0.15



Total Solids
Kg
30.0



MEK
Kg
230.1



Water
Kg
25.6



Total Solvents
Kg
255.7



Total Spray Solution Weight
Kg
285.7










The mixture temperature was adjusted to a range of 20-45° C. and mixed until it was substantially homogenous and all components were substantially dissolved.


A spray drier, Niro Production Minor Spray Dryer, fitted with pressure nozzle (Spray Systems Maximum Passage series SK-MFP having orifice size 72) was used under normal spray drying mode, following the dry spray process parameters recited in Table 1-G2.









TABLE 1-G2







Dry Spray Process Parameters Used to Generate Intermediate G.










Parameter
Value







Feed Pressure
33 bar



Feed Flow Rate
18-24 Kg/hr



Inlet Temperature
82-84° C.



Outlet Temperature
44-46° C.



Vacuum Dryer Temperature
80° C. for 2 hours then




110° C. (+/−5° C.)



Vacuum Drying Time
48 hours










A high efficiency cyclone separated the wet product from the spray gas and solvent vapors. The wet product contained 10.8% MEK and 0.7% Water and had a mean particle size of 19 um and a bulk density of 0.32 g/cc. The wet product was transferred to a 4000 L stainless steel double cone vacuum dryer for drying to reduce residual solvents to a level of less than about 5000 ppm and to generate dry Intermediate. The dry Intermediate G contained <0.05% MEK and 0.7% Water.


Intermediate H


A solvent system of MEK and DI water, formulated according to the ratio 90 wt % MEK/10 wt % DI water, was heated to a temperature of 20-30° C. in a reactor, equipped with a magnetic stirrer and thermal circuit. Into this solvent system, hypromellose acetate succinate polymer (HPMCAS)(HG grade), SLS, and Compound 1 were added according to the ratio 19.5 wt % hypromellose acetate succinate/0.5 wt % SLS/80 wt % Compound 1. The actual amounts of ingredients and solvents used to generate this mixture are recited in Table 1-H1:









TABLE 1-H1







Solid Spray Dispersion Ingredients for Intermediate H.










Units
Batch















Compound 1
Kg
56.0



HPMCAS
Kg
13.65



SLS
Kg
0.35



Total Solids
Kg
70.0



MEK
Kg
509.73



Water
Kg
56.64



Total Solvents
Kg
566.40



Total Spray Solution Weight
Kg
636.40










The mixture temperature was adjusted to a range of 20-30° C. and mixed until it was substantially homogenous and all components were substantially dissolved.


A spray drier, Niro Production Minor Spray Dryer, fitted with pressure nozzle (Spray Systems Maximum Passage series SK-MFP having orifice size #52 or #54, e.g., about 1.39-1.62 mm) was used under normal spray drying mode, following the dry spray process parameters recited in Table 1-H2.









TABLE 1-H2







Dry Spray Process Parameters Used to Generate Intermediate H.










Parameter
Value







Feed Pressure
20-50 bar



Feed Flow Rate
18-24 Kg/hr



Inlet Temperature
−7 to 7° C.



Outlet Temperature
30-70° C.










A high efficiency cyclone separated the wet product from the spray gas and solvent vapors. The wet product contained approximately 10.8% MEK and 0.7% Water and had a mean particle size of about 19 μm and a bulk density of about 0.33 g/cc.


An inertial cyclone is used to separate the spray dried intermediate from the process gas and solvent vapors. Particle size is monitored on-line. The spray dried intermediate is collected in an intermediate bulk container. The process gas and solvent vapors are passed through a filter bag to collect the fine particles not separated by the cyclone. The resultant gas is condensed to remove process vapors and recycled back to the heater and spray dryer. The spray dried intermediate will be stored at less than 30° C., if secondary drying will occur in less than 24 hours or between 2-8° C., if secondary drying will occur in more than 24 hours.


Secondary drying occurs by charging a 4000-L biconical dryer having a jacket temperature between about 20-30° C. with the spray dried intermediate. The vacuum pressure, jacket temperature, and nitrogen bleed are set at between about −0.8 psig and about −1.0 psig, between about 80-120° C., and between about 0.5-8.0 m3/h, respectively. Agitation is set at 1 rpm. Bulk samples of the spray dried intermediate are tested for MEK (GC), every 4 hours until dry. The MEK drying rate is monitored on-line by GC-MS, calibrated for MEK concentration. Upon reaching a plateau in the drying of the residual MEK, heating in the biconical dryer is discontinued while continuing rotation until the spray dried intermediate reaches a temperature less than or equal to 50° C.


Although Intermediates F through H are described above as being formed, in part, by admixing the solid spray dispersion ingredients with application of heat to form a homogeneous mixture, the solid spray dispersion ingredients can also be mixed without application of heat to form a mixture of the solid spray dispersion ingredients.


Tablets
Example 8
Exemplary Tablet 9 (Formulated with HPMCAS Polymer to have 100 mg of Compound 1)

A batch of caplet-shaped tablets was formulated to have about 100 mg of Compound 1 per tablet using the amounts of ingredients recited in Table 1-8.









TABLE 1-8







Ingredients for Exemplary Tablet 9.











Percent Dose
Dose
Batch


Tablet Formulation
% Wt./Wt.
(mg)
(g)













Intermediate F
34.09%
125.1
23.86


Microcrystalline cellulose
30.51%
112.0
21.36


Lactose
30.40%
111.6
21.28


Sodium croscarmellose
3.000%
11.01
2.100


SLS
0.500%
1.835
0.3500


Colloidal silicon dioxide
0.500%
1.835
0.3500


Magnesium stearate
1.000%
3.670
0.7000


Total
  100%
367
70









The colloidal silicon dioxide (Cabot Cab-O-Sil® M-5P Fumed Silicon Dioxide) and the microcrystalline cellulose (FMC MCC Avicel® PH102) were passed through a 30 mesh screen.


The sodium croscarmellose (FMC Ac-Di-Sol®), SLS, Intermediate F, and lactose (Foremost FastFlo® Lactose #316) were also passed, individually in the preceding order, through the same 30 mesh screen. A nitrogen purge was used when screening Intermediate F. The screened components were loaded into a 10 cubic feet V-blender, which was purged with nitrogen, and blended for about 180 (+/−10) inversions.


The Magnesium Stearate was filtered through a 40 mesh screen sieve into the blending container and mixed to provide about 54 inversions.


The resulting mixture was compressed into tablets using a fully tooled 36 Fette 2090 press with 0.568″×0.2885″ caplet type B tooling set to produce a tablet having an initial target hardness of about 10 Kp±20%.


Example 9
Exemplary Tablet 10 (Tablet 9 with Spray-Coating)

A batch of caplet-shaped tablets from Example 8 was spray-coated with OPADRY® II (Blue, Colorcon) to a weight gain of about 3.0% using a 24″ coating pan configured with the parameters in Table 1-9 followed by wax coating and then printing using Opacode® S-1-17823 (Solvent based Black, Colorcon).









TABLE 1-9







Spray-Coating Process Parameters










Coating Parameters 24″ Pan
Target














Pan Load (kg)
14



Inlet Temperature (° C.)*
*



Pan Speed (rpm)
10



Jog Time (sec)



# of Spray Guns
2



Solids Content (% w/w)
20



Gun to Bed Distance (inches)
6



Inlet Air Flow (cfm)
300



Spray Rate (g/min)
35



Exhaust Temperature (° C.)
50



Atomization Pressure (psi)
42







*Inlet temperature is monitored to achieve target exhaust temperature. Initial inlet temperature should be set at about 75° C. to achieve target exhaust temp.






The OPADRY® II suspension was prepared by measuring an amount of de-ionized water which when combined with OPADRY® II would produce a total solids content of 20% w/w. The water is mixed to a vortex followed by addition of OPADRY® II over a period of approximately 5 minutes. Once the OPADRY® II powder was wetted, mixing was continued to ensure that all solid material is well-dispersed. The suspension is then charged into a Thomas 24″ pan coating instrument using coating conditions outlined in Table 1-9.


Uncoated tablets are placed into the coating pan and pre-warmed. The inlet was increased from room temperature to about 55° C. and then increased as necessary to provide the exhaust temperature in Table 1-9. The coating process was performed with 20% w/w OPADRY® II (85 Series Blue) coating dispersion to obtain a target weight gain of about 3%. The coated tablets were then allowed to tumble for about 2 minutes without spraying. The bed temperature was then allowed to cool to about 35° C.


Upon cooling, the Carnauba wax powder was weighed out in the amount of about 0.01% w/w of the starting tablet core weight. With the air flow off, the carnauba wax powder was sprinkled evenly on the tablet bed. The pan bed was turned on to the speed indicated in Table 1-9. After 5 minutes, the air flow was turned on (without heating) to the setting indicated in Table 1-9. After about one minute the air flow and pan were turned off.


Once coated with OPADRY® II, the tablets are then labeled using a Hartnett Delta tablet printer charged with Opacode® S-1-17823.


Example 10
Exemplary Tablet 11 (Formulated with HPMCAS Polymer to have 150 mg of Compound 1)

A batch of caplet-shaped tablets was formulated to have about 150 mg of Compound 1 per tablet using the amounts of ingredients recited in Table 1-10.









TABLE 1-10







Ingredients for Exemplary Tablet 11.













Percent Dose
Dose
Batch



Tablet Formulation
% Wt./Wt.
(mg)
(g)
















Intermediate F
34.09%
187.5
23.86



Microcrystalline cellulose
30.51%
167.8
21.36



Lactose
30.40%
167.2
21.28



Sodium croscarmellose
3.000%
16.50
2.100



SLS
0.500%
2.750
0.3500



Colloidal silicon dioxide
0.500%
2.750
0.3500



Magnesium stearate
1.000%
5.500
0.7000



Total
  100%
550
70










The colloidal silicon dioxide (Cabot Cab-O-Sil® M-5P Fumed Silicon Dioxide) and the microcrystalline cellulose (FMC MCC Avicel® PH102) were passed through a 30 mesh screen.


The sodium croscarmellose (FMC Ac-Di-Sol®), SLS, Intermediate F, and lactose (Foremost FastFlo® Lactose #316) were also passed, individually in the preceding order, through the same 30 mesh screen. A nitrogen purge was used when screening Intermediate F. The screened components were loaded into a 10 cubic feet V-blender, which was purged with nitrogen, and blended for about 180 (+/−10) inversions.


The Magnesium Stearate was filtered through a 40 mesh screen sieve into the blending container and mixed to provide about 54 inversions.


The resulting mixture was compressed into tablets using a fully tooled 36 Fette 2090 press with 0.568″×0.2885″ caplet type B tooling set to produce a tablet having an initial target hardness of about 10 Kp±20%.


Example 11
Exemplary Tablet 12 (Tablet 11 with Spray-Coating)

A batch of caplet-shaped tablets from Example 10 was spray-coated with OPADRY® II (Blue, Colorcon) to a weight gain of about 3.0% using a 24″ coating pan configured with the parameters in Table 1-11 followed by wax coating and then printing using Opacode® S-1-17823 (Solvent based Black, Colorcon).









TABLE 1-11







Spray-Coating Process Parameters










Coating Parameters 24″ Pan
Target














Pan Load (kg)
14



Inlet Temperature (° C.)*
*



Pan Speed (rpm)
10



Jog Time (sec)
2-5 sec every




60 sec



# of Spray Guns
2



Solids Content (% w/w)
20



Gun to Bed Distance (inches)
6



Inlet Air Flow (cfm)
300



Spray Rate (g/min)
35



Exhaust Temperature (° C.)
50



Atomization Pressure (psi)
42







*Inlet temperature is monitored to achieve target exhaust temperature. Initial inlet temperature should be set at about 75° C. to achieve target exhaust temp.






The OPADRY® II suspension was prepared by measuring an amount of de-ionized water which when combined with OPADRY® II would produce a total solids content of 20% w/w. The water is mixed to a vortex followed by addition of OPADRY® II over a period of approximately 5 minutes. Once the OPADRY® II powder was wetted, mixing was continued to ensure that all solid material is well-dispersed. The suspension is then charged into a Thomas 24″ pan coating instrument using coating conditions outlined in Table 1-11.


Uncoated tablets are placed into the coating pan and pre-warmed. The inlet was increased from room temperature to about 55° C. and then increased as necessary to provide the exhaust temperature in Table 1-11. The coating process was performed with 20% w/w OPADRY® II (85 Series Blue) coating dispersion to obtain a target weight gain of about 3%. The coated tablets were then allowed to tumble for about 2 minutes without spraying. The bed temperature was then allowed to cool to about 35° C.


Upon cooling, the Carnauba wax powder was weighed out in the amount of about 0.01% w/w of the starting tablet core weight. With the air flow off, the carnauba wax powder was sprinkled evenly on the tablet bed. The pan bed was turned on to the speed indicated in Table 1-11. After 5 minutes, the air flow was turned on (without heating) to the setting indicated in Table 1-11. After about one minute the air flow and pan were turned off.


Once coated with OPADRY® II, the tablets are then labeled using a Hartnett Delta tablet printer charged with Opacode® S-1-17823.


Example 12
Exemplary Tablet 13 (Formulated with HPMCAS Polymer to have 150 mg of Compound 1)

A batch of caplet-shaped tablets is formulated to have about 150 mg of Compound 1 per tablet using the amounts of ingredients recited in Table 1-12.









TABLE 1-12







Ingredients for Exemplary Tablet 13.











Percent Dose



Tablet Formulation
% Wt./Wt.







Intermediate H
 34.1%



Microcrystalline cellulose
 30.5%



Lactose
 30.4%



Sodium croscarmellose
3.000%



SLS
0.500%



Colloidal silicon dioxide
0.500%



Magnesium stearate
1.000%



Total
  100%










The colloidal silicon dioxide (Cabot Cab-O-Sil® M-5P Fumed Silicon Dioxide) and the microcrystalline cellulose (FMC MCC Avicel® PH102) are passed through a 30 mesh screen.


The sodium croscarmellose (FMC Ac-Di-Sol®), SLS, Intermediate H, and lactose (Foremost FastFlo® Lactose #316) are also passed, individually in the preceding order, through the same 30 mesh screen. A nitrogen purge is used when screening


Intermediate H. The screened components are loaded into a 10 cubic feet V-blender, which is purged with nitrogen, and blended for about 180 (+/−10) inversions.


The Magnesium Stearate is filtered through a 40 mesh screen sieve into the blending container and mixed to provide about 54 inversions.


The resulting mixture is compressed into tablets using a fully tooled 36 Fette 2090 press with 0.568″×0.2885″ caplet type B tooling set to produce a tablet having an initial target hardness of about 10 Kp±20%.


Example 13
Exemplary Tablet 14 (Tablet 13 with Spray-Coating)

A batch of caplet-shaped tablets from Example 12 is spray-coated with OPADRY® II (Blue, Colorcon) to a weight gain of about 3.0% using a Thomas 48″ coating pan configured with the parameters in Table 1-13 followed by wax coating and then printing using Opacode® S-1-17823 (Solvent based Black, Colorcon).









TABLE 1-13







Spray-Coating Process Parameters










Coating Parameters 48″ Pan
Target







Pan Load (kg)
up to 120



Inlet Temperature (° C.)*
*



# of Spray Guns
4



Solids Content (% w/w)
20



Gun to Bed Distance (inches)
  7-7.5



Inlet Air Flow (cfm)
1050-2400



Spray Rate (ml/min)
203-290



Exhaust Temperature (° C.)
40-65



Atomization Pressure (slpm)
145







*Inlet temperature is monitored to achieve target exhaust temperature. Initial inlet temperature should be set at about 50-75° C. to achieve target exhaust temp.






The OPADRY® II suspension is prepared by measuring an amount of de-ionized water which when combined with OPADRY® II would produce a total solids content of 20% w/w. The water is mixed to a vortex followed by addition of OPADRY® II over a period of approximately 5 minutes. Once the OPADRY® II powder is wetted, mixing is continued to ensure that all solid material is well-dispersed. The suspension is then charged into a Thomas 48″ pan coating instrument using coating conditions outlined in Table 1-13. In other examples, the suspension can be coated with a Thomas 24″ pan coating instrument.


Uncoated tablets are placed into the coating pan and pre-warmed. The inlet is increased from room temperature to about 55° C. and then increased as necessary to provide the exhaust temperature in Table 1-13. The coating process is performed with 20% w/w OPADRY® II (85 Series Blue) coating dispersion to obtain a target weight gain of about 3%. The coated tablets are then allowed to tumble for about 2 minutes without spraying. The bed temperature is then allowed to cool to about 35° C.


Upon cooling, the Carnauba wax powder is weighed out in the amount of about 0.01% w/w of the starting tablet core weight. With the air flow off, the carnauba wax powder is sprinkled evenly on the tablet bed. The pan bed is turned on to the speed indicated in Table 1-13. After 5 minutes, the air flow is turned on (without heating) to the setting indicated in Table 1-13. After about one minute the air flow and pan is turned off.


Once coated with OPADRY® II, the tablets are then labeled using a Hartnett Delta tablet printer charged with Opacode® S-1-17823.


Another aspect of the present invention provides a method of producing a pharmaceutical composition comprising providing an admixture of a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1, a binder, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler, and compressing the admixture into a tablet having a dissolution of at least about 50% in about 30 minutes.


Each of the ingredients of this admixture is described above and in the Examples below. Furthermore, the admixture can comprise optional additives such as one or more colorants, one or more flavors, and/or one or more fragrances as described above and in the Examples below. And, the relative concentrations (e.g., wt %) of each of these ingredients (and any optional additives) in the admixture is also presented above and in the Examples below. The ingredients constituting the admixture can be provided sequentially or in any combination of additions; and, the ingredients or combination of ingredients can be provided in any order. In one embodiment the lubricant is the last component added to the admixture.


In one embodiment, the admixture comprises a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous Compound 1, a binder, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler, wherein each of these ingredients is provided in a powder form (e.g., provided as particles having a mean diameter, measured by light scattering, of 250 μm or less (e.g., 150 μm or less, 100 μm or less, 50 μm or less, 45 μm or less, 40 μm or less, or 35 μm or less)). For instance, the admixture comprises a solid dispersion of amorphous Compound 1, a binder, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler, wherein each of these ingredients is provided in a powder form (e.g., provided as particles having a mean diameter, measured by light scattering, of 250 μm or less (e.g., 150 μm or less, 100 μm or less, 50 μm or less, 45 μm or less, 40 μm or less, or 35 μm or less)).


In another embodiment, the admixture comprises a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous Compound 1, a binder, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler, wherein each of these ingredients is substantially free of water. Each of the ingredients comprises less than 5 wt % (e.g., less than 2 wt %, less than 1 wt %, less than 0.75 wt %, less than 0.5 wt %, or less than 0.25 wt %) of water by weight of the ingredient. For instance, the admixture comprises a solid dispersion of amorphous Compound 1, a binder, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler, wherein each of these ingredients is substantially free of water. Each of the ingredients comprises less than 5 wt % (e.g., less than 2 wt %, less than 1 wt %, less than 0.75 wt %, less than 0.5 wt %, or less than 0.25 wt %) of water by weight of the ingredient.


In another embodiment, compressing the admixture into a tablet is accomplished by filling a form (e.g., a mold) with the admixture and applying pressure to admixture. This can be accomplished using a die press or other similar apparatus. It is also noted that the application of pressure to the admixture in the form can be repeated using the same pressure during each compression or using different pressures during the compressions. In another example, the admixture is compressed using a die press that applies sufficient pressure to form a tablet having a dissolution of about 50% or more at about 30 minutes (e.g., about 55% or more at about 30 minutes or about 60% or more at about 30 minutes). For instance, the admixture is compressed using a die press to produce a tablet hardness of at least about 5 Kp (at least about 5.5 Kp, at least about 6 Kp, at least about 7 Kp, at least about 11 Kp, or at least 21Kp). In some instances, the admixture is compressed to produce a tablet hardness of between about 6 and 21 Kp.


In some embodiments, tablets comprising a pharmaceutical composition as described herein can be coated with about 3.0 wt % of a film coating comprising a colorant by weight of the tablet. In certain instances, the colorant suspension or solution used to coat the tablets comprises about 20% w/w of solids by weight of the colorant suspension or solution. In still further instances, the coated tablets can be labeled with a logo, other image or text.


In another embodiment, the method of producing a pharmaceutical composition comprises providing an admixture of a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous Compound 1, a binder, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler; mixing the admixture until the admixture is substantially homogenous, and compressing the admixture into a tablet as described above or in the Examples below. Or, the method of producing a pharmaceutical composition comprises providing an admixture of a solid dispersion of amorphous Compound 1, a binder, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler; mixing the admixture until the admixture is substantially homogenous, and compressing the admixture into a tablet as described above or in the Examples below. For example, the admixture is mixed by stirring, blending, shaking, or the like using hand mixing, a mixer, a blender, any combination thereof, or the like. When ingredients or combinations of ingredients are added sequentially, mixing can occur between successive additions, continuously throughout the ingredient addition, after the addition of all of the ingredients or combinations of ingredients, or any combination thereof. The admixture is mixed until it has a substantially homogenous composition.


IV.A.2.c. Administration of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation

Another aspect of the present invention provides a method of administering a pharmaceutical composition by orally administering to a patient at least once per day the composition comprising a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1, in which the solid dispersion comprises at least about 100 mg of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1.


Another aspect of the present invention provides a method of administering a pharmaceutical composition by orally administering to a patient at least once per day the composition comprising a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1, in which the solid dispersion comprises at least about 150 mg of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1.


Another aspect of the present invention provides a method of administering a pharmaceutical composition by orally administering to a patient twice per day the composition comprising a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1, in which the solid dispersion comprises at least about 100 mg of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1.


Another aspect of the present invention provides a method of administering a pharmaceutical composition by orally administering to a patient twice per day the composition comprising a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1, in which the solid dispersion comprises at least about 150 mg of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1.


Another aspect of the present invention provides a method of administering a pharmaceutical composition by orally administering to a patient once every 12 hours day. The composition comprising a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1, in which the solid dispersion comprises at least about 100 mg of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1.


Another aspect of the present invention provides a method of administering a pharmaceutical composition by orally administering to a patient once every 12 hours. The composition comprising a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1, in which the solid dispersion comprises at least about 150 mg of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1.


In still other aspects of the present invention, a pharmaceutical composition as described herein is orally administered to a patient once every 24 hours.


Another aspect of the present invention provides a method of administering a pharmaceutical composition by orally administering to a patient once per day the composition comprising a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1, in which the solid dispersion comprises at least about 100 mg of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1.


Another aspect of the present invention provides a method of administering a pharmaceutical composition by orally administering to a patient once per day the composition comprising a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1, in which the solid dispersion comprises at least about 150 mg of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1.


In some embodiments, the present invention provides a method of administering a pharmaceutical composition comprising orally administering to a patient at least one tablet comprising:

    • a. a solid dispersion comprising about 100 mg of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS;
    • b. a filler;
    • c. a disintegrant;
    • d. a surfactant;
    • e. a binder;
    • f. a glidant; and
    • g. a lubricant.


In some embodiments, the present invention provides a method of administering a pharmaceutical composition comprising orally administering to a patient at least one tablet comprising:

    • a. a solid dispersion comprising about 150 mg of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1 and HPMCAS;
    • b. a filler;
    • c. a disintegrant;
    • d. a surfactant;
    • e. a binder;
    • f. a glidant; and
    • g. a lubricant.


In some embodiments, the present invention provides for a method of orally administering the pharmaceutical composition described herein once a day. In other embodiments, the present invention provides for a method of orally administering the pharmaceutical composition described herein twice a day.


Another aspect of the present invention provides a method of administering a pharmaceutical composition by orally administering to a patient at least once per day at least one tablet comprising a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1, a filler, a binder, a glidant, a disintegrant, a surfactant, and a lubricant, in which the solid dispersion comprises at least about 100 mg of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1. In some embodiments, the tablet is orally administered to the patient once per day. In another method, the administration comprises orally administering to a patient twice per day at least one tablet comprising a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1, a filler, a binder, a glidant, a disintegrant, a surfactant, and a lubricant, in which the solid dispersion contains at least about 100 mg of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1. Other tablets useful in this method comprise a solid dispersion containing at least about 150 mg of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1. In another method, the administration includes orally administering to a patient twice per day at least one tablet comprising a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1, a filler, a binder, a glidant, a disintegrant, a surfactant, and a lubricant, in which the solid dispersion contains at least about 150 mg of substantially amorphous or amorphous Compound 1.


In another embodiment, the method of administering a pharmaceutical composition includes orally administering to a patient once per day at least one tablet comprising a pharmaceutical composition containing a solid dispersion of Compound 1, a filler, a binder, a glidant, a disintegrant, a surfactant, and a lubricant, each of which is described above and in the Examples below, wherein the solid dispersion comprises at least about 100 mg, or at least about 150 mg) of substantially amorphous Compound 1 or amorphous Compound 1. For example, the method of administering a pharmaceutical composition includes orally administering to a patient once per day one tablet comprising a pharmaceutical composition containing a solid dispersion of Compound 1, a filler, a binder, a glidant, a disintegrant, a surfactant, and a lubricant, wherein the solid dispersion comprises at least 100 mg, or at least 150 mg of substantially amorphous Compound 1 or amorphous Compound 1.


In another embodiment, the method of administering a pharmaceutical composition includes orally administering to a patient twice per day one tablet comprising a pharmaceutical composition containing a solid dispersion of Compound 1, a filler, a binder, a glidant, a disintegrant, a surfactant, and a lubricant, wherein the solid dispersion comprises at least 100 mg or at least 150 mg of substantially amorphous Compound 1 or amorphous Compound 1.


In one embodiment, the method of administering a pharmaceutical composition includes orally administering to a patient a formulation comprising from about 25 mg to about 300 mg of Compound 1. In one embodiment, the method of administering a pharmaceutical composition includes orally administering to a patient one or more tablets, each tablet comprising about 100 mg, about 150 mg, or about 250 mg of Compound 1. In some embodiments, the method includes administering a tablet comprising about 250 mg of Compound 1. In some embodiments, the method includes administering a tablet comprising about 150 mg of Compound 1 and a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 1. In one embodiment, the method includes administering to a patient a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 1 as described in Example 8 or Example 9 of Section IV.A.2.b, entitled “Preparation of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation.” In another embodiment, the method includes administering to a patient a tablet comprising about 150 mg of Compound 1 as described in Example 10, Example 11, Example 12 or Example 13 of Section IV.A.2.b, entitled “Preparation of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation.” In a further embodiment, the method includes administering to a patient a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 1 as described in Example 8 or Example 9 of Section IV.A.2.b, entitled “Preparation of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation” and a tablet comprising about 150 mg of Compound 1 as described in Example 10, Example 11, Example 12 or Example 13 of Section IV.A.2.b, entitled “Preparation of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation.” In some embodiments, the method includes administering the tablet comprising 100 mg of Compound 1 and the tablet comprising 150 mg of Compound 1 in the same vehicle. In some embodiments, the method includes administering the tablet comprising 100 mg of Compound 1 and the tablet comprising 150 mg of Compound 1 in separate vehicles.


In one embodiment, the method of administering a pharmaceutical composition includes orally administering to a patient a formulation comprising from about 25 mg to about 300 mg of Compound 1 and a formulation comprising from about 25 mg to about 250 mg of Compound 3. In one embodiment, the method of administering a pharmaceutical composition includes orally administering to a patient one or more tablets, each tablet comprising about 100 mg, about 150 mg, or about 250 mg of Compound 1 and one or more of a tablet comprising from about 25 mg to about 250 mg of Compound 3. In some embodiments, the method includes administering a tablet comprising about 250 mg of Compound 1 and one or more of the following: a tablet comprising about 200 mg of Compound 3 or a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 3. In some embodiments, the method includes administering a tablet comprising about 150 mg of Compound 1 and one or more of the following: a tablet comprising about 200 mg of Compound 3 or a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 3. In some embodiments, the method includes administering a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 1 and one or more of the following: a tablet comprising about 200 mg of Compound 3 or a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 3. In some embodiments, the method includes administering a tablet comprising about 150 mg of Compound 1; a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 1; and one or more of the following: a tablet comprising about 200 mg of Compound 3 or a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 3. In some embodiments, the method includes administering a tablet comprising about 150 mg of Compound 1; a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 1; and a tablet comprising Compound 3 as described in any of Tables 3-13-3-23. In one embodiment, the method includes administering to a patient a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 1 as described in Example 8 or Example 9 of Section IV.A.2.b, entitled “Preparation of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation” and a tablet comprising Compound 3 as described in Tables 3-19, 3-20 or 3-23. In another embodiment, the method includes administering to a patient a tablet comprising about 150 mg of Compound 1 as described in Example 10, Example 11, Example 12 or Example 13 of Section IV.A.2.b, entitled “Preparation of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation” and a tablet comprising Compound 3 as described in Tables 3-19, 3-20 or 3-23. In a further embodiment, the method includes administering to a patient a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 1 as described in Example 8 or Example 9 of Section IV.A.2.b, entitled “Preparation of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation;” a tablet comprising about 150 mg of Compound 1 as described in Example 10, Example 11, Example 12 or Example 13 of Section IV.A.2.b, entitled “Preparation of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation;” and a tablet comprising Compound 3 as described in Tables 3-19, 3-20 or 3-23. In some embodiments, the method includes administering the tablet comprising 100 mg of Compound 1, the tablet comprising 150 mg of Compound 1 and the tablet comprising Compound 3 in the same vehicle. In some embodiments, the method includes administering the tablet comprising 100 mg of Compound 1, the tablet comprising 150 mg of Compound 1 and the tablet comprising Compound 3 in separate vehicles.


In one embodiment, the method of administering a pharmaceutical composition includes orally administering to a patient a formulation comprising from about 25 mg to about 300 mg of Compound 1 and a formulation comprising from about 25 mg to about 250 mg of Compound 4. In one embodiment, the method of administering a pharmaceutical composition includes orally administering to a patient one or more tablets, each tablet comprising about 100 mg, about 150 mg, or about 250 mg of Compound 1 and one or more of a tablet comprising from about 25 mg to about 250 mg of Compound 4. In some embodiments, the method includes administering a tablet comprising about 250 mg of Compound 1 and one or more of the following: a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 4 or a tablet comprising about 50 mg of Compound 4. In some embodiments, the method includes administering a tablet comprising about 150 mg of Compound 1 and one or more of the following: a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 4 or a tablet comprising about 50 mg of Compound 4. In some embodiments, the method includes administering a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 1 and one or more of the following: a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 4 or a tablet comprising about 50 mg of Compound 4. In some embodiments, the method includes administering a tablet comprising about 150 mg of Compound 1; a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 1; and one or more of the following: a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 4 or a tablet comprising about 50 mg of Compound 4. In one embodiment, the method includes administering to a patient a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 1 as described in Example 8 or Example 9 of Section IV.A.2.b, entitled “Preparation of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation” and a tablet comprising Compound 4 as described in Tables 4-9 or 4-10. In another embodiment, the method includes administering to a patient a tablet comprising about 150 mg of Compound 1 as described in Example 10, Example 11, Example 12 or Example 13 of Section IV.A.2.b, entitled “Preparation of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation” and a tablet comprising Compound 4 as described in Tables 4-9 or 4-10. In a further embodiment, the method includes administering to a patient a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 1 as described in Example 8 or Example 9 of Section IV.A.2.b, entitled “Preparation of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation;” a tablet comprising about 150 mg of Compound 1 as described in Example 10, Example 11, Example 12 or Example 13 of Section IV.A.2.b, entitled “Preparation of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation;” and a tablet comprising Compound 4 as described in Tables 4-9 or 4-10. In some embodiments, the method includes administering the tablet comprising 100 mg of Compound 1, the tablet comprising 150 mg of Compound 1 and the tablet comprising Compound 4 in the same vehicle. In some embodiments, the method includes administering the tablet comprising 100 mg of Compound 1, the tablet comprising 150 mg of Compound 1 and the tablet comprising Compound 4 in separate vehicles.


In one embodiment, the method of administering a pharmaceutical composition includes orally administering to a patient a formulation comprising from about 25 mg to about 300 mg of Compound 1; a formulation comprising from about 25 mg to about 250 mg of Compound 3; and a formulation comprising from about 25 mg to about 250 mg of Compound 4. In one embodiment, the method of administering a pharmaceutical composition includes orally administering to a patient one or more tablets, each tablet comprising about 100 mg, about 150 mg, or about 250 mg of Compound 1; one or more of a tablet comprising from about 25 mg to about 250 mg of Compound 3; and one or more of a tablet comprising from about 25 mg to about 250 mg of Compound 4. In some embodiments, the method includes administering a tablet comprising about 250 mg of Compound 1; one or more of the following: a tablet comprising about 200 mg of Compound 3 or a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 3; and one or more of the following: a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 4 or a tablet comprising about 50 mg of Compound 4. In some embodiments, the method includes administering a tablet comprising about 150 mg of Compound 1; one or more of the following: a tablet comprising about 200 mg of Compound 3 or a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 3; and one or more of the following: a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 4 or a tablet comprising about 50 mg of Compound 4. In some embodiments, the method includes administering a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 1; one or more of the following: a tablet comprising about 200 mg of Compound 3 or a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 3; and one or more of the following: a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 4 or a tablet comprising about 50 mg of Compound 4. In some embodiments, the method includes administering a tablet comprising about 150 mg of Compound 1; a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 1; one or more of the following: a tablet comprising about 200 mg of Compound 3 or a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 3; and one or more of the following: a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 4 or a tablet comprising about 50 mg of Compound 4. In some embodiments, the method includes administering a tablet comprising about 150 mg of Compound 1; a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 1; a tablet comprising Compound 3 as described in any of Tables 3-13-3-23; and a tablet comprising Compound 4 as described in Tables 4-9 or 4-10. In one embodiment, the method includes administering to a patient a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 1 as described in Example 8 or Example 9 of Section IV.A.2.b, entitled “Preparation of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation;” a tablet comprising Compound 3 as described in Tables 3-19, 3-20 or 3-23; and a tablet comprising Compound 4 as described in Tables 4-9 or 4-10. In another embodiment, the method includes administering to a patient a tablet comprising about 150 mg of Compound 1 as described in Example 10, Example 11, Example 12 or Example 13 of Section IV.A.2.b, entitled “Preparation of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation;” a tablet comprising Compound 3 as described in Tables 3-19, 3-20 or 3-23; and a tablet comprising Compound 4 as described in Tables 4-9 or 4-10. In a further embodiment, the method includes administering to a patient a tablet comprising about 100 mg of Compound 1 as described in Example 8 or Example 9 of Section IV.A.2.b, entitled “Preparation of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation;” a tablet comprising about 150 mg of Compound 1 as described in Example 10, Example 11, Example 12 or Example 13 of Section IV.A.2.b, entitled “Preparation of Compound 1 Tablet and SDD Formulation;” a tablet comprising Compound 3 as described in Tables 3-19, 3-20 or 3-23; and a tablet comprising Compound 4 as described in Tables 4-9 or 4-10. In some embodiments, the method includes administering the tablet comprising 100 mg of Compound 1, the tablet comprising 150 mg of Compound 1, the tablet comprising Compound 3 and the tablet comprising Compound 4 in the same vehicle. In some embodiments, the method includes administering the tablet comprising 100 mg of Compound 1, the tablet comprising 150 mg of Compound 1, the tablet comprising Compound 3 and the tablet comprising Compound 4 in separate vehicles.


It is noted that the methods of administration of the present invention can optionally include orally administering a beverage (water, milk, or the like), food, and/or additional pharmaceutical compositions including additional APIs. When the method of administration includes orally administering a beverage (water, milk, or the like), food (including a standard high fat high calorie CF meal or snack), and/or additional pharmaceutical compositions including additional APIs, the oral administration of the beverage, food, and/or additional API can occur concurrently with the oral administration of the tablet, prior to the oral administration of the tablet, and/or after the administration of the tablet. For instance, in one example, the method of administering a pharmaceutical composition includes orally administering to a patient at least once per day at least one tablet comprising a pharmaceutical composition containing a solid dispersion of substantially amorphous Compound 1 or amorphous Compound 1, a filler, a binder, a glidant, a disintegrant, a surfactant, a lubricant, and a second API. In still other examples, the method of administering a pharmaceutical composition includes orally administering to a patient every 12 hours at least one tablet comprising a pharmaceutical composition as described herein, in which the tablet is administered about 30 minutes after consuming a high fat, high calorie CF meal or snack.


IV.B. Formulations of Compound 3
IV.B.1. Compound 3 Form I Aqueous Formulations
IV.B.1.a. Embodiments of Compound 3 Form I Aqueous Formulations

In some embodiments, Compound 3 is formulated as provided herein, and is administered together with Compound 1 and 2 as provided in Table I. As a note, Compound 3 may be in any of the solid forms specified herein.


In one aspect, the invention relates to an aqueous formulation comprising Compound 3, water, and a viscosity agent. In another embodiment, Compound 3 is in the form of Compound 3 Form I.


In another embodiment, the viscosity agent is selected from the group consisting of methyl cellulose, sodium carboxymethylcellulose, hydroxypropylmethyl cellulose, hydroxypropyl cellulose, sodium alginate, polyacrylate, povidone, acacia, guar gum, xanthan gum, tragacanth, and magnesium aluminum silicate. In another embodiment, the viscosity agent is methyl cellulose.


In another embodiment, the concentration of Compound 3 is from about 0.5 to about 20% by weight. In another embodiment, the concentration of Compound 3 is from about 1 to about 10% by weight. In another embodiment, the concentration of Compound 3 is from about 2.5 to about 3.5% by weight.


In another embodiment, the concentration of viscosity agent is from about 0.1 to about 2% by weight. In another embodiment, the concentration of viscosity agent is from about 0.1 to about 1% by weight. In another embodiment, the concentration of viscosity agent is about 0.5% by weight.


In another embodiment, the concentration of Compound 3 is from about 0.5 to about 20% by weight; and the concentration of viscosity agent is from about 0.1 to about 2% by weight. In another embodiment, the concentration of Compound 3 is from about 1 to about 10% by weight; and the concentration of viscosity agent is from about 0.5 to about 1% by weight. In another embodiment, the concentration of Compound 3 is from about 2.5 to about 3.5% by weight; and the concentration of viscosity agent is about 0.5% by weight. In another embodiment, the concentration of Compound 3 is from about 0.5 to about 20% by weight; and the viscosity agent is methylcellulose at about 0.5% by weight.


In another embodiment, any of the above formulations further comprises a surfactant. In another embodiment, the surfactant is an anionic, cationic, or nonionic surfactant. In another embodiment, the surfactant is an anionic surfactant selected from the group consisting of salts of dodecyl sulfate, lauryl sulfate, laureth sulfate, alkyl benzene sulfonates, butanoic acid, hexanoic acid, octanoic acid, decanoic acid, lauric acid, myristic acid, palmitic acid, stearic acid, arachidic acid, behenic acid, myristoleic acid, palmitoleic acid, oleic acid, linoleic acid, alpha-linolenic acid, arachidonic acid, eicosapentaenoic acid, erucic acid, and docosahexaenoic acid. In another embodiment, the surfactant is a cationic surfactant selected from the group consisting of cetyl trimethylammonium bromide, cetylpyridinium chloride, polethoxylated tallow amine, benzalkonium chloride, and benzethonium chloride. In another embodiment, the surfactant is a nonionic surfactant selected from the group consisting of polysorbate 20, polysorbate 40, polysorbate 60, polysorbate 65, polysorbate 80, alkyl poly(ethylene oxide), poloxamine, alkyl polyglucosides, octyl glucoside, decyl maltoside, fatty alcohol, cetyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cocamide MEA, cocamide DEA, and cocamide TEA. In another embodiment, the surfactant is polysorbate 80.


In another embodiment, the concentration of surfactant is from about 0.1 to about 10% by weight. In another embodiment, the concentration of surfactant is from about 0.1 to about 1% by weight. In another embodiment, the concentration of surfactant is about 0.5% by weight. In another embodiment, the surfactant is polysorbate 80 at about 0.5% by weight.


In another embodiment, any of the above formulations further comprises an antifoaming agent. In another embodiment, the antifoaming agent comprises polydimethylsiloxane. In another embodiment, the antifoaming agent is simethicone.


In another embodiment, the concentration of antifoaming agent is from about 0.01 to about 0.2% by weight. In another embodiment, the concentration of antifoaming agent is from about 0.01% to about 0.1% by weight. In another embodiment, the concentration of antifoaming agent is about 0.05% by weight.


In another embodiment, any of the above formulations further comprises a buffer. In another embodiment, the buffer comprises sodium, potassium or ammonium salt of acetic, boric, carbonic, phosphoric, succinic, malic, tartaric, citric, acetic, benzoic, lactic, glyceric, gluconic, glutaric or glutamic acids. In another embodiment, the buffer comprises sodium, potassium or ammonium salt of citric acid.


In another embodiment, any of the above formulations further comprises a masking and/or flavoring agent.


In another aspect, the present invention relates to a method of treating cystic fibrosis in a mammal comprising administering any of the above formulations of Compound 3. In another embodiment, the method comprises administering an additional therapeutic agent. In another embodiment, the additional therapeutic agent is selected from the group consisting of mucolytic agent, bronchodialator, an anti-biotic, an anti-infective agent, an anti-inflammatory agent, a CFTR modulator other than a compound of the present invention, and a nutritional agent.


In another embodiment, the dosage amount of Compound 3 in the dosage unit form is from about 100 mg to about 1,000 mg. In another embodiment, the dosage amount of Compound 3 is from about 200 mg to about 900 mg. In another embodiment, the dosage amount of Compound 3 is from about 300 mg to about 800 mg. In another embodiment, the dosage amount of Compound 3 is from about 400 mg to about 700 mg. In another embodiment, the dosage amount of Compound 3 is from about 500 mg to about 600 mg.


In another aspect, the present invention relates to a pharmaceutical pack or kit comprising any of the above formulations of Compound 3 and instructions for use thereof.


In another aspect, the present invention relates to an oral formulation comprising Compound 3, water, methyl cellulose, polysorbate 80, and simethicone.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 is present in a concentration of about 2.5% to about 3.5% by weight. In another embodiment, the methyl cellulose is present in a concentration of about 0.5% by weight. In another embodiment, the polysorbate 80 is present in a concentration of about 0.5% by weight. In another embodiment, the simethicone is present in a concentration of about 0.05% by weight.


IV.B.1.b. Preparation of Compound 3 Form I Aqueous Formulations

Because of the greater thermodynamic stability of Compound 3 Form I over Compound 3 HCl salt, aqueous formulations of Compound 3 Form I can be prepared by dispersing either compound in an aqueous formulation.


From Compound 3 HCl salt


Aqueous Formulation with Methylcellulose


A 100 mL stock solution of 0.5% by weight methylcellulose was prepared by stirring 0.5 g of methylcellulose with 99.5 g of purified water until completely dissolved (approximately 24 hours). The appropriate amount of Compound 3 HCl salt based on free base was weighed and transferred to a scintillation vial. The desired amount of 0.5% methylcellulose stock solution for making a 6 mg/mL based on free base (6.48 mg/mL based on HCl salt) was transferred into the vial and sonicated for 20 minutes and homogenized for approximately 5 minutes.


Compound 3 Form I is physically and chemically stable for at least 24 hrs at room temperature in a methylcellulose formulation with no sign of chemical degradation.


Aqueous Formulation with Methylcellulose and Polysorbate 80


Methylcellulose (0.5 g) was combined with 99.0 g of purified water in a beaker and stirred in a 60-70° C. water bath for 30′-1 hr. The solution was stirred in a 0° C. ice/water bath for another 30′ or until clear. Polysorbate 80 (0.5 g) was added and stirring at room temperature followed for 30′-1 hr or until a clear solution was obtained.


The appropriate amount of Compound 3 HCl salt based on free base was weighed and transferred to a scintillation vial. The desired amount of 0.5% methylcellulose and 0.5% polysorbate 80 stock solution for making a 6 mg/mL based on free base (6.48 mg/mL based on HCl salt) was transferred into the vial and sonicated for 20 minutes with alternate stirring for 1-2 minutes. The solution was homogenized for approximately 1-2 minutes.


As with 0.5% methylcellulose formulation prepared previously, the HCl salt was quickly converted to Compound 3 Form I at T(0) resulting in a crystalline free form suspension as shown by XRPD (FIG. 3-23) and confirmed by 1H NMR analysis (FIGS. 3-24 through 3-26).


The Compound 3 Form I suspension in 0.5% methylcellulose/0.5% polysorbate 80 was also tested for particle size distribution using a Malvern Master-Sizer. The suspension sample was kept at room temperature for 24 hours. As shown in Table 3-10, the average size of the suspension particles after 24 hours was below 10 microns.









TABLE 3-10







Particle size distribution of the Compound 3 suspension.











Particle Size (μm)












Time (hrs)
d10
d50
d90







T(24 hr), sample
2.271
9.792
49.130










The Compound 3 HCl salt suspension in 0.5% methylcellulose/0.5% polysorbate 80 is not physically stable. The HCl salt form was quickly converted to Compound 3 Form I in the suspension vehicle at T(0) resulting in a crystalline free form suspension. Compound 3 Form I is chemically stable for at least 24 hrs at room temperature in 0.5% methylcellulose/0.5% polysorbate 80 formulation vehicle with no sign of chemical degradation.


IV.B.2. Compound 3 Form I Capsule Formulations
IV.B.2.a. Embodiments of Compound 3 Form I Capsule Formulations

In one embodiment, the invention relates to the dosage unit of Compound 3, wherein the dosage unit is an oral dosage unit. In another embodiment, Compound 3 is in the form of Compound 3 Form I. In another embodiment, the dosage unit is a solid oral dosage unit. In another embodiment, the dosage unit is in the form of a tablet or capsule. In another embodiment, the dosage unit is in the form of a capsule. In another embodiment, the dosage unit comprises more than one capsule. In another embodiment, the dosage unit comprises 4 capsules of 50 mg of Compound 3 Form I each. In another embodiment, the dosage unit comprises 1 to 4 capsules of 25 mg of Compound 3 Form I each.


In another embodiment, the present invention relates to the dosage unit of any of the above embodiments further comprising a filler. In another embodiment, the filler is selected from the group consisting of lactose, microcrystalline cellulose, calcium phosphate dibasic anhydrous, calcium phosphate dibasic dihydrate, calcium phosphate tribasic, cellulose powder, magnesium carbonate, calcium sulfate, starch, talc, sucrose, dextrose, mannitol, hydroxypropylmethyl cellulose, hydroxypropyl cellulose, carboxymethylcellulose, fructose, xylitol, sorbitol, and combinations thereof. In another embodiment, the filler is lactose and microcrystalline cellulose. In another embodiment, the amount of filler is 40 to 80 percent by weight. In another embodiment, the amount of filler is 50 to 70 percent by weight. In another embodiment, the amount of filler is 60 percent by weight.


In another embodiment, the present invention relates to any of the above embodiments further comprising a disintegrant. In another embodiment, the disintegrant is selected from the group consisting of sodium starch glycolate, alginic acid, carboxymethylcellulose calcium, carboxymethylcellulose sodium, cellulose powder, croscarmellose sodium, crosspovidone, chitin, bicarbonate salt, gellan gum, and combinations thereof. In another embodiment, the disintegrant is sodium starch glycolate. In another embodiment, the amount of disintegrant is 1 to 20 percent by weight. In another embodiment, the amount of disintegrant is 5 to 15 percent by weight. In another embodiment, the amount of disintegrant is 10 percent by weight.


In another embodiment, the present invention relates to any of the above embodiments further comprising a surfactant. In another embodiment, the surfactant is an anionic, cationic, or nonionic surfactant. In another embodiment, the surfactant is an anionic surfactant selected from the group consisting of salts of lauryl sulfate, laureth sulfate, alkyl benzene sulfonates, butanoic acid, hexanoic acid, octanoic acid, decanoic acid, lauric acid, myristic acid, palmitic acid, stearic acid, arachidic acid, behenic acid, myristoleic acid, palmitoleic acid, oleic acid, linoleic acid, alpha-linolenic acid, arachidonic acid, eicosapentaenoic acid, erucic acid, and docosahexaenoic acid. In another embodiment, the surfactant is sodium lauryl sulfate. In another embodiment, the surfactant is a cationic surfactant selected from the group consisting of cetyl trimethylammonium bromide, cetylpyridinium chloride, polethoxylated tallow amine, benzalkonium chloride, and benzethonium chloride. In another embodiment, the surfactant is a nonionic surfactant selected from the group consisting of polysorbate 20, polysorbate 40, polysorbate 60, polysorbate 65, polysorbate 80, alkyl poly(ethylene oxide), poloxamine, alkyl polyglucosides, octyl glucoside, decyl maltoside, fatty alcohol, cetyl alcohol, oleyl alcohol, cocamide MEA, cocamide DEA, and cocamide TEA. In another embodiment, the amount of surfactant is 0.5 to 15 percent by weight. In another embodiment, the amount of surfactant is 1 to 10 percent by weight. In another embodiment, the amount of surfactant is 5 percent by weight.


In another embodiment, the present invention relates to any of the above embodiments further comprising a glidant or viscosity agent. In another embodiment, the glidant or viscosity agent is selected from the group consisting of colloidal silicon dioxide, magnesium aluminum silicate, xanthan gum, hydroxypropyl cellulose, hydroxypropylmethyl cellulose, methyl cellulose, carageenan, carboxymethyl cellulose, polyvinylpyrrolidone, sodium alginate, povidone, acacia, guar gum, tragacanth, magnesium aluminum silicate, carbomers, and combinations thereof. In another embodiment, the glidant is colloidal silicon dioxide. In another embodiment, the amount of glidant or viscosity agent is 0.05 to 2 percent by weight. In another embodiment, the amount of glidant or viscosity agent is 0.1 to 1 percent by weight. In another embodiment, the amount of glidant or viscosity agent is 0.5 percent by weight.


In another embodiment, the present invention relates to any of the above embodiments further comprising a lubricant. In another embodiment, the lubricant is selected from the group consisting of magnesium stearate, calcium stearate, magnesium trisilicate, sodium stearyl fumarate, stearic acid, zinc stearate, and combinations thereof. In another embodiment, the lubricant is magnesium stearate. In another embodiment, the amount of lubricant is 0.05 to 2 percent by weight. In another embodiment, the amount of lubricant is 0.1 to 1 percent by weight. In another embodiment, the amount of lubricant is 0.5 percent by weight.


In another embodiment, the present invention relates to any of the above embodiments wherein the dosage unit comprises a capsule comprising 50 mg of Compound 3, 40 percent by weight lactose, 20 percent by weight microcrystalline cellulose, 10 percent by weight sodium starch glycolate, 5 percent by weight sodium lauryl sulfate, 0.5 percent by weight colloidal silicon dioxide, and 0.5 percent by weight magnesium stearate.


In another embodiment, the present invention relates to any of the above embodiments wherein the dosage unit comprises Compound 3 having a particle size of 0.1 microns to 10 microns. In another embodiment, the particle size of Compound 3 is 1.0 microns to 5 microns. In another embodiment, the Compound 3 has a particle size D50 of 2.0 microns.


In another aspect, the invention relates to a method of treating a CFTR mediated disease in a subject comprising administering to a subject in need thereof an effective amount of the dosage unit of Compound 3.


IV.B.2.b. Preparation of Compound 3 Form I Capsule Formulations
Jet Milling Description

Unmicronized Compound 3 was sieved to de-lump it prior to placing it into the jet mill hopper. All sieves were disposable and received a Compound 3 wipe prior to use. Unmicronized Compound 3 was added to the jet mill hopper at a controlled feeding rate using compressed nitrogen gas. The gas pressure range was 40-45/45-70 (Venturi/Mill) PSI and the feeding rate range was 0.5-1.6 Kg/Hour. Compound 3 was micronized in the mill through particle-particle and particle-wall collisions and processed Compound 3 was emptied into the micronized product containers. It is believed that one of ordinary skill in the art may also achieve Compound 3 with a favorable particle size through pin milling based in part on the conditions described above.


Preparation of Capsules of Compound 3.

A capsule comprising Compound 3 was prepared with the components and amounts listed in Table 3-11.














TABLE 3-11








Component

Content



Component
Function
mg/capsule
(% w/w)





















Compound 3
Active Ingredient
50.00
23.81



Lactose monohydrate
Filler
84.40
40.19



Microcrystalline
Filler
42.00
20.00



Cellulose






Sodium Starch
Disintegrant
21.00
10.00



Glycolate






Sodium Lauryl
Surfactant
10.50
5.00



Sulfate






Colloidal Silicon
Glidant
1.05
0.50



Dioxide






Magnesium Stearate
Lubricant
1.05
0.50



Total

210
100










Capsules comprising Compound 3 were also prepared with the components and amounts listed in Table 3-12.












TABLE 3-12









25 mg Capsule
50 mg Capsule














Amount/

Amount/




Component
capsule
Content
capsule
Content


Component
Function
(mg)
(% w/w)
(mg)
(% w/w)















Compound 3
Active
25.00
23.81
50.00
23.81



Ingredient






Lactose
Filler
46.51
44.30
93.03
44.30


monohydrate







Microcrystalline
Filler
16.10
15.33
32.19
15.33


Cellulose







Sodium Starch
Disintegrant
10.50
10.00
21.00
10.00


Glycolate







Sodium Lauryl
Surfactant
5.79
5.51
11.57
5.51


Sulfate







Colloidal
Glidant
0.577
0.55
1.16
0.55


Silicon Dioxide







Magnesium
Lubricant
0.525
0.50
1.05
0.50


Stearate







Total

105.00
100%
210.00
100%









Equipment/Process
Equipment





    • 30 mesh hand screen

    • V-blender with 4-quart shell

    • Equipment for blend sampling

    • In-Cap capsule-filling machine

    • Capsugel size 1 white opaque gelatin Coni-Snap capsules

    • In process testing equipment (balance and weight sorting

    • equipment)

    • 75 cc HDPE bottles and lids





Screening/Weighing

Compound 3 will be screened prior to batch weigh-up. Approximately 5% excess material will be weighed and passed through a 30-mesh had screen in order to delump the material. After the material is screened, it will be reweighed according to the amount needed for blending.


Screening prior to batch weigh-up is not required for all other raw materials, but all materials must be passed through a 30-mesh hand screen before blending.


Blending

Blending (Pre-Lubrication 1):


A 4-quart V-Blender shell will be loaded in the following order:

    • 1) ½ Total Lactose (Fast-Flo 316)
    • 2) Jet Milled Compound 3
    • 3) Colloidal Silicon Dioxide
    • 4) Sodium Lauryl Sulfate


The materials will be blended for 5 minutes at set speed.


Blending (Pre-Lubrication 2):


The following excipients will be added to the V-Blender in this order:

    • 1) ½ Total Lactose (Fast-Flo 316)
    • 2) Sodium Starch Glycolate (Explotab)
    • 3) Microcrystalline Cellulose (Avicel PH-101)


The materials will be blended for 20 minutes at set speed.


Blending (Post-Lubrication):


After the pre-lubrication blending is completed, Magnesium Stearate will be delumped using a 30-mesh hand screen, added to the V-Blender, and blended with the other raw materials for 5 minutes at set speed.


Capsule Filling

Once the final blend has been completed, the blend will then be transferred to an In-Cap capsule filling machine. The gelatin capsules to be used are Capsugel size 1 white opaque Coni-Snap capsules.


The capsules should be equilibrated in the encapsulation suite for 1-3 hours before determining capsule shell weight. The capsule shell weight will be determined by taking the average of three samples of 10 capsule shells. The samples will be taken from different areas of the bulk container. The target fill weight is 210 mg, thus the target in-process weigh will be 210 mg+average capsule weight. The acceptable weight range will be +/−5% (272-300 mg assuming a capsule shell weight of 76 mg. Actual shell weight will be determined before encapsulation).


Once the target weight is achieved, capsules will be collected and the average weight determined (10 capsules for placebo and 5 capsules for active-containing batches). The individual weights of at least 5 capsules should also be determined to evaluate capsule to capsule variability. The weight will be checked every 15 minutes by determining the average weight of 10 (placebo) or 5 (active) capsules. The individual weights of 5 capsules should also be recorded. The weight setting procedure from above will be repeated if the average weight is not within range.


The usable capsules will be weight sorted using the weight range of +/−5% of target.


IV.B.3. Compound 3 Form I Tablet Formulations
IV.B.3.a. Embodiments of Compound 3 Form I Tablet Formulations

In one embodiment, the invention relates to a tablet for oral administration comprising: Compound 3, a filler; a diluent, a disintegrant; a surfactant, a lubricant, and at least one of a binder and a glidant.


In another embodiment, the invention relates to a tablet for oral administration comprising: Compound 3 Form I, a filler, a diluent, a disintegrant, a surfactant, a lubricant, and at least one of a binder and a glidant.


In another embodiment, Compound 3 or Compound 3 Form I is present in the tablet in an amount ranging from about 25 mg to about 250 mg.


In another embodiment, the amount of Compound 3 or Compound 3 Form I in the tablet ranges from about 15 wt % to about 75 wt % by weight of the tablet.


In another embodiment, the amount of Compound 3 or Compound 3 Form I in the tablet ranges from about 20 wt % to about 45 wt % by weight of the tablet.


In another embodiment, the amount of Compound 3 or Compound 3 Form I in the tablet ranges from about 40 wt % to about 60 wt % by weight of the tablet.


In another embodiment, the filler is selected from cellulose, modified cellulose, sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose hydroxymethyl cellulose, hydroxypropylcellulose, cellulose acetate, microcrystalline cellulose, dibasic calcium phosphate, sucrose, lactose, corn starch, potato starch, or any combination thereof.


In another embodiment, the filler is microcrystalline cellulose (MCC) and is present in the tablet in an amount ranging from about 20 wt % to about 50 wt % by weight of the tablet.


In another embodiment, the diluent is selected from lactose, mannitol, sorbitol, cellulose, calcium phosphate, starch, sugar or any combination thereof.


In another embodiment, the diluent is mannitol and is present in the tablet in an amount ranging from about 1 wt % to about 30 wt % by weight of the tablet.


In another embodiment, the disintegrant is selected from agar-agar, algins, calcium carbonate, carboxmethylcellulose, cellulose, hydroxypropylcellulose, low substituted hydroxypropylcellulose, clays, croscarmellose sodium, crosspovidone, gums, magnesium aluminum silicate, methylcellulose, polacrilin potassium, sodium alginate, sodium starch glycolate, maize starch, potato starch, tapioca starch, or any combination thereof.


In another embodiment, the disintegrant is croscarmellose sodium and is present in the tablet at a concentration of 5 wt % or less by weight of the tablet.


In another embodiment, the surfactant is selected from sodium lauryl sulfate, sodium stearyl fumarate, polyoxyethylene 20 sorbitan mono-oleate, or any combination thereof.


In another embodiment, the surfactant is sodium lauryl sulfate and has a concentration of about 5 wt % or less by weight of the tablet.


In another embodiment, the glidant is selected from colloidal silicon dioxide, talc, corn starch, or a combination thereof.


In another embodiment, the glidant is colloidal silicon dioxide and has a concentration of 5 wt % or less by weight of the tablet.


In another embodiment, the binder is selected from polyvinylpyrrolidone, dibasic calcium phosphate, sucrose, corn starch, modified cellulose, or any combination thereof.


In another embodiment, the binder is polyvinylpyrrolidone and has a concentration of less than 10 wt % by weight of the tablet.


In another embodiment, the lubricant is selected from magnesium stearate, calcium stearate, zinc stearate, sodium stearate, stearic acid, aluminum stearate, leucine, glyceryl behenate, hydrogenated vegetable oil or any combination thereof.


In another embodiment, the lubricant is magnesium stearate and has a concentration of less than 5 wt % by weight of the tablet.


In another embodiment, the tablet further comprises a colorant.


In another aspect, the invention relates to a pharmaceutical composition comprising a plurality of granules, the composition comprising:

    • a. Compound 3 Form I in an amount ranging from about 20 wt % to about 80 wt % by weight of the composition;
    • b. a filler in an amount ranging from about 20 wt % to about 50 wt % by weight of the composition of a filler;
    • c. a disintegrant in an amount ranging from about 1 wt % to about 5 wt % by weight of the composition;
    • d. a surfactant in an amount ranging from about 2 wt % to about 0.3 wt % by weight of the composition;
    • e. a diluent in an amount ranging from about 1 wt % to about 30 wt % by weight of the composition;
    • f. a lubricant in an amount ranging from about 0.3 wt % to about 5 wt % by weight of the composition; and
    • g. at least one of a binder in an amount from about 20 wt % to about 45 wt % by weight of the composition or a glidant in an amount ranging from about 0.05 wt % to about 2 wt % by weight of the composition.


In another aspect, the invention relates to a tablet comprising:

    • a. Compound 3 Form I in an amount ranging from about 25 mg to about 250 mg;
    • b. a filler;
    • c. a diluent;
    • d. a disintegrant;
    • e. a surfactant;
    • f. a lubricant; and
    • g. at least one of a binder and a glidant.


In another aspect, the invention relates to a tablet of the formulation set forth in Table 3-13.












TABLE 3-13







Roller Compaction Granule Blend
(% w/w)









Compound 3 Form I
20-40



Microcrystalline cellulose
30-50



Mannitol
10-30



Croscarmellose Sodium
1-5



Sodium Lauryl Sulfate
0.1-2  



Colloidal Silica
0.1-1  



Magnesium Stearate
1-3



Tablet Composition
(% w/w)



(100 mg dose)




Roller Compaction Granule Blend
  99-99.9



Magnesium Stearate
0.1-1  










In another aspect, the invention relates to a tablet of the formulation set forth in Table 3-14.












TABLE 3-14







Roller Compaction Granule Blend
(% w/w)



















Compound 3 Form I
30



Microcrystalline cellulose
42.3



Mannitol
21.2



Croscarmellose Sodium
3



Sodium Lauryl Sulfate
1



Colloidal Silica
0.5



Magnesium Stearate
2



Tablet Composition
(% w/w)



(100 mg dose, 335 mg image)




Roller Compaction Granule Blend
99.5



Magnesium Stearate
0.5










In another aspect, the invention relates to a tablet of the formulation set forth in Table 3-15.












TABLE 3-15







High Shear Granule Blend
(% w/w)









Compound 3 Form I
40-80



Microcrystalline cellulose
20-40



Mannitol
10-15



Croscarmellose Sodium
1-5



Polyvinylpyrrolidone
 1-10



Sodium Lauryl Sulfate
0.1-2  



Water (removed during drying)
   25-40%




solids



Tablet Composition
(% w/w)



(100 mg dose)




High Shear Granule Blend
95-99



Croscarmellose Sodium
1-4



Magnesium Stearate
0.1-1  










In another aspect, the invention relates to a tablet of the formulation set forth in Table 3-16.












TABLE 3-16







High Shear Granule Blend
(% w/w)



















Compound 3 Form I
50



Microcrystalline cellulose
30



Mannitol
13



Croscarmellose Sodium
2



Polyvinylpyrrolidone
4



Sodium Lauryl Sulfate
1



Water (removed during drying)
   25-40%




solids



Tablet Composition
(% w/w)



(100 mg dose, 205 mg image)




High Shear Granule Blend
97.5



Croscarmellose Sodium
2.0



Magnesium Stearate
0.5










In another aspect, the invention relates to a tablet of the formulation set forth in Table 3-17.












TABLE 3-17







High Shear Granule Blend
(% w/w)



















Compound 3 Form I
60



Microcrystalline cellulose
20



Mannitol
13



Croscarmellose Sodium
2



Polyvinylpyrrolidone
4



Sodium Lauryl Sulfate
1



Water (removed during drying)
25-40%




solids



Tablet Composition
(% w/w)



(100 mg dose, 171 mg image)




High Shear Granule Blend
97.5



Croscarmellose Sodium
2.0



Magnesium Stearate
0.5










In another aspect, the invention relates to a tablet of the formulation set forth in Table 3-18.












TABLE 3-18









High Shear Granule Blend
(% w/w)







Compound 3 Form I
60



Microcrystalline cellulose
20



Mannitol
13



Croscarmellose Sodium
2



Polyvinylpyrrolidone
4



Sodium Lauryl Sulfate
1



Water (removed during drying)
25-40%




solids







Tablet Composition




(200 mg dose, 402 mg image)
(% w/w)







High Shear Granule Blend
83



Microcrystalline cellulose
14



Croscarmellose Sodium
2



Magnesium Stearate
1










In another aspect, the invention relates to a tablet of the formulation set forth in Table 3-19.












TABLE 3-19









High Shear Granule Blend
mg







Compound 3 Form I
200



Microcrystalline cellulose
66



Mannitol
43



Croscarmellose Sodium
7



Polyvinylpyrrolidone
13



Sodium Lauryl Sulfate
3







Core Tablet Composition




(200 mg dose, 400 mg image)
mg







High Shear Granule Blend
332



Microcrystalline cellulose
56



Croscarmellose Sodium
8



Magnesium Stearate
4







Film Coated Tablet




(200 mg dose, 412 mg image)
mg







Core Tablet Composition
400



Film Coat
12



Wax
0.04










In another aspect, the invention relates to a tablet of the formulation set forth in Table 3-20.












TABLE 3-20









High Shear Granule Blend
mg







Compound 3 Form I
200



Microcrystalline cellulose
67



Mannitol
45



Croscarmellose Sodium
7



Polyvinylpyrrolidone
10.4



Sodium Lauryl Sulfate
2.6







Core Tablet Composition




(200 mg dose, 400 mg image)
mg







High Shear Granule Blend
332



Microcrystalline cellulose
56



Croscarmellose Sodium
8



Magnesium Stearate
4







Film Coated Tablet




(200 mg dose, 412 mg image)
mg







Core Tablet Composition
400



Film Coat
12



Wax
0.04










In another aspect, the invention relates to a tablet of the formulation set forth in Table 3-21.












TABLE 3-21









High Shear Granule Blend
(% w/w)







Compound 3 Form I
70



Microcrystalline cellulose
12



Mannitol
11



Croscarmellose Sodium
2



Polyvinylpyrrolidone
4



Sodium Lauryl Sulfate
1



Water (removed during drying)
25-40%




solids







Tablet Composition




(100 mg dose, 147 mg image)
(% w/w)







High Shear Granule Blend
97.5



Croscarmellose Sodium
2.0



Magnesium Stearate
0.5










In another aspect, the invention relates to a tablet of the formulation set forth in Table 3-22.












TABLE 3-22









High Shear Granule Blend
(% w/w)







Compound 3 Form I or Compound 3
61



Solvate Form A




Microcrystalline cellulose
20.3



Mannitol
13.2



Croscarmellose Sodium
2



Polyvinylpyrrolidone
2.7



Sodium Lauryl Sulfate
0.7







Tablet Composition




(100 mg dose, 197 mg image)
(% w/w)







High Shear Granule Blend
83



Microcrystalline cellulose
14



Croscarmellose Sodium
2



Magnesium Stearate
1










In another aspect, the invention relates to a tablet of the formulation set forth in Table 3-23.












TABLE 3-23









High Shear Granule Blend
mg







Compound 3 Form I or Compound 3
100



Solvate Form A




Microcrystalline cellulose
33.3



Mannitol
21.7



Croscarmellose Sodium
3.3



Polyvinylpyrrolidone
4.4



Sodium Lauryl Sulfate
1.1







Core Tablet Composition




(100 mg dose, 197 mg image)
mg







High Shear Granule Blend
163.9



Microcrystalline cellulose
27.6



Croscarmellose Sodium
3.9



Magnesium Stearate
2.0










In another aspect, the invention relates to a method of producing a pharmaceutical composition comprising the steps of: combining a therapeutically effective amount of Compound 3 Form I and at least one granulation excipient selected from the group consisting of: a binder; a glidant; a surfactant; a lubricant; a disintegrant; a filler, a diluent and combinations thereof to form an admixture; mixing the admixture; and compacting the admixture to form the pharmaceutical composition.


In another embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a plurality of granules.


In another embodiment, compacting the admixture comprises compacting the admixture in a roller compactor forming compressed sheets of admixture; and milling the sheets of admixture to form a plurality of granules.


In another embodiment, the method further comprises compressing the plurality of granules with at least one pharmaceutical acceptable excipient to form a tablet.


In another embodiment, the at least one pharmaceutical acceptable excipient is selected from the group consisting of magnesium stearate, croscarmellose sodium and combinations thereof.


In another embodiment, the plurality of granules are compressed to produce a tablet having a hardness of at least 5 kP.


In another embodiment, the step of compacting the admixture to form the pharmaceutical composition further comprises drying the admixture.


In another embodiment, mixing the admixture comprises mixing the admixture until the admixture is substantially homogenous.


In another embodiment, any of the above methods of producing a pharmaceutical composition comprise a plurality of granules formed by combining Compound 3 Form I with a granulation fluid comprising a surfactant and a binder. In another embodiment, the surfactant is sodium lauryl sulfate.


In another aspect, the invention relates to a pharmaceutical composition suitable for oral administration comprising:

    • a. Compound 3 Form I in an amount ranging from about 20 wt % to about 80 wt % by weight of the composition;
    • b. a filler comprising microcrystalline cellulose in an amount ranging from about 20 wt % to about 50 wt % by weight of the composition;
    • c. a disintegrant comprising sodium croscarmellose sodium in an amount ranging from about 1 wt % to about 5 wt % by weight of the composition;
    • d. a surfactant comprising sodium lauryl sulfate in an amount ranging from about 2 wt % to about 0.3 wt % by weight of the composition;
    • e. a diluent comprising mannitol in an amount ranging from about 1 wt % to about 30 wt % by weight of the composition;
    • f. a lubricant comprising magnesium stearate in an amount ranging from about 0.3 wt % to about 5 wt % by weight of the composition; and
    • g. at least one of: a binder comprising polyvinylpyrrolidone in an amount ranging from about 0.1 wt % to about 5 wt % by weight of the composition and a glidant comprising colloidal silica in an amount ranging from about 0.05 wt % to about 2 wt % by weight of the composition.


In another embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition further comprises about 0.4 wt % of colorant by weight of the composition.


In another embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a plurality of granules.


In another embodiment, the plurality of granules have a mean or average particle diameter ranging from 100 μm to about 2 mm.


In another embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition is a tablet. In another embodiment, the tablet comprises a coating.


In another embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition further comprises at least one additional therapeutic agent. In another embodiment, the additional therapeutic agent is a CFTR modulator. In another embodiment, the CFTR modulator is a CFTR potentiator.


In another aspect, the invention relates to a dosage unit form comprising:

    • a. about 30 wt % of Compound 3 Form I by weight of the composition;
    • b. about 42 wt % of microcrystalline cellulose by weight of the composition;
    • c. about 21 wt % of mannitol by weight of the composition;
    • d. about 3 wt % of sodium croscarmellose sodium by weight of the composition;
    • e. about 1 wt % of sodium lauryl sulfate by weight of the composition;
    • f. about 2.5 wt % of magnesium stearate by weight of the composition; and
    • g. about 0.5 wt % of colloidal silica by weight of the composition.


In another aspect, the invention relates to a dosage unit form comprising

    • a. about 50 wt % of Compound 3 Form I;
    • b. about 30 wt % of microcrystalline cellulose by weight of the composition;
    • c. about 13 wt % of mannitol by weight of the composition;
    • d. about 2 wt % of sodium croscarmellose sodium by weight of the composition;
    • e. about 4 wt % of polyvinylpyrrolidone by weight of the composition;
    • f. about 1 wt % of sodium lauryl sulfate by weight of the composition; and
    • g. about 0.5 wt % of magnesium stearate by weight of the composition.


In another aspect, the invention relates to a dosage unit form comprising

    • a. about 60 wt % of Compound 3 Form I;
    • b. about 20 wt % of microcrystalline cellulose by weight of the composition;
    • c. about 13 wt % of mannitol by weight of the composition;
    • d. about 2 wt % of sodium croscarmellose sodium by weight of the composition;
    • e. about 4 wt % of polyvinylpyrrolidone by weight of the composition;
    • f. about 1 wt % of sodium lauryl sulfate by weight of the composition; and
    • g. about 0.5 wt % of magnesium stearate by weight of the composition.


In another aspect, the invention relates to a dosage unit form comprising

    • a. about 60 wt % of Compound 3 Form I;
    • b. about 34 wt % of microcrystalline cellulose by weight of the composition;
    • c. about 13 wt % of mannitol by weight of the composition;
    • d. about 4 wt % of sodium croscarmellose sodium by weight of the composition;
    • e. about 4 wt % of polyvinylpyrrolidone by weight of the composition;
    • f. about 1 wt % of sodium lauryl sulfate by weight of the composition; and
    • g. about 1.5 wt % of magnesium stearate by weight of the composition.


In another aspect, the invention relates to a dosage unit form comprising

    • a. about 200 mg of Compound 3 Form I;
    • b. about 43 mg of mannitol;
    • c. about 123 mg of microcrystalline cellulose;
    • d. about 15 mg of croscarmellose sodium;
    • e. about 13 mg of polyvinylpyrrolidone;
    • f. about 3 mg of sodium lauryl sulfate; and
    • g. about 4 mg of magnesium stearate.


In another aspect, the invention relates to a dosage unit form comprising

    • a. about 70 wt % of Compound 3 Form I;
    • b. about 12 wt % of microcrystalline cellulose by weight of the composition;
    • c. about 11 wt % of mannitol by weight of the composition;
    • d. about 2 wt % of sodium croscarmellose sodium by weight of the composition;
    • e. about 4 wt % of polyvinylpyrrolidone by weight of the composition;
    • f. about 1 wt % of sodium lauryl sulfate by weight of the composition; and
    • g. about 0.5 wt % of magnesium stearate by weight of the composition.


In another aspect, the invention relates to a method of administering a tablet comprising orally administering to a patient at least once per day a tablet comprising:

    • a. about 25 to 200 mg of Compound 3 Form I;
    • b. a filler;
    • c. a diluent;
    • d. a disintegrant;
    • e. a surfactant;
    • f. at least one of a binder and a glidant; and
    • g. a lubricant.


In another embodiment, the tablet comprises about 25 mg of Compound 3 Form I. In another embodiment, the tablet comprises about 75 mg of Compound 3 Form I. In another embodiment, the tablet comprises about 100 mg of Compound 3 Form I. In another embodiment, the tablet comprises about 150 mg of Compound 3 Form I. In another embodiment, the tablet comprises about 200 mg of Compound 3 Form I.


In another aspect, the invention relates to a method of administering a tablet comprising orally administering to a patient twice per day a tablet comprising:

    • a. about 25 to 200 mg of Compound 3 Form I;
    • b. a filler;
    • c. a diluent;
    • d. a disintegrant;
    • e. a surfactant;
    • f. at least one of a binder and a glidant; and
    • g. a lubricant.


In another embodiment, the tablet comprises about 25 mg of Compound 3 Form I. In another embodiment, the tablet comprises about 50 mg of Compound 3 Form I. In another embodiment, the tablet comprises about 75 mg of Compound 3 Form I. In another embodiment, the tablet comprises about 100 mg of Compound 3 Form I. In another embodiment, the tablet comprises about 150 mg of Compound 3 Form I. In another embodiment, the tablet comprises about 200 mg of Compound 3 Form I.


In another aspect, the invention relates to a method for administering a tablet comprising orally administering to a patient once every 12 hours a tablet comprising:

    • a. about 25 to 200 mg of Compound 3 Form I;
    • b. a filler;
    • c. a diluent;
    • d. a disintegrant;
    • e. a surfactant;
    • f. at least one of a binder and a glidant; and
    • g. a lubricant.


In another embodiment, the tablet comprises about 25 mg of Compound 3 Form I. In another embodiment, the tablet comprises about 50 mg of Compound 3 Form I. In another embodiment, the tablet comprises about 75 mg of Compound 3 Form I. In another embodiment, the tablet comprises about 100 mg of Compound 3 Form I. In another embodiment, the tablet comprises about 150 mg of Compound 3 Form I. In another embodiment, the tablet comprises about 200 mg of Compound 3 Form I.


IV.B.3.b. Preparations of Compound 3 Form I Tablet Formulations
Equipment/Process
Equipment

Roller Compactors: Alexanderwerk WP 120, Vector TF-Mini, or Vector TF-Labo.


Screening/Weighing

Compound 3 and excipients may be screened prior to or after weigh-out. Appropriate screen sizes are mesh 20, mesh 40, or mesh 60. Compound 3 may be pre-blended with one or more of the excipients to simplify screening.


Blending

Compound 3 and excipients may be added to the blender in different order. The blending may be performed in a Turbula blender or a v-shell blender. The components may be blended for 10 minutes without lubricant followed by additional blending with lubricant for 3 minutes.


Roller Compaction

The blend may be roller compacted in ribbons and milled into granules using an Alexanderwerk WP 120. The rolls used may be the 25 mm rolls using a compaction pressure of 18 to 50 bar, a roller speed of 3 to 12 RPM, and a screw feeder speed of 20 to 80 RPM. The screen sizes of the integrated mill may be 2 mm for the top screen and 0.8 mm for the bottom screen.


Blending

The roller compacted granules may be blended with extra-granular excipients such as fillers and lubricant using a V-shell blender. The blending time may be 5, 3 or 1 minute(s).


Compression

The compression blend has been compressed into tablets using a single station Riva MiniPress with 10 mm tooling. The weight of the tablets for a 100 mg dose may be about 200, 250, or 300 mg.


Film Coating

Tablets may be film coated using a pan coater, such as, for example an O'Hara Labcoat.


Printing

Film coated tablets may be printed with a monogram on one or both tablet faces with, for example, a Hartnett Delta printer.


Tablet Formation from High Shear Granule Composition


Equipment/Process
Equipment

Granulator: Procept MiPro with a 250 ml or 1 L granulation bowl, or a Collette Gral with a 10 L bowl.


Screening/Weighing

Compound 3 and excipients may be screened prior to or after weigh-out. Possible screen sizes are mesh 20, mesh 40, or mesh 60. Compound 3 may be pre-blended with one or more of the excipients to simplify screening.


Granulation Operation

Granulation Fluid—SLS and binder are added to purified water and mixed until dissolved. A suitable ratio is 2.5% w/w SLS and 10.0% w/w PVP K30 in water.


Granulation—The excipients and Compound 3 are added to the granulation bowl. The order of addition may be Compound 3, disintegrant, diluent, and filler. The components may be mixed in the 250 ml bowl for 1 minute at impeller speed 1000 RPM and chopper speed 1000 RPM. Granulation may be performed at an impeller speed of 2000 RPM with a chopper speed of 4000 RPM while adding the granulation fluid with a syringe pump at 1.5 to 4.5 g/min. The fluid addition time may be 4 to 12 minutes. After the required binder fluid is added, the granules may be wet-massed for about 10 seconds to about 1 minute.


Drying

The granules may be dried using a vacuum oven, tray dryer, bi-conical dryer, or fluid bed drier. The granules have been dried using a vacuum oven with a nitrogen purge. After drying, the granules may be milled to an appropriate size using, for example, a Quadro Comil prior to blending.


Blending

The granules may be blended with extra-granular excipients. The granules have been blended with extra-granular disintegrant, diluent, filler, and lubricant. The granules have been blended using the Turbula blender for 3 minutes pre-lubricant and 1 minute with lubricant. A larger scale blender such as a 4-quart V-shell blender may be used.


Compression

The compression blend has been compressed into tablets using a single station Riva MiniPress with 8 mm, or 10 mm tooling. The weight of the tablets for a 100 mg dose may be about 160, 200, or 250 mg. The tablet can also be compressed using a rotary press, for example, a Picola or Fette press.


Film Coating

Tablets may be film coated using a pan coater, such as, for example an O'Hara Labcoat, or a Thomas Engineering Compu Lab coater.


Printing

Film coated tablets may be printed with a monogram on one or both tablet faces with, for example, a Hartnett Delta printer.


IV.C. Formulations of Compound 4
IV.C.1. Compound 4 Tablet Formulation
IV.C.1.a. Embodiments of Compound 4 Tablet Formulation

In one aspect, the invention features a tablet for oral administration comprising: a) Compound 4; b) a filler; c) a diluent; d) a disintegrant; e) a lubricant; and f) a glidant.


In some embodiments, Compound 4 is in a substantially amorphous form (Compound 4 Amorphous Form). In other embodiments, Compound 4 is in a substantially crystalline solid form. In one embodiment, Compound 4 is in substantially crystalline Form A (Compound 4 Form A). In other embodiments, Compound 4 is in a mixture of solid (i.e., amorphous and crystalline) forms.


In one embodiment, Compound 4 or Compound 4 Amorphous Form is present in the tablet in an amount ranging from about 25 mg to about 250 mg. In one embodiment, Compound 4 or Compound 4 Amorphous Form is present in the tablet in an amount of about 50 mg to about 200 mg. In one embodiment, Compound 4 or Compound 4 Amorphous Form is present in the tablet in an amount of about 100 mg.


In one embodiment, the amount of Compound 4 or Compound 4 Amorphous Form in the tablet ranges from about 10 wt % to about 50 wt % by weight of the tablet. In one embodiment, the amount of Compound 4 or Compound 4 Amorphous Form in the tablet ranges from about 20 wt % to about 30 wt % by weight of the tablet. In one embodiment, the amount of Compound 4 or Compound 4 Amorphous Form in the tablet is about 25 wt % of the tablet.


In one embodiment, the filler is selected from cellulose, modified cellulose, sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose hydroxymethyl cellulose, hydroxypropylcellulose, cellulose acetate, microcrystalline cellulose, dibasic calcium phosphate, sucrose, lactose, corn starch, potato starch, or any combination thereof. In one embodiment, the filler is microcrystalline cellulose (MCC) and is present in the tablet in an amount ranging from about 10 wt % to about 30 wt % by weight of the tablet.


In one embodiment, the diluent is selected from lactose monohydrate, mannitol, sorbitol, cellulose, calcium phosphate, starch, sugar or any combination thereof. In one embodiment, the diluent is lactose monohydrate and is present in the tablet in an amount ranging from about 10 wt % to about 30 wt % by weight of the tablet.


In one embodiment, the disintegrant is selected from agar-agar, algins, calcium carbonate, carboxmethylcellulose, cellulose, hydroxypropylcellulose, low substituted hydroxypropylcellulose, clays, croscarmellose sodium, crosspovidone, gums, magnesium aluminum silicate, methylcellulose, polacrilin potassium, sodium alginate, sodium starch glycolate, maize starch, potato starch, tapioca starch, or any combination thereof. In one embodiment, the disintegrant is croscarmellose sodium and is present in the tablet at a concentration of 5 wt % or less by weight of the tablet.


In one embodiment, the lubricant is selected from magnesium stearate, calcium stearate, zinc stearate, sodium stearate, stearic acid, aluminum stearate, leucine, glyceryl behenate, hydrogenated vegetable oil or any combination thereof. In one embodiment, the lubricant is magnesium stearate and has a concentration of less than 2 wt % by weight of the tablet.


In one embodiment, the glidant is selected from colloidal silicon dioxide, talc, corn starch, or a combination thereof. In one embodiment, the glidant is colloidal silicon dioxide and has a concentration of 3 wt % or less by weight of the tablet.


In one embodiment, the tablet further comprises a colorant.


In one aspect, the invention features a tablet comprising a plurality of granules, the composition comprising: a) Compound 4 Amorphous Form in an amount ranging from about 10 wt % to about 50 wt % by weight of the composition; b) a filler in an amount ranging from about 10 wt % to about 30 wt % by weight of the composition; c) a diluent in an amount ranging from about 10 wt % to about 30 wt % by weight of the composition; d) a disintegrant in an amount ranging from about 1 wt % to about 5 wt % by weight of the composition; e) a lubricant in an amount ranging from about 0.3 wt % to about 3 wt % by weight of the composition; and f) a glidant in an amount ranging from about 0.3 wt % to about 3 wt % by weight of the composition.


In one embodiment, Compound 4 is Compound 4 Amorphous Form and is in a spray dried dispersion. In one embodiment, the spray dried dispersion comprises a polymer. In one embodiment, the polymer is hydroxypropylmethylcellulose (HPMC). In one embodiment, the polymer is hydroxypropylmethylcellulose acetate succinate (HPMCAS).


In one embodiment, the polymer is present in an amount from 20% by weight to 70% by weight. In one embodiment, the polymer is present in an amount from 30% by weight to 60% by weight. In one embodiment, the polymer is present in an amount of about 49.5% by weight.


In one embodiment, the tablet further comprises a surfactant. In one embodiment, the surfactant is sodium lauryl sulfate. In one embodiment, the surfactant is present in an amount from 0.1% by weight to 5% by weight. In one embodiment, the surfactant is present in an amount of about 0.5% by weight.


In another aspect, the invention features a tablet of the formulation set forth in Table 4-9.












TABLE 4-9







Final Blend





Composition
Tablet


Component
Function
% w/w
(mg/tablet)


















50% Compound 4/
Active as a
50.00
200.0 SDD


49.5% HPMCAS-
spray dried

(100.00


HG/0.5% sodium
dispersion

Compound 4)


lauryl sulfate
(SSD)




Microcrystalline
Filler
22.63
90.5


cellulose





Lactose Monohydrate
Diluent
22.63
90.5


Crosscarmelose
Disintegrant
3.00
12.0


Sodium





Magnesium Stearate
Lubricant
0.25
1.0


Colloidal Silica
Glidant
1.00
4.0


Dioxide






Intragranular
99.5




content




Extragranular Blend





Colloidal Silica
Glidant
0.25
1.0


Dioxide





Magnesium Stearate
Lubricant
0.25
1.0



Extragranular
0.5




content





Total
100.00
400.0









In another aspect, the invention features a tablet of the formulation set forth in Table 4-10.












TABLE 4-10







Final Blend





Composition
Tablet


Component
Function
% w/w
(mg/tablet)


















50% Compound 4/
Active as a
50.00
100.0 SDD


49.5% HPMCAS-
spray dried

(50.00


HG/0.5% sodium
dispersion

Compound 4)


lauryl sulfate
(SSD)




Microcrystalline
Filler
22.63
45.25


cellulose





Lactose Monohydrate
Diluent
22.63
45.25


Crosscarmelose
Disintegrant
3.00
6.0


Sodium





Magnesium Stearate
Lubricant
0.25
0.5


Colloidal Silica
Glidant
1.00
2.0


Dioxide






Intragranular
99.5




content




Extragranular Blend





Colloidal Silica
Glidant
0.25
0.5


Dioxide





Magnesium Stearate
Lubricant
0.25
0.5



Extragranular
0.5




content





Total
100.00
200.0









In another aspect, the invention provides a pharmaceutical composition in the form of a tablet that comprises Compound 4, and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable excipients, for example, a filler, a disintegrant, a surfactant, a diluent, a glidant, and a lubricant and any combination thereof, where the tablet has a dissolution of at least about 50% in about 30 minutes. In another embodiment, the dissolution rate is at least about 75% in about 30 minutes. In another embodiment, the dissolution rate is at least about 90% in about 30 minutes.


In another aspect, the invention provides a pharmaceutical composition in the form of a tablet that comprises a powder blend or granules comprising Compound 4, and, one or more pharmaceutically acceptable excipients, for example, a filler, a disintegrant, a surfactant, a diluent, a glidant, and a lubricant, wherein the tablet has a hardness of at least about 5 kP (kP=kilo Ponds; 1 kP=˜9.8 N). In another embodiment, the tablet has a target friability of less than 1.0% after 400 revolutions.


In another aspect, the invention provides a tablet as described herein further comprising an additional therapeutic agent. In one embodiment, the additional therapeutic agent is a mucolytic agent, bronchodialator, an antibiotic, an anti-infective agent, an anti-inflammatory agent, a CFTR modulator other than Compound 4, or a nutritional agent. In some embodiments, the additional therapeutic agent is a pharmaceutical composition comprising Compound 1 and Compound 2.


In one aspect, the invention features a method of administering a tablet comprising orally administering to a patient at least once per day a tablet comprising: a) about 25 to 200 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form; b) a filler; c) a diluent; d) a disintegrant; e) a surfactant; f) a glidant; and g) a lubricant. In one embodiment, the tablet comprises about 25 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In one embodiment, the tablet comprises about 50 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In one embodiment, the tablet comprises about 100 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In one embodiment, the tablet comprises about 150 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In one embodiment, the tablet comprises about 200 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form.


In one aspect, the invention features a method of administering a tablet comprising orally administering to a patient twice per day a tablet comprising: a) about 25 to 200 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form; b) a filler; c) a diluent; d) a disintegrant; e) a surfactant; f) a glidant; and g) a lubricant. In one embodiment, the tablet comprises about 25 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In one embodiment, the tablet comprises about 50 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In one embodiment, the tablet comprises about 100 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In one embodiment, the tablet comprises about 150 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In one embodiment, the tablet comprises about 200 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form.


In one aspect, the invention features a method for administering a tablet comprising orally administering to a patient once every 12 hours a tablet comprising: a) about 25 to 200 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form; b) a filler; c) a diluent; d) a disintegrant; e) a surfactant; f) a glidant; and g) a lubricant. In one embodiment, the tablet comprises about 25 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In one embodiment, the tablet comprises about 50 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In one embodiment, the tablet comprises about 100 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In one embodiment, the tablet comprises about 200 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form.


Compound 4 Pharmaceutical Compositions


The invention provides pharmaceutical compositions, pharmaceutical formulations and solid dosage forms such as tablets comprising Compound 4 Amorphous Form or Compound 4 Form A. In some embodiments of this aspect, the amount of Compound 4 that is present in the pharmaceutical composition is 25 mg, 50 mg, 75 mg, 100 mg, 125 mg, 150 mg, or 200 mg. In some embodiments of this aspect, weight/weight relative percent of Compound 4 that is present in the pharmaceutical composition is from 10 to 50 percent. In these and other embodiments, Compound 4 is present as substantially pure Compound 4 Amorphous Form. “Substantially pure” means greater than ninety percent pure; preferably greater than 95 percent pure; more preferably greater than 99.5 percent pure (i.e., not mixed with crystalline forms of Compound 4).


Thus in one aspect, the invention provides a pharmaceutical composition comprising:

    • a. Compound 4 Amorphous Form;
    • b. a filler;
    • c. a disintegrant;
    • d. a diluent;
    • e. a lubricant; and
    • g. a glidant.


In one embodiment of this aspect, the pharmaceutical composition comprises 25 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In another embodiment of this aspect, the pharmaceutical composition comprises 50 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In another embodiment of this aspect, the pharmaceutical composition comprises 100 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In another embodiment of this aspect, the pharmaceutical composition comprises 125 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In another embodiment of this aspect, the pharmaceutical composition comprises 150 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form. In another embodiment of this aspect, the pharmaceutical composition comprises 200 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form.


In some embodiments, the pharmaceutical compositions comprises Compound 4 Amorphous Form, wherein Compound 4 Amorphous Form is present in an amount of at least 15 wt % (e.g., at least 20 wt %, at least 30 wt %, at least 40 wt %, at least 50 wt %, or at least 60 wt %) by weight of the composition.


In some embodiments, the pharmaceutical composition comprises Compound 4 Amorphous Form, a filler, a diluent, a disintegrant, a glidant, and a lubricant. In this embodiment, the composition comprises from about 10 wt % to about 50 wt % (e.g., about 15-45 wt %) of Compound 4 Amorphous Form by weight of the composition, and more typically, from 20 wt % to about 40 wt % (e.g., about 25-30 wt %) of Compound 4 Amorphous Form by weight of the composition.


In some embodiments, the pharmaceutical composition comprises Compound 4 Amorphous Form, a filler, a diluent, a disintegrant, a glidant, and a lubricant. In this embodiment, the composition comprises from about 10 wt % to about 50 wt % (e.g., about 15-45 wt %) of Compound 4 Amorphous Form by weight of the composition, and more typically from 20 wt % to about 40 wt % (e.g., about 25-30 wt %) of Compound 4 Amorphous Form by weight of the composition.


The concentration of Compound 4 Amorphous Form in the composition depends on several factors such as the amount of pharmaceutical composition needed to provide a desired amount of Compound 4 Amorphous Form and the desired dissolution profile of the pharmaceutical composition.


In another embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises Compound 4 in which the Compound 4 in its solid form has a mean particle diameter, measured by light scattering (e.g., using a Malvern Mastersizer available from Malvern Instruments in England) of 0.1 microns to 10 microns. In another embodiment, the particle size of Compound 4 is 1 micron to 5 microns. In another embodiment, Compound 4 has a particle size D50 of 2.0 microns.


As indicated, in addition to Compound 4 Amorphous Form, in some embodiments of the invention, the pharmaceutical compositions which are oral formulations also comprise one or more excipients such as fillers, disintegrants, surfactants, diluents, glidants, lubricants, colorants, or fragrances and any combination thereof.


Fillers suitable for the invention are compatible with the ingredients of the pharmaceutical composition, i.e., they do not substantially reduce the solubility, the hardness, the chemical stability, the physical stability, or the biological activity of the pharmaceutical composition. Exemplary fillers include: celluloses, modified celluloses, (e.g. sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose hydroxymethyl cellulose, hydroxypropylcellulose), cellulose acetate, microcrystalline cellulose, calcium phosphates, dibasic calcium phosphate, starches (e.g. corn starch, potato starch), sugars (e.g., sorbitol) lactose, sucrose, or the like), or any combination thereof.


Thus, in one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises at least one filler in an amount of at least 5 wt % (e.g., at least about 20 wt %, at least about 30 wt %, or at least about 40 wt %) by weight of the composition. For example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 10 wt % to about 60 wt % (e.g., from about 10 wt % to about 55 wt %, from about 15 wt % to about 30 wt %, or from about 20 wt % to about 25 wt %) of filler, by weight of the composition. In another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises at least about 20 wt % (e.g., at least 20 wt % or at least 20 wt %) of microcrystalline cellulose, for example MCC Avicel PH102, by weight of the composition.


Disintegrants suitable for the invention enhance the dispersal of the pharmaceutical composition and are compatible with the ingredients of the pharmaceutical composition, i.e., they do not substantially reduce the chemical stability, the physical stability, the hardness, or the biological activity of the pharmaceutical composition. Exemplary disintegrants include croscarmellose sodium, sodium starch glycolate, or a combination thereof.


Thus, in one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises disintegrant in an amount of about 10 wt % or less (e.g., about 7 wt % or less, about 6 wt % or less, or about 5 wt % or less) by weight of the composition. For example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 1 wt % to about 10 wt % (e.g., from about 1.5 wt % to about 7.5 wt % or from about 2.5 wt % to about 6 wt %) of disintegrant, by weight of the composition. In some examples, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 0.1% to about 10 wt % (e.g., from about 0.5 wt % to about 7.5 wt % or from about 1.5 wt % to about 6 wt %) of disintegrant, by weight of the composition. In still other examples, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 0.5% to about 10 wt % (e.g., from about 1.5 wt % to about 7.5 wt % or from about 2.5 wt % to about 6 wt %) of disintegrant, by weight of the composition.


Surfactants suitable for the invention enhance the wettability of the pharmaceutical composition and are compatible with the ingredients of the pharmaceutical composition, i.e., they do not substantially reduce the chemical stability, the physical stability, the hardness, or the biological activity of the pharmaceutical composition. Exemplary surfactants include sodium lauryl sulfate (SLS), sodium stearyl fumarate (SSF), polyoxyethylene 20 sorbitan mono-oleate (e.g., Tween™), any combination thereof, or the like.


Thus, in one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a surfactant in an amount of about 10 wt % or less (e.g., about 5 wt % or less, about 2 wt % or less, about 1 wt % or less, about 0.8 wt % or less, or about 0.6 wt % or less) by weight of the composition. For example, the pharmaceutical composition includes from about 10 wt % to about 0.1 wt % (e.g., from about 5 wt % to about 0.2 wt % or from about 2 wt % to about 0.3 wt %) of surfactant, by weight of the composition. In yet another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 10 wt % to about 0.1 wt % (e.g., from about 5 wt % to about 0.2 wt % or from about 2 wt % to about 0.3 wt %) of sodium lauryl sulfate, by weight of the composition.


Diluents suitable for the invention may add necessary bulk to a formulation to prepare tablets of the desired size and are generally compatible with the ingredients of the pharmaceutical composition, i.e., they do not substantially reduce the solubility, the hardness, the chemical stability, the physical stability, or the biological activity of the pharmaceutical composition. Exemplary diluents include: sugars, for example, confectioner's sugar, compressible sugar, dextrates, dextrin, dextrose, lactose, lactose monohydrate, mannitol, sorbitol, cellulose, and modified celluloses, for example, powdered cellulose, talc, calcium phosphate, starch, or any combination thereof.


Thus, in one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a diluent in an amount of 40 wt % or less (e.g., 35 wt % or less, 30 wt % or less, or 25 wt % or less, or 20 wt % or less, or 15 wt % or less, or 10 wt % or less) by weight of the composition. For example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 40 wt % to about 1 wt % (e.g., from about 35 wt % to about 5 wt % or from about 30 wt % to about 7 wt %, from about 25 wt % to about 15 wt %) of diluent, by weight of the composition. In another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises 40 wt % or less (e.g., 35 wt % or less, or 25 wt % or less) of lactose monohydrate, by weight of the composition. In yet another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 35 wt % to about 1 wt % (e.g., from about 30 wt % to about 5 wt % or from about 25 wt % to about 10 wt %) of lactose monohydrate, by weight of the composition.


Glidants suitable for the invention enhance the flow properties of the pharmaceutical composition and are compatible with the ingredients of the pharmaceutical composition, i.e., they do not substantially reduce the solubility, the hardness, the chemical stability, the physical stability, or the biological activity of the pharmaceutical composition. Exemplary glidants include colloidal silicon dioxide, talc, or a combination thereof.


Thus, in one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a glidant in an amount of 2 wt % or less (e.g., 1.75 wt %, 1.25 wt % or less, or 1.00 wt % or less) by weight of the composition. For example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 2 wt % to about 0.05 wt % (e.g., from about 1.5 wt % to about 0.07 wt % or from about 1.0 wt % to about 0.09 wt %) of glidant, by weight of the composition. In another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises 2 wt % or less (e.g., 1.75 wt %, 1.25 wt % or less, or 1.00 wt % or less) of colloidal silicon dioxide, by weight of the composition. In yet another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 2 wt % to about 0.05 wt % (e.g., from about 1.5 wt % to about 0.07 wt % or from about 1.0 wt % to about 0.09 wt %) of colloidal silicon dioxide, by weight of the composition.


In some embodiments, the pharmaceutical composition can include an oral solid pharmaceutical dosage form which can comprise a lubricant that can prevent adhesion of a granulate-bead admixture to a surface (e.g., a surface of a mixing bowl, a compression die and/or punch). A lubricant can also reduce interparticle friction within the granulate and improve the compression and ejection of compressed pharmaceutical compositions from a die press. The lubricant is also compatible with the ingredients of the pharmaceutical composition, i.e., they do not substantially reduce the solubility, the hardness, or the biological activity of the pharmaceutical composition. Exemplary lubricants include magnesium stearate, calcium stearate, zinc stearate, sodium stearate, stearic acid, aluminum stearate, leucine, glyceryl behenate, hydrogenated vegetable oil or any combination thereof. In one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a lubricant in an amount of 5 wt % or less (e.g., 4.75 wt %, 4.0 wt % or less, or 3.00 wt % or less, or 2.0 wt % or less) by weight of the composition. For example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 5 wt % to about 0.10 wt % (e.g., from about 4.5 wt % to about 0.5 wt % or from about 3 wt % to about 0.5 wt %) of lubricant, by weight of the composition. In another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises 5 wt % or less (e.g., 4.0 wt % or less, 3.0 wt % or less, or 2.0 wt % or less, or 1.0 wt % or less) of magnesium stearate, by weight of the composition. In yet another example, the pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 5 wt % to about 0.10 wt % (e.g., from about 4.5 wt % to about 0.15 wt % or from about 3.0 wt % to about 0.50 wt %) of magnesium stearate, by weight of the composition.


Pharmaceutical compositions of the invention can optionally comprise one or more colorants, flavors, and/or fragrances to enhance the visual appeal, taste, and/or scent of the composition. Suitable colorants, flavors, or fragrances are compatible with the ingredients of the pharmaceutical composition, i.e., they do not substantially reduce the solubility, the chemical stability, the physical stability, the hardness, or the biological activity of the pharmaceutical composition. In one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a colorant, a flavor, and/or a fragrance. In one embodiment, the pharmaceutical compositions provided by the invention are purple.


In some embodiments, the pharmaceutical composition includes or can be made into tablets and the tablets can be coated with a colorant and optionally labeled with a logo, other image and/or text using a suitable ink. In still other embodiments, the pharmaceutical composition includes or can be made into tablets and the tablets can be coated with a colorant, waxed, and optionally labeled with a logo, other image and/or text using a suitable ink. Suitable colorants and inks are compatible with the ingredients of the pharmaceutical composition, i.e., they do not substantially reduce the solubility, the chemical stability, the physical stability, the hardness, or the biological activity of the pharmaceutical composition. The suitable colorants and inks can be any color and are water based or solvent based. In one embodiment, tablets made from the pharmaceutical composition are coated with a colorant and then labeled with a logo, other image, and/or text using a suitable ink. For example, tablets comprising pharmaceutical composition as described herein can be coated with about 3 wt % (e.g., less than about 6 wt % or less than about 4 wt %) of film coating comprising a colorant. The colored tablets can be labeled with a logo and text indicating the strength of the active ingredient in the tablet using a suitable ink. In another example, tablets comprising pharmaceutical composition as described herein can be coated with about 3 wt % (e.g., less than about 6 wt % or less than about 4 wt %) of a film coating comprising a colorant.


In another embodiment, tablets made from the pharmaceutical composition are coated with a colorant, waxed, and then labeled with a logo, other image, and/or text using a suitable ink. For example, tablets comprising pharmaceutical composition as described herein can be coated with about 3 wt % (e.g., less than about 6 wt % or less than about 4 wt %) of film coating comprising a colorant. The colored tablets can be waxed with Carnauba wax powder weighed out in the amount of about 0.01% w/w of the starting tablet core weight. The waxed tablets can be labeled with a logo and text indicating the strength of the active ingredient in the tablet using a suitable ink. In another example, tablets comprising pharmaceutical composition as described herein can be coated with about 3 wt % (e.g., less than about 6 wt % or less than about 4 wt %) of a film coating comprising a colorant. The colored tablets can be waxed with Carnauba wax powder weighed out in the amount of about 0.01% w/w of the starting tablet core weight. The waxed tablets can be labeled with a logo and text indicating the strength of the active ingredient in the tablet using a pharmaceutical grade ink such as a black ink (e.g., Opacode® S-1-17823, a solvent based ink, commercially available from Colorcon, Inc. of West Point, Pa.).


One exemplary pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 15 wt % to about 70 wt % (e.g., from about 15 wt % to about 60 wt %, from about 15 wt % to about 50 wt %, or from about 25 wt % to about 50 wt %, or from about 20 wt % to about 70 wt %, or from about 30 wt % to about 70 wt %, or from about 40 wt % to about 70 wt %, or from about 50 wt % to about 70 wt %) of Compound 4 Amorphous Form, by weight of the composition. The aforementioned compositions can also include one or more pharmaceutically acceptable excipients, for example, from about 20 wt % to about 50 wt % of a filler; from about 1 wt % to about 5 wt % of a disintegrant; from about 2 wt % to about 0.25 wt % of a surfactant; from about 1 wt % to about 30 wt % of a diluent; from about 2 wt % to about 0.05 wt % of a glidant; and from about 5 wt % to about 0.1 wt % of a lubricant. Or, the pharmaceutical composition comprises a composition containing from about 15 wt % to about 70 wt % (e.g., from about 20 wt % to about 60 wt %, from about 25 wt % to about 55 wt %, or from about 30 wt % to about 50 wt %) of Compound 4 Amorphous Form, by weight of the composition; and one or more excipients, for example, from about 20 wt % to about 50 wt % of a filler; from about 1 wt % to about 5 wt % of a disintegrant; from about 2 wt % to about 0.25 wt % of a surfactant; from about 1 wt % to about 30 wt % of a diluent; from about 2 wt % to about 0.05 wt % of a glidant; and from about 5 wt % to about 0.1 wt % of a lubricant.


Another exemplary pharmaceutical composition comprises from about 15 wt % to about 70 wt % (e.g., from about 15 wt % to about 60 wt %, from about 15 wt % to about 50 wt %, or from about 25 wt % to about 50 wt % or from about 20 wt % to about 70 wt %, or from about 30 wt % to about 70 wt %, or from about 40 wt % to about 70 wt %, or from about 50 wt % to about 70 wt %) of Compound 4 Amorphous Form by weight of the composition, and one or more excipients, for example, from about 20 wt % to about 50 wt % of a filler; from about 1 wt % to about 5 wt % of a disintegrant; from about 2 wt % to about 0.25 wt % of a surfactant; from about 1 wt % to about 30 wt % of a diluent; from about 2 wt % to about 0.05 wt % of a glidant; and from about 2 wt % to about 0.1 wt % of a lubricant.


In one embodiment, the invention is a granular pharmaceutical composition comprising:

    • a. about 25 wt % of Compound 4 Amorphous Form by weight of the composition;
    • b. about 22.5 wt % of microcrystalline cellulose by weight of the composition;
    • c. about 22.5 wt % of lactose monohydrate by weight of the composition;
    • d. about 3 wt % of sodium croscarmellose sodium by weight of the composition;
    • e. about 0.25 wt % of sodium lauryl sulfate by weight of the composition;
    • f. about 0.5 wt % of magnesium stearate by weight of the composition; and
    • g. about 1.25 wt % of colloidal silica by weight of the composition.


In one embodiment, the invention is a granular pharmaceutical composition comprising:

    • a. about 25 wt % of Compound 4 Amorphous Form by weight of the composition;
    • b. about 22.5 wt % of microcrystalline cellulose by weight of the composition;
    • c. about 22.5 wt % of lactose monohydrate by weight of the composition;
    • d. about 3 wt % of sodium croscarmellose sodium by weight of the composition;
    • e. about 0.25 wt % of sodium lauryl sulfate by weight of the composition;
    • f. about 0.5 wt % of magnesium stearate by weight of the composition;
    • g. about 1.25 wt % of colloidal silica by weight of the composition; and
    • h. about 25 wt % of a polymer.


In another embodiment, the polymer is HPMCAS.


The pharmaceutical compositions of the invention can be processed into a tablet form, capsule form, pouch form, lozenge form, or other solid form that is suited for oral administration. Thus in some embodiments, the pharmaceutical compositions are in tablet form.


In still another pharmaceutical oral formulation of the invention, a shaped pharmaceutical tablet composition having an initial hardness of 5-21 kP±20 percent comprises: about 25 wt % of Compound 4 Amorphous Form; about 22.5 wt % of microcrystalline cellulose by weight of the composition; about 22.5 wt % of lactose monohydrate by weight of the composition; about 3 wt % of sodium croscarmellose sodium by weight of the composition; about 0.25 wt % of sodium lauryl sulfate by weight of the composition; about 0.5 wt % of magnesium stearate by weight of the composition; and about 1.25 wt % of colloidal silica by weight of the composition. Wherein the amount of Compound 4 Amorphous Form in the shaped pharmaceutical tablet ranges from about 25 mg to about 200 mg, for example, 50 mg, or 75 mg, or 100 mg, or 150 mg or 200 mg Compound 4 Amorphous Form per tablet.


In certain embodiments, the shaped pharmaceutical tablet contains about 100 mg of Compound 4 Amorphous Form.


Another aspect of the invention provides a pharmaceutical formulation consisting of a tablet or capsule that includes a Compound 4 Amorphous Form and other excipients (e.g., a filler, a disintegrant, a surfactant, a glidant, a colorant, a lubricant, or any combination thereof), each of which is described above and in the Examples below, wherein the tablet has a dissolution of at least about 50% (e.g., at least about 60%, at least about 70%, at least about 80%, at least about 90%, or at least about 99%) in about 30 minutes. In one example, the pharmaceutical composition consists of a tablet that includes Compound 4 Amorphous Form in an amount ranging from 25 mg to 200 mg, for example, 25 mg, or 50 mg, or 75 mg, or 100 mg, or 150 mg, or 200 mg and one or more excipients (e.g., a filler, a disintegrant, a surfactant, a glidant, a colorant, a lubricant, or any combination thereof), each of which is described above and in the Examples below, wherein the tablet has a dissolution of from about 50% to about 100% (e.g., from about 55% to about 95% or from about 60% to about 90%) in about 30 minutes.


In one embodiment, the tablet comprises a composition comprising at least about 25 mg (e.g., at least about 30 mg, at least about 40 mg, or at least about 50 mg) of Compound 4 Amorphous Form; and one or more excipients from: a filler, a diluent, a disintegrant, a surfactant, a glidant, and a lubricant. In another embodiment, the tablet comprises a composition comprising at least about 25 mg (e.g., at least about 30 mg, at least about 40 mg, at least about 50 mg, at least about 100 mg, or at least 150 mg) of Compound 4 Amorphous Form and one or more excipients from: a filler, a diluent, a disintegrant, a surfactant, a glidant, and a lubricant.


Dissolution can be measured with a standard USP Type II apparatus that employs a dissolution media of 0.1% CTAB dissolved in 900 mL of DI water, buffered at pH 6.8 with 50 mM potassium phosphate monoasic, stirring at about 50-75 rpm at a temperature of about 37° C. A single experimental tablet is tested in each test vessel of the apparatus. Dissolution can also be measured with a standard USP Type II apparatus that employs a dissolution media of 0.7% sodium lauryl sulfate dissolved in 900 mL of 50 mM sodium phosphate buffer (pH 6.8), stirring at about 65 rpm at a temperature of about 37° C. A single experimental tablet is tested in each test vessel of the apparatus. Dissolution can also be measured with a standard USP Type II apparatus that employs a dissolution media of 0.5% sodium lauryl sulfate dissolved in 900 mL of 50 mM sodium phosphate buffer (pH 6.8), stirring at about 65 rpm at a temperature of about 37° C. A single experimental tablet is tested in each test vessel of the apparatus.


IV.C.1.b. Preparation of Compound 4 Tablet Formulation

The dosage unit forms of the invention can be produced by compacting or compressing an admixture or composition, for example, a powder or granules, under pressure to form a stable three-dimensional shape (e.g., a tablet). As used herein, “tablet” includes compressed pharmaceutical dosage unit forms of all shapes and sizes, whether coated or uncoated.


The expression “dosage unit form” as used herein refers to a physically discrete unit of agent appropriate for the patient to be treated. In general, a compacted mixture has a density greater than that of the mixture prior to compaction. A dosage unit form of the invention can have almost any shape including concave and/or convex faces, rounded or angled corners, and a rounded to rectilinear shape. In some embodiments, the compressed dosage forms of the invention comprise a rounded tablet having flat faces. The solid pharmaceutical dosage forms of the invention can be prepared by any compaction and compression method known by persons of ordinary skill in the art of forming compressed solid pharmaceutical dosage forms. In particular embodiments, the formulations provided herein may be prepared using conventional methods known to those skilled in the field of pharmaceutical formulation, as described, e.g., in pertinent textbooks. See, e.g., Remington: The Science and Practice of Pharmacy, 21st Ed., Lippincott Williams & Wilkins, Baltimore, Md. (2003); Ansel et al., Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms And Drug Delivery Systems, 7th Edition, Lippincott Williams & Wilkins, (1999); The Handbook of Pharmaceutical Excipients, 4th edition, Rowe et al., Eds., American Pharmaceuticals Association (2003); Gibson, Pharmaceutical Preformulation And Formulation, CRC Press (2001), these references hereby incorporated herein by reference in their entirety.


V. Granulation and Compression

In some embodiments, solid forms, including powders comprising the active agent, Compound 4 Amorphous Form, and the included pharmaceutically acceptable excipients (e.g. filler, diluent, disintegrant, surfactant, glidant, lubricant, or any combination thereof) can be subjected to a dry granulation process. The dry granulation process causes the powder to agglomerate into larger particles having a size suitable for further processing. Dry granulation can improve the flowability of a mixture in order to be able to produce tablets that comply with the demand of mass variation or content uniformity.


Formulations as described herein may be produced using one or more mixing and dry granulations steps. The order and the number of the mixing and granulation steps do not seem to be critical. However, at least one of the excipients and Compound 4 can be been subject to dry granulation or wet high shear granulation before compression into tablets. Dry granulation of Compound 4 Amorphous Form and the excipients made together prior to tablet compression seem, surprisingly, to be a simple, inexpensive and efficient way of providing close physical contact between the ingredients of the present compositions and formulations and thus results in a tablet formulation with good stability properties. Dry granulation can be carried out by a mechanical process, which transfers energy to the mixture without any use of any liquid substances (neither in the form of aqueous solutions, solutions based on organic solutes, or mixtures thereof) in contrast to wet granulation processes, also contemplated herein. Generally, the mechanical process requires compaction such as the one provided by roller compaction. An example of an alternative method for dry granulation is slugging.


In some embodiments, roller compaction is a granulation process comprising highly intensive mechanical compacting of one or more substances. In some embodiments, a pharmaceutical composition comprising an admixture of powders is pressed, that is roller compacted, between 2 counter rotating rollers to make a solid sheet which is subsequently crushed in a sieve to form a particulate matter. In this particulate matter, a close mechanical contact between the ingredients can be obtained. An example of roller compaction equipment is Minipactor® a Gerteis 3W-Polygran from Gerteis Maschinen+Processengineering AG.


In some embodiments, tablet compression according to the invention can occur without any use of any liquid substances (neither in the form of aqueous solutions, solutions based on organic solutes, or mixtures thereof), i.e. a dry granulation process. In a typical embodiment the resulting core or tablet has a compressive strength in the range of 1 to 15 kP; such as 1.5 to 12.5 kP, preferably in the range of 2 to 10 kP.


VI. Brief Manufacturing Procedure

In some embodiments, the ingredients are weighed according to the formula set herein. Next, all of the intragranular ingredients are sifted and mixed well. The ingredients can be lubricated with a suitable lubricant, for example, magnesium stearate. The next step can comprise compaction/slugging of the powder admixture and sized ingredients. Next, the compacted or slugged blends are milled into granules and sifted to obtain the desired size. Next, the granules can be further lubricated with, for example, magnesium stearate. Next the granular composition of the invention can be compressed on suitable punches into various pharmaceutical formulations in accordance with the invention. Optionally the tablets can be coated with a film, colorant or other coating.


Another aspect of the invention provides a method for producing a pharmaceutical composition comprising providing an admixture of a composition comprising Compound 4 Amorphous Form and one or more excipients selected from: a filler, a diluent, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and compressing the composition into a tablet having a dissolution of at least about 50% in about 30 minutes.


In another embodiment, a wet granulation process is performed to yield the pharmaceutical formulation of the invention from an admixture of powdered and liquid ingredients. For example, a pharmaceutical composition comprising an admixture of a composition comprising Compound 4 Amorphous Form and one or more excipients selected from: a filler, a diluent, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, are weighed as per the formula set herein. Next, all of the intragranular ingredients are sifted and mixed in a high shear or low shear granulator using water or water with a surfactant or water with a binder or water with a surfactant and a binder to granulate the powder blend. A fluid other than water can also be used with or without surfactant and/or binder to granulate the powder blend. Next, the wet granules can optionally be milled using a suitable mill Next, water may optionally be removed from the admixture by drying the ingredients in any suitable manner Next, the dried granules can optionally be milled to the required size. Next, extra granular excipients can be added by blending (for example a filler, a diluent, and a disintegrant). Next, the sized granules can be further lubricated with magnesium stearate and a disintegrant, for example, croscarmellose sodium. Next the granular composition of the invention can be sifted for sufficient time to obtain the correct size and then compressed on suitable punches into various pharmaceutical formulations in accordance with the invention. Optionally, the tablets can be coated with a film, colorant or other coating.


Each of the ingredients of this exemplary admixture is described above and in the Examples below. Furthermore, the admixture can comprise optional additives, such as, one or more colorants, one or more flavors, and/or one or more fragrances as described above and in the Examples below. In some embodiments, the relative concentrations (e.g., wt %) of each of these ingredients (and any optional additives) in the admixture are also presented above and in the Examples below. The ingredients constituting the admixture can be provided sequentially or in any combination of additions; and, the ingredients or combination of ingredients can be provided in any order. In one embodiment, the lubricant is the last component added to the admixture.


In another embodiment, the admixture comprises a composition of Compound 4 Amorphous Form, and any one or more of the excipients; a glidant, a surfactant, a diluent, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler, wherein each of these ingredients is provided in a powder form (e.g., provided as particles having a mean or average diameter, measured by light scattering, of 250 μm or less (e.g., 150 μm or less, 100 μm or less, 50 μm or less, 45 μm or less, 40 μm or less, or 35 μm or less)). For instance, the admixture comprises a composition of Compound 4 Amorphous Form, a diluent, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler, wherein each of these ingredients is provided in a powder form (e.g., provided as particles having a mean diameter, measured by light scattering, of 250 μm or less (e.g., 150 μm or less, 100 μm or less, 50 μm or less, 45 μm or less, 40 μm or less, or 35 μm or less)). In another example, the admixture comprises a composition of Compound 4 Amorphous Form, a diluent, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler, wherein each of these ingredients is provided in a powder form (e.g., provided as particles having a mean diameter, measured by light scattering, of 250 μm or less (e.g., 150 μm or less, 100 μm or less, 50 μm or less, 45 μm or less, 40 μm or less, or 35 μm or less))


In another embodiment, the admixture comprises a composition of Compound 4 Amorphous Form, and any combination of: a glidant, a diluent, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler, wherein each of these ingredients is substantially free of water. Each of the ingredients comprises less than 5 wt % (e.g., less than 2 wt %, less than 1 wt %, less than 0.75 wt %, less than 0.5 wt %, or less than 0.25 wt %) of water by weight of the ingredient. For instance, the admixture comprises a composition of Compound 4 Amorphous Form, a diluent, a glidant, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler, wherein each of these ingredients is substantially free of water. In some embodiments, each of the ingredients comprises less than 5 wt % (e.g., less than 2 wt %, less than 1 wt %, less than 0.75 wt %, less than 0.5 wt %, or less than 0.25 wt %) of water by weight of the ingredient.


In another embodiment, compressing the admixture into a tablet is accomplished by filling a form (e.g., a mold) with the admixture and applying pressure to admixture. This can be accomplished using a die press or other similar apparatus. In some embodiments, the admixture of Compound 4 Amorphous Form and excipients can be first processed into granular form. The granules can then be sized and compressed into tablets or formulated for encapsulation according to known methods in the pharmaceutical art. It is also noted that the application of pressure to the admixture in the form can be repeated using the same pressure during each compression or using different pressures during the compressions. In another example, the admixture of powdered ingredients or granules can be compressed using a die press that applies sufficient pressure to form a tablet having a dissolution of about 50% or more at about 30 minutes (e.g., about 55% or more at about 30 minutes or about 60% or more at about 30 minutes). For instance, the admixture is compressed using a die press to produce a tablet hardness of at least about 5 kP (at least about 5.5 kP, at least about 6 kP, at least about 7 kP, at least about 10 kP, or at least 15 kP). In some instances, the admixture is compressed to produce a tablet hardness of between about 5 and 20 kP.


In some embodiments, tablets comprising a pharmaceutical composition as described herein can be coated with about 3.0 wt % of a film coating comprising a colorant by weight of the tablet. In certain instances, the colorant suspension or solution used to coat the tablets comprises about 20% w/w of solids by weight of the colorant suspension or solution. In still further instances, the coated tablets can be labeled with a logo, other image or text.


In another embodiment, the method for producing a pharmaceutical composition comprises providing an admixture of a solid forms, e.g. an admixture of powdered and/or liquid ingredients, the admixture comprising Compound 4 Amorphous Form and one or more excipients selected from: a glidant, a diluent, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler; mixing the admixture until the admixture is substantially homogenous, and compressing or compacting the admixture into a granular form. Then the granular composition comprising Compound 4 Amorphous Form can be compressed into tablets or formulated into capsules as described above or in the Examples below. Alternatively, methods for producing a pharmaceutical composition comprises providing an admixture of Compound 4 Amorphous Form, and one or more excipients, e.g. a glidant, a diluent, a surfactant, a lubricant, a disintegrant, and a filler; mixing the admixture until the admixture is substantially homogenous, and compressing/compacting the admixture into a granular form using a roller compactor using a dry granulation composition as set forth in the Examples below or alternatively, compressed/compacted into granules using a high shear wet granule compaction process as set forth in the Examples below. Pharmaceutical formulations, for example a tablet as described herein, can be made using the granules prepared incorporating Compound 4 Amorphous Form in addition to the selected excipients described herein.


In some embodiments, the admixture is mixed by stirring, blending, shaking, or the like using hand mixing, a mixer, a blender, any combination thereof, or the like. When ingredients or combinations of ingredients are added sequentially, mixing can occur between successive additions, continuously throughout the ingredient addition, after the addition of all of the ingredients or combinations of ingredients, or any combination thereof. The admixture is mixed until it has a substantially homogenous composition.


In one embodiment, the pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention may be prepared according to the following flow chart:


In another embodiment, Compound 4 Amorphous Form is in a 50% by wt. mixture with a polymer and surfactant, the brand of colloidal silica dioxide glidant used is Cabot MSP, the brand of croscarmellose sodium disintegrant used is AcDiSol, the brand of microcrystalline cellulose filler used is Avicel PH101, and the brand of lactose monohydrate diluent used is Foremost 310. In another embodiment, the Compound 4 Amorphous Form polymer is a hydroxylpropylmethylcellulose (HPMC) and the surfactant is sodium lauryl sulfate. In another embodiment, the Compound 4 Amorphous Form polymer is hydroxypropylmethylcellulose acetate succinate (HPMCAS). In another embodiment, the Compound 4 Amorphous Form polymer is hydroxypropylmethylcellulose acetate succinate—high grade (HPMCAS-HG).


In various embodiments, a second therapeutic agent can be formulated together with Compound 4 Amorphous Form to form a unitary or single dose form, for example, a tablet or capsule.


Dosage forms prepared as above can be subjected to in vitro dissolution evaluations according to Test 711 “Dissolution” in United States Pharmacopoeia 29, United States Pharmacopeial Convention, Inc., Rockville, Md., 2005 (“USP”), to determine the rate at which the active substance is released from the dosage forms. The content of active substance and the impurity levels are conveniently measured by techniques such as high performance liquid chromatography (HPLC).


In some embodiments, the invention includes use of packaging materials such as containers and closures of high-density polyethylene (HDPE), low-density polyethylene (LDPE) and or polypropylene and/or glass, glassine foil, aluminum pouches, and blisters or strips composed of aluminum or high-density polyvinyl chloride (PVC), optionally including a desiccant, polyethylene (PE), polyvinylidene dichloride (PVDC), PVC/PE/PVDC, and the like. These package materials can be used to store the various pharmaceutical compositions and formulations in a sterile fashion after appropriate sterilization of the package and its contents using chemical or physical sterilization techniques commonly employed in the pharmaceutical arts.


VII. Examples
Exemplary Oral Pharmaceutical Formulations Comprising Compound 4

A tablet is prepared with the components and amounts listed in Table 4-11 and Table 4-12.












TABLE 4-11







Final Blend





Composition
Tablet


Component
Function
% w/w
(mg/tablet)


















50% Compound 4/
Active as a
50.00
200.0 SDD


49.5% HPMCAS-
spray dried

(100.00


HG/0.5% SLS
dispersion

Compound 4)



(SSD)




Microcrystalline
Filler
22.63
90.5


cellulose (Avicel





PH101)





Lactose Monohydrate
Diluent
22.63
90.5


(Foremost 310)





Crosscarmelose
Disintegrant
3.00
12.0


Sodium (AcDiSol)





Magnesium Stearate
Lubricant
0.25
1.0


Colloidal Silica
Glidant
1.00
4.0


Dioxide (Cabot M5P)






Intragranular
99.5




content




Extragranular Blend





Colloidal Silica
Glidant
0.25
1.0


Dioxide (Cabot M5P)





Magnesium Stearate
Lubricant
0.25
1.0



Extragranular
0.5




content





Total
100.00
400.0



















TABLE 4-12







Final Blend





Composition
Tablet


Component
Function
% w/w
(mg/tablet)


















50% Compound 4/
Active as a
50.00
100.0 SDD


49.5% HPMCAS-
spray dried

(50.00 Compound 4)


HG/0.5% SLS
dispersion




(SSD)





Microcrystalline
Filler
22.63
45.25


cellulose (Avicel





PH101)





Lactose Monohydrate
Diluent
22.63
45.25


(Foremost 310)





Crosscarmelose
Disintegrant
3.00
6.0


Sodium (AcDiSol)





Magnesium Stearate
Lubricant
0.25
0.5


Colloidal Silica
Glidant
1.00
2.0


Dioxide (Cabot M5P)






Intragranular
99.5




content




Extragranular Blend





Colloidal Silica
Glidant
0.25
0.5


Dioxide (Cabot M5P)





Magnesium Stearate
Lubricant
0.25
0.5



Extragranular
0.5




content





Total
100.00
200.0









Tablet Formation from Roller Compaction Granule Composition


Equipment/Process


Equipment













Equipment
Description/Comment







Balance(s)
To weigh the powder


(mg to kg scale)
and individual tablets.


Screening and blending equipment
Delump/blend/lubrication.


2-L Turbula T2F Shaker Mixer
Prepare blends for dry


Quadro Comill 197
granulation and tabletting.


hand screen: size #20 US Mesh screen



Dry Granulation equipment
Prepare slugs with


Tabletting machine: Korsch XL100 rotary
0.72-0.77


tablet press with gravity feed frame ½ inch
solid fraction.


diameter, round, flat faced tooling



Milling
Particle size reduction.


Mortar/pestle



Quadro co-mill (U5/193)



Fitzpatrick (Fitzmill L1A)



Tablet Compression
Single tooling press.


Tablet machine: Korsch XL100 rotary
Tablet manufacture.


tablet press with gravity feed frame with



0.2839″ × 0.5879″ modified oval tooling.



Other ancillary equipment for determining



Hardness



Weight sorter



Friability



Deduster



Metal Checker









Screening/Weighing


Compound 4 Amorphous Form as the solid spray dried dispersion and Cabot M5P are combined and screened through a 20 mesh screen, and blended in the 2-L Turbula T2F Shaker Mixer for 10 minutes at 32 RPM.


Intragranular Blending


The AcDiSol, Avicel PH101, and Foremost 310 are added and blended for an additional 15 minutes. The blend is then passed through the Quadro Comill 197 (screen: 0.032″R; impeller: 1607; RPM: 1000 RPM). Magnesium stearate is screened with 2-3 times that amount (volume) of the above blend through 20 mesh screen by hand. The resulting mixture is blended in the Turbula mixer for 4 minutes at 32 RPM.


Roller Compaction


Slug the above blend in the Korsch XL100 rotary tablet press (gravity feed frame ½″ diameter, round, flat-faced tooling) to about 0.72-0.77 solid fraction. Calculate solid fraction by measuring the weight, height and using the true density of the material determined during the development. For the rotary tablet press slug process, compression force will vary depending on fill volume of the die and final weight of the slug. Lightly break slugs into roughly ¼ inch pieces with mortar and pestle. Pass the broken slugs through the Quadro Comill 197 (screen: 0.079″G; impeller: 1607; RPM: 1000).


Extragranular Blending


The extragranular Cabot M5P is screened with 2-3 times that amount (volume) of the above blend through a 20 mesh screen by hand. Add this extragranular Cabot M5P pre-blend to the main blend and blend in the 2-L Turbula T2F Shaker Mixer for 15 minutes at 32 RPM. Screen the extragranular magnesium stearate through a 20 mesh screen with 2-3 times that amount (volume) of the above blend by hand. Add this extragranular magnesium stearate pre-blend to the main blend and blend in the Turbular mixer for 4 minutes at 32 RPM.


Compression


Tablets are compressed to target hardness of 14.5±3.5 kp using a Korsch XL 100 with gravity feed frame and 0.289″×0.5879″ modified oval tooling.


Film Coating


Tablets may be film coated using a pan coater, such as, for example an O'Hara Labcoat.


Printing


Film coated tablets may be printed with a monogram on one or both tablet faces with, for example, a Hartnett Delta printer.


IV.C.1.c. Dosing Administration Schedule of Compound 4 Tablet Formulation

In another aspect, the invention relates to a method of treating a CFTR mediated disease in a subject comprising administering to a subject in need thereof an effective amount of the pharmaceutical composition provided by the invention. In another embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition is administered to the subject once every two weeks. In another embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition is administered to the subject once a week. In another embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition is administered to the subject once every three days. In another embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition is administered to the subject once a day. In one embodiment, when the pharmaceutical composition is a tablet according to Table 4-11 or 4-12, dosing is once a day.


In one embodiment, 100 mg of Compound 4 may be administered to a subject in need thereof followed by co-administration of 150 mg of a pharmaceutical composition comprising Compound 1 and Compound 2. In another embodiment, 100 mg of Compound 4 may be administered to a subject in need thereof followed by co-administration of 250 mg of a pharmaceutical composition comprising Compound 1 and Compound 2. In these embodiments, the dosage amounts may be achieved by administration of one or more tablets of the invention. A pharmaceutical composition comprising Compound 1 and Compound 2 may be administered as a pharmaceutical composition further comprising Compound 4 and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. The duration of administration may continue until amelioration of the disease is achieved or until a subject's physician advises, e.g. duration of administration may be less than a week, 1 week, 2 weeks, 3 weeks, or a month or longer. The co-administration period may be preceded by an administration period of just Compound 4 alone. For example, there could be administration of 100 mg of Compound 4 for 2 weeks followed by co-administration of 150 mg or 250 mg of a pharmaceutical composition comprising Compound 1 and Compound 2 for 1 additional week.


In one embodiment, 100 mg of Compound 4 may be administered once a day to a subject in need thereof followed by co-administration of 150 mg of a pharmaceutical composition comprising Compound 1 and Compound 2 once a day. In another embodiment, 100 mg of Compound 4 may be administered once a day to a subject in need thereof followed by co-administration of 250 mg of a pharmaceutical composition comprising Compound 1 and Compound 2 once a day. In these embodiments, the dosage amounts may be achieved by administration of one or more tablets of the invention. a pharmaceutical composition comprising Compound 1 and Compound 2 may be administered as a pharmaceutical composition further comprising Compound 4 and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. The duration of administration may continue until amelioration of the disease is achieved or until a subject's physician advises, e.g. duration of administration may be less than a week, 1 week, 2 weeks, 3 weeks, or a month or longer. The co-administration period may be preceded by an administration period of just Compound 4 alone. For example, there could be administration of 100 mg of Compound 4 for 2 weeks followed by co-administration of 150 mg or 250 mg of a pharmaceutical composition comprising Compound 1 and Compound 2 for 1 additional week.


In one embodiment, 100 mg of Compound 4 may be administered once a day to a subject in need thereof followed by co-administration of 150 mg of a pharmaceutical composition comprising Compound 1 and Compound 2 every 12 hours. In another embodiment, 100 mg of Compound 4 may be administered once a day to a subject in need thereof followed by co-administration of 250 mg of a pharmaceutical composition comprising Compound 1 and Compound 2 every 12 hours. In these embodiments, the dosage amounts may be achieved by administration of one or more tablets of the invention. A pharmaceutical composition comprising Compound 1 and Compound 2 may be administered as a pharmaceutical composition further comprising Compound 4 and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. The duration of administration may continue until amelioration of the disease is achieved or until a subject's physician advises, e.g. duration of administration may be less than a week, 1 week, 2 weeks, 3 weeks, or a month or longer. The co-administration period may be preceded by an administration period of just Compound 4 alone. For example, there could be administration of 100 mg of Compound 4 for 2 weeks followed by co-administration of 150 mg or 250 mg of a pharmaceutical composition comprising Compound 1 and Compound 2 for 1 additional week.


V. Methods of Use

In yet another aspect, the present invention provides a method of treating a condition, disease, or disorder implicated by CFTR, said method comprising administering a composition comprising a Compound of Formula I and a Compound of Formula II, according to Table I, to a subject, preferably a mammal, in need thereof. In one embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises Compound 1 and Compound 2. In a further embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises Compound 1 and Compound 2 in combination with one of Compound 3 or Compound 4. In still a further embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises Compound 1 and Compound 2 in combination with both Compound 3 and Compound 4. In another embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition comprises one component from Column A and one component from Column B, optionally in combination with one or both of a component from Column C and/or a component from Column D as provided in Table I.


In certain embodiments, the present invention provides a method of treating a condition, disease, or disorder implicated by a deficiency of CFTR activity, the method comprising administering the pharmaceutical composition of the invention to a subject, preferably a mammal, in need thereof.


In yet another aspect, the present invention provides a method of treating, or lessening the severity of a condition, disease, or disorder implicated by CFTR mutation. In certain embodiments, the present invention provides a method of treating a condition, disease, or disorder implicated by a deficiency of the CFTR activity, the method comprising administering the pharmaceutical composition of the invention to a subject, preferably a mammal, in need thereof.


In another aspect, the invention also provides a method of treating or lessening the severity of a disease in a patient, the method comprising administering the pharmaceutical composition of the invention to a subject, preferably a mammal, in need thereof, and said disease is selected from cystic fibrosis, asthma, smoke induced COPD, chronic bronchitis, rhinosinusitis, constipation, pancreatitis, pancreatic insufficiency, male infertility caused by congenital bilateral absence of the vas deferens (CBAVD), mild pulmonary disease, idiopathic pancreatitis, allergic bronchopulmonary aspergillosis (ABPA), liver disease, hereditary emphysema, hereditary hemochromatosis, coagulation-fibrinolysis deficiencies, such as protein C deficiency, Type 1 hereditary angioedema, lipid processing deficiencies, such as familial hypercholesterolemia, Type 1 chylomicronemia, abetalipoproteinemia, lysosomal storage diseases, such as I-cell disease/pseudo-Hurler, mucopolysaccharidoses, Sandhof/Tay-Sachs, Crigler-Najjar type II, polyendocrinopathy/hyperinsulemia, Diabetes mellitus, Laron dwarfism, myleoperoxidase deficiency, primary hypoparathyroidism, melanoma, glycanosis CDG type 1, congenital hyperthyroidism, osteogenesis imperfecta, hereditary hypofibrinogenemia, ACT deficiency, Diabetes insipidus (DI), neurophyseal DI, neprogenic DI, Charcot-Marie Tooth syndrome, Perlizaeus-Merzbacher disease, neurodegenerative diseases such as Alzheimer's disease, Parkinson's disease, amyotrophic lateral sclerosis, progressive supranuclear plasy, Pick's disease, several polyglutamine neurological disorders such as Huntington's, spinocerebullar ataxia type I, spinal and bulbar muscular atrophy, dentatorubal pallidoluysian, and myotonic dystrophy, as well as spongiform encephalopathies, such as hereditary Creutzfeldt-Jakob disease (due to prion protein processing defect), Fabry disease, Straussler-Scheinker syndrome, COPD, dry-eye disease, or Sjogren's disease, Osteoporosis, Osteopenia, bone healing and bone growth (including bone repair, bone regeneration, reducing bone resorption and increasing bone deposition), Gorham's Syndrome, chloride channelopathies such as myotonia congenita (Thomson and Becker forms), Bartter's syndrome type III, Dent's disease, hyperekplexia, epilepsy, lysosomal storage disease, Angelman syndrome, and Primary Ciliary Dyskinesia (PCD), a term for inherited disorders of the structure and/or function of cilia, including PCD with situs inversus (also known as Kartagener syndrome), PCD without situs inversus and ciliary aplasia.


In some embodiments, the method includes treating or lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient comprising administering to said patient one of the compositions as defined herein. In certain embodiments, the patient possesses mutant forms of human CFTR. In other embodiments, the patient possesses one or more of the following mutations ΔF508, R117H, and G551D of human CFTR. In one embodiment, the method includes treating or lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the ΔF508 mutation of human CFTR comprising administering to said patient one of the compositions as defined herein. In one embodiment, the method includes treating or lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the G551D mutation of human CFTR comprising administering to said patient one of the compositions as defined herein. In one embodiment, the method includes treating or lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the ΔF508 mutation of human CFTR on at least one allele comprising administering to said patient one of the compositions as defined herein. In one embodiment, the method includes treating or lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the ΔF508 mutation of human CFTR on both alleles comprising administering to said patient one of the compositions as defined herein. In one embodiment, the method includes treating or lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the G551D mutation of human CFTR on at least one allele comprising administering to said patient one of the compositions as defined herein. In one embodiment, the method includes treating or lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the G551D mutation of human CFTR on both alleles comprising administering to said patient one of the compositions as defined herein.


In some embodiments, the method includes lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient comprising administering to said patient one of the compositions as defined herein. In certain embodiments, the patient possesses mutant forms of human CFTR. In other embodiments, the patient possesses one or more of the following mutations ΔF508, R117H, and G551D of human CFTR. In one embodiment, the method includes lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the ΔF508 mutation of human CFTR comprising administering to said patient one of the compositions as defined herein. In one embodiment, the method includes lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the G551D mutation of human CFTR comprising administering to said patient one of the compositions as defined herein. In one embodiment, the method includes lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the ΔF508 mutation of human CFTR on at least one allele comprising administering to said patient one of the compositions as defined herein. In one embodiment, the method includes lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the ΔF508 mutation of human CFTR on both alleles comprising administering to said patient one of the compositions as defined herein. In one embodiment, the method includes lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the G551D mutation of human CFTR on at least one allele comprising administering to said patient one of the compositions as defined herein. In one embodiment, the method includes lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the G551D mutation of human CFTR on both alleles comprising administering to said patient one of the compositions as defined herein.


In some aspects, the invention provides a method of treating or lessening the severity of Osteoporosis in a patient comprising administering to said patient a composition as defined herein.


In certain embodiments, the method of treating or lessening the severity of Osteoporosis in a patient comprises administering to said patient a pharmaceutical composition as described herein.


In some aspects, the invention provides a method of treating or lessening the severity of Osteopenia in a patient comprising administering to said patient a composition as defined herein.


In certain embodiments, the method of treating or lessening the severity of Osteopenia in a patient comprises administering to said patient a pharmaceutical composition as described herein.


In some aspects, the invention provides a method of bone healing and/or bone repair in a patient comprising administering to said patient a composition as defined herein.


In certain embodiments, the method of bone healing and/or bone repair in a patient comprises administering to said patient a pharmaceutical composition as described herein.


In some aspects, the invention provides a method of reducing bone resorption in a patient comprising administering to said patient a composition as defined herein.


In some aspects, the invention provides a method of increasing bone deposition in a patient comprising administering to said patient a composition as defined herein.


In certain embodiments, the method of increasing bone deposition in a patient comprises administering to said patient a composition as defined herein.


In some aspects, the invention provides a method of treating or lessening the severity of COPD in a patient comprising administering to said patient a composition as defined herein.


In certain embodiments, the method of treating or lessening the severity of COPD in a patient comprises administering to said patient a composition as defined herein.


In some aspects, the invention provides a method of treating or lessening the severity of smoke induced COPD in a patient comprising administering to said patient a composition as defined herein.


In certain embodiments, the method of treating or lessening the severity of smoke induced COPD in a patient comprises administering to said patient a composition as defined herein.


In some aspects, the invention provides a method of treating or lessening the severity of chronic bronchitis in a patient comprising administering to said patient a composition as described herein.


In certain embodiments, the method of treating or lessening the severity of chronic bronchitis in a patient comprises administering to said patient a composition as defined herein.


According to an alternative embodiment, the present invention provides a method of treating cystic fibrosis comprising the step of administering to said mammal a composition as defined herein.


According to the invention an “effective amount” of the composition is that amount effective for treating or lessening the severity of one or more of the diseases, disorders or conditions as recited above.


Another aspect of the present invention provides a method of administering a pharmaceutical composition by orally administering to a patient at least once per day the composition as described herein. In one embodiment, the method comprises administering a composition to said patient a composition as defined herein once of Table I every 24 hours. In another embodiment, the method comprises administering to said patient a composition as defined herein every 12 hours. In a further embodiment, the method comprises administering a to said patient a composition as defined herein three times per day. In still a further embodiment, the method comprises administering to said patient a composition as defined herein.


The compositions, according to the method of the present invention, may be administered using any amount and any route of administration effective for treating or lessening the severity of one or more of the diseases, disorders or conditions as recited above.


In certain embodiments, the compositions of the present invention are useful for treating or lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in patients who exhibit residual CFTR activity in the apical membrane of respiratory and non-respiratory epithelia. The presence of residual CFTR activity at the epithelial surface can be readily detected using methods known in the art, e.g., standard electrophysiological, biochemical, or histochemical techniques. Such methods identify CFTR activity using in vivo or ex vivo electrophysiological techniques, measurement of sweat or salivary Clconcentrations, or ex vivo biochemical or histochemical techniques to monitor cell surface density. Using such methods, residual CFTR activity can be readily detected in patients heterozygous or homozygous for a variety of different mutations, including patients homozygous or heterozygous for the most common mutation, ΔF508.


In another embodiment, the compositions of the present invention are useful for treating or lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in patients who have residual CFTR activity induced or augmented using pharmacological methods or gene therapy. Such methods increase the amount of CFTR present at the cell surface, thereby inducing a hitherto absent CFTR activity in a patient or augmenting the existing level of residual CFTR activity in a patient.


In one embodiment, a composition as defined herein can be useful for treating or lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in patients within certain genotypes exhibiting residual CFTR activity, e.g., class III mutations (impaired regulation or gating), class IV mutations (altered conductance), or class V mutations (reduced synthesis) (Lee R. Choo-Kang, Pamela L., Zeitlin, Type I, II, III, IV, and V cystic fibrosis Transmembrane Conductance Regulator Defects and Opportunities of Therapy; Current Opinion in Pulmonary Medicine 6:521-529, 2000). Other patient genotypes that exhibit residual CFTR activity include patients homozygous for one of these classes or heterozygous with any other class of mutations, including class I mutations, class II mutations, or a mutation that lacks classification.


In one aspect, the invention includes a method of treating a class III mutation as described above, comprising administering to a patient in need thereof a composition comprising a compound of Formula I and a compound of Formula II. In some embodiments, the composition comprises a compound of Formula I and a compound of Formula II in combination with one or both of a compound of Formula III and/or a compound of Formula IV. In some embodiments of this aspect, the composition includes a compound of Formula I and a compound of Formula II in combination with a compound of Formula III. In some embodiments of this aspect, the composition includes a compound of Formula I and a compound of Formula II in combination with a compound of Formula IV. In some embodiments of this aspect, the composition includes a compound of Formula I and a compound of Formula II in combination with a compound of Formula III and a compound of Formula IV. In a further embodiment of this aspect, the pharmaceutical composition includes Compound 1 and Compound 2. In another embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition includes Compound 1, Compound 2 and Compound 3. In another embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition includes Compound 1, Compound 2 and Compound 4. In still another embodiment, the pharmaceutical composition includes Compound 1, Compound 2, Compound 3 and Compound 4.


In one embodiment, a composition as defined herein can be useful for treating or lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in patients within certain clinical phenotypes, e.g., a moderate to mild clinical phenotype that typically correlates with the amount of residual CFTR activity in the apical membrane of epithelia. Such phenotypes include patients exhibiting pancreatic insufficiency or patients diagnosed with idiopathic pancreatitis and congenital bilateral absence of the vas deferens, or mild lung disease.


The exact amount required will vary from subject to subject, depending on the species, age, and general condition of the subject, the severity of the infection, the particular agent, its mode of administration, and the like. The compositions of the invention are preferably formulated in dosage unit form for ease of administration and uniformity of dosage. The expression “dosage unit form” as used herein refers to a physically discrete unit of agent appropriate for the patient to be treated. It will be understood, however, that the total daily usage of the compositions of the present invention will be decided by the attending physician within the scope of sound medical judgment. The specific effective dose level for any particular patient or organism will depend upon a variety of factors including the disorder being treated and the severity of the disorder; the activity of the composition employed; the specific composition employed; the age, body weight, general health, sex and diet of the patient; the time of administration, route of administration, and rate of excretion of the specific composition employed; the duration of the treatment; drugs used in combination or coincidental with the specific composition employed, and like factors well known in the medical arts. The term “patient”, as used herein, means an animal, preferably a mammal, and most preferably a human.


In one aspect, the present invention features a kit comprising a composition as defined herein.


VI. Assays
VI.A. Protocol 1

Assays for Detecting and Measuring ΔF508-CFTR Potentiation Properties of Compounds


Membrane Potential Optical Methods for Assaying ΔF508-CFTR Modulation Properties of Compounds

The assay utilizes fluorescent voltage sensing dyes to measure changes in membrane potential using a fluorescent plate reader (e.g., FLIPR III, Molecular Devices, Inc.) as a readout for increase in functional ΔF508-CFTR in NIH 3T3 cells. The driving force for the response is the creation of a chloride ion gradient in conjunction with channel activation by a single liquid addition step after the cells have previously been treated with compounds and subsequently loaded with a voltage sensing dye.


Identification of Potentiator Compounds

To identify potentiators of ΔF508-CFTR, a double-addition HTS assay format was developed. This HTS assay utilizes fluorescent voltage sensing dyes to measure changes in membrane potential on the FLIPR III as a measurement for increase in gating (conductance) of ΔF508 CFTR in temperature-corrected ΔF508 CFTR NIH 3T3 cells. The driving force for the response is a Clion gradient in conjunction with channel activation with forskolin in a single liquid addition step using a fluorescent plate reader such as FLIPR III after the cells have previously been treated with potentiator compounds (or DMSO vehicle control) and subsequently loaded with a redistribution dye.


Solutions

Bath Solution #1: (in mM) NaCl 160, KCl 4.5, CaCl2 2, MgCl2 1, HEPES 10, pH 7.4 with NaOH.


Chloride-free bath solution: Chloride salts in Bath Solution #1 (above) are substituted with gluconate salts.


Cell Culture

NIH3T3 mouse fibroblasts stably expressing ΔF508-CFTR are used for optical measurements of membrane potential. The cells are maintained at 37° C. in 5% CO2 and 90% humidity in Dulbecco's modified Eagle's medium supplemented with 2 mM glutamine, 10% fetal bovine serum, 1×NEAA, β-ME, 1×pen/strep, and 25 mM HEPES in 175 cm2 culture flasks. For all optical assays, the cells were seeded at −20,000/well in 384-well matrigel-coated plates and cultured for 2 hrs at 37° C. before culturing at 27° C. for 24 hrs. for the potentiator assay. For the correction assays, the cells are cultured at 27° C. or 37° C. with and without compounds for 16-24 hours. Electrophysiological Assays for assaying ΔF508-CFTR modulation properties of compounds.


Using Chamber Assay

Using chamber experiments were performed on polarized airway epithelial cells expressing ΔF508-CFTR to further characterize the ΔF508-CFTR modulators identified in the optical assays. Non-CF and CF airway epithelia were isolated from bronchial tissue, cultured as previously described (Galietta, L. J. V., Lantero, S., Gazzolo, A., Sacco, O., Romano, L., Rossi, G. A., & Zegarra-Moran, O. (1998) In Vitro Cell. Dev. Biol. 34, 478-481), and plated onto Costar® Snapwell™ filters that were precoated with NIH3T3-conditioned media. After four days the apical media was removed and the cells were grown at an air liquid interface for >14 days prior to use. This resulted in a monolayer of fully differentiated columnar cells that were ciliated, features that are characteristic of airway epithelia. Non-CF HBE were isolated from non-smokers that did not have any known lung disease. CF-HBE were isolated from patients homozygous for ΔF508-CFTR.


HBE grown on Costar® Snapwell™ cell culture inserts were mounted in an Using chamber (Physiologic Instruments, Inc., San Diego, Calif.), and the transepithelial resistance and short-circuit current in the presence of a basolateral to apical Cl gradient (ISC) were measured using a voltage-clamp system (Department of Bioengineering, University of Iowa, Iowa). Briefly, HBE were examined under voltage-clamp recording conditions (Vhold=0 mV) at 37° C. The basolateral solution contained (in mM) 145 NaCl, 0.83 K2HPO4, 3.3 KH2PO4, 1.2 MgCl2, 1.2 CaCl2, 10 Glucose, 10 HEPES (pH adjusted to 7.35 with NaOH) and the apical solution contained (in mM) 145 NaGluconate, 1.2 MgCl2, 1.2 CaCl2, 10 glucose, 10 HEPES (pH adjusted to 7.35 with NaOH).


Identification of Potentiator Compounds

Typical protocol utilized a basolateral to apical membrane Cl concentration gradient. To set up this gradient, normal ringers was used on the basolateral membrane, whereas apical NaCl was replaced by equimolar sodium gluconate (titrated to pH 7.4 with NaOH) to give a large Cl concentration gradient across the epithelium. Forskolin (10 μM) and all test compounds were added to the apical side of the cell culture inserts. The efficacy of the putative ΔF508-CFTR potentiators was compared to that of the known potentiator, genistein.


Patch-Clamp Recordings

Total Clcurrent in ΔF508-NIH3T3 cells was monitored using the perforated-patch recording configuration as previously described (Rae, J., Cooper, K., Gates, P., & Watsky, M. (1991) J. Neurosci. Methods 37, 15-26). Voltage-clamp recordings were performed at 22° C. using an Axopatch 200B patch-clamp amplifier (Axon Instruments Inc., Foster City, Calif.). The pipette solution contained (in mM) 150 N-methyl-D-glucamine (NMDG)-Cl, 2 MgCl2, 2 CaCl2, 10 EGTA, 10 HEPES, and 240 μg/mL amphotericin-B (pH adjusted to 7.35 with HCl). The extracellular medium contained (in mM) 150 NMDG-Cl, 2 MgCl2, 2 CaCl2, 10 HEPES (pH adjusted to 7.35 with HCl). Pulse generation, data acquisition, and analysis were performed using a PC equipped with a Digidata 1320 A/D interface in conjunction with Clampex 8 (Axon Instruments Inc.). To activate ΔF508-CFTR, 10 μM forskolin and 20 μM genistein were added to the bath and the current-voltage relation was monitored every 30 sec.


Identification of Potentiator Compounds

The ability of ΔF508-CFTR potentiators to increase the macroscopic ΔF508-CFTR Cl current (IΔF508) in NIH3T3 cells stably expressing ΔF508-CFTR was also investigated using perforated-patch-recording techniques. The potentiators identified from the optical assays evoked a dose-dependent increase in IΔF508 with similar potency and efficacy observed in the optical assays. In all cells examined, the reversal potential before and during potentiator application was around −30 mV, which is the calculated ECl (−28 mV).


Cell Culture

NIH3T3 mouse fibroblasts stably expressing ΔF508-CFTR are used for whole-cell recordings. The cells are maintained at 37° C. in 5% CO2 and 90% humidity in Dulbecco's modified Eagle's medium supplemented with 2 mM glutamine, 10% fetal bovine serum, 1×NEAA, β-ME, 1×pen/strep, and 25 mM HEPES in 175 cm2 culture flasks. For whole-cell recordings, 2,500-5,000 cells were seeded on poly-L-lysine-coated glass coverslips and cultured for 24-48 hrs at 27° C. before use to test the activity of potentiators; and incubated with or without the corrector compound at 37° C. for measuring the activity of correctors.


Single-Channel Recordings

Gating activity of wt-CFTR and temperature-corrected ΔF508-CFTR expressed in NIH3T3 cells was observed using excised inside-out membrane patch recordings as previously described (Dalemans, W., Barbry, P., Champigny, G., Jallat, S., Dott, K., Dreyer, D., Crystal, R. G., Pavirani, A., Lecocq, J-P., Lazdunski, M. (1991) Nature 354, 526-528) using an Axopatch 200B patch-clamp amplifier (Axon Instruments Inc.). The pipette contained (in mM): 150 NMDG, 150 aspartic acid, 5 CaCl2, 2 MgCl2, and 10 HEPES (pH adjusted to 7.35 with Tris base). The bath contained (in mM): 150 NMDG-Cl, 2 MgCl2, 5 EGTA, 10 TES, and 14 Tris base (pH adjusted to 7.35 with HCl). After excision, both wt- and ΔF508-CFTR were activated by adding 1 mM Mg-ATP, 75 nM of the catalytic subunit of cAMP-dependent protein kinase (PKA; Promega Corp. Madison, Wis.), and 10 mM NaF to inhibit protein phosphatases, which prevented current rundown. The pipette potential was maintained at 80 mV. Channel activity was analyzed from membrane patches containing 2 active channels. The maximum number of simultaneous openings determined the number of active channels during the course of an experiment. To determine the single-channel current amplitude, the data recorded from 120 sec of ΔF508-CFTR activity was filtered “off-line” at 100 Hz and then used to construct all-point amplitude histograms that were fitted with multigaussian functions using Bio-Patch Analysis software (Bio-Logic Comp. France). The total microscopic current and open probability (Po) were determined from 120 sec of channel activity. The Po was determined using the Bio-Patch software or from the relationship Po=I/i(N), where I=mean current, i=single-channel current amplitude, and N=number of active channels in patch.


Cell Culture

NIH3T3 mouse fibroblasts stably expressing ΔF508-CFTR are used for excised-membrane patch-clamp recordings. The cells are maintained at 37° C. in 5% CO2 and 90% humidity in Dulbecco's modified Eagle's medium supplemented with 2 mM glutamine, 10% fetal bovine serum, 1×NEAA, β-ME, 1×pen/strep, and 25 mM HEPES in 175 cm2 culture flasks. For single channel recordings, 2,500-5,000 cells were seeded on poly-L-lysine-coated glass coverslips and cultured for 24-48 hrs at 27° C. before use.


Activity of the Compound 1

Compounds of the invention are useful as modulators of ATP binding cassette transporters. The table below illustrates the EC50 and relative efficacy of Compound 1. The following meanings apply. EC50: “+++” means <10 uM; “++” means between 10 uM to 25 uM; “+” means between 25 uM to 60 uM. % Efficacy: “+” means <25%; “++” means between 25% to 100%; “+++” means >100%.














Cmpd #
EC50 (uM)
% Activity







1
+++
++









Examples
Activity of the Compounds of Formula II

Compounds of Formula II are useful as modulators of ATP binding cassette transporters. Examples of activities and efficacies of the compounds of Formula II are shown below in Table 2-15. The compound activity is illustrated with “+++” if activity was measured to be less than 2.0 μM, “++” if activity was measured to be from 2 μM to 5.0 μM, “+” if activity was measured to be greater than 5.0 μM, and “−” if no data was available. The efficacy is illustrated with “+++” if efficacy was calculated to be greater than 100%, “++” if efficacy was calculated to be from 100% to 25%, “+” if efficacy was calculated to be less than 25%, and “−” if no data was available. It should be noted that 100% efficacy is the maximum response obtained with 4-methyl-2-(5-phenyl-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)phenol.









TABLE 2-15







Activities and Efficacies of the


compounds of Formula II











Example
Activity




Compound No.
EC50 (μm)
% Efficacy







2
+++
++



2-2
+++
++



2-3
+++
++



2-4
+++
++



2-5
+++
+++



2-6
+++
+++



2-7
+++
++



2-8
+++
++



2-9
+++
++



2-10
+++
+++



2-11
+++
++



2-12
+++
++



2-13
+++
++



2-14
+++
++










VI.C. Protocol 2

Assays for Detecting and Measuring ΔF508-CFTR Correction Properties of Compounds


Membrane potential optical methods for assaying ΔF508-CFTR modulation properties of compounds.


The optical membrane potential assay utilized voltage-sensitive FRET sensors described by Gonzalez and Tsien (See Gonzalez, J. E. and R. Y. Tsien (1995) “Voltage sensing by fluorescence resonance energy transfer in single cells” Biophys J 69(4): 1272-80, and Gonzalez, J. E. and R. Y. Tsien (1997) “Improved indicators of cell membrane potential that use fluorescence resonance energy transfer” Chem Biol 4(4): 269-77) in combination with instrumentation for measuring fluorescence changes such as the Voltage/Ion Probe Reader (VIPR) (See Gonzalez, J. E., K. Oades, et al. (1999) “Cell-based assays and instrumentation for screening ion-channel targets” Drug Discov Today 4(9): 431-439).


These voltage sensitive assays are based on the change in fluorescence resonant energy transfer (FRET) between the membrane-soluble, voltage-sensitive dye, DiSBAC2(3), and a fluorescent phospholipid, CC2-DMPE, which is attached to the outer leaflet of the plasma membrane and acts as a FRET donor. Changes in membrane potential (Vm) cause the negatively charged DiSBAC2(3) to redistribute across the plasma membrane and the amount of energy transfer from CC2-DMPE changes accordingly. The changes in fluorescence emission were monitored using VIPR™ II, which is an integrated liquid handler and fluorescent detector designed to conduct cell-based screens in 96- or 384-well microliter plates.


Identification of Correction Compounds

To identify small molecules that correct the trafficking defect associated with ΔF508-CFTR; a single-addition HTS assay format was developed. The cells were incubated in serum-free medium for 16 hrs at 37° C. in the presence or absence (negative control) of test compound. As a positive control, cells plated in 384-well plates were incubated for 16 hrs at 27° C. to “temperature-correct” ΔF508-CFTR. The cells were subsequently rinsed 3× with Krebs Ringers solution and loaded with the voltage-sensitive dyes. To activate ΔF508-CFTR, 10 μM forskolin and the CFTR potentiator, genistein (20 μM), were added along with Cl-free medium to each well. The addition of Cl-free medium promoted Cl efflux in response to ΔF508-CFTR activation and the resulting membrane depolarization was optically monitored using the FRET-based voltage-sensor dyes.


Identification of Potentiator Compounds

To identify potentiators of ΔF508-CFTR, a double-addition HTS assay format was developed. During the first addition, a Cl-free medium with or without test compound was added to each well. After 22 sec, a second addition of Cl-free medium containing 2-10 μM forskolin was added to activate ΔF508-CFTR. The extracellular Clconcentration following both additions was 28 mM, which promoted Clefflux in response to ΔF508-CFTR activation and the resulting membrane depolarization was optically monitored using the FRET-based voltage-sensor dyes.


Solutions

Bath Solution #1: (in mM) NaCl 160, KCl 4.5, CaCl2 2, MgCl2 1, HEPES 10, pH 7.4 with NaOH.


Chloride-free bath solution: Chloride salts in Bath Solution #1 (above) are substituted with gluconate salts.


CC2-DMPE: Prepared as a 10 mM stock solution in DMSO and stored at −20° C.


DiSBAC2(3): Prepared as a 10 mM stock in DMSO and stored at −20° C.


Cell Culture

NIH3T3 mouse fibroblasts stably expressing ΔF508-CFTR are used for optical measurements of membrane potential. The cells are maintained at 37° C. in 5% CO2 and 90% humidity in Dulbecco's modified Eagle's medium supplemented with 2 mM glutamine, 10% fetal bovine serum, 1×NEAA, β-ME, 1×pen/strep, and 25 mM HEPES in 175 cm2 culture flasks. For all optical assays, the cells were seeded at 30,000/well in 384-well matrigel-coated plates and cultured for 2 hrs at 37° C. before culturing at 27° C. for 24 hrs for the potentiator assay. For the correction assays, the cells are cultured at 27° C. or 37° C. with and without compounds for 16-24 hours.


Electrophysiological Assays for assaying ΔF508-CFTR modulation properties of compounds


Using Chamber Assay

Using chamber experiments were performed on polarized epithelial cells expressing ΔF508-CFTR to further characterize the ΔF508-CFTR modulators identified in the optical assays. FRTΔF508-CFTR epithelial cells grown on Costar Snapwell cell culture inserts were mounted in an Using chamber (Physiologic Instruments, Inc., San Diego, Calif.), and the monolayers were continuously short-circuited using a Voltage-clamp System (Department of Bioengineering, University of Iowa, Iowa, and, Physiologic Instruments, Inc., San Diego, Calif.). Transepithelial resistance was measured by applying a 2-mV pulse. Under these conditions, the FRT epithelia demonstrated resistances of 4 KW cm2 or more. The solutions were maintained at 27° C. and bubbled with air. The electrode offset potential and fluid resistance were corrected using a cell-free insert. Under these conditions, the current reflects the flow of Clthrough ΔF508-CFTR expressed in the apical membrane. The ISC was digitally acquired using an MP100A-CE interface and AcqKnowledge software (ν3.2.6; BIOPAC Systems, Santa Barbara, Calif.).


Identification of Correction Compounds

Typical protocol utilized a basolateral to apical membrane Cl concentration gradient. To set up this gradient, normal ringer was used on the basolateral membrane, whereas apical NaCl was replaced by equimolar sodium gluconate (titrated to pH 7.4 with NaOH) to give a large Clconcentration gradient across the epithelium. All experiments were performed with intact monolayers. To fully activate ΔF508-CFTR, forskolin (10 μM) and the PDE inhibitor, IBMX (100 μM), were applied followed by the addition of the CFTR potentiator, genistein (50 μM).


As observed in other cell types, incubation at low temperatures of FRT cells stably expressing ΔF508-CFTR increases the functional density of CFTR in the plasma membrane. To determine the activity of correction compounds, the cells were incubated with 10 μM of the test compound for 24 hours at 37° C. and were subsequently washed 3× prior to recording. The cAMP- and genistein-mediated ISC in compound-treated cells was normalized to the 27° C. and 37° C. controls and expressed as percentage activity. Preincubation of the cells with the correction compound significantly increased the cAMP- and genistein-mediated ISC compared to the 37° C. controls.


Identification of Potentiator Compounds

Typical protocol utilized a basolateral to apical membrane Clconcentration gradient. To set up this gradient, normal ringers was used on the basolateral membrane and was permeabilized with nystatin (360 μg/ml), whereas apical NaCl was replaced by equimolar sodium gluconate (titrated to pH 7.4 with NaOH) to give a large Clconcentration gradient across the epithelium. All experiments were performed 30 min after nystatin permeabilization. Forskolin (10 μM) and all test compounds were added to both sides of the cell culture inserts. The efficacy of the putative ΔF508-CFTR potentiators was compared to that of the known potentiator, genistein.


Solutions


Basolateral solution (in mM): NaCl (135), CaCl2 (1.2), MgCl2 (1.2), K2HPO4 (2.4), KHPO4 (0.6), N-2-hydroxyethylpiperazine-N′-2-ethanesulfonic acid (HEPES) (10), and dextrose (10). The solution was titrated to pH 7.4 with NaOH.


Apical solution (in mM): Same as basolateral solution with NaCl replaced with Na Gluconate (135).


Cell Culture

Fisher rat epithelial (FRT) cells expressing ΔF508-CFTR (FRTΔF508-CFTR) were used for Using chamber experiments for the putative ΔF508-CFTR modulators identified from our optical assays. The cells were cultured on Costar Snapwell cell culture inserts and cultured for five days at 37° C. and 5% CO2 in Coon's modified Ham's F-12 medium supplemented with 5% fetal calf serum, 100 U/ml penicillin, and 100 μg/ml streptomycin. Prior to use for characterizing the potentiator activity of compounds, the cells were incubated at 27° C. for 16-48 hrs to correct for the ΔF508-CFTR. To determine the activity of corrections compounds, the cells were incubated at 27° C. or 37° C. with and without the compounds for 24 hours.


Whole-Cell Recordings

The macroscopic ΔF508-CFTR current (IΔF508) in temperature- and test compound-corrected NIH3T3 cells stably expressing ΔF508-CFTR were monitored using the perforated-patch, whole-cell recording. Briefly, voltage-clamp recordings of IΔF508 were performed at room temperature using an Axopatch 200B patch-clamp amplifier (Axon Instruments Inc., Foster City, Calif.). All recordings were acquired at a sampling frequency of 10 kHz and low-pass filtered at 1 kHz. Pipettes had a resistance of 5-6 MΩ when filled with the intracellular solution. Under these recording conditions, the calculated reversal potential for Cl(ECl) at room temperature was −28 mV. All recordings had a seal resistance >20 GS and a series resistance <15 MΩ. Pulse generation, data acquisition, and analysis were performed using a PC equipped with a Digidata 1320 A/D interface in conjunction with Clampex 8 (Axon Instruments Inc.). The bath contained <250 μl of saline and was continuously perifused at a rate of 2 ml/min using a gravity-driven perfusion system,


Identification of Correction Compounds

To determine the activity of correction compounds for increasing the density of functional ΔF508-CFTR in the plasma membrane, we used the above-described perforated-patch-recording techniques to measure the current density following 24-hr treatment with the correction compounds. To fully activate ΔF508-CFTR, 10 μM forskolin and 20 μM genistein were added to the cells. Under our recording conditions, the current density following 24-hr incubation at 27° C. was higher than that observed following 24-hr incubation at 37° C. These results are consistent with the known effects of low-temperature incubation on the density of ΔF508-CFTR in the plasma membrane. To determine the effects of correction compounds on CFTR current density, the cells were incubated with 10 μM of the test compound for 24 hours at 37° C. and the current density was compared to the 27° C. and 37° C. controls (% activity). Prior to recording, the cells were washed 3× with extracellular recording medium to remove any remaining test compound. Preincubation with 10 μM of correction compounds significantly increased the cAMP- and genistein-dependent current compared to the 37° C. controls.


Identification of Potentiator Compounds

The ability of ΔF508-CFTR potentiators to increase the macroscopic ΔF508-CFTR Clcurrent (IΔF508) in NIH3T3 cells stably expressing ΔF508-CFTR was also investigated using perforated-patch-recording techniques. The potentiators identified from the optical assays evoked a dose-dependent increase in IΔF508 with similar potency and efficacy observed in the optical assays. In all cells examined, the reversal potential before and during potentiator application was around −30 mV, which is the calculated ECl (−28 mV).


Solutions

Intracellular solution (in mM): Cs-aspartate (90), CsCl (50), MgCl2 (1), HEPES (10), and 240 μg/ml amphotericin-B (pH adjusted to 7.35 with CsOH).


Extracellular solution (in mM): N-methyl-D-glucamine (NMDG)-Cl (150), MgCl2 (2), CaCl2 (2), HEPES (10) (pH adjusted to 7.35 with HCl).


Cell Culture

NIH3T3 mouse fibroblasts stably expressing ΔF508-CFTR are used for whole-cell recordings. The cells are maintained at 37° C. in 5% CO2 and 90% humidity in Dulbecco's modified Eagle's medium supplemented with 2 mM glutamine, 10% fetal bovine serum, 1×NEAA, β-ME, 1×pen/strep, and 25 mM HEPES in 175 cm2 culture flasks. For whole-cell recordings, 2,500-5,000 cells were seeded on poly-L-lysine-coated glass coverslips and cultured for 24-48 hrs at 27° C. before use to test the activity of potentiators; and incubated with or without the correction compound at 37° C. for measuring the activity of correctors.


Single-Channel Recordings

The single-channel activities of temperature-corrected ΔF508-CFTR stably expressed in NIH3T3 cells and activities of potentiator compounds were observed using excised inside-out membrane patch. Briefly, voltage-clamp recordings of single-channel activity were performed at room temperature with an Axopatch 200B patch-clamp amplifier (Axon Instruments Inc.). All recordings were acquired at a sampling frequency of 10 kHz and low-pass filtered at 400 Hz. Patch pipettes were fabricated from Corning Kovar Sealing #7052 glass (World Precision Instruments, Inc., Sarasota, Fla.) and had a resistance of 5-8 MS when filled with the extracellular solution. The ΔF508-CFTR was activated after excision, by adding 1 mM Mg-ATP, and 75 nM of the cAMP-dependent protein kinase, catalytic subunit (PKA; Promega Corp. Madison, Wis.). After channel activity stabilized, the patch was perifused using a gravity-driven microperfusion system. The inflow was placed adjacent to the patch, resulting in complete solution exchange within 1-2 sec. To maintain ΔF508-CFTR activity during the rapid perifusion, the nonspecific phosphatase inhibitor F (10 mM NaF) was added to the bath solution. Under these recording conditions, channel activity remained constant throughout the duration of the patch recording (up to 60 min) Currents produced by positive charge moving from the intra- to extracellular solutions (anions moving in the opposite direction) are shown as positive currents. The pipette potential (Vp) was maintained at 80 mV.


Channel activity was analyzed from membrane patches containing 2 active channels. The maximum number of simultaneous openings determined the number of active channels during the course of an experiment. To determine the single-channel current amplitude, the data recorded from 120 sec of ΔF508-CFTR activity was filtered “off-line” at 100 Hz and then used to construct all-point amplitude histograms that were fitted with multigaussian functions using Bio-Patch Analysis software (Bio-Logic Comp. France). The total microscopic current and open probability (Po) were determined from 120 sec of channel activity. The Po was determined using the Bio-Patch software or from the relationship Po=I/i(N), where I=mean current, i=single-channel current amplitude, and N=number of active channels in patch.


Solutions

Extracellular solution (in mM): NMDG (150), aspartic acid (150), CaCl2 (5), MgCl2 (2), and HEPES (10) (pH adjusted to 7.35 with Tris base).


Intracellular solution (in mM): NMDG-Cl (150), MgCl2 (2), EGTA (5), TES (10), and Tris base (14) (pH adjusted to 7.35 with HCl).


Cell Culture

NIH3T3 mouse fibroblasts stably expressing ΔF508-CFTR are used for excised-membrane patch-clamp recordings. The cells are maintained at 37° C. in 5% CO2 and 90% humidity in Dulbecco's modified Eagle's medium supplemented with 2 mM glutamine, 10% fetal bovine serum, 1×NEAA, β-ME, 1×pen/strep, and 25 mM HEPES in 175 cm2 culture flasks. For single channel recordings, 2,500-5,000 cells were seeded on poly-L-lysine-coated glass coverslips and cultured for 24-48 hrs at 27° C. before use.


Using the procedures described above, the activity, (EC50), of Compound 3 has been measured and is shown in Table 3-24.









TABLE 3-24







IC50/EC50 Bins: +++ <= 2.0 < ++ <= 5.0 < +


Percent Activity Bins:


+ <= 25.0 < ++ <= 100.0 < +++











Binned Max


Cmpd.
Binned EC50
Efficacy





Compound 3
+++
+++









Using the procedures described above, the activity, i.e., EC50s, of Compound 4 has been measured and is shown in Table 4-13.









TABLE 4-13







IC50/EC50 Bins: +++ <= 2.0 < ++ <= 5.0 < +


Percent Activity Bins:


+ <= 25.0 < ++ <= 100.0 < +++











Binned Max


Cmpd.
Binned EC50
Efficacy





Compound 4
+++
+++









Other Embodiments

All publications and patents referred to in this disclosure are incorporated herein by reference to the same extent as if each individual publication or patent application were specifically and individually indicated to be incorporated by reference. Should the meaning of the terms in any of the patents or publications incorporated by reference conflict with the meaning of the terms used in this disclosure, the meaning of the terms in this disclosure are intended to be controlling. Furthermore, the foregoing discussion discloses and describes merely exemplary embodiments of the present invention. One skilled in the art will readily recognize from such discussion and from the accompanying drawings and claims, that various changes, modifications and variations can be made therein without departing from the spirit and scope of the invention as defined in the following claims.

Claims
  • 1. A pharmaceutical composition comprising: A. A Compound of Formula I
  • 2. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 1, comprising a Compound of Formula I and Compound of Formula II.
  • 3. The pharmaceutical composition of any one of claims 1-2, comprising Compound 1 and Compound 2.
  • 4. The pharmaceutical composition of any one of claims 1-3, further comprising one or both of Compound 3 and/or Compound 4.
  • 5. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 4, comprising Compound 1, Compound 2, and Compound 3.
  • 6. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 1, comprising Compound 1, Compound 2, and Compound 4.
  • 7. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 4, comprising Compound 1, Compound 2, Compound 3 and Compound 4.
  • 8. A pharmaceutical composition comprising at least one component from Column A of Table I, at least one component from Column B of Table 1, and optionally an additional component from one or both of Column C and/or Column D
  • 9. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 8, wherein the Column A component is Compound 1, the Column B Component is Compound 2, and the third Component is any of the embodiments listed in Column C of Table I.
  • 10. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 8, wherein the Column A component is Compound 1, the Column B Component is Compound 2, and the third Component is any of the embodiments listed in Column D of Table I.
  • 11. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 8, wherein the Column A component is Compound 1, the Column B Component is Compound 2, the third component is any of the embodiments listed in Column C of Table I, and the fourth Component is any of the embodiments listed in Column D of Table I.
  • 12. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 8, wherein the Column A component is Compound 1, the Column B Component is Compound 2, and the third Component is Compound 3.
  • 13. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 8, wherein the Column A component is Compound 1, the Column B Component is Compound 2, and the third Component is Compound 4.
  • 14. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 8, wherein the Column A component is Compound 1, the Column B Component is Compound 2, the third component is Compound 3, and the fourth Component is Compound 4.
  • 15. A method of treating a CFTR mediated disease in a human comprising administering to the human an effective amount of a pharmaceutical composition according to any one of claims 1-14.
  • 16. The method of claim 15, wherein the CFTR mediated disease is selected from cystic fibrosis, asthma, smoke induced COPD, chronic bronchitis, rhinosinusitis, constipation, pancreatitis, pancreatic insufficiency, male infertility caused by congenital bilateral absence of the vas deferens (CBAVD), mild pulmonary disease, idiopathic pancreatitis, allergic bronchopulmonary aspergillosis (ABPA), liver disease, hereditary emphysema, hereditary hemochromatosis, coagulation-fibrinolysis deficiencies, such as protein C deficiency, Type 1 hereditary angioedema, lipid processing deficiencies, such as familial hypercholesterolemia, Type 1 chylomicronemia, abetalipoproteinemia, lysosomal storage diseases, such as I-cell disease/pseudo-Hurler, mucopolysaccharidoses, Sandhof/Tay-Sachs, Crigler-Najjar type II, polyendocrinopathy/hyperinsulemia, Diabetes mellitus, Laron dwarfism, myleoperoxidase deficiency, primary hypoparathyroidism, melanoma, glycanosis CDG type 1, congenital hyperthyroidism, osteogenesis imperfecta, hereditary hypofibrinogenemia, ACT deficiency, Diabetes insipidus (DI), neurophyseal DI, neprogenic DI, Charcot-Marie Tooth syndrome, Perlizaeus-Merzbacher disease, neurodegenerative diseases such as Alzheimer's disease, Parkinson's disease, amyotrophic lateral sclerosis, progressive supranuclear plasy, Pick's disease, several polyglutamine neurological disorders such as Huntington's, spinocerebullar ataxia type I, spinal and bulbar muscular atrophy, dentatorubal pallidoluysian, and myotonic dystrophy, as well as spongiform encephalopathies, such as hereditary Creutzfeldt-Jakob disease (due to prion protein processing defect), Fabry disease, Straussler-Scheinker syndrome, COPD, dry-eye disease, or Sjogren's disease, Osteoporosis, Osteopenia, bone healing and bone growth (including bone repair, bone regeneration, reducing bone resorption and increasing bone deposition), Gorham's Syndrome, chloride channelopathies such as myotonia congenita (Thomson and Becker forms), Bartter's syndrome type III, Dent's disease, hyperekplexia, epilepsy, lysosomal storage disease, Angelman syndrome, and Primary Ciliary Dyskinesia (PCD), a term for inherited disorders of the structure and/or function of cilia, including PCD with situs inversus (also known as Kartagener syndrome), PCD without situs inversus and ciliary aplasia.
  • 17. The method of any one of claims 15-16, wherein the CFTR mediated disease is cystic fibrosis, COPD, emphysema, dry-eye disease or osteoporosis.
  • 18. The method of any one of claims 15-17, wherein the CFTR mediated disease is cystic fibrosis.
  • 19. The method according to any one of claims 15-18, wherein the patient possesses one or more of the following mutations of human CFTR: ΔF508, R117H, and G551D.
  • 20. The method according to any one of claims 15-19, wherein the method includes treating or lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the ΔF508 mutation of human CFTR.
  • 21. The method according to any one of claims 15-20, wherein the method includes treating or lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the G551D mutation of human CFTR.
  • 22. The method according to any one of claims 15-21, wherein the method includes treating or lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the ΔF508 mutation of human CFTR on at least one allele.
  • 23. The method according to any one of claims 15-22, wherein the method includes treating or lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the ΔF508 mutation of human CFTR on both alleles.
  • 24. The method according to any one of claims 15-23, wherein the method includes treating or lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the G551D mutation of human CFTR on at least one allele.
  • 25. The method according to any one of claims 15-24, wherein the method includes treating or lessening the severity of cystic fibrosis in a patient possessing the G551D mutation of human CFTR on both alleles.
  • 26. A kit for use in measuring the activity of a CFTR or a fragment thereof in a biological sample in vitro or in vivo, comprising: (i) a pharmaceutical composition according to any one of claims 1-14;(ii) instructions for: a) contacting the composition with the biological sample;b) measuring activity of said CFTR or a fragment thereof.
  • 27. The kit of claim 26, further comprising instructions for a) contacting an additional compound with the biological sample;b) measuring the activity of said CFTR or a fragment thereof in the presence of said additional compound, andc) comparing the activity of said CFTR or fragment thereof in the presence of said additional compound with the activity of the CFTR or fragment thereof in the presence of a pharmaceutical composition according to any one of claims 1-14.
  • 28. The kit of claim 27, wherein the step of comparing the activity of said CFTR or fragment thereof provides a measure of the density of said CFTR or fragment thereof.
PRIORITY CLAIM

This application claims priority to U.S. provisional application Ser. No. 61/327,099, filed on Apr. 22, 2010, and to U.S. provisional application Ser. No. 61/329,500, filed on Apr. 29, 2010. The entire contents of both priority applications are incorporated by reference.

Related Publications (1)
Number Date Country
20150164883 A1 Jun 2015 US
Continuations (1)
Number Date Country
Parent 13657345 Oct 2012 US
Child 14630778 US